4 @setfilename ../../info/org
5 @settitle The Org Manual
8 @set DATE November 2010
10 @c Use proper quote and backtick for code sections in PDF output
11 @c Cf. Texinfo manual 14.2
12 @set txicodequoteundirected
13 @set txicodequotebacktick
15 @c Version and Contact Info
16 @set MAINTAINERSITE @uref{http://orgmode.org,maintainers webpage}
17 @set AUTHOR Carsten Dominik
18 @set MAINTAINER Carsten Dominik
19 @set MAINTAINEREMAIL @email{carsten at orgmode dot org}
20 @set MAINTAINERCONTACT @uref{mailto:carsten at orgmode dot org,contact the maintainer}
25 @c -----------------------------------------------------------------------------
27 @c Macro definitions for commands and keys
28 @c =======================================
30 @c The behavior of the key/command macros will depend on the flag cmdnames
31 @c When set, commands names are shown. When clear, they are not shown.
35 @c Below we define the following macros for Org key tables:
37 @c orgkey{key} A key item
38 @c orgcmd{key,cmd} Key with command name
39 @c xorgcmd{key,cmmand} Key with command name as @itemx
40 @c orgcmdnki{key,cmd} Like orgcmd, but do not index the key
41 @c orgcmdtkc{text,key,cmd} Like orgcmd,special text instead of key
42 @c orgcmdkkc{key1,key2,cmd} Two keys with one command name, use "or"
43 @c orgcmdkxkc{key1,key2,cmd} Two keys with one command name, but
44 @c different functions, so format as @itemx
45 @c orgcmdkskc{key1,key2,cmd} Same as orgcmdkkc, but use "or short"
46 @c xorgcmdkskc{key1,key2,cmd} Same as previous, but use @itemx
47 @c orgcmdkkcc{key1,key2,cmd1,cmd2} Two keys and two commands
49 @c a key but no command
61 @c one key with a command
62 @c Inserts: @item KEY COMMAND
63 @macro orgcmd{key,command}
68 @item @kbd{\key\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
71 @item @kbd{\key\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
80 @c One key with one command, formatted using @itemx
81 @c Inserts: @itemx KEY COMMAND
82 @macro xorgcmd{key,command}
87 @itemx @kbd{\key\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
90 @itemx @kbd{\key\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
99 @c one key with a command, bit do not index the key
100 @c Inserts: @item KEY COMMAND
101 @macro orgcmdnki{key,command}
105 @item @kbd{\key\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
108 @item @kbd{\key\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
116 @c one key with a command, and special text to replace key in item
117 @c Inserts: @item TEXT COMMAND
118 @macro orgcmdtkc{text,key,command}
123 @item @kbd{\text\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
126 @item @kbd{\text\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
135 @c two keys with one command
136 @c Inserts: @item KEY1 or KEY2 COMMAND
137 @macro orgcmdkkc{key1,key2,command}
143 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or} @ @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
146 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or} @ @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
152 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or} @ @kbd{\key2\}
156 @c Two keys with one command name, but different functions, so format as
158 @c Inserts: @item KEY1
159 @c @itemx KEY2 COMMAND
160 @macro orgcmdkxkc{key1,key2,command}
167 @itemx @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
171 @itemx @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
182 @c Same as previous, but use "or short"
183 @c Inserts: @item KEY1 or short KEY2 COMMAND
184 @macro orgcmdkskc{key1,key2,command}
190 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
193 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
199 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\}
203 @c Same as previous, but use @itemx
204 @c Inserts: @itemx KEY1 or short KEY2 COMMAND
205 @macro xorgcmdkskc{key1,key2,command}
211 @itemx @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
214 @itemx @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
220 @itemx @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\}
224 @c two keys with two commands
225 @c Inserts: @item KEY1 COMMAND1
226 @c @itemx KEY2 COMMAND2
227 @macro orgcmdkkcc{key1,key2,command1,command2}
234 @item @kbd{\key1\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command1\}
235 @itemx @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command2\}
238 @item @kbd{\key1\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command1\})
239 @itemx @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command2\})
249 @c -----------------------------------------------------------------------------
252 @c @hyphenation{time-stamp time-stamps time-stamp-ing time-stamp-ed}
255 @c Subheadings inside a table.
256 @macro tsubheading{text}
258 @subsubheading \text\
266 This manual is for Org version @value{VERSION}.
268 Copyright @copyright{} 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010
269 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
272 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
273 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
274 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
275 Invariant Sections, with the Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
276 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below. A copy of the license
277 is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License.''
279 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have the freedom to copy and
280 modify this GNU manual. Buying copies from the FSF supports it in
281 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
283 This document is part of a collection distributed under the GNU Free
284 Documentation License. If you want to distribute this document
285 separately from the collection, you can do so by adding a copy of the
286 license to the document, as described in section 6 of the license.
292 * Org Mode: (org). Outline-based notes management and organizer
296 @title The Org Manual
298 @subtitle Release @value{VERSION}
299 @author by Carsten Dominik
300 with contributions by David O'Toole, Bastien Guerry, Philip Rooke, Dan Davison, Eric Schulte, and Thomas Dye
302 @c The following two commands start the copyright page.
304 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
308 @c Output the table of contents at the beginning.
312 @node Top, Introduction, (dir), (dir)
319 * Introduction:: Getting started
320 * Document Structure:: A tree works like your brain
321 * Tables:: Pure magic for quick formatting
322 * Hyperlinks:: Notes in context
323 * TODO Items:: Every tree branch can be a TODO item
324 * Tags:: Tagging headlines and matching sets of tags
325 * Properties and Columns:: Storing information about an entry
326 * Dates and Times:: Making items useful for planning
327 * Capture - Refile - Archive:: The ins and outs for projects
328 * Agenda Views:: Collecting information into views
329 * Markup:: Prepare text for rich export
330 * Exporting:: Sharing and publishing of notes
331 * Publishing:: Create a web site of linked Org files
332 * Working With Source Code:: Export, evaluate, and tangle code blocks
333 * Miscellaneous:: All the rest which did not fit elsewhere
334 * Hacking:: How to hack your way around
335 * MobileOrg:: Viewing and capture on a mobile device
336 * History and Acknowledgments:: How Org came into being
337 * Main Index:: An index of Org's concepts and features
338 * Key Index:: Key bindings and where they are described
339 * Command and Function Index:: Command names and some internal functions
340 * Variable Index:: Variables mentioned in the manual
343 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
347 * Summary:: Brief summary of what Org does
348 * Installation:: How to install a downloaded version of Org
349 * Activation:: How to activate Org for certain buffers
350 * Feedback:: Bug reports, ideas, patches etc.
351 * Conventions:: Type-setting conventions in the manual
355 * Outlines:: Org is based on Outline mode
356 * Headlines:: How to typeset Org tree headlines
357 * Visibility cycling:: Show and hide, much simplified
358 * Motion:: Jumping to other headlines
359 * Structure editing:: Changing sequence and level of headlines
360 * Sparse trees:: Matches embedded in context
361 * Plain lists:: Additional structure within an entry
362 * Drawers:: Tucking stuff away
363 * Blocks:: Folding blocks
364 * Footnotes:: How footnotes are defined in Org's syntax
365 * Orgstruct mode:: Structure editing outside Org
369 * Built-in table editor:: Simple tables
370 * Column width and alignment:: Overrule the automatic settings
371 * Column groups:: Grouping to trigger vertical lines
372 * Orgtbl mode:: The table editor as minor mode
373 * The spreadsheet:: The table editor has spreadsheet capabilities
374 * Org-Plot:: Plotting from org tables
378 * References:: How to refer to another field or range
379 * Formula syntax for Calc:: Using Calc to compute stuff
380 * Formula syntax for Lisp:: Writing formulas in Emacs Lisp
381 * Field formulas:: Formulas valid for a single field
382 * Column formulas:: Formulas valid for an entire column
383 * Editing and debugging formulas:: Fixing formulas
384 * Updating the table:: Recomputing all dependent fields
385 * Advanced features:: Field names, parameters and automatic recalc
389 * Link format:: How links in Org are formatted
390 * Internal links:: Links to other places in the current file
391 * External links:: URL-like links to the world
392 * Handling links:: Creating, inserting and following
393 * Using links outside Org:: Linking from my C source code?
394 * Link abbreviations:: Shortcuts for writing complex links
395 * Search options:: Linking to a specific location
396 * Custom searches:: When the default search is not enough
400 * Radio targets:: Make targets trigger links in plain text
404 * TODO basics:: Marking and displaying TODO entries
405 * TODO extensions:: Workflow and assignments
406 * Progress logging:: Dates and notes for progress
407 * Priorities:: Some things are more important than others
408 * Breaking down tasks:: Splitting a task into manageable pieces
409 * Checkboxes:: Tick-off lists
411 Extended use of TODO keywords
413 * Workflow states:: From TODO to DONE in steps
414 * TODO types:: I do this, Fred does the rest
415 * Multiple sets in one file:: Mixing it all, and still finding your way
416 * Fast access to TODO states:: Single letter selection of a state
417 * Per-file keywords:: Different files, different requirements
418 * Faces for TODO keywords:: Highlighting states
419 * TODO dependencies:: When one task needs to wait for others
423 * Closing items:: When was this entry marked DONE?
424 * Tracking TODO state changes:: When did the status change?
425 * Tracking your habits:: How consistent have you been?
429 * Tag inheritance:: Tags use the tree structure of the outline
430 * Setting tags:: How to assign tags to a headline
431 * Tag searches:: Searching for combinations of tags
433 Properties and columns
435 * Property syntax:: How properties are spelled out
436 * Special properties:: Access to other Org-mode features
437 * Property searches:: Matching property values
438 * Property inheritance:: Passing values down the tree
439 * Column view:: Tabular viewing and editing
440 * Property API:: Properties for Lisp programmers
444 * Defining columns:: The COLUMNS format property
445 * Using column view:: How to create and use column view
446 * Capturing column view:: A dynamic block for column view
450 * Scope of column definitions:: Where defined, where valid?
451 * Column attributes:: Appearance and content of a column
455 * Timestamps:: Assigning a time to a tree entry
456 * Creating timestamps:: Commands which insert timestamps
457 * Deadlines and scheduling:: Planning your work
458 * Clocking work time:: Tracking how long you spend on a task
459 * Effort estimates:: Planning work effort in advance
460 * Relative timer:: Notes with a running timer
461 * Countdown timer:: Starting a countdown timer for a task
465 * The date/time prompt:: How Org-mode helps you entering date and time
466 * Custom time format:: Making dates look different
468 Deadlines and scheduling
470 * Inserting deadline/schedule:: Planning items
471 * Repeated tasks:: Items that show up again and again
475 * Clocking commands:: Starting and stopping a clock
476 * The clock table:: Detailed reports
477 * Resolving idle time:: Resolving time when you've been idle
479 Capture - Refile - Archive
481 * Capture:: Capturing new stuff
482 * Attachments:: Add files to tasks
483 * RSS Feeds:: Getting input from RSS feeds
484 * Protocols:: External (e.g. Browser) access to Emacs and Org
485 * Refiling notes:: Moving a tree from one place to another
486 * Archiving:: What to do with finished projects
490 * Setting up capture:: Where notes will be stored
491 * Using capture:: Commands to invoke and terminate capture
492 * Capture templates:: Define the outline of different note types
496 * Template elements:: What is needed for a complete template entry
497 * Template expansion:: Filling in information about time and context
501 * Moving subtrees:: Moving a tree to an archive file
502 * Internal archiving:: Switch off a tree but keep it in the file
506 * Agenda files:: Files being searched for agenda information
507 * Agenda dispatcher:: Keyboard access to agenda views
508 * Built-in agenda views:: What is available out of the box?
509 * Presentation and sorting:: How agenda items are prepared for display
510 * Agenda commands:: Remote editing of Org trees
511 * Custom agenda views:: Defining special searches and views
512 * Exporting Agenda Views:: Writing a view to a file
513 * Agenda column view:: Using column view for collected entries
515 The built-in agenda views
517 * Weekly/daily agenda:: The calendar page with current tasks
518 * Global TODO list:: All unfinished action items
519 * Matching tags and properties:: Structured information with fine-tuned search
520 * Timeline:: Time-sorted view for single file
521 * Search view:: Find entries by searching for text
522 * Stuck projects:: Find projects you need to review
524 Presentation and sorting
526 * Categories:: Not all tasks are equal
527 * Time-of-day specifications:: How the agenda knows the time
528 * Sorting of agenda items:: The order of things
532 * Storing searches:: Type once, use often
533 * Block agenda:: All the stuff you need in a single buffer
534 * Setting Options:: Changing the rules
536 Markup for rich export
538 * Structural markup elements:: The basic structure as seen by the exporter
539 * Images and tables:: Tables and Images will be included
540 * Literal examples:: Source code examples with special formatting
541 * Include files:: Include additional files into a document
542 * Index entries:: Making an index
543 * Macro replacement:: Use macros to create complex output
544 * Embedded LaTeX:: LaTeX can be freely used inside Org documents
546 Structural markup elements
548 * Document title:: Where the title is taken from
549 * Headings and sections:: The document structure as seen by the exporter
550 * Table of contents:: The if and where of the table of contents
551 * Initial text:: Text before the first heading?
553 * Paragraphs:: Paragraphs
554 * Footnote markup:: Footnotes
555 * Emphasis and monospace:: Bold, italic, etc.
556 * Horizontal rules:: Make a line
557 * Comment lines:: What will *not* be exported
561 * Special symbols:: Greek letters and other symbols
562 * Subscripts and superscripts:: Simple syntax for raising/lowering text
563 * LaTeX fragments:: Complex formulas made easy
564 * Previewing LaTeX fragments:: What will this snippet look like?
565 * CDLaTeX mode:: Speed up entering of formulas
569 * Selective export:: Using tags to select and exclude trees
570 * Export options:: Per-file export settings
571 * The export dispatcher:: How to access exporter commands
572 * ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export:: Exporting to flat files with encoding
573 * HTML export:: Exporting to HTML
574 * LaTeX and PDF export:: Exporting to La@TeX{}, and processing to PDF
575 * DocBook export:: Exporting to DocBook
576 * TaskJuggler export:: Exporting to TaskJuggler
577 * Freemind export:: Exporting to Freemind mind maps
578 * XOXO export:: Exporting to XOXO
579 * iCalendar export:: Exporting in iCalendar format
583 * HTML Export commands:: How to invoke HTML export
584 * Quoting HTML tags:: Using direct HTML in Org-mode
585 * Links in HTML export:: How links will be interpreted and formatted
586 * Tables in HTML export:: How to modify the formatting of tables
587 * Images in HTML export:: How to insert figures into HTML output
588 * Math formatting in HTML export:: Beautiful math also on the web
589 * Text areas in HTML export:: An alternative way to show an example
590 * CSS support:: Changing the appearance of the output
591 * JavaScript support:: Info and Folding in a web browser
593 La@TeX{} and PDF export
595 * LaTeX/PDF export commands:: Which key invokes which commands
596 * Header and sectioning:: Setting up the export file structure
597 * Quoting LaTeX code:: Incorporating literal La@TeX{} code
598 * Tables in LaTeX export:: Options for exporting tables to La@TeX{}
599 * Images in LaTeX export:: How to insert figures into La@TeX{} output
600 * Beamer class export:: Turning the file into a presentation
604 * DocBook export commands:: How to invoke DocBook export
605 * Quoting DocBook code:: Incorporating DocBook code in Org files
606 * Recursive sections:: Recursive sections in DocBook
607 * Tables in DocBook export:: Tables are exported as HTML tables
608 * Images in DocBook export:: How to insert figures into DocBook output
609 * Special characters:: How to handle special characters
613 * Configuration:: Defining projects
614 * Uploading files:: How to get files up on the server
615 * Sample configuration:: Example projects
616 * Triggering publication:: Publication commands
620 * Project alist:: The central configuration variable
621 * Sources and destinations:: From here to there
622 * Selecting files:: What files are part of the project?
623 * Publishing action:: Setting the function doing the publishing
624 * Publishing options:: Tweaking HTML export
625 * Publishing links:: Which links keep working after publishing?
626 * Sitemap:: Generating a list of all pages
627 * Generating an index:: An index that reaches across pages
631 * Simple example:: One-component publishing
632 * Complex example:: A multi-component publishing example
634 Working with source code
636 * Structure of code blocks:: Code block syntax described
637 * Editing source code:: Language major-mode editing
638 * Exporting code blocks:: Export contents and/or results
639 * Extracting source code:: Create pure source code files
640 * Evaluating code blocks:: Place results of evaluation in the Org-mode buffer
641 * Library of Babel:: Use and contribute to a library of useful code blocks
642 * Languages:: List of supported code block languages
643 * Header arguments:: Configure code block functionality
644 * Results of evaluation:: How evaluation results are handled
645 * Noweb reference syntax:: Literate programming in Org-mode
646 * Key bindings and useful functions:: Work quickly with code blocks
647 * Batch execution:: Call functions from the command line
651 * Using header arguments:: Different ways to set header arguments
652 * Specific header arguments:: List of header arguments
654 Using header arguments
656 * System-wide header arguments:: Set global default values
657 * Language-specific header arguments:: Set default values by language
658 * Buffer-wide header arguments:: Set default values for a specific buffer
659 * Header arguments in Org-mode properties:: Set default values for a buffer or heading
660 * Code block specific header arguments:: The most common way to set values
661 * Header arguments in function calls:: The most specific level
663 Specific header arguments
665 * var:: Pass arguments to code blocks
666 * results:: Specify the type of results and how they will
667 be collected and handled
668 * file:: Specify a path for file output
669 * dir:: Specify the default (possibly remote)
670 directory for code block execution
671 * exports:: Export code and/or results
672 * tangle:: Toggle tangling and specify file name
673 * comments:: Toggle insertion of comments in tangled
675 * no-expand:: Turn off variable assignment and noweb
676 expansion during tangling
677 * session:: Preserve the state of code evaluation
678 * noweb:: Toggle expansion of noweb references
679 * cache:: Avoid re-evaluating unchanged code blocks
680 * hlines:: Handle horizontal lines in tables
681 * colnames:: Handle column names in tables
682 * rownames:: Handle row names in tables
683 * shebang:: Make tangled files executable
684 * eval:: Limit evaluation of specific code blocks
688 * Completion:: M-TAB knows what you need
689 * Easy Templates:: Quick insertion of structural elements
690 * Speed keys:: Electric commands at the beginning of a headline
691 * Code evaluation security:: Org mode files evaluate inline code
692 * Customization:: Adapting Org to your taste
693 * In-buffer settings:: Overview of the #+KEYWORDS
694 * The very busy C-c C-c key:: When in doubt, press C-c C-c
695 * Clean view:: Getting rid of leading stars in the outline
696 * TTY keys:: Using Org on a tty
697 * Interaction:: Other Emacs packages
699 Interaction with other packages
701 * Cooperation:: Packages Org cooperates with
702 * Conflicts:: Packages that lead to conflicts
706 * Hooks:: Who to reach into Org's internals
707 * Add-on packages:: Available extensions
708 * Adding hyperlink types:: New custom link types
709 * Context-sensitive commands:: How to add functionality to such commands
710 * Tables in arbitrary syntax:: Orgtbl for La@TeX{} and other programs
711 * Dynamic blocks:: Automatically filled blocks
712 * Special agenda views:: Customized views
713 * Extracting agenda information:: Postprocessing of agenda information
714 * Using the property API:: Writing programs that use entry properties
715 * Using the mapping API:: Mapping over all or selected entries
717 Tables and lists in arbitrary syntax
719 * Radio tables:: Sending and receiving radio tables
720 * A LaTeX example:: Step by step, almost a tutorial
721 * Translator functions:: Copy and modify
722 * Radio lists:: Doing the same for lists
726 * Setting up the staging area:: Where to interact with the mobile device
727 * Pushing to MobileOrg:: Uploading Org files and agendas
728 * Pulling from MobileOrg:: Integrating captured and flagged items
733 @node Introduction, Document Structure, Top, Top
734 @chapter Introduction
738 * Summary:: Brief summary of what Org does
739 * Installation:: How to install a downloaded version of Org
740 * Activation:: How to activate Org for certain buffers
741 * Feedback:: Bug reports, ideas, patches etc.
742 * Conventions:: Type-setting conventions in the manual
745 @node Summary, Installation, Introduction, Introduction
749 Org is a mode for keeping notes, maintaining TODO lists, and doing
750 project planning with a fast and effective plain-text system.
752 Org develops organizational tasks around NOTES files that contain
753 lists or information about projects as plain text. Org is
754 implemented on top of Outline mode, which makes it possible to keep the
755 content of large files well structured. Visibility cycling and
756 structure editing help to work with the tree. Tables are easily created
757 with a built-in table editor. Org supports TODO items, deadlines,
758 timestamps, and scheduling. It dynamically compiles entries into an
759 agenda that utilizes and smoothly integrates much of the Emacs calendar
760 and diary. Plain text URL-like links connect to websites, emails,
761 Usenet messages, BBDB entries, and any files related to the projects.
762 For printing and sharing of notes, an Org file can be exported as a
763 structured ASCII file, as HTML, or (TODO and agenda items only) as an
764 iCalendar file. It can also serve as a publishing tool for a set of
767 As a project planning environment, Org works by adding metadata to outline
768 nodes. Based on this data, specific entries can be extracted in queries and
769 create dynamic @i{agenda views}.
771 Org mode contains the Org Babel environment which allows to work with
772 embedded source code block in a file, to facilitate code evaluation,
773 documentation, and tangling.
775 Org's automatic, context-sensitive table editor with spreadsheet
776 capabilities can be integrated into any major mode by activating the
777 minor Orgtbl mode. Using a translation step, it can be used to maintain
778 tables in arbitrary file types, for example in La@TeX{}. The structure
779 editing and list creation capabilities can be used outside Org with
780 the minor Orgstruct mode.
782 Org keeps simple things simple. When first fired up, it should
783 feel like a straightforward, easy to use outliner. Complexity is not
784 imposed, but a large amount of functionality is available when you need
785 it. Org is a toolbox and can be used in different ways and for different
789 @r{@bullet{} an outline extension with visibility cycling and structure editing}
790 @r{@bullet{} an ASCII system and table editor for taking structured notes}
791 @r{@bullet{} a TODO list editor}
792 @r{@bullet{} a full agenda and planner with deadlines and work scheduling}
793 @pindex GTD, Getting Things Done
794 @r{@bullet{} an environment in which to implement David Allen's GTD system}
795 @r{@bullet{} a simple hypertext system, with HTML and La@TeX{} export}
796 @r{@bullet{} a publishing tool to create a set of interlinked webpages}
797 @r{@bullet{} an environment for literate programming}
802 There is a website for Org which provides links to the newest
803 version of Org, as well as additional information, frequently asked
804 questions (FAQ), links to tutorials, etc@. This page is located at
805 @uref{http://orgmode.org}.
810 @node Installation, Activation, Summary, Introduction
811 @section Installation
815 @b{Important:} @i{If you are using a version of Org that is part of the Emacs
816 distribution or an XEmacs package, please skip this section and go directly
817 to @ref{Activation}.}
819 If you have downloaded Org from the Web, either as a distribution @file{.zip}
820 or @file{.tar} file, or as a Git archive, you must take the following steps
821 to install it: go into the unpacked Org distribution directory and edit the
822 top section of the file @file{Makefile}. You must set the name of the Emacs
823 binary (likely either @file{emacs} or @file{xemacs}), and the paths to the
824 directories where local Lisp and Info files are kept. If you don't have
825 access to the system-wide directories, you can simply run Org directly from
826 the distribution directory by adding the @file{lisp} subdirectory to the
827 Emacs load path. To do this, add the following line to @file{.emacs}:
830 (setq load-path (cons "~/path/to/orgdir/lisp" load-path))
834 If you plan to use code from the @file{contrib} subdirectory, do a similar
835 step for this directory:
838 (setq load-path (cons "~/path/to/orgdir/contrib/lisp" load-path))
841 @noindent Now byte-compile the Lisp files with the shell command:
847 @noindent If you are running Org from the distribution directory, this is
848 all. If you want to install Org into the system directories, use (as
855 Installing Info files is system dependent, because of differences in the
856 @file{install-info} program. In Debian it copies the info files into the
857 correct directory and modifies the info directory file. In many other
858 systems, the files need to be copied to the correct directory separately, and
859 @file{install-info} then only modifies the directory file. Check your system
860 documentation to find out which of the following commands you need:
864 make install-info-debian
867 Then add the following line to @file{.emacs}. It is needed so that
868 Emacs can autoload functions that are located in files not immediately loaded
869 when Org-mode starts.
871 (require 'org-install)
874 Do not forget to activate Org as described in the following section.
877 @node Activation, Feedback, Installation, Introduction
881 @cindex global key bindings
882 @cindex key bindings, global
884 Add the following lines to your @file{.emacs} file. The last three lines
885 define @emph{global} keys for the commands @command{org-store-link},
886 @command{org-agenda}, and @command{org-iswitchb}---please choose suitable
890 ;; The following lines are always needed. Choose your own keys.
891 (add-to-list 'auto-mode-alist '("\\.org\\'" . org-mode))
892 (global-set-key "\C-cl" 'org-store-link)
893 (global-set-key "\C-ca" 'org-agenda)
894 (global-set-key "\C-cb" 'org-iswitchb)
897 Furthermore, you must activate @code{font-lock-mode} in Org
898 buffers, because significant functionality depends on font-locking being
899 active. You can do this with either one of the following two lines
900 (XEmacs users must use the second option):
902 (global-font-lock-mode 1) ; for all buffers
903 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook 'turn-on-font-lock) ; Org buffers only
906 @cindex Org-mode, turning on
907 With this setup, all files with extension @samp{.org} will be put
908 into Org-mode. As an alternative, make the first line of a file look
912 MY PROJECTS -*- mode: org; -*-
915 @vindex org-insert-mode-line-in-empty-file
916 @noindent which will select Org-mode for this buffer no matter what
917 the file's name is. See also the variable
918 @code{org-insert-mode-line-in-empty-file}.
920 Many commands in Org work on the region if the region is @i{active}. To make
921 use of this, you need to have @code{transient-mark-mode}
922 (@code{zmacs-regions} in XEmacs) turned on. In Emacs 23 this is the default,
923 in Emacs 22 you need to do this yourself with
925 (transient-mark-mode 1)
927 @noindent If you do not like @code{transient-mark-mode}, you can create an
928 active region by using the mouse to select a region, or pressing
929 @kbd{C-@key{SPC}} twice before moving the cursor.
931 @node Feedback, Conventions, Activation, Introduction
938 If you find problems with Org, or if you have questions, remarks, or ideas
939 about it, please mail to the Org mailing list @email{emacs-orgmode@@gnu.org}.
940 If you are not a member of the mailing list, your mail will be passed to the
941 list after a moderator has approved it@footnote{Please consider subscribing
942 to the mailing list, in order to minimize the work the mailing list
943 moderators have to do.}.
945 For bug reports, please first try to reproduce the bug with the latest
946 version of Org available - if you are running an outdated version, it is
947 quite possible that the bug has been fixed already. If the bug persists,
948 prepare a report and provide as much information as possible, including the
949 version information of Emacs (@kbd{M-x emacs-version @key{RET}}) and Org
950 (@kbd{M-x org-version @key{RET}}), as well as the Org related setup in
951 @file{.emacs}. The easiest way to do this is to use the command
953 @kbd{M-x org-submit-bug-report}
955 @noindent which will put all this information into an Emacs mail buffer so
956 that you only need to add your description. If you re not sending the Email
957 from within Emacs, please copy and paste the content into your Email program.
959 If an error occurs, a backtrace can be very useful (see below on how to
960 create one). Often a small example file helps, along with clear information
964 @item What exactly did you do?
965 @item What did you expect to happen?
966 @item What happened instead?
968 @noindent Thank you for helping to improve this program.
970 @subsubheading How to create a useful backtrace
972 @cindex backtrace of an error
973 If working with Org produces an error with a message you don't
974 understand, you may have hit a bug. The best way to report this is by
975 providing, in addition to what was mentioned above, a @emph{backtrace}.
976 This is information from the built-in debugger about where and how the
977 error occurred. Here is how to produce a useful backtrace:
981 Reload uncompiled versions of all Org-mode Lisp files. The backtrace
982 contains much more information if it is produced with uncompiled code.
985 C-u M-x org-reload RET
988 or select @code{Org -> Refresh/Reload -> Reload Org uncompiled} from the
991 Go to the @code{Options} menu and select @code{Enter Debugger on Error}
992 (XEmacs has this option in the @code{Troubleshooting} sub-menu).
994 Do whatever you have to do to hit the error. Don't forget to
995 document the steps you take.
997 When you hit the error, a @file{*Backtrace*} buffer will appear on the
998 screen. Save this buffer to a file (for example using @kbd{C-x C-w}) and
999 attach it to your bug report.
1002 @node Conventions, , Feedback, Introduction
1003 @section Typesetting conventions used in this manual
1005 Org uses three types of keywords: TODO keywords, tags, and property
1006 names. In this manual we use the following conventions:
1011 TODO keywords are written with all capitals, even if they are
1015 User-defined tags are written in lowercase; built-in tags with special
1016 meaning are written with all capitals.
1019 User-defined properties are capitalized; built-in properties with
1020 special meaning are written with all capitals.
1023 The manual lists both the keys and the corresponding commands for accessing
1024 functionality. Org mode often uses the same key for different functions,
1025 depending on context. The command that is bound to such keys has a generic
1026 name, like @code{org-metaright}. In the manual we will, wherever possible,
1027 give the function that is internally called by the generic command. For
1028 example, in the chapter on document structure, @kbd{M-@key{right}} will be
1029 listed to call @code{org-do-demote}, while in the chapter on tables, it will
1030 be listed to call org-table-move-column-right.
1032 If you prefer, you can compile the manual without the command names by
1033 unsetting the flag @code{cmdnames} in @file{org.texi}.
1035 @node Document Structure, Tables, Introduction, Top
1036 @chapter Document structure
1037 @cindex document structure
1038 @cindex structure of document
1040 Org is based on Outline mode and provides flexible commands to
1041 edit the structure of the document.
1044 * Outlines:: Org is based on Outline mode
1045 * Headlines:: How to typeset Org tree headlines
1046 * Visibility cycling:: Show and hide, much simplified
1047 * Motion:: Jumping to other headlines
1048 * Structure editing:: Changing sequence and level of headlines
1049 * Sparse trees:: Matches embedded in context
1050 * Plain lists:: Additional structure within an entry
1051 * Drawers:: Tucking stuff away
1052 * Blocks:: Folding blocks
1053 * Footnotes:: How footnotes are defined in Org's syntax
1054 * Orgstruct mode:: Structure editing outside Org
1057 @node Outlines, Headlines, Document Structure, Document Structure
1060 @cindex Outline mode
1062 Org is implemented on top of Outline mode. Outlines allow a
1063 document to be organized in a hierarchical structure, which (at least
1064 for me) is the best representation of notes and thoughts. An overview
1065 of this structure is achieved by folding (hiding) large parts of the
1066 document to show only the general document structure and the parts
1067 currently being worked on. Org greatly simplifies the use of
1068 outlines by compressing the entire show/hide functionality into a single
1069 command, @command{org-cycle}, which is bound to the @key{TAB} key.
1071 @node Headlines, Visibility cycling, Outlines, Document Structure
1074 @cindex outline tree
1075 @vindex org-special-ctrl-a/e
1076 @vindex org-special-ctrl-k
1077 @vindex org-ctrl-k-protect-subtree
1079 Headlines define the structure of an outline tree. The headlines in Org
1080 start with one or more stars, on the left margin@footnote{See the variables
1081 @code{org-special-ctrl-a/e}, @code{org-special-ctrl-k}, and
1082 @code{org-ctrl-k-protect-subtree} to configure special behavior of @kbd{C-a},
1083 @kbd{C-e}, and @kbd{C-k} in headlines.}. For example:
1086 * Top level headline
1093 * Another top level headline
1096 @noindent Some people find the many stars too noisy and would prefer an
1097 outline that has whitespace followed by a single star as headline
1098 starters. @ref{Clean view}, describes a setup to realize this.
1100 @vindex org-cycle-separator-lines
1101 An empty line after the end of a subtree is considered part of it and
1102 will be hidden when the subtree is folded. However, if you leave at
1103 least two empty lines, one empty line will remain visible after folding
1104 the subtree, in order to structure the collapsed view. See the
1105 variable @code{org-cycle-separator-lines} to modify this behavior.
1107 @node Visibility cycling, Motion, Headlines, Document Structure
1108 @section Visibility cycling
1109 @cindex cycling, visibility
1110 @cindex visibility cycling
1111 @cindex trees, visibility
1112 @cindex show hidden text
1115 Outlines make it possible to hide parts of the text in the buffer.
1116 Org uses just two commands, bound to @key{TAB} and
1117 @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} to change the visibility in the buffer.
1119 @cindex subtree visibility states
1120 @cindex subtree cycling
1121 @cindex folded, subtree visibility state
1122 @cindex children, subtree visibility state
1123 @cindex subtree, subtree visibility state
1125 @orgcmd{@key{TAB},org-cycle}
1126 @emph{Subtree cycling}: Rotate current subtree among the states
1129 ,-> FOLDED -> CHILDREN -> SUBTREE --.
1130 '-----------------------------------'
1133 @vindex org-cycle-emulate-tab
1134 @vindex org-cycle-global-at-bob
1135 The cursor must be on a headline for this to work@footnote{see, however,
1136 the option @code{org-cycle-emulate-tab}.}. When the cursor is at the
1137 beginning of the buffer and the first line is not a headline, then
1138 @key{TAB} actually runs global cycling (see below)@footnote{see the
1139 option @code{org-cycle-global-at-bob}.}. Also when called with a prefix
1140 argument (@kbd{C-u @key{TAB}}), global cycling is invoked.
1142 @cindex global visibility states
1143 @cindex global cycling
1144 @cindex overview, global visibility state
1145 @cindex contents, global visibility state
1146 @cindex show all, global visibility state
1147 @orgcmd{S-@key{TAB},org-global-cycle}
1148 @itemx C-u @key{TAB}
1149 @emph{Global cycling}: Rotate the entire buffer among the states
1152 ,-> OVERVIEW -> CONTENTS -> SHOW ALL --.
1153 '--------------------------------------'
1156 When @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} is called with a numeric prefix argument N, the
1157 CONTENTS view up to headlines of level N will be shown. Note that inside
1158 tables, @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} jumps to the previous field.
1160 @cindex show all, command
1161 @orgcmd{C-u C-u C-u @key{TAB},show-all}
1162 Show all, including drawers.
1163 @orgcmd{C-c C-r,org-reveal}
1164 Reveal context around point, showing the current entry, the following heading
1165 and the hierarchy above. Useful for working near a location that has been
1166 exposed by a sparse tree command (@pxref{Sparse trees}) or an agenda command
1167 (@pxref{Agenda commands}). With a prefix argument show, on each
1168 level, all sibling headings. With double prefix arg, also show the entire
1169 subtree of the parent.
1170 @orgcmd{C-c C-k,show-branches}
1171 Expose all the headings of the subtree, CONTENT view for just one subtree.
1172 @orgcmd{C-c C-x b,org-tree-to-indirect-buffer}
1173 Show the current subtree in an indirect buffer@footnote{The indirect
1176 (@pxref{Indirect Buffers,,,emacs,GNU Emacs Manual})
1179 (see the Emacs manual for more information about indirect buffers)
1181 will contain the entire buffer, but will be narrowed to the current
1182 tree. Editing the indirect buffer will also change the original buffer,
1183 but without affecting visibility in that buffer.}. With a numeric
1184 prefix argument N, go up to level N and then take that tree. If N is
1185 negative then go up that many levels. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix, do not remove
1186 the previously used indirect buffer.
1189 @vindex org-startup-folded
1190 @cindex @code{overview}, STARTUP keyword
1191 @cindex @code{content}, STARTUP keyword
1192 @cindex @code{showall}, STARTUP keyword
1193 @cindex @code{showeverything}, STARTUP keyword
1195 When Emacs first visits an Org file, the global state is set to
1196 OVERVIEW, i.e. only the top level headlines are visible. This can be
1197 configured through the variable @code{org-startup-folded}, or on a
1198 per-file basis by adding one of the following lines anywhere in the
1205 #+STARTUP: showeverything
1208 @cindex property, VISIBILITY
1210 Furthermore, any entries with a @samp{VISIBILITY} property (@pxref{Properties
1211 and Columns}) will get their visibility adapted accordingly. Allowed values
1212 for this property are @code{folded}, @code{children}, @code{content}, and
1215 @orgcmd{C-u C-u @key{TAB},org-set-startup-visibility}
1216 Switch back to the startup visibility of the buffer, i.e. whatever is
1217 requested by startup options and @samp{VISIBILITY} properties in individual
1221 @node Motion, Structure editing, Visibility cycling, Document Structure
1223 @cindex motion, between headlines
1224 @cindex jumping, to headlines
1225 @cindex headline navigation
1226 The following commands jump to other headlines in the buffer.
1229 @orgcmd{C-c C-n,outline-next-visible-heading}
1231 @orgcmd{C-c C-p,outline-previous-visible-heading}
1233 @orgcmd{C-c C-f,org-forward-same-level}
1234 Next heading same level.
1235 @orgcmd{C-c C-b,org-backward-same-level}
1236 Previous heading same level.
1237 @orgcmd{C-c C-u,outline-up-heading}
1238 Backward to higher level heading.
1239 @orgcmd{C-c C-j,org-goto}
1240 Jump to a different place without changing the current outline
1241 visibility. Shows the document structure in a temporary buffer, where
1242 you can use the following keys to find your destination:
1243 @vindex org-goto-auto-isearch
1245 @key{TAB} @r{Cycle visibility.}
1246 @key{down} / @key{up} @r{Next/previous visible headline.}
1247 @key{RET} @r{Select this location.}
1248 @kbd{/} @r{Do a Sparse-tree search}
1249 @r{The following keys work if you turn off @code{org-goto-auto-isearch}}
1250 n / p @r{Next/previous visible headline.}
1251 f / b @r{Next/previous headline same level.}
1253 0-9 @r{Digit argument.}
1256 @vindex org-goto-interface
1258 See also the variable @code{org-goto-interface}.
1261 @node Structure editing, Sparse trees, Motion, Document Structure
1262 @section Structure editing
1263 @cindex structure editing
1264 @cindex headline, promotion and demotion
1265 @cindex promotion, of subtrees
1266 @cindex demotion, of subtrees
1267 @cindex subtree, cut and paste
1268 @cindex pasting, of subtrees
1269 @cindex cutting, of subtrees
1270 @cindex copying, of subtrees
1271 @cindex sorting, of subtrees
1272 @cindex subtrees, cut and paste
1275 @orgcmd{M-@key{RET},org-insert-heading}
1276 @vindex org-M-RET-may-split-line
1277 Insert new heading with same level as current. If the cursor is in a
1278 plain list item, a new item is created (@pxref{Plain lists}). To force
1279 creation of a new headline, use a prefix argument, or first press @key{RET}
1280 to get to the beginning of the next line. When this command is used in
1281 the middle of a line, the line is split and the rest of the line becomes
1282 the new headline@footnote{If you do not want the line to be split,
1283 customize the variable @code{org-M-RET-may-split-line}.}. If the
1284 command is used at the beginning of a headline, the new headline is
1285 created before the current line. If at the beginning of any other line,
1286 the content of that line is made the new heading. If the command is
1287 used at the end of a folded subtree (i.e. behind the ellipses at the end
1288 of a headline), then a headline like the current one will be inserted
1289 after the end of the subtree.
1290 @orgcmd{C-@key{RET},org-insert-heading-respect-content}
1291 Just like @kbd{M-@key{RET}}, except when adding a new heading below the
1292 current heading, the new heading is placed after the body instead of before
1293 it. This command works from anywhere in the entry.
1294 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{RET},org-insert-todo-heading}
1295 @vindex org-treat-insert-todo-heading-as-state-change
1296 Insert new TODO entry with same level as current heading. See also the
1297 variable @code{org-treat-insert-todo-heading-as-state-change}.
1298 @orgcmd{C-S-@key{RET},org-insert-todo-heading-respect-content}
1299 Insert new TODO entry with same level as current heading. Like
1300 @kbd{C-@key{RET}}, the new headline will be inserted after the current
1302 @orgcmd{@key{TAB},org-cycle}
1303 In a new entry with no text yet, the first @key{TAB} demotes the entry to
1304 become a child of the previous one. The next @key{TAB} makes it a parent,
1305 and so on, all the way to top level. Yet another @key{TAB}, and you are back
1306 to the initial level.
1307 @orgcmd{M-@key{left},org-do-promote}
1308 Promote current heading by one level.
1309 @orgcmd{M-@key{right},org-do-demote}
1310 Demote current heading by one level.
1311 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{left},org-promote-subtree}
1312 Promote the current subtree by one level.
1313 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{right},org-demote-subtree}
1314 Demote the current subtree by one level.
1315 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{up},org-move-subtree-up}
1316 Move subtree up (swap with previous subtree of same
1318 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{down},org-move-subtree-down}
1319 Move subtree down (swap with next subtree of same level).
1320 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-w,org-cut-subtree}
1321 Kill subtree, i.e. remove it from buffer but save in kill ring.
1322 With a numeric prefix argument N, kill N sequential subtrees.
1323 @orgcmd{C-c C-x M-w,org-copy-subtree}
1324 Copy subtree to kill ring. With a numeric prefix argument N, copy the N
1325 sequential subtrees.
1326 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-y,org-paste-subtree}
1327 Yank subtree from kill ring. This does modify the level of the subtree to
1328 make sure the tree fits in nicely at the yank position. The yank level can
1329 also be specified with a numeric prefix argument, or by yanking after a
1330 headline marker like @samp{****}.
1331 @orgcmd{C-y,org-yank}
1332 @vindex org-yank-adjusted-subtrees
1333 @vindex org-yank-folded-subtrees
1334 Depending on the variables @code{org-yank-adjusted-subtrees} and
1335 @code{org-yank-folded-subtrees}, Org's internal @code{yank} command will
1336 paste subtrees folded and in a clever way, using the same command as @kbd{C-c
1337 C-x C-y}. With the default settings, no level adjustment will take place,
1338 but the yanked tree will be folded unless doing so would swallow text
1339 previously visible. Any prefix argument to this command will force a normal
1340 @code{yank} to be executed, with the prefix passed along. A good way to
1341 force a normal yank is @kbd{C-u C-y}. If you use @code{yank-pop} after a
1342 yank, it will yank previous kill items plainly, without adjustment and
1344 @orgcmd{C-c C-x c,org-clone-subtree-with-time-shift}
1345 Clone a subtree by making a number of sibling copies of it. You will be
1346 prompted for the number of copies to make, and you can also specify if any
1347 timestamps in the entry should be shifted. This can be useful, for example,
1348 to create a number of tasks related to a series of lectures to prepare. For
1349 more details, see the docstring of the command
1350 @code{org-clone-subtree-with-time-shift}.
1351 @orgcmd{C-c C-w,org-refile}
1352 Refile entry or region to a different location. @xref{Refiling notes}.
1353 @orgcmd{C-c ^,org-sort-entries-or-items}
1354 Sort same-level entries. When there is an active region, all entries in the
1355 region will be sorted. Otherwise the children of the current headline are
1356 sorted. The command prompts for the sorting method, which can be
1357 alphabetically, numerically, by time (first timestamp with active preferred,
1358 creation time, scheduled time, deadline time), by priority, by TODO keyword
1359 (in the sequence the keywords have been defined in the setup) or by the value
1360 of a property. Reverse sorting is possible as well. You can also supply
1361 your own function to extract the sorting key. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix,
1362 sorting will be case-sensitive. With two @kbd{C-u C-u} prefixes, duplicate
1363 entries will also be removed.
1364 @orgcmd{C-x n s,org-narrow-to-subtree}
1365 Narrow buffer to current subtree.
1366 @orgcmd{C-x n w,widen}
1367 Widen buffer to remove narrowing.
1368 @orgcmd{C-c *,org-toggle-heading}
1369 Turn a normal line or plain list item into a headline (so that it becomes a
1370 subheading at its location). Also turn a headline into a normal line by
1371 removing the stars. If there is an active region, turn all lines in the
1372 region into headlines. If the first line in the region was an item, turn
1373 only the item lines into headlines. Finally, if the first line is a
1374 headline, remove the stars from all headlines in the region.
1377 @cindex region, active
1378 @cindex active region
1379 @cindex transient mark mode
1380 When there is an active region (Transient Mark mode), promotion and
1381 demotion work on all headlines in the region. To select a region of
1382 headlines, it is best to place both point and mark at the beginning of a
1383 line, mark at the beginning of the first headline, and point at the line
1384 just after the last headline to change. Note that when the cursor is
1385 inside a table (@pxref{Tables}), the Meta-Cursor keys have different
1389 @node Sparse trees, Plain lists, Structure editing, Document Structure
1390 @section Sparse trees
1391 @cindex sparse trees
1392 @cindex trees, sparse
1393 @cindex folding, sparse trees
1394 @cindex occur, command
1396 @vindex org-show-hierarchy-above
1397 @vindex org-show-following-heading
1398 @vindex org-show-siblings
1399 @vindex org-show-entry-below
1400 An important feature of Org-mode is the ability to construct @emph{sparse
1401 trees} for selected information in an outline tree, so that the entire
1402 document is folded as much as possible, but the selected information is made
1403 visible along with the headline structure above it@footnote{See also the
1404 variables @code{org-show-hierarchy-above}, @code{org-show-following-heading},
1405 @code{org-show-siblings}, and @code{org-show-entry-below} for detailed
1406 control on how much context is shown around each match.}. Just try it out
1407 and you will see immediately how it works.
1409 Org-mode contains several commands creating such trees, all these
1410 commands can be accessed through a dispatcher:
1413 @orgcmd{C-c /,org-sparse-tree}
1414 This prompts for an extra key to select a sparse-tree creating command.
1415 @orgcmd{C-c / r,org-occur}
1416 @vindex org-remove-highlights-with-change
1417 Occur. Prompts for a regexp and shows a sparse tree with all matches. If
1418 the match is in a headline, the headline is made visible. If the match is in
1419 the body of an entry, headline and body are made visible. In order to
1420 provide minimal context, also the full hierarchy of headlines above the match
1421 is shown, as well as the headline following the match. Each match is also
1422 highlighted; the highlights disappear when the buffer is changed by an
1423 editing command@footnote{This depends on the option
1424 @code{org-remove-highlights-with-change}}, or by pressing @kbd{C-c C-c}.
1425 When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, previous highlights are kept,
1426 so several calls to this command can be stacked.
1430 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
1431 For frequently used sparse trees of specific search strings, you can
1432 use the variable @code{org-agenda-custom-commands} to define fast
1433 keyboard access to specific sparse trees. These commands will then be
1434 accessible through the agenda dispatcher (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}).
1438 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
1439 '(("f" occur-tree "FIXME")))
1442 @noindent will define the key @kbd{C-c a f} as a shortcut for creating
1443 a sparse tree matching the string @samp{FIXME}.
1445 The other sparse tree commands select headings based on TODO keywords,
1446 tags, or properties and will be discussed later in this manual.
1449 @cindex printing sparse trees
1450 @cindex visible text, printing
1451 To print a sparse tree, you can use the Emacs command
1452 @code{ps-print-buffer-with-faces} which does not print invisible parts
1453 of the document @footnote{This does not work under XEmacs, because
1454 XEmacs uses selective display for outlining, not text properties.}.
1455 Or you can use the command @kbd{C-c C-e v} to export only the visible
1456 part of the document and print the resulting file.
1458 @node Plain lists, Drawers, Sparse trees, Document Structure
1459 @section Plain lists
1461 @cindex lists, plain
1462 @cindex lists, ordered
1463 @cindex ordered lists
1465 Within an entry of the outline tree, hand-formatted lists can provide
1466 additional structure. They also provide a way to create lists of checkboxes
1467 (@pxref{Checkboxes}). Org supports editing such lists, and every exporter
1468 (@pxref{Exporting}) can parse and format them.
1470 Org knows ordered lists, unordered lists, and description lists.
1473 @emph{Unordered} list items start with @samp{-}, @samp{+}, or
1474 @samp{*}@footnote{When using @samp{*} as a bullet, lines must be indented or
1475 they will be seen as top-level headlines. Also, when you are hiding leading
1476 stars to get a clean outline view, plain list items starting with a star are
1477 visually indistinguishable from true headlines. In short: even though
1478 @samp{*} is supported, it may be better to not use it for plain list items.}
1481 @vindex org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator
1482 @emph{Ordered} list items start with a numeral followed by either a period or
1483 a right parenthesis@footnote{You can filter out any of them by configuring
1484 @code{org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator}.}, such as @samp{1.} or
1485 @samp{1)}. If you want a list to start a different value (e.g. 20), start
1486 the text of the item with @code{[@@20]}@footnote{If there's a checkbox in the
1487 item, the cookie must be put @emph{before} the checkbox.}. Those constructs
1488 can be used in any item of the list in order to enforce a particular
1491 @emph{Description} list items are unordered list items, and contain the
1492 separator @samp{ :: } to separate the description @emph{term} from the
1496 Items belonging to the same list must have the same indentation on the first
1497 line. In particular, if an ordered list reaches number @samp{10.}, then the
1498 2--digit numbers must be written left-aligned with the other numbers in the
1501 @vindex org-list-ending-method
1502 @vindex org-list-end-regexp
1503 @vindex org-empty-line-terminates-plain-lists
1504 Two methods@footnote{To disable either of them, configure
1505 @code{org-list-ending-method}.} are provided to terminate lists. A list ends
1506 before the next line that is indented like the bullet/number or less, or it
1507 ends before two blank lines@footnote{See also
1508 @code{org-empty-line-terminates-plain-lists}.}. In both cases, all levels of
1509 the list are closed@footnote{So you cannot have a sublist, some text and then
1510 another sublist while still in the same top-level list item. This used to be
1511 possible, but it was only supported in the HTML exporter and difficult to
1512 manage with automatic indentation.}. For finer control, you can end lists
1513 with any pattern set in @code{org-list-end-regexp}. Here is an example:
1517 ** Lord of the Rings
1518 My favorite scenes are (in this order)
1519 1. The attack of the Rohirrim
1520 2. Eowyn's fight with the witch king
1521 + this was already my favorite scene in the book
1522 + I really like Miranda Otto.
1523 3. Peter Jackson being shot by Legolas
1524 He makes a really funny face when it happens.
1526 But in the end, no individual scenes matter but the film as a whole.
1527 Important actors in this film are:
1528 - @b{Elijah Wood} :: He plays Frodo
1529 - @b{Sean Austin} :: He plays Sam, Frodo's friend. I still remember
1530 him very well from his role as Mikey Walsh in @i{The Goonies}.
1534 Org supports these lists by tuning filling and wrapping commands to deal with
1535 them correctly@footnote{Org only changes the filling settings for Emacs. For
1536 XEmacs, you should use Kyle E. Jones' @file{filladapt.el}. To turn this on,
1537 put into @file{.emacs}: @code{(require 'filladapt)}}, and by exporting them
1538 properly (@pxref{Exporting}). Since indentation is what governs the
1539 structure of these lists, many structural constructs like @code{#+BEGIN_...}
1540 blocks can be indented to signal that they should be considered of a list
1543 @vindex org-list-demote-modify-bullet
1544 If you find that using a different bullet for a sub-list (than that used for
1545 the current list-level) improves readability, customize the variable
1546 @code{org-list-demote-modify-bullet}.
1548 @vindex org-list-automatic-rules
1549 The following commands act on items when the cursor is in the first line of
1550 an item (the line with the bullet or number). Some of them imply the
1551 application of automatic rules to keep list structure in tact. If some of
1552 these actions get in your way, configure @code{org-list-automatic-rules}
1553 to disable them individually.
1556 @orgcmd{@key{TAB},org-cycle}
1557 @vindex org-cycle-include-plain-lists
1558 Items can be folded just like headline levels. Normally this works only if
1559 the cursor is on a plain list item. For more details, see the variable
1560 @code{org-cycle-include-plain-lists}. to @code{integrate}, plain list items
1561 will be treated like low-level. The level of an item is then given by the
1562 indentation of the bullet/number. Items are always subordinate to real
1563 headlines, however; the hierarchies remain completely separated.
1564 @orgcmd{M-@key{RET},org-insert-heading}
1565 @vindex org-M-RET-may-split-line
1566 @vindex org-list-automatic-rules
1567 Insert new item at current level. With a prefix argument, force a new
1568 heading (@pxref{Structure editing}). If this command is used in the middle
1569 of a line, the line is @emph{split} and the rest of the line becomes the new
1570 item@footnote{If you do not want the line to be split, customize the variable
1571 @code{org-M-RET-may-split-line}.}. If this command is executed @emph{before
1572 item's body}, the new item is created @emph{before} the current item. If the
1573 command is executed in the white space before the text that is part of an
1574 item but does not contain the bullet, a bullet is added to the current line.
1576 As a new item cannot be inserted in a structural construct (like an example
1577 or source code block) within a list, Org will instead insert it right before
1578 the structure, or return an error.
1579 @kindex M-S-@key{RET}
1581 Insert a new item with a checkbox (@pxref{Checkboxes}).
1582 @orgcmd{@key{TAB},org-cycle}
1583 In a new item with no text yet, the first @key{TAB} demotes the item to
1584 become a child of the previous one. Subsequents @key{TAB} move the item to
1585 meaningful levels in the list and eventually get it back to its initial
1587 @kindex S-@key{down}
1590 @cindex shift-selection-mode
1591 @vindex org-support-shift-select
1592 Jump to the previous/next item in the current list, but only if
1593 @code{org-support-shift-select} is off. If not, you can still use paragraph
1594 jumping commands like @kbd{C-@key{up}} and @kbd{C-@key{down}} to quite
1596 @kindex M-S-@key{up}
1597 @kindex M-S-@key{down}
1599 @itemx M-S-@key{down}
1600 Move the item including subitems up/down (swap with previous/next item
1601 of same indentation). If the list is ordered, renumbering is
1603 @kindex M-@key{left}
1604 @kindex M-@key{right}
1606 @itemx M-@key{right}
1607 Decrease/increase the indentation of an item, leaving children alone.
1608 @kindex M-S-@key{left}
1609 @kindex M-S-@key{right}
1610 @item M-S-@key{left}
1611 @itemx M-S-@key{right}
1612 Decrease/increase the indentation of the item, including subitems.
1613 Initially, the item tree is selected based on current indentation. When
1614 these commands are executed several times in direct succession, the initially
1615 selected region is used, even if the new indentation would imply a different
1616 hierarchy. To use the new hierarchy, break the command chain with a cursor
1619 As a special case, using this command on the very first item of a list will
1620 move the whole list. This behavior can be disabled by configuring
1621 @code{org-list-automatic-rules}. The global indentation of a list has no
1622 influence on the text @emph{after} the list.
1625 If there is a checkbox (@pxref{Checkboxes}) in the item line, toggle the
1626 state of the checkbox. Also, makes sure that all the
1627 items on this list level use the same bullet and that the numbering of list
1628 items (if applicable) is correct.
1630 @vindex org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator
1631 @vindex org-list-automatic-rules
1633 Cycle the entire list level through the different itemize/enumerate bullets
1634 (@samp{-}, @samp{+}, @samp{*}, @samp{1.}, @samp{1)}) or a subset of them,
1635 depending on @code{org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator}, the type of list,
1636 and its position@footnote{See @code{bullet} rule in
1637 @code{org-list-automatic-rules} for more information.}. With a numeric
1638 prefix argument N, select the Nth bullet from this list. If there is an
1639 active region when calling this, all lines will be converted to list items.
1640 If the first line already was a list item, any item markers will be removed
1641 from the list. Finally, even without an active region, a normal line will be
1642 converted into a list item.
1645 Turn a plain list item into a headline (so that it becomes a subheading at
1646 its location). @xref{Structure editing}, for a detailed explanation.
1647 @kindex S-@key{left}
1648 @kindex S-@key{right}
1649 @item S-@key{left}/@key{right}
1650 @vindex org-support-shift-select
1651 This command also cycles bullet styles when the cursor in on the bullet or
1652 anywhere in an item line, details depending on
1653 @code{org-support-shift-select}.
1656 Sort the plain list. You will be prompted for the sorting method:
1657 numerically, alphabetically, by time, or by custom function.
1660 @node Drawers, Blocks, Plain lists, Document Structure
1664 @cindex visibility cycling, drawers
1667 Sometimes you want to keep information associated with an entry, but you
1668 normally don't want to see it. For this, Org-mode has @emph{drawers}.
1669 Drawers need to be configured with the variable
1670 @code{org-drawers}@footnote{You can define drawers on a per-file basis
1671 with a line like @code{#+DRAWERS: HIDDEN PROPERTIES STATE}}. Drawers
1675 ** This is a headline
1676 Still outside the drawer
1678 This is inside the drawer.
1683 Visibility cycling (@pxref{Visibility cycling}) on the headline will hide and
1684 show the entry, but keep the drawer collapsed to a single line. In order to
1685 look inside the drawer, you need to move the cursor to the drawer line and
1686 press @key{TAB} there. Org-mode uses the @code{PROPERTIES} drawer for
1687 storing properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}), and you can also arrange
1688 for state change notes (@pxref{Tracking TODO state changes}) and clock times
1689 (@pxref{Clocking work time}) to be stored in a drawer @code{LOGBOOK}. If you
1690 want to store a quick note in the LOGBOOK drawer, in a similar way as this is
1691 done by state changes, use
1696 Add a time-stamped note to the LOGBOOK drawer.
1699 @node Blocks, Footnotes, Drawers, Document Structure
1702 @vindex org-hide-block-startup
1703 @cindex blocks, folding
1704 Org-mode uses begin...end blocks for various purposes from including source
1705 code examples (@pxref{Literal examples}) to capturing time logging
1706 information (@pxref{Clocking work time}). These blocks can be folded and
1707 unfolded by pressing TAB in the begin line. You can also get all blocks
1708 folded at startup by configuring the variable @code{org-hide-block-startup}
1709 or on a per-file basis by using
1711 @cindex @code{hideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
1712 @cindex @code{nohideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
1714 #+STARTUP: hideblocks
1715 #+STARTUP: nohideblocks
1718 @node Footnotes, Orgstruct mode, Blocks, Document Structure
1722 Org-mode supports the creation of footnotes. In contrast to the
1723 @file{footnote.el} package, Org-mode's footnotes are designed for work on a
1724 larger document, not only for one-off documents like emails. The basic
1725 syntax is similar to the one used by @file{footnote.el}, i.e. a footnote is
1726 defined in a paragraph that is started by a footnote marker in square
1727 brackets in column 0, no indentation allowed. If you need a paragraph break
1728 inside a footnote, use the La@TeX{} idiom @samp{\par}. The footnote reference
1729 is simply the marker in square brackets, inside text. For example:
1732 The Org homepage[fn:1] now looks a lot better than it used to.
1734 [fn:1] The link is: http://orgmode.org
1737 Org-mode extends the number-based syntax to @emph{named} footnotes and
1738 optional inline definition. Using plain numbers as markers (as
1739 @file{footnote.el} does) is supported for backward compatibility, but not
1740 encouraged because of possible conflicts with La@TeX{} snippets (@pxref{Embedded
1741 LaTeX}). Here are the valid references:
1745 A plain numeric footnote marker. Compatible with @file{footnote.el}, but not
1746 recommended because something like @samp{[1]} could easily be part of a code
1749 A named footnote reference, where @code{name} is a unique label word, or, for
1750 simplicity of automatic creation, a number.
1751 @item [fn:: This is the inline definition of this footnote]
1752 A La@TeX{}-like anonymous footnote where the definition is given directly at the
1754 @item [fn:name: a definition]
1755 An inline definition of a footnote, which also specifies a name for the note.
1756 Since Org allows multiple references to the same note, you can then use
1757 @code{[fn:name]} to create additional references.
1760 @vindex org-footnote-auto-label
1761 Footnote labels can be created automatically, or you can create names yourself.
1762 This is handled by the variable @code{org-footnote-auto-label} and its
1763 corresponding @code{#+STARTUP} keywords, see the docstring of that variable
1766 @noindent The following command handles footnotes:
1771 The footnote action command.
1773 When the cursor is on a footnote reference, jump to the definition. When it
1774 is at a definition, jump to the (first) reference.
1776 @vindex org-footnote-define-inline
1777 @vindex org-footnote-section
1778 @vindex org-footnote-auto-adjust
1779 Otherwise, create a new footnote. Depending on the variable
1780 @code{org-footnote-define-inline}@footnote{The corresponding in-buffer
1781 setting is: @code{#+STARTUP: fninline} or @code{#+STARTUP: nofninline}}, the
1782 definition will be placed right into the text as part of the reference, or
1783 separately into the location determined by the variable
1784 @code{org-footnote-section}.
1786 When this command is called with a prefix argument, a menu of additional
1789 s @r{Sort the footnote definitions by reference sequence. During editing,}
1790 @r{Org makes no effort to sort footnote definitions into a particular}
1791 @r{sequence. If you want them sorted, use this command, which will}
1792 @r{also move entries according to @code{org-footnote-section}. Automatic}
1793 @r{sorting after each insertion/deletion can be configured using the}
1794 @r{variable @code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}.}
1795 r @r{Renumber the simple @code{fn:N} footnotes. Automatic renumbering}
1796 @r{after each insertion/deletion can be configured using the variable}
1797 @r{@code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}.}
1798 S @r{Short for first @code{r}, then @code{s} action.}
1799 n @r{Normalize the footnotes by collecting all definitions (including}
1800 @r{inline definitions) into a special section, and then numbering them}
1801 @r{in sequence. The references will then also be numbers. This is}
1802 @r{meant to be the final step before finishing a document (e.g. sending}
1803 @r{off an email). The exporters do this automatically, and so could}
1804 @r{something like @code{message-send-hook}.}
1805 d @r{Delete the footnote at point, and all definitions of and references}
1808 Depending on the variable @code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}@footnote{the
1809 corresponding in-buffer options are @code{fnadjust} and @code{nofnadjust}.},
1810 renumbering and sorting footnotes can be automatic after each insertion or
1815 If the cursor is on a footnote reference, jump to the definition. If it is a
1816 the definition, jump back to the reference. When called at a footnote
1817 location with a prefix argument, offer the same menu as @kbd{C-c C-x f}.
1821 @item C-c C-o @r{or} mouse-1/2
1822 Footnote labels are also links to the corresponding definition/reference, and
1823 you can use the usual commands to follow these links.
1826 @node Orgstruct mode, , Footnotes, Document Structure
1827 @section The Orgstruct minor mode
1828 @cindex Orgstruct mode
1829 @cindex minor mode for structure editing
1831 If you like the intuitive way the Org-mode structure editing and list
1832 formatting works, you might want to use these commands in other modes like
1833 Text mode or Mail mode as well. The minor mode @code{orgstruct-mode} makes
1834 this possible. Toggle the mode with @kbd{M-x orgstruct-mode}, or
1835 turn it on by default, for example in Mail mode, with one of:
1838 (add-hook 'mail-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgstruct)
1839 (add-hook 'mail-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgstruct++)
1842 When this mode is active and the cursor is on a line that looks to Org like a
1843 headline or the first line of a list item, most structure editing commands
1844 will work, even if the same keys normally have different functionality in the
1845 major mode you are using. If the cursor is not in one of those special
1846 lines, Orgstruct mode lurks silently in the shadow. When you use
1847 @code{orgstruct++-mode}, Org will also export indentation and autofill
1848 settings into that mode, and detect item context after the first line of an
1851 @node Tables, Hyperlinks, Document Structure, Top
1854 @cindex editing tables
1856 Org comes with a fast and intuitive table editor. Spreadsheet-like
1857 calculations are supported in connection with the Emacs @file{calc}
1860 (@pxref{Top,Calc,,Calc,Gnu Emacs Calculator Manual}).
1863 (see the Emacs Calculator manual for more information about the Emacs
1868 * Built-in table editor:: Simple tables
1869 * Column width and alignment:: Overrule the automatic settings
1870 * Column groups:: Grouping to trigger vertical lines
1871 * Orgtbl mode:: The table editor as minor mode
1872 * The spreadsheet:: The table editor has spreadsheet capabilities
1873 * Org-Plot:: Plotting from org tables
1876 @node Built-in table editor, Column width and alignment, Tables, Tables
1877 @section The built-in table editor
1878 @cindex table editor, built-in
1880 Org makes it easy to format tables in plain ASCII. Any line with
1881 @samp{|} as the first non-whitespace character is considered part of a
1882 table. @samp{|} is also the column separator. A table might look like
1886 | Name | Phone | Age |
1887 |-------+-------+-----|
1888 | Peter | 1234 | 17 |
1889 | Anna | 4321 | 25 |
1892 A table is re-aligned automatically each time you press @key{TAB} or
1893 @key{RET} or @kbd{C-c C-c} inside the table. @key{TAB} also moves to
1894 the next field (@key{RET} to the next row) and creates new table rows
1895 at the end of the table or before horizontal lines. The indentation
1896 of the table is set by the first line. Any line starting with
1897 @samp{|-} is considered as a horizontal separator line and will be
1898 expanded on the next re-align to span the whole table width. So, to
1899 create the above table, you would only type
1906 @noindent and then press @key{TAB} to align the table and start filling in
1907 fields. Even faster would be to type @code{|Name|Phone|Age} followed by
1908 @kbd{C-c @key{RET}}.
1910 @vindex org-enable-table-editor
1911 @vindex org-table-auto-blank-field
1912 When typing text into a field, Org treats @key{DEL},
1913 @key{Backspace}, and all character keys in a special way, so that
1914 inserting and deleting avoids shifting other fields. Also, when
1915 typing @emph{immediately after the cursor was moved into a new field
1916 with @kbd{@key{TAB}}, @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} or @kbd{@key{RET}}}, the
1917 field is automatically made blank. If this behavior is too
1918 unpredictable for you, configure the variables
1919 @code{org-enable-table-editor} and @code{org-table-auto-blank-field}.
1922 @tsubheading{Creation and conversion}
1923 @orgcmd{C-c |,org-table-create-or-convert-from-region}
1924 Convert the active region to table. If every line contains at least one
1925 TAB character, the function assumes that the material is tab separated.
1926 If every line contains a comma, comma-separated values (CSV) are assumed.
1927 If not, lines are split at whitespace into fields. You can use a prefix
1928 argument to force a specific separator: @kbd{C-u} forces CSV, @kbd{C-u
1929 C-u} forces TAB, and a numeric argument N indicates that at least N
1930 consecutive spaces, or alternatively a TAB will be the separator.
1932 If there is no active region, this command creates an empty Org
1933 table. But it's easier just to start typing, like
1934 @kbd{|Name|Phone|Age @key{RET} |- @key{TAB}}.
1936 @tsubheading{Re-aligning and field motion}
1937 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-table-align}
1938 Re-align the table without moving the cursor.
1940 @orgcmd{<TAB>,org-table-next-field}
1941 Re-align the table, move to the next field. Creates a new row if
1944 @orgcmd{S-@key{TAB},org-table-previous-field}
1945 Re-align, move to previous field.
1947 @orgcmd{@key{RET},org-table-next-row}
1948 Re-align the table and move down to next row. Creates a new row if
1949 necessary. At the beginning or end of a line, @key{RET} still does
1950 NEWLINE, so it can be used to split a table.
1952 @orgcmd{M-a,org-table-beginning-of-field}
1953 Move to beginning of the current table field, or on to the previous field.
1954 @orgcmd{M-e,org-table-end-of-field}
1955 Move to end of the current table field, or on to the next field.
1957 @tsubheading{Column and row editing}
1958 @orgcmdkkcc{M-@key{left},M-@key{right},org-table-move-column-left,org-table-move-column-right}
1959 Move the current column left/right.
1961 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{left},org-table-delete-column}
1962 Kill the current column.
1964 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{right},org-table-insert-column}
1965 Insert a new column to the left of the cursor position.
1967 @orgcmdkkcc{M-@key{up},M-@key{down},org-table-move-row-up,org-table-move-row-down}
1968 Move the current row up/down.
1970 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{up},org-table-kill-row}
1971 Kill the current row or horizontal line.
1973 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{down},org-table-insert-row}
1974 Insert a new row above the current row. With a prefix argument, the line is
1975 created below the current one.
1977 @orgcmd{C-c -,org-table-insert-hline}
1978 Insert a horizontal line below current row. With a prefix argument, the line
1979 is created above the current line.
1981 @orgcmd{C-c @key{RET},org-table-hline-and-move}
1982 Insert a horizontal line below current row, and move the cursor into the row
1985 @orgcmd{C-c ^,org-table-sort-lines}
1986 Sort the table lines in the region. The position of point indicates the
1987 column to be used for sorting, and the range of lines is the range
1988 between the nearest horizontal separator lines, or the entire table. If
1989 point is before the first column, you will be prompted for the sorting
1990 column. If there is an active region, the mark specifies the first line
1991 and the sorting column, while point should be in the last line to be
1992 included into the sorting. The command prompts for the sorting type
1993 (alphabetically, numerically, or by time). When called with a prefix
1994 argument, alphabetic sorting will be case-sensitive.
1996 @tsubheading{Regions}
1997 @orgcmd{C-c C-x M-w,org-table-copy-region}
1998 Copy a rectangular region from a table to a special clipboard. Point and
1999 mark determine edge fields of the rectangle. If there is no active region,
2000 copy just the current field. The process ignores horizontal separator lines.
2002 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-w,org-table-cut-region}
2003 Copy a rectangular region from a table to a special clipboard, and
2004 blank all fields in the rectangle. So this is the ``cut'' operation.
2006 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-y,org-table-paste-rectangle}
2007 Paste a rectangular region into a table.
2008 The upper left corner ends up in the current field. All involved fields
2009 will be overwritten. If the rectangle does not fit into the present table,
2010 the table is enlarged as needed. The process ignores horizontal separator
2013 @orgcmd{M-@key{RET},org-table-wrap-region}
2014 Split the current field at the cursor position and move the rest to the line
2015 below. If there is an active region, and both point and mark are in the same
2016 column, the text in the column is wrapped to minimum width for the given
2017 number of lines. A numeric prefix argument may be used to change the number
2018 of desired lines. If there is no region, but you specify a prefix argument,
2019 the current field is made blank, and the content is appended to the field
2022 @tsubheading{Calculations}
2023 @cindex formula, in tables
2024 @cindex calculations, in tables
2025 @cindex region, active
2026 @cindex active region
2027 @cindex transient mark mode
2028 @orgcmd{C-c +,org-table-sum}
2029 Sum the numbers in the current column, or in the rectangle defined by
2030 the active region. The result is shown in the echo area and can
2031 be inserted with @kbd{C-y}.
2033 @orgcmd{S-@key{RET},org-table-copy-down}
2034 @vindex org-table-copy-increment
2035 When current field is empty, copy from first non-empty field above. When not
2036 empty, copy current field down to next row and move cursor along with it.
2037 Depending on the variable @code{org-table-copy-increment}, integer field
2038 values will be incremented during copy. Integers that are too large will not
2039 be incremented. Also, a @code{0} prefix argument temporarily disables the
2040 increment. This key is also used by shift-selection and related modes
2041 (@pxref{Conflicts}).
2043 @tsubheading{Miscellaneous}
2044 @orgcmd{C-c `,org-table-edit-field}
2045 Edit the current field in a separate window. This is useful for fields that
2046 are not fully visible (@pxref{Column width and alignment}). When called with
2047 a @kbd{C-u} prefix, just make the full field visible, so that it can be
2050 @item M-x org-table-import
2051 Import a file as a table. The table should be TAB or whitespace
2052 separated. Use, for example, to import a spreadsheet table or data
2053 from a database, because these programs generally can write
2054 TAB-separated text files. This command works by inserting the file into
2055 the buffer and then converting the region to a table. Any prefix
2056 argument is passed on to the converter, which uses it to determine the
2058 @orgcmd{C-c |,org-table-create-or-convert-from-region}
2059 Tables can also be imported by pasting tabular text into the Org
2060 buffer, selecting the pasted text with @kbd{C-x C-x} and then using the
2061 @kbd{C-c |} command (see above under @i{Creation and conversion}).
2063 @item M-x org-table-export
2064 @findex org-table-export
2065 @vindex org-table-export-default-format
2066 Export the table, by default as a TAB-separated file. Use for data
2067 exchange with, for example, spreadsheet or database programs. The format
2068 used to export the file can be configured in the variable
2069 @code{org-table-export-default-format}. You may also use properties
2070 @code{TABLE_EXPORT_FILE} and @code{TABLE_EXPORT_FORMAT} to specify the file
2071 name and the format for table export in a subtree. Org supports quite
2072 general formats for exported tables. The exporter format is the same as the
2073 format used by Orgtbl radio tables, see @ref{Translator functions}, for a
2074 detailed description.
2077 If you don't like the automatic table editor because it gets in your
2078 way on lines which you would like to start with @samp{|}, you can turn
2082 (setq org-enable-table-editor nil)
2085 @noindent Then the only table command that still works is
2086 @kbd{C-c C-c} to do a manual re-align.
2088 @node Column width and alignment, Column groups, Built-in table editor, Tables
2089 @section Column width and alignment
2090 @cindex narrow columns in tables
2091 @cindex alignment in tables
2093 The width of columns is automatically determined by the table editor. And
2094 also the alignment of a column is determined automatically from the fraction
2095 of number-like versus non-number fields in the column.
2097 Sometimes a single field or a few fields need to carry more text, leading to
2098 inconveniently wide columns. Or maybe you want to make a table with several
2099 columns having a fixed width, regardless of content. To set@footnote{This
2100 feature does not work on XEmacs.} the width of a column, one field anywhere
2101 in the column may contain just the string @samp{<N>} where @samp{N} is an
2102 integer specifying the width of the column in characters. The next re-align
2103 will then set the width of this column to this value.
2107 |---+------------------------------| |---+--------|
2109 | 1 | one | | 1 | one |
2110 | 2 | two | ----\ | 2 | two |
2111 | 3 | This is a long chunk of text | ----/ | 3 | This=> |
2112 | 4 | four | | 4 | four |
2113 |---+------------------------------| |---+--------|
2118 Fields that are wider become clipped and end in the string @samp{=>}.
2119 Note that the full text is still in the buffer, it is only invisible.
2120 To see the full text, hold the mouse over the field---a tool-tip window
2121 will show the full content. To edit such a field, use the command
2122 @kbd{C-c `} (that is @kbd{C-c} followed by the backquote). This will
2123 open a new window with the full field. Edit it and finish with @kbd{C-c
2126 @vindex org-startup-align-all-tables
2127 When visiting a file containing a table with narrowed columns, the
2128 necessary character hiding has not yet happened, and the table needs to
2129 be aligned before it looks nice. Setting the option
2130 @code{org-startup-align-all-tables} will realign all tables in a file
2131 upon visiting, but also slow down startup. You can also set this option
2132 on a per-file basis with:
2139 If you would like to overrule the automatic alignment of number-rich columns
2140 to the right and of string-rich column to the left, you and use @samp{<r>},
2141 @samp{c}@footnote{Centering does not work inside Emacs, but it does have an
2142 effect when exporting to HTML.} or @samp{<l>} in a similar fashion. You may
2143 also combine alignment and field width like this: @samp{<l10>}.
2145 Lines which only contain these formatting cookies will be removed
2146 automatically when exporting the document.
2148 @node Column groups, Orgtbl mode, Column width and alignment, Tables
2149 @section Column groups
2150 @cindex grouping columns in tables
2152 When Org exports tables, it does so by default without vertical
2153 lines because that is visually more satisfying in general. Occasionally
2154 however, vertical lines can be useful to structure a table into groups
2155 of columns, much like horizontal lines can do for groups of rows. In
2156 order to specify column groups, you can use a special row where the
2157 first field contains only @samp{/}. The further fields can either
2158 contain @samp{<} to indicate that this column should start a group,
2159 @samp{>} to indicate the end of a column, or @samp{<>} to make a column
2160 a group of its own. Boundaries between column groups will upon export be
2161 marked with vertical lines. Here is an example:
2164 | N | N^2 | N^3 | N^4 | sqrt(n) | sqrt[4](N) |
2165 |---+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------|
2166 | / | < | | > | < | > |
2167 | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 |
2168 | 2 | 4 | 8 | 16 | 1.4142 | 1.1892 |
2169 | 3 | 9 | 27 | 81 | 1.7321 | 1.3161 |
2170 |---+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------|
2171 #+TBLFM: $2=$1^2::$3=$1^3::$4=$1^4::$5=sqrt($1)::$6=sqrt(sqrt(($1)))
2174 It is also sufficient to just insert the column group starters after
2175 every vertical line you would like to have:
2178 | N | N^2 | N^3 | N^4 | sqrt(n) | sqrt[4](N) |
2179 |----+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------|
2183 @node Orgtbl mode, The spreadsheet, Column groups, Tables
2184 @section The Orgtbl minor mode
2186 @cindex minor mode for tables
2188 If you like the intuitive way the Org table editor works, you
2189 might also want to use it in other modes like Text mode or Mail mode.
2190 The minor mode Orgtbl mode makes this possible. You can always toggle
2191 the mode with @kbd{M-x orgtbl-mode}. To turn it on by default, for
2192 example in mail mode, use
2195 (add-hook 'mail-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgtbl)
2198 Furthermore, with some special setup, it is possible to maintain tables
2199 in arbitrary syntax with Orgtbl mode. For example, it is possible to
2200 construct La@TeX{} tables with the underlying ease and power of
2201 Orgtbl mode, including spreadsheet capabilities. For details, see
2202 @ref{Tables in arbitrary syntax}.
2204 @node The spreadsheet, Org-Plot, Orgtbl mode, Tables
2205 @section The spreadsheet
2206 @cindex calculations, in tables
2207 @cindex spreadsheet capabilities
2208 @cindex @file{calc} package
2210 The table editor makes use of the Emacs @file{calc} package to implement
2211 spreadsheet-like capabilities. It can also evaluate Emacs Lisp forms to
2212 derive fields from other fields. While fully featured, Org's implementation
2213 is not identical to other spreadsheets. For example, Org knows the concept
2214 of a @emph{column formula} that will be applied to all non-header fields in a
2215 column without having to copy the formula to each relevant field. There is
2216 also a formula debugger, and a formula editor with features for highlighting
2217 fields in the table corresponding to the references at the point in the
2218 formula, moving these references by arrow keys
2221 * References:: How to refer to another field or range
2222 * Formula syntax for Calc:: Using Calc to compute stuff
2223 * Formula syntax for Lisp:: Writing formulas in Emacs Lisp
2224 * Field formulas:: Formulas valid for a single field
2225 * Column formulas:: Formulas valid for an entire column
2226 * Editing and debugging formulas:: Fixing formulas
2227 * Updating the table:: Recomputing all dependent fields
2228 * Advanced features:: Field names, parameters and automatic recalc
2231 @node References, Formula syntax for Calc, The spreadsheet, The spreadsheet
2232 @subsection References
2235 To compute fields in the table from other fields, formulas must
2236 reference other fields or ranges. In Org, fields can be referenced
2237 by name, by absolute coordinates, and by relative coordinates. To find
2238 out what the coordinates of a field are, press @kbd{C-c ?} in that
2239 field, or press @kbd{C-c @}} to toggle the display of a grid.
2241 @subsubheading Field references
2242 @cindex field references
2243 @cindex references, to fields
2245 Formulas can reference the value of another field in two ways. Like in
2246 any other spreadsheet, you may reference fields with a letter/number
2247 combination like @code{B3}, meaning the 2nd field in the 3rd row.
2248 @c Such references are always fixed to that field, they don't change
2249 @c when you copy and paste a formula to a different field. So
2250 @c Org's @code{B3} behaves like @code{$B$3} in other spreadsheets.
2253 Org also uses another, more general operator that looks like this:
2255 @@@var{row}$@var{column}
2259 Column references can be absolute like @samp{1}, @samp{2},...@samp{@var{N}},
2260 or relative to the current column like @samp{+1} or @samp{-2}.
2262 The row specification only counts data lines and ignores horizontal
2263 separator lines (hlines). You can use absolute row numbers
2264 @samp{1}...@samp{@var{N}}, and row numbers relative to the current row like
2265 @samp{+3} or @samp{-1}. Or specify the row relative to one of the
2266 hlines: @samp{I} refers to the first hline@footnote{Note that only
2267 hlines are counted that @emph{separate} table lines. If the table
2268 starts with a hline above the header, it does not count.}, @samp{II} to
2269 the second, etc@. @samp{-I} refers to the first such line above the
2270 current line, @samp{+I} to the first such line below the current line.
2271 You can also write @samp{III+2} which is the second data line after the
2272 third hline in the table.
2274 @samp{0} refers to the current row and column. Also, if you omit
2275 either the column or the row part of the reference, the current
2276 row/column is implied.
2278 Org's references with @emph{unsigned} numbers are fixed references
2279 in the sense that if you use the same reference in the formula for two
2280 different fields, the same field will be referenced each time.
2281 Org's references with @emph{signed} numbers are floating
2282 references because the same reference operator can reference different
2283 fields depending on the field being calculated by the formula.
2285 As a special case, references like @samp{$LR5} and @samp{$LR12} can be used
2286 to refer in a stable way to the 5th and 12th field in the last row of the
2289 Here are a few examples:
2292 @@2$3 @r{2nd row, 3rd column}
2293 C2 @r{same as previous}
2294 $5 @r{column 5 in the current row}
2295 E& @r{same as previous}
2296 @@2 @r{current column, row 2}
2297 @@-1$-3 @r{the field one row up, three columns to the left}
2298 @@-I$2 @r{field just under hline above current row, column 2}
2301 @subsubheading Range references
2302 @cindex range references
2303 @cindex references, to ranges
2305 You may reference a rectangular range of fields by specifying two field
2306 references connected by two dots @samp{..}. If both fields are in the
2307 current row, you may simply use @samp{$2..$7}, but if at least one field
2308 is in a different row, you need to use the general @code{@@row$column}
2309 format at least for the first field (i.e the reference must start with
2310 @samp{@@} in order to be interpreted correctly). Examples:
2313 $1..$3 @r{First three fields in the current row.}
2314 $P..$Q @r{Range, using column names (see under Advanced)}
2315 @@2$1..@@4$3 @r{6 fields between these two fields.}
2316 A2..C4 @r{Same as above.}
2317 @@-1$-2..@@-1 @r{3 numbers from the column to the left, 2 up to current row}
2320 @noindent Range references return a vector of values that can be fed
2321 into Calc vector functions. Empty fields in ranges are normally
2322 suppressed, so that the vector contains only the non-empty fields (but
2323 see the @samp{E} mode switch below). If there are no non-empty fields,
2324 @samp{[0]} is returned to avoid syntax errors in formulas.
2326 @subsubheading Field coordinates in formulas
2327 @cindex field coordinates
2328 @cindex coordinates, of field
2329 @cindex row, of field coordinates
2330 @cindex column, of field coordinates
2332 For Calc formulas and Lisp formulas @code{@@#} and @code{$#} can be used to
2333 get the row or column number of the field where the formula result goes.
2334 The traditional Lisp formula equivalents are @code{org-table-current-dline}
2335 and @code{org-table-current-column}. Examples:
2338 if(@@# % 2, $#, string("")) @r{column number on odd lines only}
2339 $3 = remote(FOO, @@@@#$2) @r{copy column 2 from table FOO into}
2340 @r{column 3 of the current table}
2343 @noindent For the second example, table FOO must have at least as many rows
2344 as the current table. Inefficient@footnote{The computation time scales as
2345 O(N^2) because table FOO is parsed for each field to be copied.} for large
2348 @subsubheading Named references
2349 @cindex named references
2350 @cindex references, named
2351 @cindex name, of column or field
2352 @cindex constants, in calculations
2355 @vindex org-table-formula-constants
2356 @samp{$name} is interpreted as the name of a column, parameter or
2357 constant. Constants are defined globally through the variable
2358 @code{org-table-formula-constants}, and locally (for the file) through a
2362 #+CONSTANTS: c=299792458. pi=3.14 eps=2.4e-6
2366 @vindex constants-unit-system
2367 @pindex constants.el
2368 Also properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}) can be used as
2369 constants in table formulas: for a property @samp{:Xyz:} use the name
2370 @samp{$PROP_Xyz}, and the property will be searched in the current
2371 outline entry and in the hierarchy above it. If you have the
2372 @file{constants.el} package, it will also be used to resolve constants,
2373 including natural constants like @samp{$h} for Planck's constant, and
2374 units like @samp{$km} for kilometers@footnote{@file{constants.el} can
2375 supply the values of constants in two different unit systems, @code{SI}
2376 and @code{cgs}. Which one is used depends on the value of the variable
2377 @code{constants-unit-system}. You can use the @code{#+STARTUP} options
2378 @code{constSI} and @code{constcgs} to set this value for the current
2379 buffer.}. Column names and parameters can be specified in special table
2380 lines. These are described below, see @ref{Advanced features}. All
2381 names must start with a letter, and further consist of letters and
2384 @subsubheading Remote references
2385 @cindex remote references
2386 @cindex references, remote
2387 @cindex references, to a different table
2388 @cindex name, of column or field
2389 @cindex constants, in calculations
2392 You may also reference constants, fields and ranges from a different table,
2393 either in the current file or even in a different file. The syntax is
2396 remote(NAME-OR-ID,REF)
2400 where NAME can be the name of a table in the current file as set by a
2401 @code{#+TBLNAME: NAME} line before the table. It can also be the ID of an
2402 entry, even in a different file, and the reference then refers to the first
2403 table in that entry. REF is an absolute field or range reference as
2404 described above for example @code{@@3$3} or @code{$somename}, valid in the
2407 @node Formula syntax for Calc, Formula syntax for Lisp, References, The spreadsheet
2408 @subsection Formula syntax for Calc
2409 @cindex formula syntax, Calc
2410 @cindex syntax, of formulas
2412 A formula can be any algebraic expression understood by the Emacs
2413 @file{Calc} package. @b{Note that @file{calc} has the
2414 non-standard convention that @samp{/} has lower precedence than
2415 @samp{*}, so that @samp{a/b*c} is interpreted as @samp{a/(b*c)}.} Before
2416 evaluation by @code{calc-eval} (@pxref{Calling Calc from
2417 Your Programs,calc-eval,Calling Calc from Your Lisp Programs,Calc,GNU
2418 Emacs Calc Manual}),
2419 @c FIXME: The link to the Calc manual in HTML does not work.
2420 variable substitution takes place according to the rules described above.
2421 @cindex vectors, in table calculations
2422 The range vectors can be directly fed into the Calc vector functions
2423 like @samp{vmean} and @samp{vsum}.
2425 @cindex format specifier
2426 @cindex mode, for @file{calc}
2427 @vindex org-calc-default-modes
2428 A formula can contain an optional mode string after a semicolon. This
2429 string consists of flags to influence Calc and other modes during
2430 execution. By default, Org uses the standard Calc modes (precision
2431 12, angular units degrees, fraction and symbolic modes off). The display
2432 format, however, has been changed to @code{(float 8)} to keep tables
2433 compact. The default settings can be configured using the variable
2434 @code{org-calc-default-modes}.
2437 p20 @r{set the internal Calc calculation precision to 20 digits}
2438 n3 s3 e2 f4 @r{Normal, scientific, engineering, or fixed}
2439 @r{format of the result of Calc passed back to Org.}
2440 @r{Calc formatting is unlimited in precision as}
2441 @r{long as the Calc calculation precision is greater.}
2442 D R @r{angle modes: degrees, radians}
2443 F S @r{fraction and symbolic modes}
2444 N @r{interpret all fields as numbers, use 0 for non-numbers}
2445 T @r{force text interpretation}
2446 E @r{keep empty fields in ranges}
2451 Unless you use large integer numbers or high-precision-calculation
2452 and -display for floating point numbers you may alternatively provide a
2453 @code{printf} format specifier to reformat the Calc result after it has been
2454 passed back to Org instead of letting Calc already do the
2455 formatting@footnote{The @code{printf} reformatting is limited in precision
2456 because the value passed to it is converted into an @code{integer} or
2457 @code{double}. The @code{integer} is limited in size by truncating the
2458 signed value to 32 bits. The @code{double} is limited in precision to 64
2459 bits overall which leaves approximately 16 significant decimal digits.}.
2463 $1+$2 @r{Sum of first and second field}
2464 $1+$2;%.2f @r{Same, format result to two decimals}
2465 exp($2)+exp($1) @r{Math functions can be used}
2466 $0;%.1f @r{Reformat current cell to 1 decimal}
2467 ($3-32)*5/9 @r{Degrees F -> C conversion}
2468 $c/$1/$cm @r{Hz -> cm conversion, using @file{constants.el}}
2469 tan($1);Dp3s1 @r{Compute in degrees, precision 3, display SCI 1}
2470 sin($1);Dp3%.1e @r{Same, but use printf specifier for display}
2471 vmean($2..$7) @r{Compute column range mean, using vector function}
2472 vmean($2..$7);EN @r{Same, but treat empty fields as 0}
2473 taylor($3,x=7,2) @r{taylor series of $3, at x=7, second degree}
2476 Calc also contains a complete set of logical operations. For example
2479 if($1<20,teen,string("")) @r{``teen'' if age $1 less than 20, else empty}
2482 @node Formula syntax for Lisp, Field formulas, Formula syntax for Calc, The spreadsheet
2483 @subsection Emacs Lisp forms as formulas
2484 @cindex Lisp forms, as table formulas
2486 It is also possible to write a formula in Emacs Lisp; this can be useful
2487 for string manipulation and control structures, if Calc's
2488 functionality is not enough. If a formula starts with a single-quote
2489 followed by an opening parenthesis, then it is evaluated as a Lisp form.
2490 The evaluation should return either a string or a number. Just as with
2491 @file{calc} formulas, you can specify modes and a printf format after a
2492 semicolon. With Emacs Lisp forms, you need to be conscious about the way
2493 field references are interpolated into the form. By default, a
2494 reference will be interpolated as a Lisp string (in double-quotes)
2495 containing the field. If you provide the @samp{N} mode switch, all
2496 referenced elements will be numbers (non-number fields will be zero) and
2497 interpolated as Lisp numbers, without quotes. If you provide the
2498 @samp{L} flag, all fields will be interpolated literally, without quotes.
2499 I.e., if you want a reference to be interpreted as a string by the Lisp
2500 form, enclose the reference operator itself in double-quotes, like
2501 @code{"$3"}. Ranges are inserted as space-separated fields, so you can
2502 embed them in list or vector syntax. A few examples, note how the
2503 @samp{N} mode is used when we do computations in Lisp.
2506 @r{Swap the first two characters of the content of column 1}
2507 '(concat (substring $1 1 2) (substring $1 0 1) (substring $1 2))
2508 @r{Add columns 1 and 2, equivalent to Calc's @code{$1+$2}}
2510 @r{Compute the sum of columns 1-4, like Calc's @code{vsum($1..$4)}}
2511 '(apply '+ '($1..$4));N
2514 @node Field formulas, Column formulas, Formula syntax for Lisp, The spreadsheet
2515 @subsection Field formulas
2516 @cindex field formula
2517 @cindex formula, for individual table field
2519 To assign a formula to a particular field, type it directly into the
2520 field, preceded by @samp{:=}, for example @samp{:=$1+$2}. When you
2521 press @key{TAB} or @key{RET} or @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in
2522 the field, the formula will be stored as the formula for this field,
2523 evaluated, and the current field replaced with the result.
2526 Formulas are stored in a special line starting with @samp{#+TBLFM:}
2527 directly below the table. If you typed the equation in the 4th field of
2528 the 3rd data line in the table, the formula will look like
2529 @samp{@@3$4=$1+$2}. When inserting/deleting/swapping column and rows
2530 with the appropriate commands, @i{absolute references} (but not relative
2531 ones) in stored formulas are modified in order to still reference the
2532 same field. Of course this is not true if you edit the table structure
2533 with normal editing commands---then you must fix the equations yourself.
2534 The left-hand side of a formula may also be a named field (@pxref{Advanced
2535 features}), or a last-row reference like @samp{$LR3}.
2537 Instead of typing an equation into the field, you may also use the
2541 @orgcmd{C-u C-c =,org-table-eval-formula}
2542 Install a new formula for the current field. The command prompts for a
2543 formula with default taken from the @samp{#+TBLFM:} line, applies
2544 it to the current field, and stores it.
2547 @node Column formulas, Editing and debugging formulas, Field formulas, The spreadsheet
2548 @subsection Column formulas
2549 @cindex column formula
2550 @cindex formula, for table column
2552 Often in a table, the same formula should be used for all fields in a
2553 particular column. Instead of having to copy the formula to all fields
2554 in that column, Org allows you to assign a single formula to an entire
2555 column. If the table contains horizontal separator hlines, everything
2556 before the first such line is considered part of the table @emph{header}
2557 and will not be modified by column formulas.
2559 To assign a formula to a column, type it directly into any field in the
2560 column, preceded by an equal sign, like @samp{=$1+$2}. When you press
2561 @key{TAB} or @key{RET} or @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the field,
2562 the formula will be stored as the formula for the current column, evaluated
2563 and the current field replaced with the result. If the field contains only
2564 @samp{=}, the previously stored formula for this column is used. For each
2565 column, Org will only remember the most recently used formula. In the
2566 @samp{#+TBLFM:} line, column formulas will look like @samp{$4=$1+$2}. The left-hand
2567 side of a column formula cannot currently be the name of column, it
2568 must be the numeric column reference.
2570 Instead of typing an equation into the field, you may also use the
2574 @orgcmd{C-c =,org-table-eval-formula}
2575 Install a new formula for the current column and replace current field with
2576 the result of the formula. The command prompts for a formula, with default
2577 taken from the @samp{#+TBLFM} line, applies it to the current field and
2578 stores it. With a numeric prefix argument(e.g. @kbd{C-5 C-c =}) the command
2579 will apply it to that many consecutive fields in the current column.
2582 @node Editing and debugging formulas, Updating the table, Column formulas, The spreadsheet
2583 @subsection Editing and debugging formulas
2584 @cindex formula editing
2585 @cindex editing, of table formulas
2587 @vindex org-table-use-standard-references
2588 You can edit individual formulas in the minibuffer or directly in the
2589 field. Org can also prepare a special buffer with all active
2590 formulas of a table. When offering a formula for editing, Org
2591 converts references to the standard format (like @code{B3} or @code{D&})
2592 if possible. If you prefer to only work with the internal format (like
2593 @code{@@3$2} or @code{$4}), configure the variable
2594 @code{org-table-use-standard-references}.
2597 @orgcmdkkc{C-c =,C-u C-c =,org-table-eval-formula}
2598 Edit the formula associated with the current column/field in the
2599 minibuffer. See @ref{Column formulas}, and @ref{Field formulas}.
2600 @orgcmd{C-u C-u C-c =,org-table-eval-formula}
2601 Re-insert the active formula (either a
2602 field formula, or a column formula) into the current field, so that you
2603 can edit it directly in the field. The advantage over editing in the
2604 minibuffer is that you can use the command @kbd{C-c ?}.
2605 @orgcmd{C-c ?,org-table-field-info}
2606 While editing a formula in a table field, highlight the field(s)
2607 referenced by the reference at the cursor position in the formula.
2609 @findex org-table-toggle-coordinate-overlays
2611 Toggle the display of row and column numbers for a table, using overlays
2612 (@command{org-table-toggle-coordinate-overlays}). These are updated each
2613 time the table is aligned; you can force it with @kbd{C-c C-c}.
2615 @findex org-table-toggle-formula-debugger
2617 Toggle the formula debugger on and off
2618 (@command{org-table-toggle-formula-debugger}). See below.
2619 @orgcmd{C-c ',org-table-edit-formulas}
2620 Edit all formulas for the current table in a special buffer, where the
2621 formulas will be displayed one per line. If the current field has an
2622 active formula, the cursor in the formula editor will mark it.
2623 While inside the special buffer, Org will automatically highlight
2624 any field or range reference at the cursor position. You may edit,
2625 remove and add formulas, and use the following commands:
2627 @orgcmdkkc{C-c C-c,C-x C-s,org-table-fedit-finish}
2628 Exit the formula editor and store the modified formulas. With @kbd{C-u}
2629 prefix, also apply the new formulas to the entire table.
2630 @orgcmd{C-c C-q,org-table-fedit-abort}
2631 Exit the formula editor without installing changes.
2632 @orgcmd{C-c C-r,org-table-fedit-toggle-ref-type}
2633 Toggle all references in the formula editor between standard (like
2634 @code{B3}) and internal (like @code{@@3$2}).
2635 @orgcmd{@key{TAB},org-table-fedit-lisp-indent}
2636 Pretty-print or indent Lisp formula at point. When in a line containing
2637 a Lisp formula, format the formula according to Emacs Lisp rules.
2638 Another @key{TAB} collapses the formula back again. In the open
2639 formula, @key{TAB} re-indents just like in Emacs Lisp mode.
2640 @orgcmd{M-@key{TAB},lisp-complete-symbol}
2641 Complete Lisp symbols, just like in Emacs Lisp mode.
2643 @kindex S-@key{down}
2644 @kindex S-@key{left}
2645 @kindex S-@key{right}
2646 @findex org-table-fedit-ref-up
2647 @findex org-table-fedit-ref-down
2648 @findex org-table-fedit-ref-left
2649 @findex org-table-fedit-ref-right
2650 @item S-@key{up}/@key{down}/@key{left}/@key{right}
2651 Shift the reference at point. For example, if the reference is
2652 @code{B3} and you press @kbd{S-@key{right}}, it will become @code{C3}.
2653 This also works for relative references and for hline references.
2654 @orgcmdkkcc{M-S-@key{up},M-S-@key{down},org-table-fedit-line-up,org-table-fedit-line-down}
2655 Move the test line for column formulas in the Org buffer up and
2657 @orgcmdkkcc{M-@key{up},M-@key{down},org-table-fedit-scroll-down,org-table-fedit-scroll-up}
2658 Scroll the window displaying the table.
2660 @findex org-table-toggle-coordinate-overlays
2662 Turn the coordinate grid in the table on and off.
2666 Making a table field blank does not remove the formula associated with
2667 the field, because that is stored in a different line (the @samp{#+TBLFM}
2668 line)---during the next recalculation the field will be filled again.
2669 To remove a formula from a field, you have to give an empty reply when
2670 prompted for the formula, or to edit the @samp{#+TBLFM} line.
2673 You may edit the @samp{#+TBLFM} directly and re-apply the changed
2674 equations with @kbd{C-c C-c} in that line or with the normal
2675 recalculation commands in the table.
2677 @subsubheading Debugging formulas
2678 @cindex formula debugging
2679 @cindex debugging, of table formulas
2680 When the evaluation of a formula leads to an error, the field content
2681 becomes the string @samp{#ERROR}. If you would like see what is going
2682 on during variable substitution and calculation in order to find a bug,
2683 turn on formula debugging in the @code{Tbl} menu and repeat the
2684 calculation, for example by pressing @kbd{C-u C-u C-c = @key{RET}} in a
2685 field. Detailed information will be displayed.
2687 @node Updating the table, Advanced features, Editing and debugging formulas, The spreadsheet
2688 @subsection Updating the table
2689 @cindex recomputing table fields
2690 @cindex updating, table
2692 Recalculation of a table is normally not automatic, but needs to be
2693 triggered by a command. See @ref{Advanced features}, for a way to make
2694 recalculation at least semi-automatic.
2696 In order to recalculate a line of a table or the entire table, use the
2700 @orgcmd{C-c *,org-table-recalculate}
2701 Recalculate the current row by first applying the stored column formulas
2702 from left to right, and all field formulas in the current row.
2708 Recompute the entire table, line by line. Any lines before the first
2709 hline are left alone, assuming that these are part of the table header.
2711 @orgcmdkkc{C-u C-u C-c *,C-u C-u C-c C-c,org-table-iterate}
2712 Iterate the table by recomputing it until no further changes occur.
2713 This may be necessary if some computed fields use the value of other
2714 fields that are computed @i{later} in the calculation sequence.
2715 @item M-x org-table-recalculate-buffer-tables
2716 @findex org-table-recalculate-buffer-tables
2717 Recompute all tables in the current buffer.
2718 @item M-x org-table-iterate-buffer-tables
2719 @findex org-table-iterate-buffer-tables
2720 Iterate all tables in the current buffer, in order to converge table-to-table
2724 @node Advanced features, , Updating the table, The spreadsheet
2725 @subsection Advanced features
2727 If you want the recalculation of fields to happen automatically, or if
2728 you want to be able to assign @i{names} to fields and columns, you need
2729 to reserve the first column of the table for special marking characters.
2731 @orgcmd{C-#,org-table-rotate-recalc-marks}
2732 Rotate the calculation mark in first column through the states @samp{ },
2733 @samp{#}, @samp{*}, @samp{!}, @samp{$}. When there is an active region,
2734 change all marks in the region.
2737 Here is an example of a table that collects exam results of students and
2738 makes use of these features:
2742 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2743 | | Student | Prob 1 | Prob 2 | Prob 3 | Total | Note |
2744 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2745 | ! | | P1 | P2 | P3 | Tot | |
2746 | # | Maximum | 10 | 15 | 25 | 50 | 10.0 |
2747 | ^ | | m1 | m2 | m3 | mt | |
2748 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2749 | # | Peter | 10 | 8 | 23 | 41 | 8.2 |
2750 | # | Sam | 2 | 4 | 3 | 9 | 1.8 |
2751 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2752 | | Average | | | | 29.7 | |
2753 | ^ | | | | | at | |
2754 | $ | max=50 | | | | | |
2755 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2756 #+TBLFM: $6=vsum($P1..$P3)::$7=10*$Tot/$max;%.1f::$at=vmean(@@-II..@@-I);%.1f
2760 @noindent @b{Important}: please note that for these special tables,
2761 recalculating the table with @kbd{C-u C-c *} will only affect rows that
2762 are marked @samp{#} or @samp{*}, and fields that have a formula assigned
2763 to the field itself. The column formulas are not applied in rows with
2766 @cindex marking characters, tables
2767 The marking characters have the following meaning:
2770 The fields in this line define names for the columns, so that you may
2771 refer to a column as @samp{$Tot} instead of @samp{$6}.
2773 This row defines names for the fields @emph{above} the row. With such
2774 a definition, any formula in the table may use @samp{$m1} to refer to
2775 the value @samp{10}. Also, if you assign a formula to a names field, it
2776 will be stored as @samp{$name=...}.
2778 Similar to @samp{^}, but defines names for the fields in the row
2781 Fields in this row can define @emph{parameters} for formulas. For
2782 example, if a field in a @samp{$} row contains @samp{max=50}, then
2783 formulas in this table can refer to the value 50 using @samp{$max}.
2784 Parameters work exactly like constants, only that they can be defined on
2787 Fields in this row are automatically recalculated when pressing
2788 @key{TAB} or @key{RET} or @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} in this row. Also, this row
2789 is selected for a global recalculation with @kbd{C-u C-c *}. Unmarked
2790 lines will be left alone by this command.
2792 Selects this line for global recalculation with @kbd{C-u C-c *}, but
2793 not for automatic recalculation. Use this when automatic
2794 recalculation slows down editing too much.
2796 Unmarked lines are exempt from recalculation with @kbd{C-u C-c *}.
2797 All lines that should be recalculated should be marked with @samp{#}
2800 Do not export this line. Useful for lines that contain the narrowing
2801 @samp{<N>} markers or column group markers.
2804 Finally, just to whet your appetite for what can be done with the
2805 fantastic @file{calc.el} package, here is a table that computes the Taylor
2806 series of degree @code{n} at location @code{x} for a couple of
2811 |---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------|
2812 | | Func | n | x | Result |
2813 |---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------|
2814 | # | exp(x) | 1 | x | 1 + x |
2815 | # | exp(x) | 2 | x | 1 + x + x^2 / 2 |
2816 | # | exp(x) | 3 | x | 1 + x + x^2 / 2 + x^3 / 6 |
2817 | # | x^2+sqrt(x) | 2 | x=0 | x*(0.5 / 0) + x^2 (2 - 0.25 / 0) / 2 |
2818 | # | x^2+sqrt(x) | 2 | x=1 | 2 + 2.5 x - 2.5 + 0.875 (x - 1)^2 |
2819 | * | tan(x) | 3 | x | 0.0175 x + 1.77e-6 x^3 |
2820 |---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------|
2821 #+TBLFM: $5=taylor($2,$4,$3);n3
2825 @node Org-Plot, , The spreadsheet, Tables
2827 @cindex graph, in tables
2828 @cindex plot tables using Gnuplot
2831 Org-Plot can produce 2D and 3D graphs of information stored in org tables
2832 using @file{Gnuplot} @uref{http://www.gnuplot.info/} and @file{gnuplot-mode}
2833 @uref{http://cars9.uchicago.edu/~ravel/software/gnuplot-mode.html}. To see
2834 this in action, ensure that you have both Gnuplot and Gnuplot mode installed
2835 on your system, then call @code{org-plot/gnuplot} on the following table.
2839 #+PLOT: title:"Citas" ind:1 deps:(3) type:2d with:histograms set:"yrange [0:]"
2840 | Sede | Max cites | H-index |
2841 |-----------+-----------+---------|
2842 | Chile | 257.72 | 21.39 |
2843 | Leeds | 165.77 | 19.68 |
2844 | Sao Paolo | 71.00 | 11.50 |
2845 | Stockholm | 134.19 | 14.33 |
2846 | Morelia | 257.56 | 17.67 |
2850 Notice that Org Plot is smart enough to apply the table's headers as labels.
2851 Further control over the labels, type, content, and appearance of plots can
2852 be exercised through the @code{#+PLOT:} lines preceding a table. See below
2853 for a complete list of Org-plot options. For more information and examples
2854 see the Org-plot tutorial at
2855 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-tutorials/org-plot.php}.
2857 @subsubheading Plot Options
2861 Specify any @command{gnuplot} option to be set when graphing.
2864 Specify the title of the plot.
2867 Specify which column of the table to use as the @code{x} axis.
2870 Specify the columns to graph as a Lisp style list, surrounded by parentheses
2871 and separated by spaces for example @code{dep:(3 4)} to graph the third and
2872 fourth columns (defaults to graphing all other columns aside from the @code{ind}
2876 Specify whether the plot will be @code{2d}, @code{3d}, or @code{grid}.
2879 Specify a @code{with} option to be inserted for every col being plotted
2880 (e.g. @code{lines}, @code{points}, @code{boxes}, @code{impulses}, etc...).
2881 Defaults to @code{lines}.
2884 If you want to plot to a file, specify @code{"@var{path/to/desired/output-file}"}.
2887 List of labels to be used for the deps (defaults to the column headers if
2891 Specify an entire line to be inserted in the Gnuplot script.
2894 When plotting @code{3d} or @code{grid} types, set this to @code{t} to graph a
2895 flat mapping rather than a @code{3d} slope.
2898 Specify format of Org-mode timestamps as they will be parsed by Gnuplot.
2899 Defaults to @samp{%Y-%m-%d-%H:%M:%S}.
2902 If you want total control, you can specify a script file (place the file name
2903 between double-quotes) which will be used to plot. Before plotting, every
2904 instance of @code{$datafile} in the specified script will be replaced with
2905 the path to the generated data file. Note: even if you set this option, you
2906 may still want to specify the plot type, as that can impact the content of
2910 @node Hyperlinks, TODO Items, Tables, Top
2914 Like HTML, Org provides links inside a file, external links to
2915 other files, Usenet articles, emails, and much more.
2918 * Link format:: How links in Org are formatted
2919 * Internal links:: Links to other places in the current file
2920 * External links:: URL-like links to the world
2921 * Handling links:: Creating, inserting and following
2922 * Using links outside Org:: Linking from my C source code?
2923 * Link abbreviations:: Shortcuts for writing complex links
2924 * Search options:: Linking to a specific location
2925 * Custom searches:: When the default search is not enough
2928 @node Link format, Internal links, Hyperlinks, Hyperlinks
2929 @section Link format
2931 @cindex format, of links
2933 Org will recognize plain URL-like links and activate them as
2934 clickable links. The general link format, however, looks like this:
2937 [[link][description]] @r{or alternatively} [[link]]
2941 Once a link in the buffer is complete (all brackets present), Org
2942 will change the display so that @samp{description} is displayed instead
2943 of @samp{[[link][description]]} and @samp{link} is displayed instead of
2944 @samp{[[link]]}. Links will be highlighted in the face @code{org-link},
2945 which by default is an underlined face. You can directly edit the
2946 visible part of a link. Note that this can be either the @samp{link}
2947 part (if there is no description) or the @samp{description} part. To
2948 edit also the invisible @samp{link} part, use @kbd{C-c C-l} with the
2951 If you place the cursor at the beginning or just behind the end of the
2952 displayed text and press @key{BACKSPACE}, you will remove the
2953 (invisible) bracket at that location. This makes the link incomplete
2954 and the internals are again displayed as plain text. Inserting the
2955 missing bracket hides the link internals again. To show the
2956 internal structure of all links, use the menu entry
2957 @code{Org->Hyperlinks->Literal links}.
2959 @node Internal links, External links, Link format, Hyperlinks
2960 @section Internal links
2961 @cindex internal links
2962 @cindex links, internal
2963 @cindex targets, for links
2965 @cindex property, CUSTOM_ID
2966 If the link does not look like a URL, it is considered to be internal in the
2967 current file. The most important case is a link like
2968 @samp{[[#my-custom-id]]} which will link to the entry with the
2969 @code{CUSTOM_ID} property @samp{my-custom-id}. Such custom IDs are very good
2970 for HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}) where they produce pretty section
2971 links. You are responsible yourself to make sure these custom IDs are unique
2974 Links such as @samp{[[My Target]]} or @samp{[[My Target][Find my target]]}
2975 lead to a text search in the current file.
2977 The link can be followed with @kbd{C-c C-o} when the cursor is on the link,
2978 or with a mouse click (@pxref{Handling links}). Links to custom IDs will
2979 point to the corresponding headline. The preferred match for a text link is
2980 a @i{dedicated target}: the same string in double angular brackets. Targets
2981 may be located anywhere; sometimes it is convenient to put them into a
2982 comment line. For example
2988 @noindent In HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}), such targets will become
2989 named anchors for direct access through @samp{http} links@footnote{Note that
2990 text before the first headline is usually not exported, so the first such
2991 target should be after the first headline, or in the line directly before the
2994 If no dedicated target exists, Org will search for a headline that is exactly
2995 the link text but may also include a TODO keyword and tags@footnote{To insert
2996 a link targeting a headline, in-buffer completion can be used. Just type a
2997 star followed by a few optional letters into the buffer and press
2998 @kbd{M-@key{TAB}}. All headlines in the current buffer will be offered as
2999 completions.}. In non-Org files, the search will look for the words in the
3000 link text, in the above example the search would be for @samp{my target}.
3002 Following a link pushes a mark onto Org's own mark ring. You can
3003 return to the previous position with @kbd{C-c &}. Using this command
3004 several times in direct succession goes back to positions recorded
3008 * Radio targets:: Make targets trigger links in plain text
3011 @node Radio targets, , Internal links, Internal links
3012 @subsection Radio targets
3013 @cindex radio targets
3014 @cindex targets, radio
3015 @cindex links, radio targets
3017 Org can automatically turn any occurrences of certain target names
3018 in normal text into a link. So without explicitly creating a link, the
3019 text connects to the target radioing its position. Radio targets are
3020 enclosed by triple angular brackets. For example, a target @samp{<<<My
3021 Target>>>} causes each occurrence of @samp{my target} in normal text to
3022 become activated as a link. The Org file is scanned automatically
3023 for radio targets only when the file is first loaded into Emacs. To
3024 update the target list during editing, press @kbd{C-c C-c} with the
3025 cursor on or at a target.
3027 @node External links, Handling links, Internal links, Hyperlinks
3028 @section External links
3029 @cindex links, external
3030 @cindex external links
3031 @cindex links, external
3039 @cindex WANDERLUST links
3041 @cindex USENET links
3046 Org supports links to files, websites, Usenet and email messages,
3047 BBDB database entries and links to both IRC conversations and their
3048 logs. External links are URL-like locators. They start with a short
3049 identifying string followed by a colon. There can be no space after
3050 the colon. The following list shows examples for each link type.
3053 http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik @r{on the web}
3054 doi:10.1000/182 @r{DOI for an electronic resource}
3055 file:/home/dominik/images/jupiter.jpg @r{file, absolute path}
3056 /home/dominik/images/jupiter.jpg @r{same as above}
3057 file:papers/last.pdf @r{file, relative path}
3058 ./papers/last.pdf @r{same as above}
3059 file:/myself@@some.where:papers/last.pdf @r{file, path on remote machine}
3060 /myself@@some.where:papers/last.pdf @r{same as above}
3061 file:sometextfile::NNN @r{file with line number to jump to}
3062 file:projects.org @r{another Org file}
3063 file:projects.org::some words @r{text search in Org file}
3064 file:projects.org::*task title @r{heading search in Org file}
3065 docview:papers/last.pdf::NNN @r{open file in doc-view mode at page NNN}
3066 id:B7423F4D-2E8A-471B-8810-C40F074717E9 @r{Link to heading by ID}
3067 news:comp.emacs @r{Usenet link}
3068 mailto:adent@@galaxy.net @r{Mail link}
3069 vm:folder @r{VM folder link}
3070 vm:folder#id @r{VM message link}
3071 vm://myself@@some.where.org/folder#id @r{VM on remote machine}
3072 wl:folder @r{WANDERLUST folder link}
3073 wl:folder#id @r{WANDERLUST message link}
3074 mhe:folder @r{MH-E folder link}
3075 mhe:folder#id @r{MH-E message link}
3076 rmail:folder @r{RMAIL folder link}
3077 rmail:folder#id @r{RMAIL message link}
3078 gnus:group @r{Gnus group link}
3079 gnus:group#id @r{Gnus article link}
3080 bbdb:R.*Stallman @r{BBDB link (with regexp)}
3081 irc:/irc.com/#emacs/bob @r{IRC link}
3082 info:org:External%20links @r{Info node link (with encoded space)}
3083 shell:ls *.org @r{A shell command}
3084 elisp:org-agenda @r{Interactive Elisp command}
3085 elisp:(find-file-other-frame "Elisp.org") @r{Elisp form to evaluate}
3088 A link should be enclosed in double brackets and may contain a
3089 descriptive text to be displayed instead of the URL (@pxref{Link
3090 format}), for example:
3093 [[http://www.gnu.org/software/emacs/][GNU Emacs]]
3097 If the description is a file name or URL that points to an image, HTML
3098 export (@pxref{HTML export}) will inline the image as a clickable
3099 button. If there is no description at all and the link points to an
3101 that image will be inlined into the exported HTML file.
3103 @cindex square brackets, around links
3104 @cindex plain text external links
3105 Org also finds external links in the normal text and activates them
3106 as links. If spaces must be part of the link (for example in
3107 @samp{bbdb:Richard Stallman}), or if you need to remove ambiguities
3108 about the end of the link, enclose them in square brackets.
3110 @node Handling links, Using links outside Org, External links, Hyperlinks
3111 @section Handling links
3112 @cindex links, handling
3114 Org provides methods to create a link in the correct syntax, to
3115 insert it into an Org file, and to follow the link.
3118 @orgcmd{C-c l,org-store-link}
3119 @cindex storing links
3120 Store a link to the current location. This is a @emph{global} command (you
3121 must create the key binding yourself) which can be used in any buffer to
3122 create a link. The link will be stored for later insertion into an Org
3123 buffer (see below). What kind of link will be created depends on the current
3126 @b{Org-mode buffers}@*
3127 For Org files, if there is a @samp{<<target>>} at the cursor, the link points
3128 to the target. Otherwise it points to the current headline, which will also
3131 @vindex org-link-to-org-use-id
3132 @cindex property, CUSTOM_ID
3133 @cindex property, ID
3134 If the headline has a @code{CUSTOM_ID} property, a link to this custom ID
3135 will be stored. In addition or alternatively (depending on the value of
3136 @code{org-link-to-org-use-id}), a globally unique @code{ID} property will be
3137 created and/or used to construct a link. So using this command in Org
3138 buffers will potentially create two links: a human-readable from the custom
3139 ID, and one that is globally unique and works even if the entry is moved from
3140 file to file. Later, when inserting the link, you need to decide which one
3143 @b{Email/News clients: VM, Rmail, Wanderlust, MH-E, Gnus}@*
3144 Pretty much all Emacs mail clients are supported. The link will point to the
3145 current article, or, in some GNUS buffers, to the group. The description is
3146 constructed from the author and the subject.
3148 @b{Web browsers: W3 and W3M}@*
3149 Here the link will be the current URL, with the page title as description.
3151 @b{Contacts: BBDB}@*
3152 Links created in a BBDB buffer will point to the current entry.
3155 @vindex org-irc-link-to-logs
3156 For IRC links, if you set the variable @code{org-irc-link-to-logs} to
3157 @code{t}, a @samp{file:/} style link to the relevant point in the logs for
3158 the current conversation is created. Otherwise an @samp{irc:/} style link to
3159 the user/channel/server under the point will be stored.
3162 For any other files, the link will point to the file, with a search string
3163 (@pxref{Search options}) pointing to the contents of the current line. If
3164 there is an active region, the selected words will form the basis of the
3165 search string. If the automatically created link is not working correctly or
3166 accurately enough, you can write custom functions to select the search string
3167 and to do the search for particular file types---see @ref{Custom searches}.
3168 The key binding @kbd{C-c l} is only a suggestion---see @ref{Installation}.
3171 When the cursor is in an agenda view, the created link points to the
3172 entry referenced by the current line.
3175 @orgcmd{C-c C-l,org-insert-link}
3176 @cindex link completion
3177 @cindex completion, of links
3178 @cindex inserting links
3179 @vindex org-keep-stored-link-after-insertion
3180 Insert a link@footnote{ Note that you don't have to use this command to
3181 insert a link. Links in Org are plain text, and you can type or paste them
3182 straight into the buffer. By using this command, the links are automatically
3183 enclosed in double brackets, and you will be asked for the optional
3184 descriptive text.}. This prompts for a link to be inserted into the buffer.
3185 You can just type a link, using text for an internal link, or one of the link
3186 type prefixes mentioned in the examples above. The link will be inserted
3187 into the buffer@footnote{After insertion of a stored link, the link will be
3188 removed from the list of stored links. To keep it in the list later use, use
3189 a triple @kbd{C-u} prefix argument to @kbd{C-c C-l}, or configure the option
3190 @code{org-keep-stored-link-after-insertion}.}, along with a descriptive text.
3191 If some text was selected when this command is called, the selected text
3192 becomes the default description.
3194 @b{Inserting stored links}@*
3195 All links stored during the
3196 current session are part of the history for this prompt, so you can access
3197 them with @key{up} and @key{down} (or @kbd{M-p/n}).
3199 @b{Completion support}@* Completion with @key{TAB} will help you to insert
3200 valid link prefixes like @samp{http:} or @samp{ftp:}, including the prefixes
3201 defined through link abbreviations (@pxref{Link abbreviations}). If you
3202 press @key{RET} after inserting only the @var{prefix}, Org will offer
3203 specific completion support for some link types@footnote{This works by
3204 calling a special function @code{org-PREFIX-complete-link}.} For
3205 example, if you type @kbd{file @key{RET}}, file name completion (alternative
3206 access: @kbd{C-u C-c C-l}, see below) will be offered, and after @kbd{bbdb
3207 @key{RET}} you can complete contact names.
3209 @cindex file name completion
3210 @cindex completion, of file names
3211 When @kbd{C-c C-l} is called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, a link to
3212 a file will be inserted and you may use file name completion to select
3213 the name of the file. The path to the file is inserted relative to the
3214 directory of the current Org file, if the linked file is in the current
3215 directory or in a sub-directory of it, or if the path is written relative
3216 to the current directory using @samp{../}. Otherwise an absolute path
3217 is used, if possible with @samp{~/} for your home directory. You can
3218 force an absolute path with two @kbd{C-u} prefixes.
3220 @item C-c C-l @ @r{(with cursor on existing link)}
3221 When the cursor is on an existing link, @kbd{C-c C-l} allows you to edit the
3222 link and description parts of the link.
3224 @cindex following links
3225 @orgcmd{C-c C-o,org-open-at-point}
3226 @vindex org-file-apps
3227 Open link at point. This will launch a web browser for URLs (using
3228 @command{browse-url-at-point}), run VM/MH-E/Wanderlust/Rmail/Gnus/BBDB for
3229 the corresponding links, and execute the command in a shell link. When the
3230 cursor is on an internal link, this command runs the corresponding search.
3231 When the cursor is on a TAG list in a headline, it creates the corresponding
3232 TAGS view. If the cursor is on a timestamp, it compiles the agenda for that
3233 date. Furthermore, it will visit text and remote files in @samp{file:} links
3234 with Emacs and select a suitable application for local non-text files.
3235 Classification of files is based on file extension only. See option
3236 @code{org-file-apps}. If you want to override the default application and
3237 visit the file with Emacs, use a @kbd{C-u} prefix. If you want to avoid
3238 opening in Emacs, use a @kbd{C-u C-u} prefix.@*
3239 If the cursor is on a headline, but not on a link, offer all links in the
3240 headline and entry text.
3242 @vindex org-return-follows-link
3243 When @code{org-return-follows-link} is set, @kbd{@key{RET}} will also follow
3250 On links, @kbd{mouse-2} will open the link just as @kbd{C-c C-o}
3251 would. Under Emacs 22 and later, @kbd{mouse-1} will also follow a link.
3255 @vindex org-display-internal-link-with-indirect-buffer
3256 Like @kbd{mouse-2}, but force file links to be opened with Emacs, and
3257 internal links to be displayed in another window@footnote{See the
3258 variable @code{org-display-internal-link-with-indirect-buffer}}.
3260 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-v,org-toggle-inline-images}
3261 @cindex inlining images
3262 @cindex images, inlining
3263 @vindex org-startup-with-inline-images
3264 @cindex @code{inlineimages}, STARTUP keyword
3265 @cindex @code{noinlineimages}, STARTUP keyword
3266 Toggle the inline display of linked images. Normally this will only inline
3267 images that have no description part in the link, i.e. images that will also
3268 be inlined during export. When called with a prefix argument, also display
3269 images that do have a link description. You can ask for inline images to be
3270 displayed at startup by configuring the variable
3271 @code{org-startup-with-inline-images}@footnote{with corresponding
3272 @code{#+STARTUP} keywords @code{inlineimages} and @code{inlineimages}}.
3273 @orgcmd{C-c %,org-mark-ring-push}
3275 Push the current position onto the mark ring, to be able to return
3276 easily. Commands following an internal link do this automatically.
3278 @orgcmd{C-c &,org-mark-ring-goto}
3279 @cindex links, returning to
3280 Jump back to a recorded position. A position is recorded by the
3281 commands following internal links, and by @kbd{C-c %}. Using this
3282 command several times in direct succession moves through a ring of
3283 previously recorded positions.
3285 @orgcmdkkcc{C-c C-x C-n,C-c C-x C-p,org-next-link,org-previous-link}
3286 @cindex links, finding next/previous
3287 Move forward/backward to the next link in the buffer. At the limit of
3288 the buffer, the search fails once, and then wraps around. The key
3289 bindings for this are really too long, you might want to bind this also
3290 to @kbd{C-n} and @kbd{C-p}
3292 (add-hook 'org-load-hook
3294 (define-key 'org-mode-map "\C-n" 'org-next-link)
3295 (define-key 'org-mode-map "\C-p" 'org-previous-link)))
3299 @node Using links outside Org, Link abbreviations, Handling links, Hyperlinks
3300 @section Using links outside Org
3302 You can insert and follow links that have Org syntax not only in
3303 Org, but in any Emacs buffer. For this, you should create two
3304 global commands, like this (please select suitable global keys
3308 (global-set-key "\C-c L" 'org-insert-link-global)
3309 (global-set-key "\C-c o" 'org-open-at-point-global)
3312 @node Link abbreviations, Search options, Using links outside Org, Hyperlinks
3313 @section Link abbreviations
3314 @cindex link abbreviations
3315 @cindex abbreviation, links
3317 Long URLs can be cumbersome to type, and often many similar links are
3318 needed in a document. For this you can use link abbreviations. An
3319 abbreviated link looks like this
3322 [[linkword:tag][description]]
3326 @vindex org-link-abbrev-alist
3327 where the tag is optional.
3328 The @i{linkword} must be a word, starting with a letter, followed by
3329 letters, numbers, @samp{-}, and @samp{_}. Abbreviations are resolved
3330 according to the information in the variable @code{org-link-abbrev-alist}
3331 that relates the linkwords to replacement text. Here is an example:
3335 (setq org-link-abbrev-alist
3336 '(("bugzilla" . "http://10.1.2.9/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=")
3337 ("google" . "http://www.google.com/search?q=")
3338 ("gmap" . "http://maps.google.com/maps?q=%s")
3339 ("omap" . "http://nominatim.openstreetmap.org/search?q=%s&polygon=1")
3340 ("ads" . "http://adsabs.harvard.edu/cgi-bin/nph-abs_connect?author=%s&db_key=AST")))
3344 If the replacement text contains the string @samp{%s}, it will be
3345 replaced with the tag. Otherwise the tag will be appended to the string
3346 in order to create the link. You may also specify a function that will
3347 be called with the tag as the only argument to create the link.
3349 With the above setting, you could link to a specific bug with
3350 @code{[[bugzilla:129]]}, search the web for @samp{OrgMode} with
3351 @code{[[google:OrgMode]]}, show the map location of the Free Software
3352 Foundation @code{[[gmap:51 Franklin Street, Boston]]} or of Carsten office
3353 @code{[[omap:Science Park 904, Amsterdam, The Netherlands]]} and find out
3354 what the Org author is doing besides Emacs hacking with
3355 @code{[[ads:Dominik,C]]}.
3357 If you need special abbreviations just for a single Org buffer, you
3358 can define them in the file with
3362 #+LINK: bugzilla http://10.1.2.9/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=
3363 #+LINK: google http://www.google.com/search?q=%s
3367 In-buffer completion (@pxref{Completion}) can be used after @samp{[} to
3368 complete link abbreviations. You may also define a function
3369 @code{org-PREFIX-complete-link} that implements special (e.g. completion)
3370 support for inserting such a link with @kbd{C-c C-l}. Such a function should
3371 not accept any arguments, and return the full link with prefix.
3373 @node Search options, Custom searches, Link abbreviations, Hyperlinks
3374 @section Search options in file links
3375 @cindex search option in file links
3376 @cindex file links, searching
3378 File links can contain additional information to make Emacs jump to a
3379 particular location in the file when following a link. This can be a
3380 line number or a search option after a double@footnote{For backward
3381 compatibility, line numbers can also follow a single colon.} colon. For
3382 example, when the command @kbd{C-c l} creates a link (@pxref{Handling
3383 links}) to a file, it encodes the words in the current line as a search
3384 string that can be used to find this line back later when following the
3385 link with @kbd{C-c C-o}.
3387 Here is the syntax of the different ways to attach a search to a file
3388 link, together with an explanation:
3391 [[file:~/code/main.c::255]]
3392 [[file:~/xx.org::My Target]]
3393 [[file:~/xx.org::*My Target]]
3394 [[file:~/xx.org::#my-custom-id]]
3395 [[file:~/xx.org::/regexp/]]
3402 Search for a link target @samp{<<My Target>>}, or do a text search for
3403 @samp{my target}, similar to the search in internal links, see
3404 @ref{Internal links}. In HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}), such a file
3405 link will become an HTML reference to the corresponding named anchor in
3408 In an Org file, restrict search to headlines.
3410 Link to a heading with a @code{CUSTOM_ID} property
3412 Do a regular expression search for @code{regexp}. This uses the Emacs
3413 command @code{occur} to list all matches in a separate window. If the
3414 target file is in Org-mode, @code{org-occur} is used to create a
3415 sparse tree with the matches.
3416 @c If the target file is a directory,
3417 @c @code{grep} will be used to search all files in the directory.
3420 As a degenerate case, a file link with an empty file name can be used
3421 to search the current file. For example, @code{[[file:::find me]]} does
3422 a search for @samp{find me} in the current file, just as
3423 @samp{[[find me]]} would.
3425 @node Custom searches, , Search options, Hyperlinks
3426 @section Custom Searches
3427 @cindex custom search strings
3428 @cindex search strings, custom
3430 The default mechanism for creating search strings and for doing the
3431 actual search related to a file link may not work correctly in all
3432 cases. For example, Bib@TeX{} database files have many entries like
3433 @samp{year="1993"} which would not result in good search strings,
3434 because the only unique identification for a Bib@TeX{} entry is the
3437 @vindex org-create-file-search-functions
3438 @vindex org-execute-file-search-functions
3439 If you come across such a problem, you can write custom functions to set
3440 the right search string for a particular file type, and to do the search
3441 for the string in the file. Using @code{add-hook}, these functions need
3442 to be added to the hook variables
3443 @code{org-create-file-search-functions} and
3444 @code{org-execute-file-search-functions}. See the docstring for these
3445 variables for more information. Org actually uses this mechanism
3446 for Bib@TeX{} database files, and you can use the corresponding code as
3447 an implementation example. See the file @file{org-bibtex.el}.
3449 @node TODO Items, Tags, Hyperlinks, Top
3453 Org-mode does not maintain TODO lists as separate documents@footnote{Of
3454 course, you can make a document that contains only long lists of TODO items,
3455 but this is not required.}. Instead, TODO items are an integral part of the
3456 notes file, because TODO items usually come up while taking notes! With Org
3457 mode, simply mark any entry in a tree as being a TODO item. In this way,
3458 information is not duplicated, and the entire context from which the TODO
3459 item emerged is always present.
3461 Of course, this technique for managing TODO items scatters them
3462 throughout your notes file. Org-mode compensates for this by providing
3463 methods to give you an overview of all the things that you have to do.
3466 * TODO basics:: Marking and displaying TODO entries
3467 * TODO extensions:: Workflow and assignments
3468 * Progress logging:: Dates and notes for progress
3469 * Priorities:: Some things are more important than others
3470 * Breaking down tasks:: Splitting a task into manageable pieces
3471 * Checkboxes:: Tick-off lists
3474 @node TODO basics, TODO extensions, TODO Items, TODO Items
3475 @section Basic TODO functionality
3477 Any headline becomes a TODO item when it starts with the word
3478 @samp{TODO}, for example:
3481 *** TODO Write letter to Sam Fortune
3485 The most important commands to work with TODO entries are:
3488 @orgcmd{C-c C-t,org-todo}
3489 @cindex cycling, of TODO states
3490 Rotate the TODO state of the current item among
3493 ,-> (unmarked) -> TODO -> DONE --.
3494 '--------------------------------'
3497 The same rotation can also be done ``remotely'' from the timeline and
3498 agenda buffers with the @kbd{t} command key (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
3500 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-t}
3501 Select a specific keyword using completion or (if it has been set up)
3502 the fast selection interface. For the latter, you need to assign keys
3503 to TODO states, see @ref{Per-file keywords}, and @ref{Setting tags}, for
3506 @kindex S-@key{right}
3507 @kindex S-@key{left}
3508 @item S-@key{right} @ @r{/} @ S-@key{left}
3509 @vindex org-treat-S-cursor-todo-selection-as-state-change
3510 Select the following/preceding TODO state, similar to cycling. Useful
3511 mostly if more than two TODO states are possible (@pxref{TODO
3512 extensions}). See also @ref{Conflicts}, for a discussion of the interaction
3513 with @code{shift-selection-mode}. See also the variable
3514 @code{org-treat-S-cursor-todo-selection-as-state-change}.
3515 @orgcmd{C-c / t,org-show-todo-key}
3516 @cindex sparse tree, for TODO
3517 @vindex org-todo-keywords
3518 View TODO items in a @emph{sparse tree} (@pxref{Sparse trees}). Folds the
3519 entire buffer, but shows all TODO items (with not-DONE state) and the
3520 headings hierarchy above them. With a prefix argument (or by using @kbd{C-c
3521 / T}), search for a specific TODO. You will be prompted for the keyword, and
3522 you can also give a list of keywords like @code{KWD1|KWD2|...} to list
3523 entries that match any one of these keywords. With numeric prefix argument
3524 N, show the tree for the Nth keyword in the variable
3525 @code{org-todo-keywords}. With two prefix arguments, find all TODO states,
3526 both un-done and done.
3527 @orgcmd{C-c a t,org-todo-list}
3528 Show the global TODO list. Collects the TODO items (with not-DONE states)
3529 from all agenda files (@pxref{Agenda Views}) into a single buffer. The new
3530 buffer will be in @code{agenda-mode}, which provides commands to examine and
3531 manipulate the TODO entries from the new buffer (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
3532 @xref{Global TODO list}, for more information.
3533 @orgcmd{S-M-@key{RET},org-insert-todo-heading}
3534 Insert a new TODO entry below the current one.
3538 @vindex org-todo-state-tags-triggers
3539 Changing a TODO state can also trigger tag changes. See the docstring of the
3540 option @code{org-todo-state-tags-triggers} for details.
3542 @node TODO extensions, Progress logging, TODO basics, TODO Items
3543 @section Extended use of TODO keywords
3544 @cindex extended TODO keywords
3546 @vindex org-todo-keywords
3547 By default, marked TODO entries have one of only two states: TODO and
3548 DONE. Org-mode allows you to classify TODO items in more complex ways
3549 with @emph{TODO keywords} (stored in @code{org-todo-keywords}). With
3550 special setup, the TODO keyword system can work differently in different
3553 Note that @i{tags} are another way to classify headlines in general and
3554 TODO items in particular (@pxref{Tags}).
3557 * Workflow states:: From TODO to DONE in steps
3558 * TODO types:: I do this, Fred does the rest
3559 * Multiple sets in one file:: Mixing it all, and still finding your way
3560 * Fast access to TODO states:: Single letter selection of a state
3561 * Per-file keywords:: Different files, different requirements
3562 * Faces for TODO keywords:: Highlighting states
3563 * TODO dependencies:: When one task needs to wait for others
3566 @node Workflow states, TODO types, TODO extensions, TODO extensions
3567 @subsection TODO keywords as workflow states
3568 @cindex TODO workflow
3569 @cindex workflow states as TODO keywords
3571 You can use TODO keywords to indicate different @emph{sequential} states
3572 in the process of working on an item, for example@footnote{Changing
3573 this variable only becomes effective after restarting Org-mode in a
3577 (setq org-todo-keywords
3578 '((sequence "TODO" "FEEDBACK" "VERIFY" "|" "DONE" "DELEGATED")))
3581 The vertical bar separates the TODO keywords (states that @emph{need
3582 action}) from the DONE states (which need @emph{no further action}). If
3583 you don't provide the separator bar, the last state is used as the DONE
3585 @cindex completion, of TODO keywords
3586 With this setup, the command @kbd{C-c C-t} will cycle an entry from TODO
3587 to FEEDBACK, then to VERIFY, and finally to DONE and DELEGATED. You may
3588 also use a numeric prefix argument to quickly select a specific state. For
3589 example @kbd{C-3 C-c C-t} will change the state immediately to VERIFY.
3590 Or you can use @kbd{S-@key{left}} to go backward through the sequence. If you
3591 define many keywords, you can use in-buffer completion
3592 (@pxref{Completion}) or even a special one-key selection scheme
3593 (@pxref{Fast access to TODO states}) to insert these words into the
3594 buffer. Changing a TODO state can be logged with a timestamp, see
3595 @ref{Tracking TODO state changes}, for more information.
3597 @node TODO types, Multiple sets in one file, Workflow states, TODO extensions
3598 @subsection TODO keywords as types
3600 @cindex names as TODO keywords
3601 @cindex types as TODO keywords
3603 The second possibility is to use TODO keywords to indicate different
3604 @emph{types} of action items. For example, you might want to indicate
3605 that items are for ``work'' or ``home''. Or, when you work with several
3606 people on a single project, you might want to assign action items
3607 directly to persons, by using their names as TODO keywords. This would
3608 be set up like this:
3611 (setq org-todo-keywords '((type "Fred" "Sara" "Lucy" "|" "DONE")))
3614 In this case, different keywords do not indicate a sequence, but rather
3615 different types. So the normal work flow would be to assign a task to a
3616 person, and later to mark it DONE. Org-mode supports this style by adapting
3617 the workings of the command @kbd{C-c C-t}@footnote{This is also true for the
3618 @kbd{t} command in the timeline and agenda buffers.}. When used several
3619 times in succession, it will still cycle through all names, in order to first
3620 select the right type for a task. But when you return to the item after some
3621 time and execute @kbd{C-c C-t} again, it will switch from any name directly
3622 to DONE. Use prefix arguments or completion to quickly select a specific
3623 name. You can also review the items of a specific TODO type in a sparse tree
3624 by using a numeric prefix to @kbd{C-c / t}. For example, to see all things
3625 Lucy has to do, you would use @kbd{C-3 C-c / t}. To collect Lucy's items
3626 from all agenda files into a single buffer, you would use the numeric prefix
3627 argument as well when creating the global TODO list: @kbd{C-3 C-c a t}.
3629 @node Multiple sets in one file, Fast access to TODO states, TODO types, TODO extensions
3630 @subsection Multiple keyword sets in one file
3631 @cindex TODO keyword sets
3633 Sometimes you may want to use different sets of TODO keywords in
3634 parallel. For example, you may want to have the basic
3635 @code{TODO}/@code{DONE}, but also a workflow for bug fixing, and a
3636 separate state indicating that an item has been canceled (so it is not
3637 DONE, but also does not require action). Your setup would then look
3641 (setq org-todo-keywords
3642 '((sequence "TODO" "|" "DONE")
3643 (sequence "REPORT" "BUG" "KNOWNCAUSE" "|" "FIXED")
3644 (sequence "|" "CANCELED")))
3647 The keywords should all be different, this helps Org-mode to keep track
3648 of which subsequence should be used for a given entry. In this setup,
3649 @kbd{C-c C-t} only operates within a subsequence, so it switches from
3650 @code{DONE} to (nothing) to @code{TODO}, and from @code{FIXED} to
3651 (nothing) to @code{REPORT}. Therefore you need a mechanism to initially
3652 select the correct sequence. Besides the obvious ways like typing a
3653 keyword or using completion, you may also apply the following commands:
3656 @kindex C-S-@key{right}
3657 @kindex C-S-@key{left}
3658 @kindex C-u C-u C-c C-t
3659 @item C-u C-u C-c C-t
3660 @itemx C-S-@key{right}
3661 @itemx C-S-@key{left}
3662 These keys jump from one TODO subset to the next. In the above example,
3663 @kbd{C-u C-u C-c C-t} or @kbd{C-S-@key{right}} would jump from @code{TODO} or
3664 @code{DONE} to @code{REPORT}, and any of the words in the second row to
3665 @code{CANCELED}. Note that the @kbd{C-S-} key binding conflict with
3666 @code{shift-selection-mode} (@pxref{Conflicts}).
3667 @kindex S-@key{right}
3668 @kindex S-@key{left}
3671 @kbd{S-@key{<left>}} and @kbd{S-@key{<right>}} and walk through @emph{all}
3672 keywords from all sets, so for example @kbd{S-@key{<right>}} would switch
3673 from @code{DONE} to @code{REPORT} in the example above. See also
3674 @ref{Conflicts}, for a discussion of the interaction with
3675 @code{shift-selection-mode}.
3678 @node Fast access to TODO states, Per-file keywords, Multiple sets in one file, TODO extensions
3679 @subsection Fast access to TODO states
3681 If you would like to quickly change an entry to an arbitrary TODO state
3682 instead of cycling through the states, you can set up keys for
3683 single-letter access to the states. This is done by adding the section
3684 key after each keyword, in parentheses. For example:
3687 (setq org-todo-keywords
3688 '((sequence "TODO(t)" "|" "DONE(d)")
3689 (sequence "REPORT(r)" "BUG(b)" "KNOWNCAUSE(k)" "|" "FIXED(f)")
3690 (sequence "|" "CANCELED(c)")))
3693 @vindex org-fast-tag-selection-include-todo
3694 If you then press @code{C-c C-t} followed by the selection key, the entry
3695 will be switched to this state. @key{SPC} can be used to remove any TODO
3696 keyword from an entry.@footnote{Check also the variable
3697 @code{org-fast-tag-selection-include-todo}, it allows you to change the TODO
3698 state through the tags interface (@pxref{Setting tags}), in case you like to
3699 mingle the two concepts. Note that this means you need to come up with
3700 unique keys across both sets of keywords.}
3702 @node Per-file keywords, Faces for TODO keywords, Fast access to TODO states, TODO extensions
3703 @subsection Setting up keywords for individual files
3704 @cindex keyword options
3705 @cindex per-file keywords
3710 It can be very useful to use different aspects of the TODO mechanism in
3711 different files. For file-local settings, you need to add special lines
3712 to the file which set the keywords and interpretation for that file
3713 only. For example, to set one of the two examples discussed above, you
3714 need one of the following lines, starting in column zero anywhere in the
3718 #+TODO: TODO FEEDBACK VERIFY | DONE CANCELED
3720 @noindent (you may also write @code{#+SEQ_TODO} to be explicit about the
3721 interpretation, but it means the same as @code{#+TODO}), or
3723 #+TYP_TODO: Fred Sara Lucy Mike | DONE
3726 A setup for using several sets in parallel would be:
3730 #+TODO: REPORT BUG KNOWNCAUSE | FIXED
3734 @cindex completion, of option keywords
3736 @noindent To make sure you are using the correct keyword, type
3737 @samp{#+} into the buffer and then use @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} completion.
3739 @cindex DONE, final TODO keyword
3740 Remember that the keywords after the vertical bar (or the last keyword
3741 if no bar is there) must always mean that the item is DONE (although you
3742 may use a different word). After changing one of these lines, use
3743 @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the line to make the changes
3744 known to Org-mode@footnote{Org-mode parses these lines only when
3745 Org-mode is activated after visiting a file. @kbd{C-c C-c} with the
3746 cursor in a line starting with @samp{#+} is simply restarting Org-mode
3747 for the current buffer.}.
3749 @node Faces for TODO keywords, TODO dependencies, Per-file keywords, TODO extensions
3750 @subsection Faces for TODO keywords
3751 @cindex faces, for TODO keywords
3753 @vindex org-todo @r{(face)}
3754 @vindex org-done @r{(face)}
3755 @vindex org-todo-keyword-faces
3756 Org-mode highlights TODO keywords with special faces: @code{org-todo}
3757 for keywords indicating that an item still has to be acted upon, and
3758 @code{org-done} for keywords indicating that an item is finished. If
3759 you are using more than 2 different states, you might want to use
3760 special faces for some of them. This can be done using the variable
3761 @code{org-todo-keyword-faces}. For example:
3765 (setq org-todo-keyword-faces
3766 '(("TODO" . org-warning) ("STARTED" . "yellow")
3767 ("CANCELED" . (:foreground "blue" :weight bold))))
3771 While using a list with face properties as shown for CANCELED @emph{should}
3772 work, this does not aways seem to be the case. If necessary, define a
3773 special face and use that. A string is interpreted as a color. The variable
3774 @code{org-faces-easy-properties} determines if that color is interpreted as a
3775 foreground or a background color.
3777 @node TODO dependencies, , Faces for TODO keywords, TODO extensions
3778 @subsection TODO dependencies
3779 @cindex TODO dependencies
3780 @cindex dependencies, of TODO states
3782 @vindex org-enforce-todo-dependencies
3783 @cindex property, ORDERED
3784 The structure of Org files (hierarchy and lists) makes it easy to define TODO
3785 dependencies. Usually, a parent TODO task should not be marked DONE until
3786 all subtasks (defined as children tasks) are marked as DONE. And sometimes
3787 there is a logical sequence to a number of (sub)tasks, so that one task
3788 cannot be acted upon before all siblings above it are done. If you customize
3789 the variable @code{org-enforce-todo-dependencies}, Org will block entries
3790 from changing state to DONE while they have children that are not DONE.
3791 Furthermore, if an entry has a property @code{ORDERED}, each of its children
3792 will be blocked until all earlier siblings are marked DONE. Here is an
3796 * TODO Blocked until (two) is done
3805 ** TODO b, needs to wait for (a)
3806 ** TODO c, needs to wait for (a) and (b)
3810 @orgcmd{C-c C-x o,org-toggle-ordered-property}
3811 @vindex org-track-ordered-property-with-tag
3812 @cindex property, ORDERED
3813 Toggle the @code{ORDERED} property of the current entry. A property is used
3814 for this behavior because this should be local to the current entry, not
3815 inherited like a tag. However, if you would like to @i{track} the value of
3816 this property with a tag for better visibility, customize the variable
3817 @code{org-track-ordered-property-with-tag}.
3818 @orgkey{C-u C-u C-u C-c C-t}
3819 Change TODO state, circumventing any state blocking.
3822 @vindex org-agenda-dim-blocked-tasks
3823 If you set the variable @code{org-agenda-dim-blocked-tasks}, TODO entries
3824 that cannot be closed because of such dependencies will be shown in a dimmed
3825 font or even made invisible in agenda views (@pxref{Agenda Views}).
3827 @cindex checkboxes and TODO dependencies
3828 @vindex org-enforce-todo-dependencies
3829 You can also block changes of TODO states by looking at checkboxes
3830 (@pxref{Checkboxes}). If you set the variable
3831 @code{org-enforce-todo-checkbox-dependencies}, an entry that has unchecked
3832 checkboxes will be blocked from switching to DONE.
3834 If you need more complex dependency structures, for example dependencies
3835 between entries in different trees or files, check out the contributed
3836 module @file{org-depend.el}.
3839 @node Progress logging, Priorities, TODO extensions, TODO Items
3840 @section Progress logging
3841 @cindex progress logging
3842 @cindex logging, of progress
3844 Org-mode can automatically record a timestamp and possibly a note when
3845 you mark a TODO item as DONE, or even each time you change the state of
3846 a TODO item. This system is highly configurable, settings can be on a
3847 per-keyword basis and can be localized to a file or even a subtree. For
3848 information on how to clock working time for a task, see @ref{Clocking
3852 * Closing items:: When was this entry marked DONE?
3853 * Tracking TODO state changes:: When did the status change?
3854 * Tracking your habits:: How consistent have you been?
3857 @node Closing items, Tracking TODO state changes, Progress logging, Progress logging
3858 @subsection Closing items
3860 The most basic logging is to keep track of @emph{when} a certain TODO
3861 item was finished. This is achieved with@footnote{The corresponding
3862 in-buffer setting is: @code{#+STARTUP: logdone}}.
3865 (setq org-log-done 'time)
3869 Then each time you turn an entry from a TODO (not-done) state into any
3870 of the DONE states, a line @samp{CLOSED: [timestamp]} will be inserted
3871 just after the headline. If you turn the entry back into a TODO item
3872 through further state cycling, that line will be removed again. If you
3873 want to record a note along with the timestamp, use@footnote{The
3874 corresponding in-buffer setting is: @code{#+STARTUP: lognotedone}}
3877 (setq org-log-done 'note)
3881 You will then be prompted for a note, and that note will be stored below
3882 the entry with a @samp{Closing Note} heading.
3884 In the timeline (@pxref{Timeline}) and in the agenda
3885 (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}), you can then use the @kbd{l} key to
3886 display the TODO items with a @samp{CLOSED} timestamp on each day,
3887 giving you an overview of what has been done.
3889 @node Tracking TODO state changes, Tracking your habits, Closing items, Progress logging
3890 @subsection Tracking TODO state changes
3891 @cindex drawer, for state change recording
3893 @vindex org-log-states-order-reversed
3894 @vindex org-log-into-drawer
3895 @cindex property, LOG_INTO_DRAWER
3896 When TODO keywords are used as workflow states (@pxref{Workflow states}), you
3897 might want to keep track of when a state change occurred and maybe take a
3898 note about this change. You can either record just a timestamp, or a
3899 time-stamped note for a change. These records will be inserted after the
3900 headline as an itemized list, newest first@footnote{See the variable
3901 @code{org-log-states-order-reversed}}. When taking a lot of notes, you might
3902 want to get the notes out of the way into a drawer (@pxref{Drawers}).
3903 Customize the variable @code{org-log-into-drawer} to get this
3904 behavior---the recommended drawer for this is called @code{LOGBOOK}. You can
3905 also overrule the setting of this variable for a subtree by setting a
3906 @code{LOG_INTO_DRAWER} property.
3908 Since it is normally too much to record a note for every state, Org-mode
3909 expects configuration on a per-keyword basis for this. This is achieved by
3910 adding special markers @samp{!} (for a timestamp) and @samp{@@} (for a note)
3911 in parentheses after each keyword. For example, with the setting
3914 (setq org-todo-keywords
3915 '((sequence "TODO(t)" "WAIT(w@@/!)" "|" "DONE(d!)" "CANCELED(c@@)")))
3919 @vindex org-log-done
3920 you not only define global TODO keywords and fast access keys, but also
3921 request that a time is recorded when the entry is set to
3922 DONE@footnote{It is possible that Org-mode will record two timestamps
3923 when you are using both @code{org-log-done} and state change logging.
3924 However, it will never prompt for two notes---if you have configured
3925 both, the state change recording note will take precedence and cancel
3926 the @samp{Closing Note}.}, and that a note is recorded when switching to
3927 WAIT or CANCELED. The setting for WAIT is even more special: the
3928 @samp{!} after the slash means that in addition to the note taken when
3929 entering the state, a timestamp should be recorded when @i{leaving} the
3930 WAIT state, if and only if the @i{target} state does not configure
3931 logging for entering it. So it has no effect when switching from WAIT
3932 to DONE, because DONE is configured to record a timestamp only. But
3933 when switching from WAIT back to TODO, the @samp{/!} in the WAIT
3934 setting now triggers a timestamp even though TODO has no logging
3937 You can use the exact same syntax for setting logging preferences local
3940 #+TODO: TODO(t) WAIT(w@@/!) | DONE(d!) CANCELED(c@@)
3943 @cindex property, LOGGING
3944 In order to define logging settings that are local to a subtree or a
3945 single item, define a LOGGING property in this entry. Any non-empty
3946 LOGGING property resets all logging settings to nil. You may then turn
3947 on logging for this specific tree using STARTUP keywords like
3948 @code{lognotedone} or @code{logrepeat}, as well as adding state specific
3949 settings like @code{TODO(!)}. For example
3952 * TODO Log each state with only a time
3954 :LOGGING: TODO(!) WAIT(!) DONE(!) CANCELED(!)
3956 * TODO Only log when switching to WAIT, and when repeating
3958 :LOGGING: WAIT(@@) logrepeat
3960 * TODO No logging at all
3966 @node Tracking your habits, , Tracking TODO state changes, Progress logging
3967 @subsection Tracking your habits
3970 Org has the ability to track the consistency of a special category of TODOs,
3971 called ``habits''. A habit has the following properties:
3975 You have enabled the @code{habits} module by customizing the variable
3978 The habit is a TODO, with a TODO keyword representing an open state.
3980 The property @code{STYLE} is set to the value @code{habit}.
3982 The TODO has a scheduled date, usually with a @code{.+} style repeat
3983 interval. A @code{++} style may be appropriate for habits with time
3984 constraints, e.g., must be done on weekends, or a @code{+} style for an
3985 unusual habit that can have a backlog, e.g., weekly reports.
3987 The TODO may also have minimum and maximum ranges specified by using the
3988 syntax @samp{.+2d/3d}, which says that you want to do the task at least every
3989 three days, but at most every two days.
3991 You must also have state logging for the @code{DONE} state enabled, in order
3992 for historical data to be represented in the consistency graph. If it's not
3993 enabled it's not an error, but the consistency graphs will be largely
3997 To give you an idea of what the above rules look like in action, here's an
3998 actual habit with some history:
4002 SCHEDULED: <2009-10-17 Sat .+2d/4d>
4003 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-15 Thu]
4004 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-12 Mon]
4005 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-10 Sat]
4006 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-04 Sun]
4007 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-02 Fri]
4008 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-29 Tue]
4009 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-25 Fri]
4010 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-19 Sat]
4011 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-16 Wed]
4012 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-12 Sat]
4015 :LAST_REPEAT: [2009-10-19 Mon 00:36]
4019 What this habit says is: I want to shave at most every 2 days (given by the
4020 @code{SCHEDULED} date and repeat interval) and at least every 4 days. If
4021 today is the 15th, then the habit first appears in the agenda on Oct 17,
4022 after the minimum of 2 days has elapsed, and will appear overdue on Oct 19,
4023 after four days have elapsed.
4025 What's really useful about habits is that they are displayed along with a
4026 consistency graph, to show how consistent you've been at getting that task
4027 done in the past. This graph shows every day that the task was done over the
4028 past three weeks, with colors for each day. The colors used are:
4032 If the task wasn't to be done yet on that day.
4034 If the task could have been done on that day.
4036 If the task was going to be overdue the next day.
4038 If the task was overdue on that day.
4041 In addition to coloring each day, the day is also marked with an asterisk if
4042 the task was actually done that day, and an exclamation mark to show where
4043 the current day falls in the graph.
4045 There are several configuration variables that can be used to change the way
4046 habits are displayed in the agenda.
4049 @item org-habit-graph-column
4050 The buffer column at which the consistency graph should be drawn. This will
4051 overwrite any text in that column, so it's a good idea to keep your habits'
4052 titles brief and to the point.
4053 @item org-habit-preceding-days
4054 The amount of history, in days before today, to appear in consistency graphs.
4055 @item org-habit-following-days
4056 The number of days after today that will appear in consistency graphs.
4057 @item org-habit-show-habits-only-for-today
4058 If non-nil, only show habits in today's agenda view. This is set to true by
4062 Lastly, pressing @kbd{K} in the agenda buffer will cause habits to
4063 temporarily be disabled and they won't appear at all. Press @kbd{K} again to
4064 bring them back. They are also subject to tag filtering, if you have habits
4065 which should only be done in certain contexts, for example.
4067 @node Priorities, Breaking down tasks, Progress logging, TODO Items
4071 If you use Org-mode extensively, you may end up with enough TODO items that
4072 it starts to make sense to prioritize them. Prioritizing can be done by
4073 placing a @emph{priority cookie} into the headline of a TODO item, like this
4076 *** TODO [#A] Write letter to Sam Fortune
4080 @vindex org-priority-faces
4081 By default, Org-mode supports three priorities: @samp{A}, @samp{B}, and
4082 @samp{C}. @samp{A} is the highest priority. An entry without a cookie is
4083 treated just like priority @samp{B}. Priorities make a difference only for
4084 sorting in the agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}); outside the agenda, they
4085 have no inherent meaning to Org-mode. The cookies can be highlighted with
4086 special faces by customizing the variable @code{org-priority-faces}.
4088 Priorities can be attached to any outline node; they do not need to be TODO
4094 @findex org-priority
4095 Set the priority of the current headline (@command{org-priority}). The
4096 command prompts for a priority character @samp{A}, @samp{B} or @samp{C}.
4097 When you press @key{SPC} instead, the priority cookie is removed from the
4098 headline. The priorities can also be changed ``remotely'' from the timeline
4099 and agenda buffer with the @kbd{,} command (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
4101 @orgcmdkkcc{S-@key{up},S-@key{down},org-priority-up,org-priority-down}
4102 @vindex org-priority-start-cycle-with-default
4103 Increase/decrease priority of current headline@footnote{See also the option
4104 @code{org-priority-start-cycle-with-default}.}. Note that these keys are
4105 also used to modify timestamps (@pxref{Creating timestamps}). See also
4106 @ref{Conflicts}, for a discussion of the interaction with
4107 @code{shift-selection-mode}.
4110 @vindex org-highest-priority
4111 @vindex org-lowest-priority
4112 @vindex org-default-priority
4113 You can change the range of allowed priorities by setting the variables
4114 @code{org-highest-priority}, @code{org-lowest-priority}, and
4115 @code{org-default-priority}. For an individual buffer, you may set
4116 these values (highest, lowest, default) like this (please make sure that
4117 the highest priority is earlier in the alphabet than the lowest
4120 @cindex #+PRIORITIES
4125 @node Breaking down tasks, Checkboxes, Priorities, TODO Items
4126 @section Breaking tasks down into subtasks
4127 @cindex tasks, breaking down
4128 @cindex statistics, for TODO items
4130 @vindex org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels
4131 It is often advisable to break down large tasks into smaller, manageable
4132 subtasks. You can do this by creating an outline tree below a TODO item,
4133 with detailed subtasks on the tree@footnote{To keep subtasks out of the
4134 global TODO list, see the @code{org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels}.}. To keep
4135 the overview over the fraction of subtasks that are already completed, insert
4136 either @samp{[/]} or @samp{[%]} anywhere in the headline. These cookies will
4137 be updated each time the TODO status of a child changes, or when pressing
4138 @kbd{C-c C-c} on the cookie. For example:
4141 * Organize Party [33%]
4142 ** TODO Call people [1/2]
4146 ** DONE Talk to neighbor
4149 @cindex property, COOKIE_DATA
4150 If a heading has both checkboxes and TODO children below it, the meaning of
4151 the statistics cookie become ambiguous. Set the property
4152 @code{COOKIE_DATA} to either @samp{checkbox} or @samp{todo} to resolve
4155 @vindex org-hierarchical-todo-statistics
4156 If you would like to have the statistics cookie count any TODO entries in the
4157 subtree (not just direct children), configure the variable
4158 @code{org-hierarchical-todo-statistics}. To do this for a single subtree,
4159 include the word @samp{recursive} into the value of the @code{COOKIE_DATA}
4163 * Parent capturing statistics [2/20]
4165 :COOKIE_DATA: todo recursive
4169 If you would like a TODO entry to automatically change to DONE
4170 when all children are done, you can use the following setup:
4173 (defun org-summary-todo (n-done n-not-done)
4174 "Switch entry to DONE when all subentries are done, to TODO otherwise."
4175 (let (org-log-done org-log-states) ; turn off logging
4176 (org-todo (if (= n-not-done 0) "DONE" "TODO"))))
4178 (add-hook 'org-after-todo-statistics-hook 'org-summary-todo)
4182 Another possibility is the use of checkboxes to identify (a hierarchy of) a
4183 large number of subtasks (@pxref{Checkboxes}).
4186 @node Checkboxes, , Breaking down tasks, TODO Items
4190 @vindex org-list-automatic-rules
4191 Every item in a plain list@footnote{With the exception of description
4192 lists. But you can allow it by modifying @code{org-list-automatic-rules}
4193 accordingly.} (@pxref{Plain lists}) can be made into a checkbox by starting
4194 it with the string @samp{[ ]}. This feature is similar to TODO items
4195 (@pxref{TODO Items}), but is more lightweight. Checkboxes are not included
4196 into the global TODO list, so they are often great to split a task into a
4197 number of simple steps. Or you can use them in a shopping list. To toggle a
4198 checkbox, use @kbd{C-c C-c}, or use the mouse (thanks to Piotr Zielinski's
4199 @file{org-mouse.el}).
4201 Here is an example of a checkbox list.
4204 * TODO Organize party [2/4]
4205 - [-] call people [1/3]
4210 - [ ] think about what music to play
4211 - [X] talk to the neighbors
4214 Checkboxes work hierarchically, so if a checkbox item has children that
4215 are checkboxes, toggling one of the children checkboxes will make the
4216 parent checkbox reflect if none, some, or all of the children are
4219 @cindex statistics, for checkboxes
4220 @cindex checkbox statistics
4221 @cindex property, COOKIE_DATA
4222 @vindex org-hierarchical-checkbox-statistics
4223 The @samp{[2/4]} and @samp{[1/3]} in the first and second line are cookies
4224 indicating how many checkboxes present in this entry have been checked off,
4225 and the total number of checkboxes present. This can give you an idea on how
4226 many checkboxes remain, even without opening a folded entry. The cookies can
4227 be placed into a headline or into (the first line of) a plain list item.
4228 Each cookie covers checkboxes of direct children structurally below the
4229 headline/item on which the cookie appears@footnote{Set the variable
4230 @code{org-hierarchical-checkbox-statistics} if you want such cookies to
4231 represent the all checkboxes below the cookie, not just the direct
4232 children.}. You have to insert the cookie yourself by typing either
4233 @samp{[/]} or @samp{[%]}. With @samp{[/]} you get an @samp{n out of m}
4234 result, as in the examples above. With @samp{[%]} you get information about
4235 the percentage of checkboxes checked (in the above example, this would be
4236 @samp{[50%]} and @samp{[33%]}, respectively). In a headline, a cookie can
4237 count either checkboxes below the heading or TODO states of children, and it
4238 will display whatever was changed last. Set the property @code{COOKIE_DATA}
4239 to either @samp{checkbox} or @samp{todo} to resolve this issue.
4241 @cindex blocking, of checkboxes
4242 @cindex checkbox blocking
4243 @cindex property, ORDERED
4244 If the current outline node has an @code{ORDERED} property, checkboxes must
4245 be checked off in sequence, and an error will be thrown if you try to check
4246 off a box while there are unchecked boxes above it.
4248 @noindent The following commands work with checkboxes:
4251 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-toggle-checkbox}
4252 Toggle checkbox status or (with prefix arg) checkbox presence at point. With
4253 double prefix argument, set it to @samp{[-]}, which is considered to be an
4255 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-b,org-toggle-checkbox}
4256 Toggle checkbox status or (with prefix arg) checkbox presence at point. With
4257 double prefix argument, set it to @samp{[-]}, which is considered to be an
4261 If there is an active region, toggle the first checkbox in the region
4262 and set all remaining boxes to the same status as the first. With a prefix
4263 arg, add or remove the checkbox for all items in the region.
4265 If the cursor is in a headline, toggle checkboxes in the region between
4266 this headline and the next (so @emph{not} the entire subtree).
4268 If there is no active region, just toggle the checkbox at point.
4270 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{RET},org-insert-todo-heading}
4271 Insert a new item with a checkbox.
4272 This works only if the cursor is already in a plain list item
4273 (@pxref{Plain lists}).
4274 @orgcmd{C-c C-x o,org-toggle-ordered-property}
4275 @vindex org-track-ordered-property-with-tag
4276 @cindex property, ORDERED
4277 Toggle the @code{ORDERED} property of the entry, to toggle if checkboxes must
4278 be checked off in sequence. A property is used for this behavior because
4279 this should be local to the current entry, not inherited like a tag.
4280 However, if you would like to @i{track} the value of this property with a tag
4281 for better visibility, customize the variable
4282 @code{org-track-ordered-property-with-tag}.
4283 @orgcmd{C-c #,org-update-statistics-cookies}
4284 Update the statistics cookie in the current outline entry. When called with
4285 a @kbd{C-u} prefix, update the entire file. Checkbox statistic cookies are
4286 updated automatically if you toggle checkboxes with @kbd{C-c C-c} and make
4287 new ones with @kbd{M-S-@key{RET}}. TODO statistics cookies update when
4288 changing TODO states. If you delete boxes/entries or add/change them by
4289 hand, use this command to get things back into sync. Or simply toggle any
4290 entry twice (checkboxes with @kbd{C-c C-c}).
4293 @node Tags, Properties and Columns, TODO Items, Top
4296 @cindex headline tagging
4297 @cindex matching, tags
4298 @cindex sparse tree, tag based
4300 An excellent way to implement labels and contexts for cross-correlating
4301 information is to assign @i{tags} to headlines. Org-mode has extensive
4304 @vindex org-tag-faces
4305 Every headline can contain a list of tags; they occur at the end of the
4306 headline. Tags are normal words containing letters, numbers, @samp{_}, and
4307 @samp{@@}. Tags must be preceded and followed by a single colon, e.g.,
4308 @samp{:work:}. Several tags can be specified, as in @samp{:work:urgent:}.
4309 Tags will by default be in bold face with the same color as the headline.
4310 You may specify special faces for specific tags using the variable
4311 @code{org-tag-faces}, in much the same way as you can for TODO keywords
4312 (@pxref{Faces for TODO keywords}).
4315 * Tag inheritance:: Tags use the tree structure of the outline
4316 * Setting tags:: How to assign tags to a headline
4317 * Tag searches:: Searching for combinations of tags
4320 @node Tag inheritance, Setting tags, Tags, Tags
4321 @section Tag inheritance
4322 @cindex tag inheritance
4323 @cindex inheritance, of tags
4324 @cindex sublevels, inclusion into tags match
4326 @i{Tags} make use of the hierarchical structure of outline trees. If a
4327 heading has a certain tag, all subheadings will inherit the tag as
4328 well. For example, in the list
4331 * Meeting with the French group :work:
4332 ** Summary by Frank :boss:notes:
4333 *** TODO Prepare slides for him :action:
4337 the final heading will have the tags @samp{:work:}, @samp{:boss:},
4338 @samp{:notes:}, and @samp{:action:} even though the final heading is not
4339 explicitly marked with those tags. You can also set tags that all entries in
4340 a file should inherit just as if these tags were defined in a hypothetical
4341 level zero that surrounds the entire file. Use a line like this@footnote{As
4342 with all these in-buffer settings, pressing @kbd{C-c C-c} activates any
4343 changes in the line.}:
4347 #+FILETAGS: :Peter:Boss:Secret:
4351 @vindex org-use-tag-inheritance
4352 @vindex org-tags-exclude-from-inheritance
4353 To limit tag inheritance to specific tags, or to turn it off entirely, use
4354 the variables @code{org-use-tag-inheritance} and
4355 @code{org-tags-exclude-from-inheritance}.
4357 @vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
4358 When a headline matches during a tags search while tag inheritance is turned
4359 on, all the sublevels in the same tree will (for a simple match form) match
4360 as well@footnote{This is only true if the search does not involve more
4361 complex tests including properties (@pxref{Property searches}).}. The list
4362 of matches may then become very long. If you only want to see the first tags
4363 match in a subtree, configure the variable
4364 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels} (not recommended).
4366 @node Setting tags, Tag searches, Tag inheritance, Tags
4367 @section Setting tags
4368 @cindex setting tags
4369 @cindex tags, setting
4372 Tags can simply be typed into the buffer at the end of a headline.
4373 After a colon, @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} offers completion on tags. There is
4374 also a special command for inserting tags:
4377 @orgcmd{C-c C-q,org-set-tags-command}
4378 @cindex completion, of tags
4379 @vindex org-tags-column
4380 Enter new tags for the current headline. Org-mode will either offer
4381 completion or a special single-key interface for setting tags, see
4382 below. After pressing @key{RET}, the tags will be inserted and aligned
4383 to @code{org-tags-column}. When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, all
4384 tags in the current buffer will be aligned to that column, just to make
4385 things look nice. TAGS are automatically realigned after promotion,
4386 demotion, and TODO state changes (@pxref{TODO basics}).
4387 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-set-tags-command}
4388 When the cursor is in a headline, this does the same as @kbd{C-c C-q}.
4391 @vindex org-tag-alist
4392 Org will support tag insertion based on a @emph{list of tags}. By
4393 default this list is constructed dynamically, containing all tags
4394 currently used in the buffer. You may also globally specify a hard list
4395 of tags with the variable @code{org-tag-alist}. Finally you can set
4396 the default tags for a given file with lines like
4400 #+TAGS: @@work @@home @@tennisclub
4401 #+TAGS: laptop car pc sailboat
4404 If you have globally defined your preferred set of tags using the
4405 variable @code{org-tag-alist}, but would like to use a dynamic tag list
4406 in a specific file, add an empty TAGS option line to that file:
4412 @vindex org-tag-persistent-alist
4413 If you have a preferred set of tags that you would like to use in every file,
4414 in addition to those defined on a per-file basis by TAGS option lines, then
4415 you may specify a list of tags with the variable
4416 @code{org-tag-persistent-alist}. You may turn this off on a per-file basis
4417 by adding a STARTUP option line to that file:
4423 By default Org-mode uses the standard minibuffer completion facilities for
4424 entering tags. However, it also implements another, quicker, tag selection
4425 method called @emph{fast tag selection}. This allows you to select and
4426 deselect tags with just a single key press. For this to work well you should
4427 assign unique letters to most of your commonly used tags. You can do this
4428 globally by configuring the variable @code{org-tag-alist} in your
4429 @file{.emacs} file. For example, you may find the need to tag many items in
4430 different files with @samp{:@@home:}. In this case you can set something
4434 (setq org-tag-alist '(("@@work" . ?w) ("@@home" . ?h) ("laptop" . ?l)))
4437 @noindent If the tag is only relevant to the file you are working on, then you
4438 can instead set the TAGS option line as:
4441 #+TAGS: @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t) laptop(l) pc(p)
4444 @noindent The tags interface will show the available tags in a splash
4445 window. If you want to start a new line after a specific tag, insert
4446 @samp{\n} into the tag list
4449 #+TAGS: @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t) \n laptop(l) pc(p)
4452 @noindent or write them in two lines:
4455 #+TAGS: @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t)
4456 #+TAGS: laptop(l) pc(p)
4460 You can also group together tags that are mutually exclusive by using
4464 #+TAGS: @{ @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t) @} laptop(l) pc(p)
4467 @noindent you indicate that at most one of @samp{@@work}, @samp{@@home},
4468 and @samp{@@tennisclub} should be selected. Multiple such groups are allowed.
4470 @noindent Don't forget to press @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor in one of
4471 these lines to activate any changes.
4474 To set these mutually exclusive groups in the variable @code{org-tags-alist},
4475 you must use the dummy tags @code{:startgroup} and @code{:endgroup} instead
4476 of the braces. Similarly, you can use @code{:newline} to indicate a line
4477 break. The previous example would be set globally by the following
4481 (setq org-tag-alist '((:startgroup . nil)
4482 ("@@work" . ?w) ("@@home" . ?h)
4483 ("@@tennisclub" . ?t)
4485 ("laptop" . ?l) ("pc" . ?p)))
4488 If at least one tag has a selection key then pressing @kbd{C-c C-c} will
4489 automatically present you with a special interface, listing inherited tags,
4490 the tags of the current headline, and a list of all valid tags with
4491 corresponding keys@footnote{Keys will automatically be assigned to tags which
4492 have no configured keys.}. In this interface, you can use the following
4497 Pressing keys assigned to tags will add or remove them from the list of
4498 tags in the current line. Selecting a tag in a group of mutually
4499 exclusive tags will turn off any other tags from that group.
4502 Enter a tag in the minibuffer, even if the tag is not in the predefined
4503 list. You will be able to complete on all tags present in the buffer.
4506 Clear all tags for this line.
4509 Accept the modified set.
4511 Abort without installing changes.
4513 If @kbd{q} is not assigned to a tag, it aborts like @kbd{C-g}.
4515 Turn off groups of mutually exclusive tags. Use this to (as an
4516 exception) assign several tags from such a group.
4518 Toggle auto-exit after the next change (see below).
4519 If you are using expert mode, the first @kbd{C-c} will display the
4524 This method lets you assign tags to a headline with very few keys. With
4525 the above setup, you could clear the current tags and set @samp{@@home},
4526 @samp{laptop} and @samp{pc} tags with just the following keys: @kbd{C-c
4527 C-c @key{SPC} h l p @key{RET}}. Switching from @samp{@@home} to
4528 @samp{@@work} would be done with @kbd{C-c C-c w @key{RET}} or
4529 alternatively with @kbd{C-c C-c C-c w}. Adding the non-predefined tag
4530 @samp{Sarah} could be done with @kbd{C-c C-c @key{TAB} S a r a h
4531 @key{RET} @key{RET}}.
4533 @vindex org-fast-tag-selection-single-key
4534 If you find that most of the time you need only a single key press to
4535 modify your list of tags, set the variable
4536 @code{org-fast-tag-selection-single-key}. Then you no longer have to
4537 press @key{RET} to exit fast tag selection---it will immediately exit
4538 after the first change. If you then occasionally need more keys, press
4539 @kbd{C-c} to turn off auto-exit for the current tag selection process
4540 (in effect: start selection with @kbd{C-c C-c C-c} instead of @kbd{C-c
4541 C-c}). If you set the variable to the value @code{expert}, the special
4542 window is not even shown for single-key tag selection, it comes up only
4543 when you press an extra @kbd{C-c}.
4545 @node Tag searches, , Setting tags, Tags
4546 @section Tag searches
4547 @cindex tag searches
4548 @cindex searching for tags
4550 Once a system of tags has been set up, it can be used to collect related
4551 information into special lists.
4554 @orgcmdkkc{C-c / m,C-c \,org-match-sparse-tree}
4555 Create a sparse tree with all headlines matching a tags search. With a
4556 @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, ignore headlines that are not a TODO line.
4557 @orgcmd{C-c a m,org-tags-view}
4558 Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files.
4559 @xref{Matching tags and properties}.
4560 @orgcmd{C-c a M,org-tags-view}
4561 @vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
4562 Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files, but check
4563 only TODO items and force checking subitems (see variable
4564 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels}).
4567 These commands all prompt for a match string which allows basic Boolean logic
4568 like @samp{+boss+urgent-project1}, to find entries with tags @samp{boss} and
4569 @samp{urgent}, but not @samp{project1}, or @samp{Kathy|Sally} to find entries
4570 which are tagged, like @samp{Kathy} or @samp{Sally}. The full syntax of the search
4571 string is rich and allows also matching against TODO keywords, entry levels
4572 and properties. For a complete description with many examples, see
4573 @ref{Matching tags and properties}.
4576 @node Properties and Columns, Dates and Times, Tags, Top
4577 @chapter Properties and columns
4580 Properties are a set of key-value pairs associated with an entry. There
4581 are two main applications for properties in Org-mode. First, properties
4582 are like tags, but with a value. Second, you can use properties to
4583 implement (very basic) database capabilities in an Org buffer. For
4584 an example of the first application, imagine maintaining a file where
4585 you document bugs and plan releases for a piece of software. Instead of
4586 using tags like @code{:release_1:}, @code{:release_2:}, one can use a
4587 property, say @code{:Release:}, that in different subtrees has different
4588 values, such as @code{1.0} or @code{2.0}. For an example of the second
4589 application of properties, imagine keeping track of your music CDs,
4590 where properties could be things such as the album, artist, date of
4591 release, number of tracks, and so on.
4593 Properties can be conveniently edited and viewed in column view
4594 (@pxref{Column view}).
4597 * Property syntax:: How properties are spelled out
4598 * Special properties:: Access to other Org-mode features
4599 * Property searches:: Matching property values
4600 * Property inheritance:: Passing values down the tree
4601 * Column view:: Tabular viewing and editing
4602 * Property API:: Properties for Lisp programmers
4605 @node Property syntax, Special properties, Properties and Columns, Properties and Columns
4606 @section Property syntax
4607 @cindex property syntax
4608 @cindex drawer, for properties
4610 Properties are key-value pairs. They need to be inserted into a special
4611 drawer (@pxref{Drawers}) with the name @code{PROPERTIES}. Each property
4612 is specified on a single line, with the key (surrounded by colons)
4613 first, and the value after it. Here is an example:
4618 *** Goldberg Variations
4620 :Title: Goldberg Variations
4621 :Composer: J.S. Bach
4623 :Publisher: Deutsche Grammophon
4628 You may define the allowed values for a particular property @samp{:Xyz:}
4629 by setting a property @samp{:Xyz_ALL:}. This special property is
4630 @emph{inherited}, so if you set it in a level 1 entry, it will apply to
4631 the entire tree. When allowed values are defined, setting the
4632 corresponding property becomes easier and is less prone to typing
4633 errors. For the example with the CD collection, we can predefine
4634 publishers and the number of disks in a box like this:
4639 :NDisks_ALL: 1 2 3 4
4640 :Publisher_ALL: "Deutsche Grammophon" Philips EMI
4644 If you want to set properties that can be inherited by any entry in a
4645 file, use a line like
4646 @cindex property, _ALL
4649 #+PROPERTY: NDisks_ALL 1 2 3 4
4652 @vindex org-global-properties
4653 Property values set with the global variable
4654 @code{org-global-properties} can be inherited by all entries in all
4658 The following commands help to work with properties:
4661 @orgcmd{M-@key{TAB},org-complete}
4662 After an initial colon in a line, complete property keys. All keys used
4663 in the current file will be offered as possible completions.
4664 @orgcmd{C-c C-x p,org-set-property}
4665 Set a property. This prompts for a property name and a value. If
4666 necessary, the property drawer is created as well.
4667 @item M-x org-insert-property-drawer
4668 @findex org-insert-property-drawer
4669 Insert a property drawer into the current entry. The drawer will be
4670 inserted early in the entry, but after the lines with planning
4671 information like deadlines.
4672 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-property-action}
4673 With the cursor in a property drawer, this executes property commands.
4674 @orgcmd{C-c C-c s,org-set-property}
4675 Set a property in the current entry. Both the property and the value
4676 can be inserted using completion.
4677 @orgcmdkkcc{S-@key{right},S-@key{left},org-property-next-allowed-value,org-property-previous-allowed-value}
4678 Switch property at point to the next/previous allowed value.
4679 @orgcmd{C-c C-c d,org-delete-property}
4680 Remove a property from the current entry.
4681 @orgcmd{C-c C-c D,org-delete-property-globally}
4682 Globally remove a property, from all entries in the current file.
4683 @orgcmd{C-c C-c c,org-compute-property-at-point}
4684 Compute the property at point, using the operator and scope from the
4685 nearest column format definition.
4688 @node Special properties, Property searches, Property syntax, Properties and Columns
4689 @section Special properties
4690 @cindex properties, special
4692 Special properties provide an alternative access method to Org-mode
4693 features, like the TODO state or the priority of an entry, discussed in the
4694 previous chapters. This interface exists so that you can include
4695 these states in a column view (@pxref{Column view}), or to use them in
4696 queries. The following property names are special and should not be
4697 used as keys in the properties drawer:
4699 @cindex property, special, TODO
4700 @cindex property, special, TAGS
4701 @cindex property, special, ALLTAGS
4702 @cindex property, special, CATEGORY
4703 @cindex property, special, PRIORITY
4704 @cindex property, special, DEADLINE
4705 @cindex property, special, SCHEDULED
4706 @cindex property, special, CLOSED
4707 @cindex property, special, TIMESTAMP
4708 @cindex property, special, TIMESTAMP_IA
4709 @cindex property, special, CLOCKSUM
4710 @cindex property, special, BLOCKED
4711 @c guessing that ITEM is needed in this area; also, should this list be sorted?
4712 @cindex property, special, ITEM
4714 TODO @r{The TODO keyword of the entry.}
4715 TAGS @r{The tags defined directly in the headline.}
4716 ALLTAGS @r{All tags, including inherited ones.}
4717 CATEGORY @r{The category of an entry.}
4718 PRIORITY @r{The priority of the entry, a string with a single letter.}
4719 DEADLINE @r{The deadline time string, without the angular brackets.}
4720 SCHEDULED @r{The scheduling timestamp, without the angular brackets.}
4721 CLOSED @r{When was this entry closed?}
4722 TIMESTAMP @r{The first keyword-less timestamp in the entry.}
4723 TIMESTAMP_IA @r{The first inactive timestamp in the entry.}
4724 CLOCKSUM @r{The sum of CLOCK intervals in the subtree. @code{org-clock-sum}}
4725 @r{must be run first to compute the values.}
4726 BLOCKED @r{"t" if task is currently blocked by children or siblings}
4727 ITEM @r{The content of the entry.}
4730 @node Property searches, Property inheritance, Special properties, Properties and Columns
4731 @section Property searches
4732 @cindex properties, searching
4733 @cindex searching, of properties
4735 To create sparse trees and special lists with selection based on properties,
4736 the same commands are used as for tag searches (@pxref{Tag searches}).
4738 @orgcmdkkc{C-c / m,C-c \,org-match-sparse-tree}
4739 Create a sparse tree with all matching entries. With a
4740 @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, ignore headlines that are not a TODO line.
4741 @orgcmd{C-c a m,org-tags-view}
4742 Create a global list of tag/property matches from all agenda files.
4743 @xref{Matching tags and properties}.
4744 @orgcmd{C-c a M,org-tags-view}
4745 @vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
4746 Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files, but check
4747 only TODO items and force checking of subitems (see variable
4748 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels}).
4751 The syntax for the search string is described in @ref{Matching tags and
4754 There is also a special command for creating sparse trees based on a
4759 Create a sparse tree based on the value of a property. This first
4760 prompts for the name of a property, and then for a value. A sparse tree
4761 is created with all entries that define this property with the given
4762 value. If you enclose the value into curly braces, it is interpreted as
4763 a regular expression and matched against the property values.
4766 @node Property inheritance, Column view, Property searches, Properties and Columns
4767 @section Property Inheritance
4768 @cindex properties, inheritance
4769 @cindex inheritance, of properties
4771 @vindex org-use-property-inheritance
4772 The outline structure of Org-mode documents lends itself for an
4773 inheritance model of properties: if the parent in a tree has a certain
4774 property, the children can inherit this property. Org-mode does not
4775 turn this on by default, because it can slow down property searches
4776 significantly and is often not needed. However, if you find inheritance
4777 useful, you can turn it on by setting the variable
4778 @code{org-use-property-inheritance}. It may be set to @code{t} to make
4779 all properties inherited from the parent, to a list of properties
4780 that should be inherited, or to a regular expression that matches
4781 inherited properties. If a property has the value @samp{nil}, this is
4782 interpreted as an explicit undefine of he property, so that inheritance
4783 search will stop at this value and return @code{nil}.
4785 Org-mode has a few properties for which inheritance is hard-coded, at
4786 least for the special applications for which they are used:
4788 @cindex property, COLUMNS
4791 The @code{:COLUMNS:} property defines the format of column view
4792 (@pxref{Column view}). It is inherited in the sense that the level
4793 where a @code{:COLUMNS:} property is defined is used as the starting
4794 point for a column view table, independently of the location in the
4795 subtree from where columns view is turned on.
4797 @cindex property, CATEGORY
4798 For agenda view, a category set through a @code{:CATEGORY:} property
4799 applies to the entire subtree.
4801 @cindex property, ARCHIVE
4802 For archiving, the @code{:ARCHIVE:} property may define the archive
4803 location for the entire subtree (@pxref{Moving subtrees}).
4805 @cindex property, LOGGING
4806 The LOGGING property may define logging settings for an entry or a
4807 subtree (@pxref{Tracking TODO state changes}).
4810 @node Column view, Property API, Property inheritance, Properties and Columns
4811 @section Column view
4813 A great way to view and edit properties in an outline tree is
4814 @emph{column view}. In column view, each outline node is turned into a
4815 table row. Columns in this table provide access to properties of the
4816 entries. Org-mode implements columns by overlaying a tabular structure
4817 over the headline of each item. While the headlines have been turned
4818 into a table row, you can still change the visibility of the outline
4819 tree. For example, you get a compact table by switching to CONTENTS
4820 view (@kbd{S-@key{TAB} S-@key{TAB}}, or simply @kbd{c} while column view
4821 is active), but you can still open, read, and edit the entry below each
4822 headline. Or, you can switch to column view after executing a sparse
4823 tree command and in this way get a table only for the selected items.
4824 Column view also works in agenda buffers (@pxref{Agenda Views}) where
4825 queries have collected selected items, possibly from a number of files.
4828 * Defining columns:: The COLUMNS format property
4829 * Using column view:: How to create and use column view
4830 * Capturing column view:: A dynamic block for column view
4833 @node Defining columns, Using column view, Column view, Column view
4834 @subsection Defining columns
4835 @cindex column view, for properties
4836 @cindex properties, column view
4838 Setting up a column view first requires defining the columns. This is
4839 done by defining a column format line.
4842 * Scope of column definitions:: Where defined, where valid?
4843 * Column attributes:: Appearance and content of a column
4846 @node Scope of column definitions, Column attributes, Defining columns, Defining columns
4847 @subsubsection Scope of column definitions
4849 To define a column format for an entire file, use a line like
4853 #+COLUMNS: %25ITEM %TAGS %PRIORITY %TODO
4856 To specify a format that only applies to a specific tree, add a
4857 @code{:COLUMNS:} property to the top node of that tree, for example:
4860 ** Top node for columns view
4862 :COLUMNS: %25ITEM %TAGS %PRIORITY %TODO
4866 If a @code{:COLUMNS:} property is present in an entry, it defines columns
4867 for the entry itself, and for the entire subtree below it. Since the
4868 column definition is part of the hierarchical structure of the document,
4869 you can define columns on level 1 that are general enough for all
4870 sublevels, and more specific columns further down, when you edit a
4871 deeper part of the tree.
4873 @node Column attributes, , Scope of column definitions, Defining columns
4874 @subsubsection Column attributes
4875 A column definition sets the attributes of a column. The general
4876 definition looks like this:
4879 %[@var{width}]@var{property}[(@var{title})][@{@var{summary-type}@}]
4883 Except for the percent sign and the property name, all items are
4884 optional. The individual parts have the following meaning:
4887 @var{width} @r{An integer specifying the width of the column in characters.}
4888 @r{If omitted, the width will be determined automatically.}
4889 @var{property} @r{The property that should be edited in this column.}
4890 @r{Special properties representing meta data are allowed here}
4891 @r{as well (@pxref{Special properties})}
4892 @var{title} @r{The header text for the column. If omitted, the property}
4894 @{@var{summary-type}@} @r{The summary type. If specified, the column values for}
4895 @r{parent nodes are computed from the children.}
4896 @r{Supported summary types are:}
4897 @{+@} @r{Sum numbers in this column.}
4898 @{+;%.1f@} @r{Like @samp{+}, but format result with @samp{%.1f}.}
4899 @{$@} @r{Currency, short for @samp{+;%.2f}.}
4900 @{:@} @r{Sum times, HH:MM, plain numbers are hours.}
4901 @{X@} @r{Checkbox status, @samp{[X]} if all children are @samp{[X]}.}
4902 @{X/@} @r{Checkbox status, @samp{[n/m]}.}
4903 @{X%@} @r{Checkbox status, @samp{[n%]}.}
4904 @{min@} @r{Smallest number in column.}
4905 @{max@} @r{Largest number.}
4906 @{mean@} @r{Arithmetic mean of numbers.}
4907 @{:min@} @r{Smallest time value in column.}
4908 @{:max@} @r{Largest time value.}
4909 @{:mean@} @r{Arithmetic mean of time values.}
4910 @{@@min@} @r{Minimum age (in days/hours/mins/seconds).}
4911 @{@@max@} @r{Maximum age (in days/hours/mins/seconds).}
4912 @{@@mean@} @r{Arithmetic mean of ages (in days/hours/mins/seconds).}
4913 @{est+@} @r{Add low-high estimates.}
4917 Be aware that you can only have one summary type for any property you
4918 include. Subsequent columns referencing the same property will all display the
4919 same summary information.
4921 The @code{est+} summary type requires further explanation. It is used for
4922 combining estimates, expressed as low-high ranges. For example, instead
4923 of estimating a particular task will take 5 days, you might estimate it as
4924 5-6 days if you're fairly confident you know how much woark is required, or
4925 1-10 days if you don't really know what needs to be done. Both ranges
4926 average at 5.5 days, but the first represents a more predictable delivery.
4928 When combining a set of such estimates, simply adding the lows and highs
4929 produces an unrealistically wide result. Instead, @code{est+} adds the
4930 statistical mean and variance of the sub-tasks, generating a final estimate
4931 from the sum. For example, suppose you had ten tasks, each of which was
4932 estimated at 0.5 to 2 days of work. Straight addition produces an estimate
4933 of 5 to 20 days, representing what to expect if everything goes either
4934 extremely well or extremely poorly. In contrast, @code{est+} estimates the
4935 full job more realistically, at 10-15 days.
4937 Here is an example for a complete columns definition, along with allowed
4941 :COLUMNS: %25ITEM %9Approved(Approved?)@{X@} %Owner %11Status \@footnote{Please note that the COLUMNS definition must be on a single line---it is wrapped here only because of formatting constraints.}
4942 %10Time_Estimate@{:@} %CLOCKSUM
4943 :Owner_ALL: Tammy Mark Karl Lisa Don
4944 :Status_ALL: "In progress" "Not started yet" "Finished" ""
4945 :Approved_ALL: "[ ]" "[X]"
4949 The first column, @samp{%25ITEM}, means the first 25 characters of the
4950 item itself, i.e. of the headline. You probably always should start the
4951 column definition with the @samp{ITEM} specifier. The other specifiers
4952 create columns @samp{Owner} with a list of names as allowed values, for
4953 @samp{Status} with four different possible values, and for a checkbox
4954 field @samp{Approved}. When no width is given after the @samp{%}
4955 character, the column will be exactly as wide as it needs to be in order
4956 to fully display all values. The @samp{Approved} column does have a
4957 modified title (@samp{Approved?}, with a question mark). Summaries will
4958 be created for the @samp{Time_Estimate} column by adding time duration
4959 expressions like HH:MM, and for the @samp{Approved} column, by providing
4960 an @samp{[X]} status if all children have been checked. The
4961 @samp{CLOCKSUM} column is special, it lists the sum of CLOCK intervals
4964 @node Using column view, Capturing column view, Defining columns, Column view
4965 @subsection Using column view
4968 @tsubheading{Turning column view on and off}
4969 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-c,org-columns}
4970 @vindex org-columns-default-format
4971 Turn on column view. If the cursor is before the first headline in the file,
4972 column view is turned on for the entire file, using the @code{#+COLUMNS}
4973 definition. If the cursor is somewhere inside the outline, this command
4974 searches the hierarchy, up from point, for a @code{:COLUMNS:} property that
4975 defines a format. When one is found, the column view table is established
4976 for the tree starting at the entry that contains the @code{:COLUMNS:}
4977 property. If no such property is found, the format is taken from the
4978 @code{#+COLUMNS} line or from the variable @code{org-columns-default-format},
4979 and column view is established for the current entry and its subtree.
4980 @orgcmd{r,org-columns-redo}
4981 Recreate the column view, to include recent changes made in the buffer.
4982 @orgcmd{g,org-columns-redo}
4984 @orgcmd{q,org-columns-quit}
4986 @tsubheading{Editing values}
4987 @item @key{left} @key{right} @key{up} @key{down}
4988 Move through the column view from field to field.
4989 @kindex S-@key{left}
4990 @kindex S-@key{right}
4991 @item S-@key{left}/@key{right}
4992 Switch to the next/previous allowed value of the field. For this, you
4993 have to have specified allowed values for a property.
4995 Directly select the nth allowed value, @kbd{0} selects the 10th value.
4996 @orgcmdkkcc{n,p,org-columns-next-allowed-value,org-columns-previous-allowed-value}
4997 Same as @kbd{S-@key{left}/@key{right}}
4998 @orgcmd{e,org-columns-edit-value}
4999 Edit the property at point. For the special properties, this will
5000 invoke the same interface that you normally use to change that
5001 property. For example, when editing a TAGS property, the tag completion
5002 or fast selection interface will pop up.
5003 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-columns-set-tags-or-toggle}
5004 When there is a checkbox at point, toggle it.
5005 @orgcmd{v,org-columns-show-value}
5006 View the full value of this property. This is useful if the width of
5007 the column is smaller than that of the value.
5008 @orgcmd{a,org-columns-edit-allowed}
5009 Edit the list of allowed values for this property. If the list is found
5010 in the hierarchy, the modified values is stored there. If no list is
5011 found, the new value is stored in the first entry that is part of the
5012 current column view.
5013 @tsubheading{Modifying the table structure}
5014 @orgcmdkkcc{<,>,org-columns-narrow,org-columns-widen}
5015 Make the column narrower/wider by one character.
5016 @orgcmd{S-M-@key{right},org-columns-new}
5017 Insert a new column, to the left of the current column.
5018 @orgcmd{S-M-@key{left},org-columns-delete}
5019 Delete the current column.
5022 @node Capturing column view, , Using column view, Column view
5023 @subsection Capturing column view
5025 Since column view is just an overlay over a buffer, it cannot be
5026 exported or printed directly. If you want to capture a column view, use
5027 a @code{columnview} dynamic block (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}). The frame
5028 of this block looks like this:
5030 @cindex #+BEGIN, columnview
5033 #+BEGIN: columnview :hlines 1 :id "label"
5038 @noindent This dynamic block has the following parameters:
5042 This is the most important parameter. Column view is a feature that is
5043 often localized to a certain (sub)tree, and the capture block might be
5044 at a different location in the file. To identify the tree whose view to
5045 capture, you can use 4 values:
5046 @cindex property, ID
5048 local @r{use the tree in which the capture block is located}
5049 global @r{make a global view, including all headings in the file}
5050 "file:@var{path-to-file}"
5051 @r{run column view at the top of this file}
5052 "@var{ID}" @r{call column view in the tree that has an @code{:ID:}}
5053 @r{property with the value @i{label}. You can use}
5054 @r{@kbd{M-x org-id-copy} to create a globally unique ID for}
5055 @r{the current entry and copy it to the kill-ring.}
5058 When @code{t}, insert an hline after every line. When a number @var{N}, insert
5059 an hline before each headline with level @code{<= @var{N}}.
5061 When set to @code{t}, force column groups to get vertical lines.
5063 When set to a number, don't capture entries below this level.
5064 @item :skip-empty-rows
5065 When set to @code{t}, skip rows where the only non-empty specifier of the
5066 column view is @code{ITEM}.
5071 The following commands insert or update the dynamic block:
5074 @orgcmd{C-c C-x i,org-insert-columns-dblock}
5075 Insert a dynamic block capturing a column view. You will be prompted
5076 for the scope or ID of the view.
5077 @orgcmdkkc{C-c C-c,C-c C-x C-u,org-dblock-update}
5078 Update dynamic block at point. The cursor needs to be in the
5079 @code{#+BEGIN} line of the dynamic block.
5080 @orgcmd{C-u C-c C-x C-u,org-update-all-dblocks}
5081 Update all dynamic blocks (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}). This is useful if
5082 you have several clock table blocks, column-capturing blocks or other dynamic
5086 You can add formulas to the column view table and you may add plotting
5087 instructions in front of the table---these will survive an update of the
5088 block. If there is a @code{#+TBLFM:} after the table, the table will
5089 actually be recalculated automatically after an update.
5091 An alternative way to capture and process property values into a table is
5092 provided by Eric Schulte's @file{org-collector.el} which is a contributed
5093 package@footnote{Contributed packages are not part of Emacs, but are
5094 distributed with the main distribution of Org (visit
5095 @uref{http://orgmode.org}).}. It provides a general API to collect
5096 properties from entries in a certain scope, and arbitrary Lisp expressions to
5097 process these values before inserting them into a table or a dynamic block.
5099 @node Property API, , Column view, Properties and Columns
5100 @section The Property API
5101 @cindex properties, API
5102 @cindex API, for properties
5104 There is a full API for accessing and changing properties. This API can
5105 be used by Emacs Lisp programs to work with properties and to implement
5106 features based on them. For more information see @ref{Using the
5109 @node Dates and Times, Capture - Refile - Archive, Properties and Columns, Top
5110 @chapter Dates and times
5116 To assist project planning, TODO items can be labeled with a date and/or
5117 a time. The specially formatted string carrying the date and time
5118 information is called a @emph{timestamp} in Org-mode. This may be a
5119 little confusing because timestamp is often used as indicating when
5120 something was created or last changed. However, in Org-mode this term
5121 is used in a much wider sense.
5124 * Timestamps:: Assigning a time to a tree entry
5125 * Creating timestamps:: Commands which insert timestamps
5126 * Deadlines and scheduling:: Planning your work
5127 * Clocking work time:: Tracking how long you spend on a task
5128 * Effort estimates:: Planning work effort in advance
5129 * Relative timer:: Notes with a running timer
5130 * Countdown timer:: Starting a countdown timer for a task
5134 @node Timestamps, Creating timestamps, Dates and Times, Dates and Times
5135 @section Timestamps, deadlines, and scheduling
5137 @cindex ranges, time
5142 A timestamp is a specification of a date (possibly with a time or a range of
5143 times) in a special format, either @samp{<2003-09-16 Tue>} or
5144 @samp{<2003-09-16 Tue 09:39>} or @samp{<2003-09-16 Tue
5145 12:00-12:30>}@footnote{This is inspired by the standard ISO 8601 date/time
5146 format. To use an alternative format, see @ref{Custom time format}.}. A
5147 timestamp can appear anywhere in the headline or body of an Org tree entry.
5148 Its presence causes entries to be shown on specific dates in the agenda
5149 (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}). We distinguish:
5152 @item Plain timestamp; Event; Appointment
5154 A simple timestamp just assigns a date/time to an item. This is just
5155 like writing down an appointment or event in a paper agenda. In the
5156 timeline and agenda displays, the headline of an entry associated with a
5157 plain timestamp will be shown exactly on that date.
5160 * Meet Peter at the movies <2006-11-01 Wed 19:15>
5161 * Discussion on climate change <2006-11-02 Thu 20:00-22:00>
5164 @item Timestamp with repeater interval
5165 @cindex timestamp, with repeater interval
5166 A timestamp may contain a @emph{repeater interval}, indicating that it
5167 applies not only on the given date, but again and again after a certain
5168 interval of N days (d), weeks (w), months (m), or years (y). The
5169 following will show up in the agenda every Wednesday:
5172 * Pick up Sam at school <2007-05-16 Wed 12:30 +1w>
5175 @item Diary-style sexp entries
5176 For more complex date specifications, Org-mode supports using the
5177 special sexp diary entries implemented in the Emacs calendar/diary
5178 package. For example
5181 * The nerd meeting on every 2nd Thursday of the month
5182 <%%(diary-float t 4 2)>
5185 @item Time/Date range
5188 Two timestamps connected by @samp{--} denote a range. The headline
5189 will be shown on the first and last day of the range, and on any dates
5190 that are displayed and fall in the range. Here is an example:
5193 ** Meeting in Amsterdam
5194 <2004-08-23 Mon>--<2004-08-26 Thu>
5197 @item Inactive timestamp
5198 @cindex timestamp, inactive
5199 @cindex inactive timestamp
5200 Just like a plain timestamp, but with square brackets instead of
5201 angular ones. These timestamps are inactive in the sense that they do
5202 @emph{not} trigger an entry to show up in the agenda.
5205 * Gillian comes late for the fifth time [2006-11-01 Wed]
5210 @node Creating timestamps, Deadlines and scheduling, Timestamps, Dates and Times
5211 @section Creating timestamps
5212 @cindex creating timestamps
5213 @cindex timestamps, creating
5215 For Org-mode to recognize timestamps, they need to be in the specific
5216 format. All commands listed below produce timestamps in the correct
5220 @orgcmd{C-c .,org-time-stamp}
5221 Prompt for a date and insert a corresponding timestamp. When the cursor is
5222 at an existing timestamp in the buffer, the command is used to modify this
5223 timestamp instead of inserting a new one. When this command is used twice in
5224 succession, a time range is inserted.
5226 @orgcmd{C-c !,org-time-stamp-inactive}
5227 Like @kbd{C-c .}, but insert an inactive timestamp that will not cause
5234 @vindex org-time-stamp-rounding-minutes
5235 Like @kbd{C-c .} and @kbd{C-c !}, but use the alternative format which
5236 contains date and time. The default time can be rounded to multiples of 5
5237 minutes, see the option @code{org-time-stamp-rounding-minutes}.
5239 @orgcmd{C-c <,org-date-from-calendar}
5240 Insert a timestamp corresponding to the cursor date in the Calendar.
5242 @orgcmd{C-c >,org-goto-calendar}
5243 Access the Emacs calendar for the current date. If there is a
5244 timestamp in the current line, go to the corresponding date
5247 @orgcmd{C-c C-o,org-open-at-point}
5248 Access the agenda for the date given by the timestamp or -range at
5249 point (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}).
5251 @orgcmdkkcc{S-@key{left},S-@key{right},org-timestamp-down-day,org-timestamp-up-day}
5252 Change date at cursor by one day. These key bindings conflict with
5253 shift-selection and related modes (@pxref{Conflicts}).
5255 @orgcmdkkcc{S-@key{up},S-@key{down},org-timestamp-up,org-timestamp-down-down}
5256 Change the item under the cursor in a timestamp. The cursor can be on a
5257 year, month, day, hour or minute. When the timestamp contains a time range
5258 like @samp{15:30-16:30}, modifying the first time will also shift the second,
5259 shifting the time block with constant length. To change the length, modify
5260 the second time. Note that if the cursor is in a headline and not at a
5261 timestamp, these same keys modify the priority of an item.
5262 (@pxref{Priorities}). The key bindings also conflict with shift-selection and
5263 related modes (@pxref{Conflicts}).
5265 @orgcmd{C-c C-y,org-evaluate-time-range}
5266 @cindex evaluate time range
5267 Evaluate a time range by computing the difference between start and end.
5268 With a prefix argument, insert result after the time range (in a table: into
5269 the following column).
5274 * The date/time prompt:: How Org-mode helps you entering date and time
5275 * Custom time format:: Making dates look different
5278 @node The date/time prompt, Custom time format, Creating timestamps, Creating timestamps
5279 @subsection The date/time prompt
5280 @cindex date, reading in minibuffer
5281 @cindex time, reading in minibuffer
5283 @vindex org-read-date-prefer-future
5284 When Org-mode prompts for a date/time, the default is shown in default
5285 date/time format, and the prompt therefore seems to ask for a specific
5286 format. But it will in fact accept any string containing some date and/or
5287 time information, and it is really smart about interpreting your input. You
5288 can, for example, use @kbd{C-y} to paste a (possibly multi-line) string
5289 copied from an email message. Org-mode will find whatever information is in
5290 there and derive anything you have not specified from the @emph{default date
5291 and time}. The default is usually the current date and time, but when
5292 modifying an existing timestamp, or when entering the second stamp of a
5293 range, it is taken from the stamp in the buffer. When filling in
5294 information, Org-mode assumes that most of the time you will want to enter a
5295 date in the future: if you omit the month/year and the given day/month is
5296 @i{before} today, it will assume that you mean a future date@footnote{See the
5297 variable @code{org-read-date-prefer-future}. You may set that variable to
5298 the symbol @code{time} to even make a time before now shift the date to
5299 tomorrow.}. If the date has been automatically shifted into the future, the
5300 time prompt will show this with @samp{(=>F).}
5302 For example, let's assume that today is @b{June 13, 2006}. Here is how
5303 various inputs will be interpreted, the items filled in by Org-mode are
5307 3-2-5 --> 2003-02-05
5308 2/5/3 --> 2003-02-05
5309 14 --> @b{2006}-@b{06}-14
5310 12 --> @b{2006}-@b{07}-12
5311 2/5 --> @b{2007}-02-05
5312 Fri --> nearest Friday (default date or later)
5313 sep 15 --> @b{2006}-09-15
5314 feb 15 --> @b{2007}-02-15
5315 sep 12 9 --> 2009-09-12
5316 12:45 --> @b{2006}-@b{06}-@b{13} 12:45
5317 22 sept 0:34 --> @b{2006}-09-22 0:34
5318 w4 --> ISO week for of the current year @b{2006}
5319 2012 w4 fri --> Friday of ISO week 4 in 2012
5320 2012-w04-5 --> Same as above
5323 Furthermore you can specify a relative date by giving, as the
5324 @emph{first} thing in the input: a plus/minus sign, a number and a
5325 letter ([dwmy]) to indicate change in days, weeks, months, or years. With a
5326 single plus or minus, the date is always relative to today. With a
5327 double plus or minus, it is relative to the default date. If instead of
5328 a single letter, you use the abbreviation of day name, the date will be
5329 the nth such day. E.g.
5334 +4d --> four days from today
5335 +4 --> same as above
5336 +2w --> two weeks from today
5337 ++5 --> five days from default date
5338 +2tue --> second Tuesday from now.
5341 @vindex parse-time-months
5342 @vindex parse-time-weekdays
5343 The function understands English month and weekday abbreviations. If
5344 you want to use unabbreviated names and/or other languages, configure
5345 the variables @code{parse-time-months} and @code{parse-time-weekdays}.
5347 You can specify a time range by giving start and end times or by giving a
5348 start time and a duration (in HH:MM format). Use '-' or '--' as the separator
5349 in the former case and use '+' as the separator in the latter case. E.g.
5352 11am-1:15pm --> 11:00-13:15
5353 11am--1:15pm --> same as above
5354 11am+2:15 --> same as above
5357 @cindex calendar, for selecting date
5358 @vindex org-popup-calendar-for-date-prompt
5359 Parallel to the minibuffer prompt, a calendar is popped up@footnote{If
5360 you don't need/want the calendar, configure the variable
5361 @code{org-popup-calendar-for-date-prompt}.}. When you exit the date
5362 prompt, either by clicking on a date in the calendar, or by pressing
5363 @key{RET}, the date selected in the calendar will be combined with the
5364 information entered at the prompt. You can control the calendar fully
5365 from the minibuffer:
5372 @kindex S-@key{right}
5373 @kindex S-@key{left}
5374 @kindex S-@key{down}
5376 @kindex M-S-@key{right}
5377 @kindex M-S-@key{left}
5380 @key{RET} @r{Choose date at cursor in calendar.}
5381 mouse-1 @r{Select date by clicking on it.}
5382 S-@key{right}/@key{left} @r{One day forward/backward.}
5383 S-@key{down}/@key{up} @r{One week forward/backward.}
5384 M-S-@key{right}/@key{left} @r{One month forward/backward.}
5385 > / < @r{Scroll calendar forward/backward by one month.}
5386 M-v / C-v @r{Scroll calendar forward/backward by 3 months.}
5389 @vindex org-read-date-display-live
5390 The actions of the date/time prompt may seem complex, but I assure you they
5391 will grow on you, and you will start getting annoyed by pretty much any other
5392 way of entering a date/time out there. To help you understand what is going
5393 on, the current interpretation of your input will be displayed live in the
5394 minibuffer@footnote{If you find this distracting, turn the display of with
5395 @code{org-read-date-display-live}.}.
5397 @node Custom time format, , The date/time prompt, Creating timestamps
5398 @subsection Custom time format
5399 @cindex custom date/time format
5400 @cindex time format, custom
5401 @cindex date format, custom
5403 @vindex org-display-custom-times
5404 @vindex org-time-stamp-custom-formats
5405 Org-mode uses the standard ISO notation for dates and times as it is
5406 defined in ISO 8601. If you cannot get used to this and require another
5407 representation of date and time to keep you happy, you can get it by
5408 customizing the variables @code{org-display-custom-times} and
5409 @code{org-time-stamp-custom-formats}.
5412 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-t,org-toggle-time-stamp-overlays}
5413 Toggle the display of custom formats for dates and times.
5417 Org-mode needs the default format for scanning, so the custom date/time
5418 format does not @emph{replace} the default format---instead it is put
5419 @emph{over} the default format using text properties. This has the
5420 following consequences:
5423 You cannot place the cursor onto a timestamp anymore, only before or
5426 The @kbd{S-@key{up}/@key{down}} keys can no longer be used to adjust
5427 each component of a timestamp. If the cursor is at the beginning of
5428 the stamp, @kbd{S-@key{up}/@key{down}} will change the stamp by one day,
5429 just like @kbd{S-@key{left}/@key{right}}. At the end of the stamp, the
5430 time will be changed by one minute.
5432 If the timestamp contains a range of clock times or a repeater, these
5433 will not be overlayed, but remain in the buffer as they were.
5435 When you delete a timestamp character-by-character, it will only
5436 disappear from the buffer after @emph{all} (invisible) characters
5437 belonging to the ISO timestamp have been removed.
5439 If the custom timestamp format is longer than the default and you are
5440 using dates in tables, table alignment will be messed up. If the custom
5441 format is shorter, things do work as expected.
5445 @node Deadlines and scheduling, Clocking work time, Creating timestamps, Dates and Times
5446 @section Deadlines and scheduling
5448 A timestamp may be preceded by special keywords to facilitate planning:
5452 @cindex DEADLINE keyword
5454 Meaning: the task (most likely a TODO item, though not necessarily) is supposed
5455 to be finished on that date.
5457 @vindex org-deadline-warning-days
5458 On the deadline date, the task will be listed in the agenda. In
5459 addition, the agenda for @emph{today} will carry a warning about the
5460 approaching or missed deadline, starting
5461 @code{org-deadline-warning-days} before the due date, and continuing
5462 until the entry is marked DONE. An example:
5465 *** TODO write article about the Earth for the Guide
5466 The editor in charge is [[bbdb:Ford Prefect]]
5467 DEADLINE: <2004-02-29 Sun>
5470 You can specify a different lead time for warnings for a specific
5471 deadlines using the following syntax. Here is an example with a warning
5472 period of 5 days @code{DEADLINE: <2004-02-29 Sun -5d>}.
5475 @cindex SCHEDULED keyword
5477 Meaning: you are planning to start working on that task on the given
5480 @vindex org-agenda-skip-scheduled-if-done
5481 The headline will be listed under the given date@footnote{It will still
5482 be listed on that date after it has been marked DONE. If you don't like
5483 this, set the variable @code{org-agenda-skip-scheduled-if-done}.}. In
5484 addition, a reminder that the scheduled date has passed will be present
5485 in the compilation for @emph{today}, until the entry is marked DONE.
5486 I.e. the task will automatically be forwarded until completed.
5489 *** TODO Call Trillian for a date on New Years Eve.
5490 SCHEDULED: <2004-12-25 Sat>
5494 @b{Important:} Scheduling an item in Org-mode should @i{not} be
5495 understood in the same way that we understand @i{scheduling a meeting}.
5496 Setting a date for a meeting is just a simple appointment, you should
5497 mark this entry with a simple plain timestamp, to get this item shown
5498 on the date where it applies. This is a frequent misunderstanding by
5499 Org users. In Org-mode, @i{scheduling} means setting a date when you
5500 want to start working on an action item.
5503 You may use timestamps with repeaters in scheduling and deadline
5504 entries. Org-mode will issue early and late warnings based on the
5505 assumption that the timestamp represents the @i{nearest instance} of
5506 the repeater. However, the use of diary sexp entries like
5508 @code{<%%(diary-float t 42)>}
5510 in scheduling and deadline timestamps is limited. Org-mode does not
5511 know enough about the internals of each sexp function to issue early and
5512 late warnings. However, it will show the item on each day where the
5516 * Inserting deadline/schedule:: Planning items
5517 * Repeated tasks:: Items that show up again and again
5520 @node Inserting deadline/schedule, Repeated tasks, Deadlines and scheduling, Deadlines and scheduling
5521 @subsection Inserting deadlines or schedules
5523 The following commands allow you to quickly insert a deadline or to schedule
5528 @orgcmd{C-c C-d,org-deadline}
5529 Insert @samp{DEADLINE} keyword along with a stamp. The insertion will happen
5530 in the line directly following the headline. When called with a prefix arg,
5531 an existing deadline will be removed from the entry. Depending on the
5532 variable @code{org-log-redeadline}@footnote{with corresponding
5533 @code{#+STARTUP} keywords @code{logredeadline}, @code{lognoteredeadline},
5534 and @code{nologredeadline}}, a note will be taken when changing an existing
5536 @c FIXME Any CLOSED timestamp will be removed.????????
5538 @orgcmd{C-c C-s,org-schedule}
5539 Insert @samp{SCHEDULED} keyword along with a stamp. The insertion will
5540 happen in the line directly following the headline. Any CLOSED timestamp
5541 will be removed. When called with a prefix argument, remove the scheduling
5542 date from the entry. Depending on the variable
5543 @code{org-log-reschedule}@footnote{with corresponding @code{#+STARTUP}
5544 keywords @code{logredeadline}, @code{lognoteredeadline}, and
5545 @code{nologredeadline}}, a note will be taken when changing an existing
5548 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-k,org-mark-entry-for-agenda-action}
5551 Mark the current entry for agenda action. After you have marked the entry
5552 like this, you can open the agenda or the calendar to find an appropriate
5553 date. With the cursor on the selected date, press @kbd{k s} or @kbd{k d} to
5554 schedule the marked item.
5556 @orgcmd{C-c / d,org-check-deadlines}
5557 @cindex sparse tree, for deadlines
5558 @vindex org-deadline-warning-days
5559 Create a sparse tree with all deadlines that are either past-due, or
5560 which will become due within @code{org-deadline-warning-days}.
5561 With @kbd{C-u} prefix, show all deadlines in the file. With a numeric
5562 prefix, check that many days. For example, @kbd{C-1 C-c / d} shows
5563 all deadlines due tomorrow.
5565 @orgcmd{C-c / b,org-check-before-date}
5566 Sparse tree for deadlines and scheduled items before a given date.
5568 @orgcmd{C-c / a,org-check-after-date}
5569 Sparse tree for deadlines and scheduled items after a given date.
5572 @node Repeated tasks, , Inserting deadline/schedule, Deadlines and scheduling
5573 @subsection Repeated tasks
5574 @cindex tasks, repeated
5575 @cindex repeated tasks
5577 Some tasks need to be repeated again and again. Org-mode helps to
5578 organize such tasks using a so-called repeater in a DEADLINE, SCHEDULED,
5579 or plain timestamp. In the following example
5581 ** TODO Pay the rent
5582 DEADLINE: <2005-10-01 Sat +1m>
5585 the @code{+1m} is a repeater; the intended interpretation is that the task
5586 has a deadline on <2005-10-01> and repeats itself every (one) month starting
5587 from that time. If you need both a repeater and a special warning period in
5588 a deadline entry, the repeater should come first and the warning period last:
5589 @code{DEADLINE: <2005-10-01 Sat +1m -3d>}.
5591 @vindex org-todo-repeat-to-state
5592 Deadlines and scheduled items produce entries in the agenda when they are
5593 over-due, so it is important to be able to mark such an entry as completed
5594 once you have done so. When you mark a DEADLINE or a SCHEDULE with the TODO
5595 keyword DONE, it will no longer produce entries in the agenda. The problem
5596 with this is, however, that then also the @emph{next} instance of the
5597 repeated entry will not be active. Org-mode deals with this in the following
5598 way: When you try to mark such an entry DONE (using @kbd{C-c C-t}), it will
5599 shift the base date of the repeating timestamp by the repeater interval, and
5600 immediately set the entry state back to TODO@footnote{In fact, the target
5601 state is taken from, in this sequence, the @code{REPEAT_TO_STATE} property or
5602 the variable @code{org-todo-repeat-to-state}. If neither of these is
5603 specified, the target state defaults to the first state of the TODO state
5604 sequence.}. In the example above, setting the state to DONE would actually
5605 switch the date like this:
5608 ** TODO Pay the rent
5609 DEADLINE: <2005-11-01 Tue +1m>
5612 @vindex org-log-repeat
5613 A timestamp@footnote{You can change this using the option
5614 @code{org-log-repeat}, or the @code{#+STARTUP} options @code{logrepeat},
5615 @code{lognoterepeat}, and @code{nologrepeat}. With @code{lognoterepeat}, you
5616 will also be prompted for a note.} will be added under the deadline, to keep
5617 a record that you actually acted on the previous instance of this deadline.
5619 As a consequence of shifting the base date, this entry will no longer be
5620 visible in the agenda when checking past dates, but all future instances
5623 With the @samp{+1m} cookie, the date shift will always be exactly one
5624 month. So if you have not paid the rent for three months, marking this
5625 entry DONE will still keep it as an overdue deadline. Depending on the
5626 task, this may not be the best way to handle it. For example, if you
5627 forgot to call you father for 3 weeks, it does not make sense to call
5628 him 3 times in a single day to make up for it. Finally, there are tasks
5629 like changing batteries which should always repeat a certain time
5630 @i{after} the last time you did it. For these tasks, Org-mode has
5631 special repeaters markers with @samp{++} and @samp{.+}. For example:
5635 DEADLINE: <2008-02-10 Sun ++1w>
5636 Marking this DONE will shift the date by at least one week,
5637 but also by as many weeks as it takes to get this date into
5638 the future. However, it stays on a Sunday, even if you called
5639 and marked it done on Saturday.
5640 ** TODO Check the batteries in the smoke detectors
5641 DEADLINE: <2005-11-01 Tue .+1m>
5642 Marking this DONE will shift the date to one month after
5646 You may have both scheduling and deadline information for a specific
5647 task---just make sure that the repeater intervals on both are the same.
5649 An alternative to using a repeater is to create a number of copies of a task
5650 subtree, with dates shifted in each copy. The command @kbd{C-c C-x c} was
5651 created for this purpose, it is described in @ref{Structure editing}.
5654 @node Clocking work time, Effort estimates, Deadlines and scheduling, Dates and Times
5655 @section Clocking work time
5656 @cindex clocking time
5657 @cindex time clocking
5659 Org-mode allows you to clock the time you spend on specific tasks in a
5660 project. When you start working on an item, you can start the clock.
5661 When you stop working on that task, or when you mark the task done, the
5662 clock is stopped and the corresponding time interval is recorded. It
5663 also computes the total time spent on each subtree of a project. And it
5664 remembers a history or tasks recently clocked, to that you can jump quickly
5665 between a number of tasks absorbing your time.
5667 To save the clock history across Emacs sessions, use
5669 (setq org-clock-persist 'history)
5670 (org-clock-persistence-insinuate)
5672 When you clock into a new task after resuming Emacs, the incomplete
5673 clock@footnote{To resume the clock under the assumption that you have worked
5674 on this task while outside Emacs, use @code{(setq org-clock-persist t)}.}
5675 will be found (@pxref{Resolving idle time}) and you will be prompted about
5679 * Clocking commands:: Starting and stopping a clock
5680 * The clock table:: Detailed reports
5681 * Resolving idle time:: Resolving time when you've been idle
5684 @node Clocking commands, The clock table, Clocking work time, Clocking work time
5685 @subsection Clocking commands
5688 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-i,org-clock-in}
5689 @vindex org-clock-into-drawer
5690 Start the clock on the current item (clock-in). This inserts the CLOCK
5691 keyword together with a timestamp. If this is not the first clocking of
5692 this item, the multiple CLOCK lines will be wrapped into a
5693 @code{:LOGBOOK:} drawer (see also the variable
5694 @code{org-clock-into-drawer}). When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument,
5695 select the task from a list of recently clocked tasks. With two @kbd{C-u
5696 C-u} prefixes, clock into the task at point and mark it as the default task.
5697 The default task will always be available when selecting a clocking task,
5698 with letter @kbd{d}.@*
5699 @cindex property: CLOCK_MODELINE_TOTAL
5700 @cindex property: LAST_REPEAT
5701 @vindex org-clock-modeline-total
5702 While the clock is running, the current clocking time is shown in the mode
5703 line, along with the title of the task. The clock time shown will be all
5704 time ever clocked for this task and its children. If the task has an effort
5705 estimate (@pxref{Effort estimates}), the mode line displays the current
5706 clocking time against it@footnote{To add an effort estimate ``on the fly'',
5707 hook a function doing this to @code{org-clock-in-prepare-hook}.} If the task
5708 is a repeating one (@pxref{Repeated tasks}), only the time since the last
5709 reset of the task @footnote{as recorded by the @code{LAST_REPEAT} property}
5710 will be shown. More control over what time is shown can be exercised with
5711 the @code{CLOCK_MODELINE_TOTAL} property. It may have the values
5712 @code{current} to show only the current clocking instance, @code{today} to
5713 show all time clocked on this tasks today (see also the variable
5714 @code{org-extend-today-until}), @code{all} to include all time, or
5715 @code{auto} which is the default@footnote{See also the variable
5716 @code{org-clock-modeline-total}.}.@* Clicking with @kbd{mouse-1} onto the
5717 mode line entry will pop up a menu with clocking options.
5719 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-o,org-clock-out}
5720 @vindex org-log-note-clock-out
5721 Stop the clock (clock-out). This inserts another timestamp at the same
5722 location where the clock was last started. It also directly computes
5723 the resulting time in inserts it after the time range as @samp{=>
5724 HH:MM}. See the variable @code{org-log-note-clock-out} for the
5725 possibility to record an additional note together with the clock-out
5726 timestamp@footnote{The corresponding in-buffer setting is:
5727 @code{#+STARTUP: lognoteclock-out}}.
5728 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-e,org-clock-modify-effort-estimate}
5729 Update the effort estimate for the current clock task.
5732 @orgcmdkkc{C-c C-c,C-c C-y,org-evaluate-time-range}
5733 Recompute the time interval after changing one of the timestamps. This
5734 is only necessary if you edit the timestamps directly. If you change
5735 them with @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} keys, the update is automatic.
5736 @orgcmd{C-c C-t,org-todo}
5737 Changing the TODO state of an item to DONE automatically stops the clock
5738 if it is running in this same item.
5739 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-x,org-clock-cancel}
5740 Cancel the current clock. This is useful if a clock was started by
5741 mistake, or if you ended up working on something else.
5742 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-j,org-clock-goto}
5743 Jump to the headline of the currently clocked in task. With a @kbd{C-u}
5744 prefix arg, select the target task from a list of recently clocked tasks.
5745 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-d,org-clock-display}
5746 @vindex org-remove-highlights-with-change
5747 Display time summaries for each subtree in the current buffer. This
5748 puts overlays at the end of each headline, showing the total time
5749 recorded under that heading, including the time of any subheadings. You
5750 can use visibility cycling to study the tree, but the overlays disappear
5751 when you change the buffer (see variable
5752 @code{org-remove-highlights-with-change}) or press @kbd{C-c C-c}.
5755 The @kbd{l} key may be used in the timeline (@pxref{Timeline}) and in
5756 the agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}) to show which tasks have been
5757 worked on or closed during a day.
5759 @node The clock table, Resolving idle time, Clocking commands, Clocking work time
5760 @subsection The clock table
5761 @cindex clocktable, dynamic block
5762 @cindex report, of clocked time
5764 Org mode can produce quite complex reports based on the time clocking
5765 inormation. Such a report is called a @emph{clock table}, because it is
5766 formatted as one or several Org tables.
5769 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-r,org-clock-report}
5770 Insert a dynamic block (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}) containing a clock
5771 report as an Org-mode table into the current file. When the cursor is
5772 at an existing clock table, just update it. When called with a prefix
5773 argument, jump to the first clock report in the current document and
5775 @orgcmdkkc{C-c C-c,C-c C-x C-u,org-dblock-update}
5776 Update dynamic block at point. The cursor needs to be in the
5777 @code{#+BEGIN} line of the dynamic block.
5778 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-x C-u}
5779 Update all dynamic blocks (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}). This is useful if
5780 you have several clock table blocks in a buffer.
5781 @orgcmdkxkc{S-@key{left},S-@key{right},org-clocktable-try-shift}
5782 Shift the current @code{:block} interval and update the table. The cursor
5783 needs to be in the @code{#+BEGIN: clocktable} line for this command. If
5784 @code{:block} is @code{today}, it will be shifted to @code{today-1} etc.
5788 Here is an example of the frame for a clock table as it is inserted into the
5789 buffer with the @kbd{C-c C-x C-r} command:
5791 @cindex #+BEGIN, clocktable
5793 #+BEGIN: clocktable :maxlevel 2 :emphasize nil :scope file
5797 @vindex org-clocktable-defaults
5798 The @samp{BEGIN} line and specify a number of options to define the scope,
5799 structure, and formatting of the report. Defaults for all these options can
5800 be configured in the variable @code{org-clocktable-defaults}.
5802 @noindent First there are options that determine which clock entries are to
5805 :maxlevel @r{Maximum level depth to which times are listed in the table.}
5806 @r{Clocks at deeper levels will be summed into the upper level.}
5807 :scope @r{The scope to consider. This can be any of the following:}
5808 nil @r{the current buffer or narrowed region}
5809 file @r{the full current buffer}
5810 subtree @r{the subtree where the clocktable is located}
5811 tree@var{N} @r{the surrounding level @var{N} tree, for example @code{tree3}}
5812 tree @r{the surrounding level 1 tree}
5813 agenda @r{all agenda files}
5814 ("file"..) @r{scan these files}
5815 file-with-archives @r{current file and its archives}
5816 agenda-with-archives @r{all agenda files, including archives}
5817 :block @r{The time block to consider. This block is specified either}
5818 @r{absolute, or relative to the current time and may be any of}
5820 2007-12-31 @r{New year eve 2007}
5821 2007-12 @r{December 2007}
5822 2007-W50 @r{ISO-week 50 in 2007}
5823 2007 @r{the year 2007}
5824 today, yesterday, today-@var{N} @r{a relative day}
5825 thisweek, lastweek, thisweek-@var{N} @r{a relative week}
5826 thismonth, lastmonth, thismonth-@var{N} @r{a relative month}
5827 thisyear, lastyear, thisyear-@var{N} @r{a relative year}
5828 @r{Use @kbd{S-@key{left}/@key{right}} keys to shift the time interval.}
5829 :tstart @r{A time string specifying when to start considering times.}
5830 :tend @r{A time string specifying when to stop considering times.}
5831 :step @r{@code{week} or @code{day}, to split the table into chunks.}
5832 @r{To use this, @code{:block} or @code{:tstart}, @code{:tend} are needed.}
5833 :stepskip0 @r{Do not show steps that have zero time.}
5834 :fileskip0 @r{Do not show table sections from files which did not contribute.}
5835 :tags @r{A tags match to select entries that should contribute}.
5838 Then there are options which determine the formatting of the table. There
5839 options are interpreted by the function @code{org-clocktable-write-default},
5840 but you can specify your own function using the @code{:formatter} parameter.
5842 :emphasize @r{When @code{t}, emphasize level one and level two items.}
5843 :link @r{Link the item headlines in the table to their origins.}
5844 :narrow @r{An integer to limit the width of the headline column in}
5845 @r{the org table. If you write it like @samp{50!}, then the}
5846 @r{headline will also be shortened in export.}
5847 :indent @r{Indent each headline field according to its level.}
5848 :tcolumns @r{Number of columns to be used for times. If this is smaller}
5849 @r{than @code{:maxlevel}, lower levels will be lumped into one column.}
5850 :level @r{Should a level number column be included?}
5851 :compact @r{Abbreviation for @code{:level nil :indent t :narrow 40! :tcolumns 1}}
5852 @r{All are overwritten except if there is an explicit @code{:narrow}}
5853 :timestamp @r{A timestamp for the entry, when available. Look for SCHEDULED,}
5854 @r{DEADLINE, TIMESTAMP and TIMESTAMP_IA, in this order.}
5855 :formula @r{Content of a @code{#+TBLFM} line to be added and evaluated.}
5856 @r{As a special case, @samp{:formula %} adds a column with % time.}
5857 @r{If you do not specify a formula here, any existing formula.}
5858 @r{below the clock table will survive updates and be evaluated.}
5859 :formatter @r{A function to format clock data and insert it into the buffer.}
5861 To get a clock summary of the current level 1 tree, for the current
5862 day, you could write
5864 #+BEGIN: clocktable :maxlevel 2 :block today :scope tree1 :link t
5868 and to use a specific time range you could write@footnote{Note that all
5869 parameters must be specified in a single line---the line is broken here
5870 only to fit it into the manual.}
5872 #+BEGIN: clocktable :tstart "<2006-08-10 Thu 10:00>"
5873 :tend "<2006-08-10 Thu 12:00>"
5876 A summary of the current subtree with % times would be
5878 #+BEGIN: clocktable :scope subtree :link t :formula %
5881 A horizontally compact representation of everything clocked during last week
5884 #+BEGIN: clocktable :scope agenda :block lastweek :compact t
5888 @node Resolving idle time, , The clock table, Clocking work time
5889 @subsection Resolving idle time
5890 @cindex resolve idle time
5892 @cindex idle, resolve, dangling
5893 If you clock in on a work item, and then walk away from your
5894 computer---perhaps to take a phone call---you often need to ``resolve'' the
5895 time you were away by either subtracting it from the current clock, or
5896 applying it to another one.
5898 @vindex org-clock-idle-time
5899 By customizing the variable @code{org-clock-idle-time} to some integer, such
5900 as 10 or 15, Emacs can alert you when you get back to your computer after
5901 being idle for that many minutes@footnote{On computers using Mac OS X,
5902 idleness is based on actual user idleness, not just Emacs' idle time. For
5903 X11, you can install a utility program @file{x11idle.c}, available in the
5904 UTILITIES directory of the Org git distribution, to get the same general
5905 treatment of idleness. On other systems, idle time refers to Emacs idle time
5906 only.}, and ask what you want to do with the idle time. There will be a
5907 question waiting for you when you get back, indicating how much idle time has
5908 passed (constantly updated with the current amount), as well as a set of
5909 choices to correct the discrepancy:
5913 To keep some or all of the minutes and stay clocked in, press @kbd{k}. Org
5914 will ask how many of the minutes to keep. Press @key{RET} to keep them all,
5915 effectively changing nothing, or enter a number to keep that many minutes.
5917 If you use the shift key and press @kbd{K}, it will keep however many minutes
5918 you request and then immediately clock out of that task. If you keep all of
5919 the minutes, this is the same as just clocking out of the current task.
5921 To keep none of the minutes, use @kbd{s} to subtract all the away time from
5922 the clock, and then check back in from the moment you returned.
5924 To keep none of the minutes and just clock out at the start of the away time,
5925 use the shift key and press @kbd{S}. Remember that using shift will always
5926 leave you clocked out, no matter which option you choose.
5928 To cancel the clock altogether, use @kbd{C}. Note that if instead of
5929 canceling you subtract the away time, and the resulting clock amount is less
5930 than a minute, the clock will still be canceled rather than clutter up the
5931 log with an empty entry.
5934 What if you subtracted those away minutes from the current clock, and now
5935 want to apply them to a new clock? Simply clock in to any task immediately
5936 after the subtraction. Org will notice that you have subtracted time ``on
5937 the books'', so to speak, and will ask if you want to apply those minutes to
5938 the next task you clock in on.
5940 There is one other instance when this clock resolution magic occurs. Say you
5941 were clocked in and hacking away, and suddenly your cat chased a mouse who
5942 scared a hamster that crashed into your UPS's power button! You suddenly
5943 lose all your buffers, but thanks to auto-save you still have your recent Org
5944 mode changes, including your last clock in.
5946 If you restart Emacs and clock into any task, Org will notice that you have a
5947 dangling clock which was never clocked out from your last session. Using
5948 that clock's starting time as the beginning of the unaccounted-for period,
5949 Org will ask how you want to resolve that time. The logic and behavior is
5950 identical to dealing with away time due to idleness, it's just happening due
5951 to a recovery event rather than a set amount of idle time.
5953 You can also check all the files visited by your Org agenda for dangling
5954 clocks at any time using @kbd{M-x org-resolve-clocks}.
5956 @node Effort estimates, Relative timer, Clocking work time, Dates and Times
5957 @section Effort estimates
5958 @cindex effort estimates
5960 @cindex property, Effort
5961 @vindex org-effort-property
5962 If you want to plan your work in a very detailed way, or if you need to
5963 produce offers with quotations of the estimated work effort, you may want to
5964 assign effort estimates to entries. If you are also clocking your work, you
5965 may later want to compare the planned effort with the actual working time, a
5966 great way to improve planning estimates. Effort estimates are stored in a
5967 special property @samp{Effort}@footnote{You may change the property being
5968 used with the variable @code{org-effort-property}.}. You can set the effort
5969 for an entry with the following commands:
5972 @orgcmd{C-c C-x e,org-set-effort}
5973 Set the effort estimate for the current entry. With a numeric prefix
5974 argument, set it to the NTH allowed value (see below). This command is also
5975 accessible from the agenda with the @kbd{e} key.
5976 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-e,org-clock-modify-effort-estimate}
5977 Modify the effort estimate of the item currently being clocked.
5980 Clearly the best way to work with effort estimates is through column view
5981 (@pxref{Column view}). You should start by setting up discrete values for
5982 effort estimates, and a @code{COLUMNS} format that displays these values
5983 together with clock sums (if you want to clock your time). For a specific
5987 #+PROPERTY: Effort_ALL 0 0:10 0:30 1:00 2:00 3:00 4:00 5:00 6:00 7:00 8:00
5988 #+COLUMNS: %40ITEM(Task) %17Effort(Estimated Effort)@{:@} %CLOCKSUM
5992 @vindex org-global-properties
5993 @vindex org-columns-default-format
5994 or, even better, you can set up these values globally by customizing the
5995 variables @code{org-global-properties} and @code{org-columns-default-format}.
5996 In particular if you want to use this setup also in the agenda, a global
5997 setup may be advised.
5999 The way to assign estimates to individual items is then to switch to column
6000 mode, and to use @kbd{S-@key{right}} and @kbd{S-@key{left}} to change the
6001 value. The values you enter will immediately be summed up in the hierarchy.
6002 In the column next to it, any clocked time will be displayed.
6004 @vindex org-agenda-columns-add-appointments-to-effort-sum
6005 If you switch to column view in the daily/weekly agenda, the effort column
6006 will summarize the estimated work effort for each day@footnote{Please note
6007 the pitfalls of summing hierarchical data in a flat list (@pxref{Agenda
6008 column view}).}, and you can use this to find space in your schedule. To get
6009 an overview of the entire part of the day that is committed, you can set the
6010 option @code{org-agenda-columns-add-appointments-to-effort-sum}. The
6011 appointments on a day that take place over a specified time interval will
6012 then also be added to the load estimate of the day.
6014 Effort estimates can be used in secondary agenda filtering that is triggered
6015 with the @kbd{/} key in the agenda (@pxref{Agenda commands}). If you have
6016 these estimates defined consistently, two or three key presses will narrow
6017 down the list to stuff that fits into an available time slot.
6019 @node Relative timer, Countdown timer, Effort estimates, Dates and Times
6020 @section Taking notes with a relative timer
6021 @cindex relative timer
6023 When taking notes during, for example, a meeting or a video viewing, it can
6024 be useful to have access to times relative to a starting time. Org provides
6025 such a relative timer and make it easy to create timed notes.
6028 @orgcmd{C-c C-x .,org-timer}
6029 Insert a relative time into the buffer. The first time you use this, the
6030 timer will be started. When called with a prefix argument, the timer is
6032 @orgcmd{C-c C-x -,org-timer-item}
6033 Insert a description list item with the current relative time. With a prefix
6034 argument, first reset the timer to 0.
6035 @orgcmd{M-@key{RET},org-insert-heading}
6036 Once the timer list is started, you can also use @kbd{M-@key{RET}} to insert
6038 @c for key sequences with a comma, command name macros fail :(
6041 Pause the timer, or continue it if it is already paused
6042 (@command{org-timer-pause-or-continue}).
6043 @c removed the sentence because it is redundant to the following item
6044 @kindex C-u C-c C-x ,
6046 Stop the timer. After this, you can only start a new timer, not continue the
6047 old one. This command also removes the timer from the mode line.
6048 @orgcmd{C-c C-x 0,org-timer-start}
6049 Reset the timer without inserting anything into the buffer. By default, the
6050 timer is reset to 0. When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, reset the timer to
6051 specific starting offset. The user is prompted for the offset, with a
6052 default taken from a timer string at point, if any, So this can be used to
6053 restart taking notes after a break in the process. When called with a double
6054 prefix argument @kbd{C-u C-u}, change all timer strings in the active region
6055 by a certain amount. This can be used to fix timer strings if the timer was
6056 not started at exactly the right moment.
6059 @node Countdown timer, , Relative timer, Dates and Times
6060 @section Countdown timer
6061 @cindex Countdown timer
6065 Calling @code{org-timer-set-timer} from an Org-mode buffer runs a countdown
6066 timer. Use @key{;} from agenda buffers, @key{C-c C-x ;} everwhere else.
6068 @code{org-timer-set-timer} prompts the user for a duration and displays a
6069 countdown timer in the modeline. @code{org-timer-default-timer} sets the
6070 default countdown value. Giving a prefix numeric argument overrides this
6073 @node Capture - Refile - Archive, Agenda Views, Dates and Times, Top
6074 @chapter Capture - Refile - Archive
6077 An important part of any organization system is the ability to quickly
6078 capture new ideas and tasks, and to associate reference material with them.
6079 Org does this using a process called @i{capture}. It also can store files
6080 related to a task (@i{attachments}) in a special directory. Once in the
6081 system, tasks and projects need to be moved around. Moving completed project
6082 trees to an archive file keeps the system compact and fast.
6085 * Capture:: Capturing new stuff
6086 * Attachments:: Add files to tasks
6087 * RSS Feeds:: Getting input from RSS feeds
6088 * Protocols:: External (e.g. Browser) access to Emacs and Org
6089 * Refiling notes:: Moving a tree from one place to another
6090 * Archiving:: What to do with finished projects
6093 @node Capture, Attachments, Capture - Refile - Archive, Capture - Refile - Archive
6097 Org's method for capturing new items is heavily inspired by John Wiegley
6098 excellent remember package. Up to version 6.36 Org used a special setup
6099 for @file{remember.el}. @file{org-remember.el} is still part of Org-mode for
6100 backward compatibility with existing setups. You can find the documentation
6101 for org-remember at @url{http://orgmode.org/org-remember.pdf}.
6103 The new capturing setup described here is preferred and should be used by new
6104 users. To convert your @code{org-remember-templates}, run the command
6106 @kbd{M-x org-capture-import-remember-templates @key{RET}}
6108 @noindent and then customize the new variable with @kbd{M-x
6109 customize-variable org-capture-templates}, check the result, and save the
6110 customization. You can then use both remember and capture until
6111 you are familiar with the new mechanism.
6113 Capture lets you quickly store notes with little interruption of your work
6114 flow. The basic process of capturing is very similar to remember, but Org
6115 does enhance it with templates and more.
6118 * Setting up capture:: Where notes will be stored
6119 * Using capture:: Commands to invoke and terminate capture
6120 * Capture templates:: Define the outline of different note types
6123 @node Setting up capture, Using capture, Capture, Capture
6124 @subsection Setting up capture
6126 The following customization sets a default target file for notes, and defines
6127 a global key@footnote{Please select your own key, @kbd{C-c c} is only a
6128 suggestion.} for capturing new material.
6130 @vindex org-default-notes-file
6132 (setq org-default-notes-file (concat org-directory "/notes.org"))
6133 (define-key global-map "\C-cc" 'org-capture)
6136 @node Using capture, Capture templates, Setting up capture, Capture
6137 @subsection Using capture
6140 @orgcmd{C-c c,org-capture}
6141 Call the command @code{org-capture}. Note that this keybinding is global and
6142 not active by default - you need to install it. If you have templates
6143 defined @pxref{Capture templates}, it will offer these templates for
6144 selection or use a new Org outline node as the default template. It will
6145 insert the template into the target file and switch to an indirect buffer
6146 narrowed to this new node. You may then insert the information you want.
6148 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-capture-finalize}
6149 Once you have finished entering information into the capture buffer, @kbd{C-c
6150 C-c} will return you to the window configuration before the capture process,
6151 so that you can resume your work without further distraction.
6153 @orgcmd{C-c C-w,org-capture-refile}
6154 Finalize the capture process by refiling (@pxref{Refiling notes}) the note to
6155 a different place. Please realize that this is a normal refiling command
6156 that will be executed - so the cursor position at the moment you run this
6157 command is important. If you have inserted a tree with a parent and
6158 children, first move the cursor back to the parent.
6160 @orgcmd{C-c C-k,org-capture-kill}
6161 Abort the capture process and return to the previous state.
6164 You can also call @code{org-capture} in a special way from the agenda, using
6165 the @kbd{k c} key combination. With this access, any timestamps inserted by
6166 the selected capture template will default to the cursor date in the agenda,
6167 rather than to the current date.
6169 @node Capture templates, , Using capture, Capture
6170 @subsection Capture templates
6171 @cindex templates, for Capture
6173 You can use templates for different types of capture items, and
6174 for different target locations. The easiest way to create such templates is
6175 through the customize interface.
6179 Customize the variable @code{org-capture-templates}.
6182 Before we give the formal description of template definitions, let's look at
6183 an example. Say you would like to use one template to create general TODO
6184 entries, and you want to put these entries under the heading @samp{Tasks} in
6185 your file @file{~/org/gtd.org}. Also, a date tree in the file
6186 @file{journal.org} should capture journal entries. A possible configuration
6190 (setq org-capture-templates
6191 '(("t" "Todo" entry (file+headline "~/org/gtd.org" "Tasks")
6192 "* TODO %?\n %i\n %a")
6193 ("j" "Journal" entry (file+datetree "~/org/journal.org")
6194 "* %?\nEntered on %U\n %i\n %a")))
6197 @noindent If you then press @kbd{C-c c t}, Org will prepare the template
6201 [[file:@var{link to where you initiated capture}]]
6205 During expansion of the template, @code{%a} has been replaced by a link to
6206 the location from where you called the capture command. This can be
6207 extremely useful for deriving tasks from emails, for example. You fill in
6208 the task definition, press @code{C-c C-c} and Org returns you to the same
6209 place where you started the capture process.
6213 * Template elements:: What is needed for a complete template entry
6214 * Template expansion:: Filling in information about time and context
6217 @node Template elements, Template expansion, Capture templates, Capture templates
6218 @subsubsection Template elements
6220 Now lets look at the elements of a template definition. Each entry in
6221 @code{org-capture-templates} is a list with the following items:
6225 The keys that will select the template, as a string, characters
6226 only, for example @code{"a"} for a template to be selected with a
6227 single key, or @code{"bt"} for selection with two keys. When using
6228 several keys, keys using the same prefix key must be sequential
6229 in the list and preceded by a 2-element entry explaining the
6230 prefix key, for example
6232 ("b" "Templates for marking stuff to buy")
6234 @noindent If you do not define a template for the @kbd{C} key, this key will
6235 be used to open the customize buffer for this complex variable.
6238 A short string describing the template, which will be shown during
6242 The type of entry, a symbol. Valid values are:
6245 An Org-mode node, with a headline. Will be filed as the child of the
6246 target entry or as a top-level entry. The target file should be an Org-mode
6249 A plain list item, placed in the first plain list at the target
6250 location. Again the target file should be an Org file.
6252 A checkbox item. This only differs from the plain list item by the
6255 a new line in the first table at the target location. Where exactly the
6256 line will be inserted depends on the properties @code{:prepend} and
6257 @code{:table-line-pos} (see below).
6259 Text to be inserted as it is.
6263 @vindex org-default-notes-file
6264 Specification of where the captured item should be placed. In Org-mode
6265 files, targets usually define a node. Entries will become children of this
6266 node, other types will be added to the table or list in the body of this
6267 node. Most target specifications contain a file name. If that file name is
6268 the empty string, it defaults to @code{org-default-notes-file}.
6272 @item (file "path/to/file")
6273 Text will be placed at the beginning or end of that file.
6275 @item (id "id of existing org entry")
6276 Filing as child of this entry, or in the body of the entry.
6278 @item (file+headline "path/to/file" "node headline")
6279 Fast configuration if the target heading is unique in the file.
6281 @item (file+olp "path/to/file" "Level 1 heading" "Level 2" ...)
6282 For non-unique headings, the full path is safer.
6284 @item (file+regexp "path/to/file" "regexp to find location")
6285 Use a regular expression to position the cursor.
6287 @item (file+datetree "path/to/file")
6288 Will create a heading in a date tree for today's date.
6290 @item (file+datetree+prompt "path/to/file")
6291 Will create a heading in a date tree, but will prompt for the date.
6293 @item (file+function "path/to/file" function-finding-location)
6294 A function to find the right location in the file.
6297 File to the entry that is currently being clocked.
6299 @item (function function-finding-location)
6300 Most general way, write your own function to find both
6305 The template for creating the capture item. If you leave this empty, an
6306 appropriate default template will be used. Otherwise this is a string with
6307 escape codes, which will be replaced depending on time and context of the
6308 capture call. The string with escapes may be loaded from a template file,
6309 using the special syntax @code{(file "path/to/template")}. See below for
6313 The rest of the entry is a property list of additional options.
6314 Recognized properties are:
6317 Normally new captured information will be appended at
6318 the target location (last child, last table line, last list item...).
6319 Setting this property will change that.
6321 @item :immediate-finish
6322 When set, do not offer to edit the information, just
6323 file it away immediately. This makes sense if the template only needs
6324 information that can be added automatically.
6327 Set this to the number of lines to insert
6328 before and after the new item. Default 0, only common other value is 1.
6331 Start the clock in this item.
6334 If starting the capture interrupted a clock, restart that clock when finished
6338 Do not narrow the target buffer, simply show the full buffer. Default is to
6339 narrow it so that you only see the new material.
6342 If the target file was not yet visited when capture was invoked, kill the
6343 buffer again after capture is completed.
6347 @node Template expansion, , Template elements, Capture templates
6348 @subsubsection Template expansion
6350 In the template itself, special @kbd{%}-escapes@footnote{If you need one of
6351 these sequences literally, escape the @kbd{%} with a backslash.} allow
6352 dynamic insertion of content:
6354 @comment SJE: should these sentences terminate in period?
6356 %^@{@var{prompt}@} @r{prompt the user for a string and replace this sequence with it.}
6357 @r{You may specify a default value and a completion table with}
6358 @r{%^@{prompt|default|completion2|completion3...@}}
6359 @r{The arrow keys access a prompt-specific history.}
6360 %a @r{annotation, normally the link created with @code{org-store-link}}
6361 %A @r{like @code{%a}, but prompt for the description part}
6362 %i @r{initial content, the region when capture is called while the}
6363 @r{region is active.}
6364 @r{The entire text will be indented like @code{%i} itself.}
6365 %t @r{timestamp, date only}
6366 %T @r{timestamp with date and time}
6367 %u, %U @r{like the above, but inactive timestamps}
6368 %^t @r{like @code{%t}, but prompt for date. Similarly @code{%^T}, @code{%^u}, @code{%^U}}
6369 @r{You may define a prompt like @code{%^@{Birthday@}t}}
6370 %n @r{user name (taken from @code{user-full-name})}
6371 %c @r{Current kill ring head.}
6372 %x @r{Content of the X clipboard.}
6373 %^C @r{Interactive selection of which kill or clip to use.}
6374 %^L @r{Like @code{%^C}, but insert as link.}
6375 %k @r{title of the currently clocked task}
6376 %K @r{link to the currently clocked task}
6377 %^g @r{prompt for tags, with completion on tags in target file.}
6378 %^G @r{prompt for tags, with completion all tags in all agenda files.}
6379 %^@{@var{prop}@}p @r{Prompt the user for a value for property @var{prop}}
6380 %:keyword @r{specific information for certain link types, see below}
6381 %[@var{file}] @r{insert the contents of the file given by @var{file}}
6382 %(@var{sexp}) @r{evaluate Elisp @var{sexp} and replace with the result}
6386 For specific link types, the following keywords will be
6387 defined@footnote{If you define your own link types (@pxref{Adding
6388 hyperlink types}), any property you store with
6389 @code{org-store-link-props} can be accessed in capture templates in a
6392 @vindex org-from-is-user-regexp
6394 Link type | Available keywords
6395 -------------------+----------------------------------------------
6396 bbdb | %:name %:company
6397 irc | %:server %:port %:nick
6398 vm, wl, mh, mew, rmail | %:type %:subject %:message-id
6399 | %:from %:fromname %:fromaddress
6400 | %:to %:toname %:toaddress
6401 | %:date @r{(message date header field)}
6402 | %:date-timestamp @r{(date as active timestamp)}
6403 | %:date-timestamp-inactive @r{(date as inactive timestamp)}
6404 | %:fromto @r{(either "to NAME" or "from NAME")@footnote{This will always be the other, not the user. See the variable @code{org-from-is-user-regexp}.}}
6405 gnus | %:group, @r{for messages also all email fields}
6407 info | %:file %:node
6412 To place the cursor after template expansion use:
6415 %? @r{After completing the template, position cursor here.}
6419 @node Attachments, RSS Feeds, Capture, Capture - Refile - Archive
6420 @section Attachments
6423 @vindex org-attach-directory
6424 It is often useful to associate reference material with an outline node/task.
6425 Small chunks of plain text can simply be stored in the subtree of a project.
6426 Hyperlinks (@pxref{Hyperlinks}) can establish associations with
6427 files that live elsewhere on your computer or in the cloud, like emails or
6428 source code files belonging to a project. Another method is @i{attachments},
6429 which are files located in a directory belonging to an outline node. Org
6430 uses directories named by the unique ID of each entry. These directories are
6431 located in the @file{data} directory which lives in the same directory where
6432 your Org file lives@footnote{If you move entries or Org files from one
6433 directory to another, you may want to configure @code{org-attach-directory}
6434 to contain an absolute path.}. If you initialize this directory with
6435 @code{git init}, Org will automatically commit changes when it sees them.
6436 The attachment system has been contributed to Org by John Wiegley.
6438 In cases where it seems better to do so, you can also attach a directory of your
6439 choice to an entry. You can also make children inherit the attachment
6440 directory from a parent, so that an entire subtree uses the same attached
6443 @noindent The following commands deal with attachments:
6447 @orgcmd{C-c C-a,org-attach}
6448 The dispatcher for commands related to the attachment system. After these
6449 keys, a list of commands is displayed and you must press an additional key
6450 to select a command:
6453 @orgcmdtkc{a,C-c C-a a,org-attach-attach}
6454 @vindex org-attach-method
6455 Select a file and move it into the task's attachment directory. The file
6456 will be copied, moved, or linked, depending on @code{org-attach-method}.
6457 Note that hard links are not supported on all systems.
6463 Attach a file using the copy/move/link method.
6464 Note that hard links are not supported on all systems.
6466 @orgcmdtkc{n,C-c C-a n,org-attach-new}
6467 Create a new attachment as an Emacs buffer.
6469 @orgcmdtkc{z,C-c C-a z,org-attach-sync}
6470 Synchronize the current task with its attachment directory, in case you added
6471 attachments yourself.
6473 @orgcmdtkc{p,C-c C-a o,org-attach-open}
6474 @vindex org-file-apps
6475 Open current task's attachment. If there is more than one, prompt for a
6476 file name first. Opening will follow the rules set by @code{org-file-apps}.
6477 For more details, see the information on following hyperlinks
6478 (@pxref{Handling links}).
6480 @orgcmdtkc{O,C-c C-a O,org-attach-open-in-emacs}
6481 Also open the attachment, but force opening the file in Emacs.
6483 @orgcmdtkc{f,C-c C-a f,org-attach-reveal}
6484 Open the current task's attachment directory.
6486 @orgcmdtkc{F,C-c C-a F,org-attach-reveal-in-emacs}
6487 Also open the directory, but force using @command{dired} in Emacs.
6489 @orgcmdtkc{d,C-c C-a d,org-attach-delete-one}
6490 Select and delete a single attachment.
6492 @orgcmdtkc{D,C-c C-a D,org-attach-delete-all}
6493 Delete all of a task's attachments. A safer way is to open the directory in
6494 @command{dired} and delete from there.
6496 @orgcmdtkc{s,C-c C-a s,org-attach-set-directory}
6497 @cindex property, ATTACH_DIR
6498 Set a specific directory as the entry's attachment directory. This works by
6499 putting the directory path into the @code{ATTACH_DIR} property.
6501 @orgcmdtkc{i,C-c C-a i,org-attach-set-inherit}
6502 @cindex property, ATTACH_DIR_INHERIT
6503 Set the @code{ATTACH_DIR_INHERIT} property, so that children will use the
6504 same directory for attachments as the parent does.
6508 @node RSS Feeds, Protocols, Attachments, Capture - Refile - Archive
6513 Org can add and change entries based on information found in RSS feeds and
6514 Atom feeds. You could use this to make a task out of each new podcast in a
6515 podcast feed. Or you could use a phone-based note-creating service on the
6516 web to import tasks into Org. To access feeds, configure the variable
6517 @code{org-feed-alist}. The docstring of this variable has detailed
6518 information. Here is just an example:
6521 (setq org-feed-alist
6523 "http://rss.slashdot.org/Slashdot/slashdot"
6524 "~/txt/org/feeds.org" "Slashdot Entries")))
6528 will configure that new items from the feed provided by
6529 @code{rss.slashdot.org} will result in new entries in the file
6530 @file{~/org/feeds.org} under the heading @samp{Slashdot Entries}, whenever
6531 the following command is used:
6534 @orgcmd{C-c C-x g,org-feed-update-all}
6536 Collect items from the feeds configured in @code{org-feed-alist} and act upon
6538 @orgcmd{C-c C-x G,org-feed-goto-inbox}
6539 Prompt for a feed name and go to the inbox configured for this feed.
6542 Under the same headline, Org will create a drawer @samp{FEEDSTATUS} in which
6543 it will store information about the status of items in the feed, to avoid
6544 adding the same item several times. You should add @samp{FEEDSTATUS} to the
6545 list of drawers in that file:
6548 #+DRAWERS: LOGBOOK PROPERTIES FEEDSTATUS
6551 For more information, including how to read atom feeds, see
6552 @file{org-feed.el} and the docstring of @code{org-feed-alist}.
6554 @node Protocols, Refiling notes, RSS Feeds, Capture - Refile - Archive
6555 @section Protocols for external access
6556 @cindex protocols, for external access
6559 You can set up Org for handling protocol calls from outside applications that
6560 are passed to Emacs through the @file{emacsserver}. For example, you can
6561 configure bookmarks in your web browser to send a link to the current page to
6562 Org and create a note from it using capture (@pxref{Capture}). Or you
6563 could create a bookmark that will tell Emacs to open the local source file of
6564 a remote website you are looking at with the browser. See
6565 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/org-protocol.php} for detailed
6566 documentation and setup instructions.
6568 @node Refiling notes, Archiving, Protocols, Capture - Refile - Archive
6569 @section Refiling notes
6570 @cindex refiling notes
6572 When reviewing the captured data, you may want to refile some of the entries
6573 into a different list, for example into a project. Cutting, finding the
6574 right location, and then pasting the note is cumbersome. To simplify this
6575 process, you can use the following special command:
6578 @orgcmd{C-c C-w,org-refile}
6579 @vindex org-reverse-note-order
6580 @vindex org-refile-targets
6581 @vindex org-refile-use-outline-path
6582 @vindex org-outline-path-complete-in-steps
6583 @vindex org-refile-allow-creating-parent-nodes
6584 @vindex org-log-refile
6585 @vindex org-refile-use-cache
6586 Refile the entry or region at point. This command offers possible locations
6587 for refiling the entry and lets you select one with completion. The item (or
6588 all items in the region) is filed below the target heading as a subitem.
6589 Depending on @code{org-reverse-note-order}, it will be either the first or
6591 By default, all level 1 headlines in the current buffer are considered to be
6592 targets, but you can have more complex definitions across a number of files.
6593 See the variable @code{org-refile-targets} for details. If you would like to
6594 select a location via a file-path-like completion along the outline path, see
6595 the variables @code{org-refile-use-outline-path} and
6596 @code{org-outline-path-complete-in-steps}. If you would like to be able to
6597 create new nodes as new parents for refiling on the fly, check the
6598 variable @code{org-refile-allow-creating-parent-nodes}.
6599 When the variable @code{org-log-refile}@footnote{with corresponding
6600 @code{#+STARTUP} keywords @code{logrefile}, @code{lognoterefile},
6601 and @code{nologrefile}} is set, a time stamp or a note will be
6602 recorded when an entry has been refiled.
6603 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-w}
6604 Use the refile interface to jump to a heading.
6605 @orgcmd{C-u C-u C-c C-w,org-refile-goto-last-stored}
6606 Jump to the location where @code{org-refile} last moved a tree to.
6608 Refile as the child of the item currently being clocked.
6609 @item C-0 C-c C-w @ @r{or} @ C-u C-u C-u C-c C-w
6611 @orgcmdtkc{C-0 C-c C-w @ @r{or} @ C-u C-u C-u C-c C-w,C-0 C-c C-w,org-refile-cache-clear}
6613 Clear the target cache. Caching of refile targets can be turned on by
6614 setting @code{org-refile-use-cache}. To make the command seen new possible
6615 targets, you have to clear the cache with this command.
6618 @node Archiving, , Refiling notes, Capture - Refile - Archive
6622 When a project represented by a (sub)tree is finished, you may want
6623 to move the tree out of the way and to stop it from contributing to the
6624 agenda. Archiving is important to keep your working files compact and global
6625 searches like the construction of agenda views fast.
6628 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-a,org-archive-subtree-default}
6629 @vindex org-archive-default-command
6630 Archive the current entry using the command specified in the variable
6631 @code{org-archive-default-command}.
6635 * Moving subtrees:: Moving a tree to an archive file
6636 * Internal archiving:: Switch off a tree but keep it in the file
6639 @node Moving subtrees, Internal archiving, Archiving, Archiving
6640 @subsection Moving a tree to the archive file
6641 @cindex external archiving
6643 The most common archiving action is to move a project tree to another file,
6647 @orgcmdkskc{C-c C-x C-s,C-c $,org-archive-subtree}
6648 @vindex org-archive-location
6649 Archive the subtree starting at the cursor position to the location
6650 given by @code{org-archive-location}.
6651 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-x C-s}
6652 Check if any direct children of the current headline could be moved to
6653 the archive. To do this, each subtree is checked for open TODO entries.
6654 If none are found, the command offers to move it to the archive
6655 location. If the cursor is @emph{not} on a headline when this command
6656 is invoked, the level 1 trees will be checked.
6659 @cindex archive locations
6660 The default archive location is a file in the same directory as the
6661 current file, with the name derived by appending @file{_archive} to the
6662 current file name. For information and examples on how to change this,
6663 see the documentation string of the variable
6664 @code{org-archive-location}. There is also an in-buffer option for
6665 setting this variable, for example@footnote{For backward compatibility,
6666 the following also works: If there are several such lines in a file,
6667 each specifies the archive location for the text below it. The first
6668 such line also applies to any text before its definition. However,
6669 using this method is @emph{strongly} deprecated as it is incompatible
6670 with the outline structure of the document. The correct method for
6671 setting multiple archive locations in a buffer is using properties.}:
6675 #+ARCHIVE: %s_done::
6678 @cindex property, ARCHIVE
6680 If you would like to have a special ARCHIVE location for a single entry
6681 or a (sub)tree, give the entry an @code{:ARCHIVE:} property with the
6682 location as the value (@pxref{Properties and Columns}).
6684 @vindex org-archive-save-context-info
6685 When a subtree is moved, it receives a number of special properties that
6686 record context information like the file from where the entry came, its
6687 outline path the archiving time etc. Configure the variable
6688 @code{org-archive-save-context-info} to adjust the amount of information
6692 @node Internal archiving, , Moving subtrees, Archiving
6693 @subsection Internal archiving
6695 If you want to just switch off (for agenda views) certain subtrees without
6696 moving them to a different file, you can use the @code{ARCHIVE tag}.
6698 A headline that is marked with the ARCHIVE tag (@pxref{Tags}) stays at
6699 its location in the outline tree, but behaves in the following way:
6702 @vindex org-cycle-open-archived-trees
6703 It does not open when you attempt to do so with a visibility cycling
6704 command (@pxref{Visibility cycling}). You can force cycling archived
6705 subtrees with @kbd{C-@key{TAB}}, or by setting the option
6706 @code{org-cycle-open-archived-trees}. Also normal outline commands like
6707 @code{show-all} will open archived subtrees.
6709 @vindex org-sparse-tree-open-archived-trees
6710 During sparse tree construction (@pxref{Sparse trees}), matches in
6711 archived subtrees are not exposed, unless you configure the option
6712 @code{org-sparse-tree-open-archived-trees}.
6714 @vindex org-agenda-skip-archived-trees
6715 During agenda view construction (@pxref{Agenda Views}), the content of
6716 archived trees is ignored unless you configure the option
6717 @code{org-agenda-skip-archived-trees}, in which case these trees will always
6718 be included. In the agenda you can press @kbd{v a} to get archives
6719 temporarily included.
6721 @vindex org-export-with-archived-trees
6722 Archived trees are not exported (@pxref{Exporting}), only the headline
6723 is. Configure the details using the variable
6724 @code{org-export-with-archived-trees}.
6726 @vindex org-columns-skip-archived-trees
6727 Archived trees are excluded from column view unless the variable
6728 @code{org-columns-skip-archived-trees} is configured to @code{nil}.
6731 The following commands help manage the ARCHIVE tag:
6734 @orgcmd{C-c C-x a,org-toggle-archive-tag}
6735 Toggle the ARCHIVE tag for the current headline. When the tag is set,
6736 the headline changes to a shadowed face, and the subtree below it is
6738 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-x a}
6739 Check if any direct children of the current headline should be archived.
6740 To do this, each subtree is checked for open TODO entries. If none are
6741 found, the command offers to set the ARCHIVE tag for the child. If the
6742 cursor is @emph{not} on a headline when this command is invoked, the
6743 level 1 trees will be checked.
6744 @orgcmd{C-@kbd{TAB},org-force-cycle-archived}
6745 Cycle a tree even if it is tagged with ARCHIVE.
6746 @orgcmd{C-c C-x A,org-archive-to-archive-sibling}
6747 Move the current entry to the @emph{Archive Sibling}. This is a sibling of
6748 the entry with the heading @samp{Archive} and the tag @samp{ARCHIVE}. The
6749 entry becomes a child of that sibling and in this way retains a lot of its
6750 original context, including inherited tags and approximate position in the
6755 @node Agenda Views, Markup, Capture - Refile - Archive, Top
6756 @chapter Agenda views
6757 @cindex agenda views
6759 Due to the way Org works, TODO items, time-stamped items, and
6760 tagged headlines can be scattered throughout a file or even a number of
6761 files. To get an overview of open action items, or of events that are
6762 important for a particular date, this information must be collected,
6763 sorted and displayed in an organized way.
6765 Org can select items based on various criteria and display them
6766 in a separate buffer. Seven different view types are provided:
6770 an @emph{agenda} that is like a calendar and shows information
6773 a @emph{TODO list} that covers all unfinished
6776 a @emph{match view}, showings headlines based on the tags, properties, and
6777 TODO state associated with them,
6779 a @emph{timeline view} that shows all events in a single Org file,
6780 in time-sorted view,
6782 a @emph{text search view} that shows all entries from multiple files
6783 that contain specified keywords,
6785 a @emph{stuck projects view} showing projects that currently don't move
6788 @emph{custom views} that are special searches and combinations of different
6793 The extracted information is displayed in a special @emph{agenda
6794 buffer}. This buffer is read-only, but provides commands to visit the
6795 corresponding locations in the original Org files, and even to
6796 edit these files remotely.
6798 @vindex org-agenda-window-setup
6799 @vindex org-agenda-restore-windows-after-quit
6800 Two variables control how the agenda buffer is displayed and whether the
6801 window configuration is restored when the agenda exits:
6802 @code{org-agenda-window-setup} and
6803 @code{org-agenda-restore-windows-after-quit}.
6806 * Agenda files:: Files being searched for agenda information
6807 * Agenda dispatcher:: Keyboard access to agenda views
6808 * Built-in agenda views:: What is available out of the box?
6809 * Presentation and sorting:: How agenda items are prepared for display
6810 * Agenda commands:: Remote editing of Org trees
6811 * Custom agenda views:: Defining special searches and views
6812 * Exporting Agenda Views:: Writing a view to a file
6813 * Agenda column view:: Using column view for collected entries
6816 @node Agenda files, Agenda dispatcher, Agenda Views, Agenda Views
6817 @section Agenda files
6818 @cindex agenda files
6819 @cindex files for agenda
6821 @vindex org-agenda-files
6822 The information to be shown is normally collected from all @emph{agenda
6823 files}, the files listed in the variable
6824 @code{org-agenda-files}@footnote{If the value of that variable is not a
6825 list, but a single file name, then the list of agenda files will be
6826 maintained in that external file.}. If a directory is part of this list,
6827 all files with the extension @file{.org} in this directory will be part
6830 Thus, even if you only work with a single Org file, that file should
6831 be put into the list@footnote{When using the dispatcher, pressing
6832 @kbd{<} before selecting a command will actually limit the command to
6833 the current file, and ignore @code{org-agenda-files} until the next
6834 dispatcher command.}. You can customize @code{org-agenda-files}, but
6835 the easiest way to maintain it is through the following commands
6837 @cindex files, adding to agenda list
6839 @orgcmd{C-c [,org-agenda-to-front}
6840 Add current file to the list of agenda files. The file is added to
6841 the front of the list. If it was already in the list, it is moved to
6842 the front. With a prefix argument, file is added/moved to the end.
6843 @orgcmd{C-c ],org-remove-file}
6844 Remove current file from the list of agenda files.
6846 @orgcmd{C-',org-cycle-agenda-files}
6848 Cycle through agenda file list, visiting one file after the other.
6849 @kindex M-x org-iswitchb
6850 @item M-x org-iswitchb
6851 Command to use an @code{iswitchb}-like interface to switch to and between Org
6856 The Org menu contains the current list of files and can be used
6857 to visit any of them.
6859 If you would like to focus the agenda temporarily on a file not in
6860 this list, or on just one file in the list, or even on only a subtree in a
6861 file, then this can be done in different ways. For a single agenda command,
6862 you may press @kbd{<} once or several times in the dispatcher
6863 (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}). To restrict the agenda scope for an
6864 extended period, use the following commands:
6867 @orgcmd{C-c C-x <,org-agenda-set-restriction-lock}
6868 Permanently restrict the agenda to the current subtree. When with a
6869 prefix argument, or with the cursor before the first headline in a file,
6870 the agenda scope is set to the entire file. This restriction remains in
6871 effect until removed with @kbd{C-c C-x >}, or by typing either @kbd{<}
6872 or @kbd{>} in the agenda dispatcher. If there is a window displaying an
6873 agenda view, the new restriction takes effect immediately.
6874 @orgcmd{C-c C-x >,org-agenda-remove-restriction-lock}
6875 Remove the permanent restriction created by @kbd{C-c C-x <}.
6879 When working with @file{speedbar.el}, you can use the following commands in
6882 @orgcmdtkc{< @r{in the speedbar frame},<,org-speedbar-set-agenda-restriction}
6883 Permanently restrict the agenda to the item---either an Org file or a subtree
6884 in such a file---at the cursor in the Speedbar frame.
6885 If there is a window displaying an agenda view, the new restriction takes
6887 @orgcmdtkc{> @r{in the speedbar frame},>,org-agenda-remove-restriction-lock}
6888 Lift the restriction.
6891 @node Agenda dispatcher, Built-in agenda views, Agenda files, Agenda Views
6892 @section The agenda dispatcher
6893 @cindex agenda dispatcher
6894 @cindex dispatching agenda commands
6895 The views are created through a dispatcher, which should be bound to a
6896 global key---for example @kbd{C-c a} (@pxref{Installation}). In the
6897 following we will assume that @kbd{C-c a} is indeed how the dispatcher
6898 is accessed and list keyboard access to commands accordingly. After
6899 pressing @kbd{C-c a}, an additional letter is required to execute a
6900 command. The dispatcher offers the following default commands:
6903 Create the calendar-like agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}).
6905 Create a list of all TODO items (@pxref{Global TODO list}).
6907 Create a list of headlines matching a TAGS expression (@pxref{Matching
6908 tags and properties}).
6910 Create the timeline view for the current buffer (@pxref{Timeline}).
6912 Create a list of entries selected by a boolean expression of keywords
6913 and/or regular expressions that must or must not occur in the entry.
6915 @vindex org-agenda-text-search-extra-files
6916 Search for a regular expression in all agenda files and additionally in
6917 the files listed in @code{org-agenda-text-search-extra-files}. This
6918 uses the Emacs command @code{multi-occur}. A prefix argument can be
6919 used to specify the number of context lines for each match, default is
6922 Create a list of stuck projects (@pxref{Stuck projects}).
6924 Restrict an agenda command to the current buffer@footnote{For backward
6925 compatibility, you can also press @kbd{1} to restrict to the current
6926 buffer.}. After pressing @kbd{<}, you still need to press the character
6927 selecting the command.
6929 If there is an active region, restrict the following agenda command to
6930 the region. Otherwise, restrict it to the current subtree@footnote{For
6931 backward compatibility, you can also press @kbd{0} to restrict to the
6932 current region/subtree.}. After pressing @kbd{< <}, you still need to press the
6933 character selecting the command.
6936 You can also define custom commands that will be accessible through the
6937 dispatcher, just like the default commands. This includes the
6938 possibility to create extended agenda buffers that contain several
6939 blocks together, for example the weekly agenda, the global TODO list and
6940 a number of special tags matches. @xref{Custom agenda views}.
6942 @node Built-in agenda views, Presentation and sorting, Agenda dispatcher, Agenda Views
6943 @section The built-in agenda views
6945 In this section we describe the built-in views.
6948 * Weekly/daily agenda:: The calendar page with current tasks
6949 * Global TODO list:: All unfinished action items
6950 * Matching tags and properties:: Structured information with fine-tuned search
6951 * Timeline:: Time-sorted view for single file
6952 * Search view:: Find entries by searching for text
6953 * Stuck projects:: Find projects you need to review
6956 @node Weekly/daily agenda, Global TODO list, Built-in agenda views, Built-in agenda views
6957 @subsection The weekly/daily agenda
6959 @cindex weekly agenda
6960 @cindex daily agenda
6962 The purpose of the weekly/daily @emph{agenda} is to act like a page of a
6963 paper agenda, showing all the tasks for the current week or day.
6966 @cindex org-agenda, command
6967 @orgcmd{C-c a a,org-agenda-list}
6968 @vindex org-agenda-ndays
6969 Compile an agenda for the current week from a list of Org files. The agenda
6970 shows the entries for each day. With a numeric prefix@footnote{For backward
6971 compatibility, the universal prefix @kbd{C-u} causes all TODO entries to be
6972 listed before the agenda. This feature is deprecated, use the dedicated TODO
6973 list, or a block agenda instead (@pxref{Block agenda}).} (like @kbd{C-u 2 1
6974 C-c a a}) you may set the number of days to be displayed (see also the
6975 variable @code{org-agenda-ndays})
6978 Remote editing from the agenda buffer means, for example, that you can
6979 change the dates of deadlines and appointments from the agenda buffer.
6980 The commands available in the Agenda buffer are listed in @ref{Agenda
6983 @subsubheading Calendar/Diary integration
6984 @cindex calendar integration
6985 @cindex diary integration
6987 Emacs contains the calendar and diary by Edward M. Reingold. The
6988 calendar displays a three-month calendar with holidays from different
6989 countries and cultures. The diary allows you to keep track of
6990 anniversaries, lunar phases, sunrise/set, recurrent appointments
6991 (weekly, monthly) and more. In this way, it is quite complementary to
6992 Org. It can be very useful to combine output from Org with
6995 In order to include entries from the Emacs diary into Org-mode's
6996 agenda, you only need to customize the variable
6999 (setq org-agenda-include-diary t)
7002 @noindent After that, everything will happen automatically. All diary
7003 entries including holidays, anniversaries, etc., will be included in the
7004 agenda buffer created by Org-mode. @key{SPC}, @key{TAB}, and
7005 @key{RET} can be used from the agenda buffer to jump to the diary
7006 file in order to edit existing diary entries. The @kbd{i} command to
7007 insert new entries for the current date works in the agenda buffer, as
7008 well as the commands @kbd{S}, @kbd{M}, and @kbd{C} to display
7009 Sunrise/Sunset times, show lunar phases and to convert to other
7010 calendars, respectively. @kbd{c} can be used to switch back and forth
7011 between calendar and agenda.
7013 If you are using the diary only for sexp entries and holidays, it is
7014 faster to not use the above setting, but instead to copy or even move
7015 the entries into an Org file. Org-mode evaluates diary-style sexp
7016 entries, and does it faster because there is no overhead for first
7017 creating the diary display. Note that the sexp entries must start at
7018 the left margin, no whitespace is allowed before them. For example,
7019 the following segment of an Org file will be processed and entries
7020 will be made in the agenda:
7023 * Birthdays and similar stuff
7025 %%(org-calendar-holiday) ; special function for holiday names
7027 %%(diary-anniversary 5 14 1956)@footnote{Note that the order of the arguments (month, day, year) depends on the setting of @code{calendar-date-style}.} Arthur Dent is %d years old
7028 %%(diary-anniversary 10 2 1869) Mahatma Gandhi would be %d years old
7031 @subsubheading Anniversaries from BBDB
7032 @cindex BBDB, anniversaries
7033 @cindex anniversaries, from BBDB
7035 If you are using the Big Brothers Database to store your contacts, you will
7036 very likely prefer to store anniversaries in BBDB rather than in a
7037 separate Org or diary file. Org supports this and will show BBDB
7038 anniversaries as part of the agenda. All you need to do is to add the
7039 following to one your your agenda files:
7046 %%(org-bbdb-anniversaries)
7049 You can then go ahead and define anniversaries for a BBDB record. Basically,
7050 you need to press @kbd{C-o anniversary @key{RET}} with the cursor in a BBDB
7051 record and then add the date in the format @code{YYYY-MM-DD}, followed by a
7052 space and the class of the anniversary (@samp{birthday} or @samp{wedding}, or
7053 a format string). If you omit the class, it will default to @samp{birthday}.
7054 Here are a few examples, the header for the file @file{org-bbdb.el} contains
7055 more detailed information.
7060 2008-04-14 %s released version 6.01 of org-mode, %d years ago
7063 After a change to BBDB, or for the first agenda display during an Emacs
7064 session, the agenda display will suffer a short delay as Org updates its
7065 hash with anniversaries. However, from then on things will be very fast---much
7066 faster in fact than a long list of @samp{%%(diary-anniversary)} entries
7067 in an Org or Diary file.
7069 @subsubheading Appointment reminders
7070 @cindex @file{appt.el}
7071 @cindex appointment reminders
7073 Org can interact with Emacs appointments notification facility. To add all
7074 the appointments of your agenda files, use the command
7075 @code{org-agenda-to-appt}. This command also lets you filter through the
7076 list of your appointments and add only those belonging to a specific category
7077 or matching a regular expression. See the docstring for details.
7079 @node Global TODO list, Matching tags and properties, Weekly/daily agenda, Built-in agenda views
7080 @subsection The global TODO list
7081 @cindex global TODO list
7082 @cindex TODO list, global
7084 The global TODO list contains all unfinished TODO items formatted and
7085 collected into a single place.
7088 @orgcmd{C-c a t,org-todo-list}
7089 Show the global TODO list. This collects the TODO items from all agenda
7090 files (@pxref{Agenda Views}) into a single buffer. By default, this lists
7091 items with a state the is not a DONE state. The buffer is in
7092 @code{agenda-mode}, so there are commands to examine and manipulate the TODO
7093 entries directly from that buffer (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
7094 @orgcmd{C-c a T,org-todo-list}
7095 @cindex TODO keyword matching
7096 @vindex org-todo-keywords
7097 Like the above, but allows selection of a specific TODO keyword. You can
7098 also do this by specifying a prefix argument to @kbd{C-c a t}. You are
7099 prompted for a keyword, and you may also specify several keywords by
7100 separating them with @samp{|} as the boolean OR operator. With a numeric
7101 prefix, the nth keyword in @code{org-todo-keywords} is selected.
7103 The @kbd{r} key in the agenda buffer regenerates it, and you can give
7104 a prefix argument to this command to change the selected TODO keyword,
7105 for example @kbd{3 r}. If you often need a search for a specific
7106 keyword, define a custom command for it (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}).@*
7107 Matching specific TODO keywords can also be done as part of a tags
7108 search (@pxref{Tag searches}).
7111 Remote editing of TODO items means that you can change the state of a
7112 TODO entry with a single key press. The commands available in the
7113 TODO list are described in @ref{Agenda commands}.
7115 @cindex sublevels, inclusion into TODO list
7116 Normally the global TODO list simply shows all headlines with TODO
7117 keywords. This list can become very long. There are two ways to keep
7121 @vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-scheduled
7122 @vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-deadlines
7123 @vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-with-date
7124 Some people view a TODO item that has been @emph{scheduled} for execution or
7125 have a @emph{deadline} (@pxref{Timestamps}) as no longer @emph{open}.
7126 Configure the variables @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-scheduled},
7127 @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-deadlines}, and/or
7128 @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-with-date} to exclude such items from the
7131 @vindex org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels
7132 TODO items may have sublevels to break up the task into subtasks. In
7133 such cases it may be enough to list only the highest level TODO headline
7134 and omit the sublevels from the global list. Configure the variable
7135 @code{org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels} to get this behavior.
7138 @node Matching tags and properties, Timeline, Global TODO list, Built-in agenda views
7139 @subsection Matching tags and properties
7140 @cindex matching, of tags
7141 @cindex matching, of properties
7145 If headlines in the agenda files are marked with @emph{tags} (@pxref{Tags}),
7146 or have properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}), you can select headlines
7147 based on this metadata and collect them into an agenda buffer. The match
7148 syntax described here also applies when creating sparse trees with @kbd{C-c /
7152 @orgcmd{C-c a m,org-tags-view}
7153 Produce a list of all headlines that match a given set of tags. The
7154 command prompts for a selection criterion, which is a boolean logic
7155 expression with tags, like @samp{+work+urgent-withboss} or
7156 @samp{work|home} (@pxref{Tags}). If you often need a specific search,
7157 define a custom command for it (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}).
7158 @orgcmd{C-c a M,org-tags-view}
7159 @vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
7160 @vindex org-agenda-tags-todo-honor-ignore-options
7161 Like @kbd{C-c a m}, but only select headlines that are also TODO items in a
7162 not-DONE state and force checking subitems (see variable
7163 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels}). To exclude scheduled/deadline items,
7164 see the variable @code{org-agenda-tags-todo-honor-ignore-options}. Matching
7165 specific TODO keywords together with a tags match is also possible, see
7169 The commands available in the tags list are described in @ref{Agenda
7172 @subsubheading Match syntax
7174 @cindex Boolean logic, for tag/property searches
7175 A search string can use Boolean operators @samp{&} for AND and @samp{|} for
7176 OR. @samp{&} binds more strongly than @samp{|}. Parentheses are currently
7177 not implemented. Each element in the search is either a tag, a regular
7178 expression matching tags, or an expression like @code{PROPERTY OPERATOR
7179 VALUE} with a comparison operator, accessing a property value. Each element
7180 may be preceded by @samp{-}, to select against it, and @samp{+} is syntactic
7181 sugar for positive selection. The AND operator @samp{&} is optional when
7182 @samp{+} or @samp{-} is present. Here are some examples, using only tags.
7186 Select headlines tagged @samp{:work:}, but discard those also tagged
7189 Selects lines tagged @samp{:work:} or @samp{:laptop:}.
7190 @item work|laptop+night
7191 Like before, but require the @samp{:laptop:} lines to be tagged also
7195 @cindex regular expressions, with tags search
7196 Instead of a tag, you may also specify a regular expression enclosed in curly
7197 braces. For example,
7198 @samp{work+@{^boss.*@}} matches headlines that contain the tag
7199 @samp{:work:} and any tag @i{starting} with @samp{boss}.
7201 @cindex TODO keyword matching, with tags search
7202 @cindex level, require for tags/property match
7203 @cindex category, require for tags/property match
7204 @vindex org-odd-levels-only
7205 You may also test for properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}) at the same
7206 time as matching tags. The properties may be real properties, or special
7207 properties that represent other metadata (@pxref{Special properties}). For
7208 example, the ``property'' @code{TODO} represents the TODO keyword of the
7209 entry. Or, the ``property'' @code{LEVEL} represents the level of an entry.
7210 So a search @samp{+LEVEL=3+boss-TODO="DONE"} lists all level three headlines
7211 that have the tag @samp{boss} and are @emph{not} marked with the TODO keyword
7212 DONE. In buffers with @code{org-odd-levels-only} set, @samp{LEVEL} does not
7213 count the number of stars, but @samp{LEVEL=2} will correspond to 3 stars etc.
7215 Here are more examples:
7217 @item work+TODO="WAITING"
7218 Select @samp{:work:}-tagged TODO lines with the specific TODO
7219 keyword @samp{WAITING}.
7220 @item work+TODO="WAITING"|home+TODO="WAITING"
7221 Waiting tasks both at work and at home.
7224 When matching properties, a number of different operators can be used to test
7225 the value of a property. Here is a complex example:
7228 +work-boss+PRIORITY="A"+Coffee="unlimited"+Effort<2 \
7229 +With=@{Sarah\|Denny@}+SCHEDULED>="<2008-10-11>"
7233 The type of comparison will depend on how the comparison value is written:
7236 If the comparison value is a plain number, a numerical comparison is done,
7237 and the allowed operators are @samp{<}, @samp{=}, @samp{>}, @samp{<=},
7238 @samp{>=}, and @samp{<>}.
7240 If the comparison value is enclosed in double-quotes,
7241 a string comparison is done, and the same operators are allowed.
7243 If the comparison value is enclosed in double-quotes @emph{and} angular
7244 brackets (like @samp{DEADLINE<="<2008-12-24 18:30>"}), both values are
7245 assumed to be date/time specifications in the standard Org way, and the
7246 comparison will be done accordingly. Special values that will be recognized
7247 are @code{"<now>"} for now (including time), and @code{"<today>"}, and
7248 @code{"<tomorrow>"} for these days at 0:00 hours, i.e. without a time
7249 specification. Also strings like @code{"<+5d>"} or @code{"<-2m>"} with units
7250 @code{d}, @code{w}, @code{m}, and @code{y} for day, week, month, and year,
7251 respectively, can be used.
7253 If the comparison value is enclosed
7254 in curly braces, a regexp match is performed, with @samp{=} meaning that the
7255 regexp matches the property value, and @samp{<>} meaning that it does not
7259 So the search string in the example finds entries tagged @samp{:work:} but
7260 not @samp{:boss:}, which also have a priority value @samp{A}, a
7261 @samp{:Coffee:} property with the value @samp{unlimited}, an @samp{Effort}
7262 property that is numerically smaller than 2, a @samp{:With:} property that is
7263 matched by the regular expression @samp{Sarah\|Denny}, and that are scheduled
7264 on or after October 11, 2008.
7266 Accessing TODO, LEVEL, and CATEGORY during a search is fast. Accessing any
7267 other properties will slow down the search. However, once you have paid the
7268 price by accessing one property, testing additional properties is cheap
7271 You can configure Org-mode to use property inheritance during a search, but
7272 beware that this can slow down searches considerably. See @ref{Property
7273 inheritance}, for details.
7275 For backward compatibility, and also for typing speed, there is also a
7276 different way to test TODO states in a search. For this, terminate the
7277 tags/property part of the search string (which may include several terms
7278 connected with @samp{|}) with a @samp{/} and then specify a Boolean
7279 expression just for TODO keywords. The syntax is then similar to that for
7280 tags, but should be applied with care: for example, a positive selection on
7281 several TODO keywords cannot meaningfully be combined with boolean AND.
7282 However, @emph{negative selection} combined with AND can be meaningful. To
7283 make sure that only lines are checked that actually have any TODO keyword
7284 (resulting in a speed-up), use @kbd{C-c a M}, or equivalently start the TODO
7285 part after the slash with @samp{!}. Using @kbd{C-c a M} or @samp{/!} will
7286 not match TODO keywords in a DONE state. Examples:
7290 Same as @samp{work+TODO="WAITING"}
7291 @item work/!-WAITING-NEXT
7292 Select @samp{:work:}-tagged TODO lines that are neither @samp{WAITING}
7294 @item work/!+WAITING|+NEXT
7295 Select @samp{:work:}-tagged TODO lines that are either @samp{WAITING} or
7299 @node Timeline, Search view, Matching tags and properties, Built-in agenda views
7300 @subsection Timeline for a single file
7301 @cindex timeline, single file
7302 @cindex time-sorted view
7304 The timeline summarizes all time-stamped items from a single Org-mode
7305 file in a @emph{time-sorted view}. The main purpose of this command is
7306 to give an overview over events in a project.
7309 @orgcmd{C-c a L,org-timeline}
7310 Show a time-sorted view of the Org file, with all time-stamped items.
7311 When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, all unfinished TODO entries
7312 (scheduled or not) are also listed under the current date.
7316 The commands available in the timeline buffer are listed in
7317 @ref{Agenda commands}.
7319 @node Search view, Stuck projects, Timeline, Built-in agenda views
7320 @subsection Search view
7323 @cindex searching, for text
7325 This agenda view is a general text search facility for Org-mode entries.
7326 It is particularly useful to find notes.
7329 @orgcmd{C-c a s,org-search-view}
7330 This is a special search that lets you select entries by matching a substring
7331 or specific words using a boolean logic.
7333 For example, the search string @samp{computer equipment} will find entries
7334 that contain @samp{computer equipment} as a substring. If the two words are
7335 separated by more space or a line break, the search will still match.
7336 Search view can also search for specific keywords in the entry, using Boolean
7337 logic. The search string @samp{+computer +wifi -ethernet -@{8\.11[bg]@}}
7338 will search for note entries that contain the keywords @code{computer}
7339 and @code{wifi}, but not the keyword @code{ethernet}, and which are also
7340 not matched by the regular expression @code{8\.11[bg]}, meaning to
7341 exclude both 8.11b and 8.11g. The first @samp{+} is necessary to turn on
7342 word search, other @samp{+} characters are optional. For more details, see
7343 the docstring of the command @code{org-search-view}.
7345 @vindex org-agenda-text-search-extra-files
7346 Note that in addition to the agenda files, this command will also search
7347 the files listed in @code{org-agenda-text-search-extra-files}.
7349 @node Stuck projects, , Search view, Built-in agenda views
7350 @subsection Stuck projects
7352 If you are following a system like David Allen's GTD to organize your
7353 work, one of the ``duties'' you have is a regular review to make sure
7354 that all projects move along. A @emph{stuck} project is a project that
7355 has no defined next actions, so it will never show up in the TODO lists
7356 Org-mode produces. During the review, you need to identify such
7357 projects and define next actions for them.
7360 @orgcmd{C-c a #,org-agenda-list-stuck-projects}
7361 List projects that are stuck.
7364 @vindex org-stuck-projects
7365 Customize the variable @code{org-stuck-projects} to define what a stuck
7366 project is and how to find it.
7369 You almost certainly will have to configure this view before it will
7370 work for you. The built-in default assumes that all your projects are
7371 level-2 headlines, and that a project is not stuck if it has at least
7372 one entry marked with a TODO keyword TODO or NEXT or NEXTACTION.
7374 Let's assume that you, in your own way of using Org-mode, identify
7375 projects with a tag PROJECT, and that you use a TODO keyword MAYBE to
7376 indicate a project that should not be considered yet. Let's further
7377 assume that the TODO keyword DONE marks finished projects, and that NEXT
7378 and TODO indicate next actions. The tag @@SHOP indicates shopping and
7379 is a next action even without the NEXT tag. Finally, if the project
7380 contains the special word IGNORE anywhere, it should not be listed
7381 either. In this case you would start by identifying eligible projects
7382 with a tags/todo match@footnote{@xref{Tag searches}.}
7383 @samp{+PROJECT/-MAYBE-DONE}, and then check for TODO, NEXT, @@SHOP, and
7384 IGNORE in the subtree to identify projects that are not stuck. The
7385 correct customization for this is
7388 (setq org-stuck-projects
7389 '("+PROJECT/-MAYBE-DONE" ("NEXT" "TODO") ("@@SHOP")
7393 Note that if a project is identified as non-stuck, the subtree of this entry
7394 will still be searched for stuck projects.
7396 @node Presentation and sorting, Agenda commands, Built-in agenda views, Agenda Views
7397 @section Presentation and sorting
7398 @cindex presentation, of agenda items
7400 @vindex org-agenda-prefix-format
7401 Before displaying items in an agenda view, Org-mode visually prepares
7402 the items and sorts them. Each item occupies a single line. The line
7403 starts with a @emph{prefix} that contains the @emph{category}
7404 (@pxref{Categories}) of the item and other important information. You can
7405 customize the prefix using the option @code{org-agenda-prefix-format}.
7406 The prefix is followed by a cleaned-up version of the outline headline
7407 associated with the item.
7410 * Categories:: Not all tasks are equal
7411 * Time-of-day specifications:: How the agenda knows the time
7412 * Sorting of agenda items:: The order of things
7415 @node Categories, Time-of-day specifications, Presentation and sorting, Presentation and sorting
7416 @subsection Categories
7420 The category is a broad label assigned to each agenda item. By default,
7421 the category is simply derived from the file name, but you can also
7422 specify it with a special line in the buffer, like this@footnote{For
7423 backward compatibility, the following also works: if there are several
7424 such lines in a file, each specifies the category for the text below it.
7425 The first category also applies to any text before the first CATEGORY
7426 line. However, using this method is @emph{strongly} deprecated as it is
7427 incompatible with the outline structure of the document. The correct
7428 method for setting multiple categories in a buffer is using a
7436 @cindex property, CATEGORY
7437 If you would like to have a special CATEGORY for a single entry or a
7438 (sub)tree, give the entry a @code{:CATEGORY:} property with the
7439 special category you want to apply as the value.
7442 The display in the agenda buffer looks best if the category is not
7443 longer than 10 characters.
7446 You can set up icons for category by customizing the
7447 @code{org-agenda-category-icon-alist} variable.
7449 @node Time-of-day specifications, Sorting of agenda items, Categories, Presentation and sorting
7450 @subsection Time-of-day specifications
7451 @cindex time-of-day specification
7453 Org-mode checks each agenda item for a time-of-day specification. The
7454 time can be part of the timestamp that triggered inclusion into the
7455 agenda, for example as in @w{@samp{<2005-05-10 Tue 19:00>}}. Time
7456 ranges can be specified with two timestamps, like
7458 @w{@samp{<2005-05-10 Tue 20:30>--<2005-05-10 Tue 22:15>}}.
7460 In the headline of the entry itself, a time(range) may also appear as
7461 plain text (like @samp{12:45} or a @samp{8:30-1pm}). If the agenda
7462 integrates the Emacs diary (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}), time
7463 specifications in diary entries are recognized as well.
7465 For agenda display, Org-mode extracts the time and displays it in a
7466 standard 24 hour format as part of the prefix. The example times in
7467 the previous paragraphs would end up in the agenda like this:
7470 8:30-13:00 Arthur Dent lies in front of the bulldozer
7471 12:45...... Ford Prefect arrives and takes Arthur to the pub
7472 19:00...... The Vogon reads his poem
7473 20:30-22:15 Marvin escorts the Hitchhikers to the bridge
7477 If the agenda is in single-day mode, or for the display of today, the
7478 timed entries are embedded in a time grid, like
7481 8:00...... ------------------
7482 8:30-13:00 Arthur Dent lies in front of the bulldozer
7483 10:00...... ------------------
7484 12:00...... ------------------
7485 12:45...... Ford Prefect arrives and takes Arthur to the pub
7486 14:00...... ------------------
7487 16:00...... ------------------
7488 18:00...... ------------------
7489 19:00...... The Vogon reads his poem
7490 20:00...... ------------------
7491 20:30-22:15 Marvin escorts the Hitchhikers to the bridge
7494 @vindex org-agenda-use-time-grid
7495 @vindex org-agenda-time-grid
7496 The time grid can be turned on and off with the variable
7497 @code{org-agenda-use-time-grid}, and can be configured with
7498 @code{org-agenda-time-grid}.
7500 @node Sorting of agenda items, , Time-of-day specifications, Presentation and sorting
7501 @subsection Sorting of agenda items
7502 @cindex sorting, of agenda items
7503 @cindex priorities, of agenda items
7504 Before being inserted into a view, the items are sorted. How this is
7505 done depends on the type of view.
7508 @vindex org-agenda-files
7509 For the daily/weekly agenda, the items for each day are sorted. The
7510 default order is to first collect all items containing an explicit
7511 time-of-day specification. These entries will be shown at the beginning
7512 of the list, as a @emph{schedule} for the day. After that, items remain
7513 grouped in categories, in the sequence given by @code{org-agenda-files}.
7514 Within each category, items are sorted by priority (@pxref{Priorities}),
7515 which is composed of the base priority (2000 for priority @samp{A}, 1000
7516 for @samp{B}, and 0 for @samp{C}), plus additional increments for
7517 overdue scheduled or deadline items.
7519 For the TODO list, items remain in the order of categories, but within
7520 each category, sorting takes place according to priority
7521 (@pxref{Priorities}). The priority used for sorting derives from the
7522 priority cookie, with additions depending on how close an item is to its due
7525 For tags matches, items are not sorted at all, but just appear in the
7526 sequence in which they are found in the agenda files.
7529 @vindex org-agenda-sorting-strategy
7530 Sorting can be customized using the variable
7531 @code{org-agenda-sorting-strategy}, and may also include criteria based on
7532 the estimated effort of an entry (@pxref{Effort estimates}).
7534 @node Agenda commands, Custom agenda views, Presentation and sorting, Agenda Views
7535 @section Commands in the agenda buffer
7536 @cindex commands, in agenda buffer
7538 Entries in the agenda buffer are linked back to the Org file or diary
7539 file where they originate. You are not allowed to edit the agenda
7540 buffer itself, but commands are provided to show and jump to the
7541 original entry location, and to edit the Org files ``remotely'' from
7542 the agenda buffer. In this way, all information is stored only once,
7543 removing the risk that your agenda and note files may diverge.
7545 Some commands can be executed with mouse clicks on agenda lines. For
7546 the other commands, the cursor needs to be in the desired line.
7549 @tsubheading{Motion}
7550 @cindex motion commands in agenda
7551 @orgcmd{n,org-agenda-next-line}
7552 Next line (same as @key{up} and @kbd{C-p}).
7553 @orgcmd{p,org-agenda-previous-line}
7554 Previous line (same as @key{down} and @kbd{C-n}).
7555 @tsubheading{View/Go to Org file}
7556 @orgcmdkkc{@key{SPC},mouse-3,org-agenda-show-and-scroll-up}
7557 Display the original location of the item in another window.
7558 With prefix arg, make sure that the entire entry is made visible in the
7559 outline, not only the heading.
7561 @orgcmd{L,org-agenda-recenter}
7562 Display original location and recenter that window.
7564 @orgcmdkkc{@key{TAB},mouse-2,org-agenda-goto}
7565 Go to the original location of the item in another window.
7567 @orgcmd{@key{RET},org-agenda-switch-to}
7568 Go to the original location of the item and delete other windows.
7570 @orgcmd{F,org-agenda-follow-mode}
7571 @vindex org-agenda-start-with-follow-mode
7572 Toggle Follow mode. In Follow mode, as you move the cursor through
7573 the agenda buffer, the other window always shows the corresponding
7574 location in the Org file. The initial setting for this mode in new
7575 agenda buffers can be set with the variable
7576 @code{org-agenda-start-with-follow-mode}.
7578 @orgcmd{C-c C-x b,org-agenda-tree-to-indirect-buffer}
7579 Display the entire subtree of the current item in an indirect buffer. With a
7580 numeric prefix argument N, go up to level N and then take that tree. If N is
7581 negative, go up that many levels. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix, do not remove the
7582 previously used indirect buffer.
7584 @orgcmd{C-c C-o,org-agenda-open-link}
7585 Follow a link in the entry. This will offer a selection of any links in the
7586 text belonging to the referenced Org node. If there is only one link, it
7587 will be followed without a selection prompt.
7589 @tsubheading{Change display}
7590 @cindex display changing, in agenda
7593 Delete other windows.
7601 @c @item v d @ @r{or short} @ d
7602 @c @itemx v w @ @r{or short} @ w
7605 @orgcmdkskc{v d,d,org-aganda-day-view}
7606 @xorgcmdkskc{v w,w,org-aganda-day-view}
7607 @xorgcmd{v m,org-agenda-month-view}
7608 @xorgcmd{v y,org-agenda-month-year}
7609 Switch to day/week/month/year view. When switching to day or week view,
7610 this setting becomes the default for subsequent agenda commands. Since
7611 month and year views are slow to create, they do not become the default.
7612 A numeric prefix argument may be used to jump directly to a specific day
7613 of the year, ISO week, month, or year, respectively. For example,
7614 @kbd{32 d} jumps to February 1st, @kbd{9 w} to ISO week number 9. When
7615 setting day, week, or month view, a year may be encoded in the prefix
7616 argument as well. For example, @kbd{200712 w} will jump to week 12 in
7617 2007. If such a year specification has only one or two digits, it will
7618 be mapped to the interval 1938-2037.
7620 @orgcmd{f,org-agenda-later}
7621 @vindex org-agenda-ndays
7622 Go forward in time to display the following @code{org-agenda-ndays} days.
7623 For example, if the display covers a week, switch to the following week.
7624 With prefix arg, go forward that many times @code{org-agenda-ndays} days.
7626 @orgcmd{b,org-agenda-earlier}
7627 Go backward in time to display earlier dates.
7629 @orgcmd{.,org-agenda-goto-today}
7632 @orgcmd{j,org-agenda-goto-date}
7633 Prompt for a date and go there.
7635 @orgcmd{J,org-agenda-clock-goto}
7636 Go to the currently clocked-in task @i{in the agenda buffer}.
7638 @orgcmd{D,org-agenda-toggle-diary}
7639 Toggle the inclusion of diary entries. See @ref{Weekly/daily agenda}.
7641 @orgcmdkskc{v l,l,org-agenda-log-mode}
7643 @vindex org-log-done
7644 @vindex org-agenda-log-mode-items
7645 Toggle Logbook mode. In Logbook mode, entries that were marked DONE while
7646 logging was on (variable @code{org-log-done}) are shown in the agenda, as are
7647 entries that have been clocked on that day. You can configure the entry
7648 types that should be included in log mode using the variable
7649 @code{org-agenda-log-mode-items}. When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, show
7650 all possible logbook entries, including state changes. When called with two
7651 prefix args @kbd{C-u C-u}, show only logging information, nothing else.
7652 @kbd{v L} is equivalent to @kbd{C-u v l}.
7654 @orgcmdkskc{v [,[,org-agenda-manipulate-query-add}
7655 Include inactive timestamps into the current view. Only for weekly/daily
7656 agenda and timeline views.
7658 @orgcmd{v a,org-agenda-archives-mode}
7659 @xorgcmd{v A,org-agenda-archives-mode 'files}
7660 Toggle Archives mode. In Archives mode, trees that are marked
7661 @code{ARCHIVED} are also scanned when producing the agenda. When you use the
7662 capital @kbd{A}, even all archive files are included. To exit archives mode,
7663 press @kbd{v a} again.
7665 @orgcmdkskc{v R,R,org-agenda-clockreport-mode}
7666 @vindex org-agenda-start-with-clockreport-mode
7667 Toggle Clockreport mode. In Clockreport mode, the daily/weekly agenda will
7668 always show a table with the clocked times for the timespan and file scope
7669 covered by the current agenda view. The initial setting for this mode in new
7670 agenda buffers can be set with the variable
7671 @code{org-agenda-start-with-clockreport-mode}. By using a prefix argument
7672 when toggling this mode (i.e. @kbd{C-u R}), the clock table will not show
7673 contributions from entries that are hidden by agenda filtering@footnote{Only
7674 tags filtering will be respected here, effort filtering is ignored.}.
7676 @orgcmdkskc{v E,E,org-agenda-entry-text-mode}
7677 @vindex org-agenda-start-with-entry-text-mode
7678 @vindex org-agenda-entry-text-maxlines
7679 Toggle entry text mode. In entry text mode, a number of lines from the Org
7680 outline node referenced by an agenda line will be displayed below the line.
7681 The maximum number of lines is given by the variable
7682 @code{org-agenda-entry-text-maxlines}. Calling this command with a numeric
7683 prefix argument will temporarily modify that number to the prefix value.
7685 @orgcmd{G,org-agenda-toggle-time-grid}
7686 @vindex org-agenda-use-time-grid
7687 @vindex org-agenda-time-grid
7688 Toggle the time grid on and off. See also the variables
7689 @code{org-agenda-use-time-grid} and @code{org-agenda-time-grid}.
7691 @orgcmd{r,org-agenda-rodo}
7692 Recreate the agenda buffer, for example to reflect the changes after
7693 modification of the timestamps of items with @kbd{S-@key{left}} and
7694 @kbd{S-@key{right}}. When the buffer is the global TODO list, a prefix
7695 argument is interpreted to create a selective list for a specific TODO
7697 @orgcmd{g,org-agenda-rodo}
7700 @orgcmdkskc{C-x C-s,s,org-save-all-org-buffers}
7701 Save all Org buffers in the current Emacs session, and also the locations of
7704 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-c,org-agenda-columns}
7705 @vindex org-columns-default-format
7706 Invoke column view (@pxref{Column view}) in the agenda buffer. The column
7707 view format is taken from the entry at point, or (if there is no entry at
7708 point), from the first entry in the agenda view. So whatever the format for
7709 that entry would be in the original buffer (taken from a property, from a
7710 @code{#+COLUMNS} line, or from the default variable
7711 @code{org-columns-default-format}), will be used in the agenda.
7713 @orgcmd{C-c C-x >,org-agenda-remove-restriction-lock}
7714 Remove the restriction lock on the agenda, if it is currently restricted to a
7715 file or subtree (@pxref{Agenda files}).
7717 @tsubheading{Secondary filtering and query editing}
7718 @cindex filtering, by tag and effort, in agenda
7719 @cindex tag filtering, in agenda
7720 @cindex effort filtering, in agenda
7721 @cindex query editing, in agenda
7723 @orgcmd{/,org-agenda-filter-by-tag}
7724 @vindex org-agenda-filter-preset
7725 Filter the current agenda view with respect to a tag and/or effort estimates.
7726 The difference between this and a custom agenda command is that filtering is
7727 very fast, so that you can switch quickly between different filters without
7728 having to recreate the agenda@footnote{Custom commands can preset a filter by
7729 binding the variable @code{org-agenda-filter-preset} as an option. This
7730 filter will then be applied to the view and persist as a basic filter through
7731 refreshes and more secondary filtering. The filter is a global property of
7732 the entire agenda view - in a block agenda, you should only set this in the
7733 global options section, not in the section of an individual block.}
7735 You will be prompted for a tag selection letter, SPC will mean any tag at
7736 all. Pressing @key{TAB} at that prompt will offer use completion to select a
7737 tag (including any tags that do not have a selection character). The command
7738 then hides all entries that do not contain or inherit this tag. When called
7739 with prefix arg, remove the entries that @emph{do} have the tag. A second
7740 @kbd{/} at the prompt will turn off the filter and unhide any hidden entries.
7741 If the first key you press is either @kbd{+} or @kbd{-}, the previous filter
7742 will be narrowed by requiring or forbidding the selected additional tag.
7743 Instead of pressing @kbd{+} or @kbd{-} after @kbd{/}, you can also
7744 immediately use the @kbd{\} command.
7746 @vindex org-sort-agenda-noeffort-is-high
7747 In order to filter for effort estimates, you should set-up allowed
7748 efforts globally, for example
7750 (setq org-global-properties
7751 '(("Effort_ALL". "0 0:10 0:30 1:00 2:00 3:00 4:00")))
7753 You can then filter for an effort by first typing an operator, one of
7754 @kbd{<}, @kbd{>}, and @kbd{=}, and then the one-digit index of an effort
7755 estimate in your array of allowed values, where @kbd{0} means the 10th value.
7756 The filter will then restrict to entries with effort smaller-or-equal, equal,
7757 or larger-or-equal than the selected value. If the digits 0-9 are not used
7758 as fast access keys to tags, you can also simply press the index digit
7759 directly without an operator. In this case, @kbd{<} will be assumed. For
7760 application of the operator, entries without a defined effort will be treated
7761 according to the value of @code{org-sort-agenda-noeffort-is-high}. To filter
7762 for tasks without effort definition, press @kbd{?} as the operator.
7764 Org also supports automatic, context-aware tag filtering. If the variable
7765 @code{org-agenda-auto-exclude-function} is set to a user-defined function,
7766 that function can decide which tags should be excluded from the agenda
7767 automatically. Once this is set, the @kbd{/} command then accepts @kbd{RET}
7768 as a sub-option key and runs the auto exclusion logic. For example, let's
7769 say you use a @code{Net} tag to identify tasks which need network access, an
7770 @code{Errand} tag for errands in town, and a @code{Call} tag for making phone
7771 calls. You could auto-exclude these tags based on the availability of the
7772 Internet, and outside of business hours, with something like this:
7776 (defun org-my-auto-exclude-function (tag)
7778 ((string= tag "Net")
7779 (/= 0 (call-process "/sbin/ping" nil nil nil
7780 "-c1" "-q" "-t1" "mail.gnu.org")))
7781 ((or (string= tag "Errand") (string= tag "Call"))
7782 (let ((hour (nth 2 (decode-time))))
7783 (or (< hour 8) (> hour 21)))))
7786 (setq org-agenda-auto-exclude-function 'org-my-auto-exclude-function)
7790 @orgcmd{\,org-agenda-filter-by-tag-refine}
7791 Narrow the current agenda filter by an additional condition. When called with
7792 prefix arg, remove the entries that @emph{do} have the tag, or that do match
7793 the effort criterion. You can achieve the same effect by pressing @kbd{+} or
7794 @kbd{-} as the first key after the @kbd{/} command.
7803 @item @r{in} search view
7804 add new search words (@kbd{[} and @kbd{]}) or new regular expressions
7805 (@kbd{@{} and @kbd{@}}) to the query string. The opening bracket/brace will
7806 add a positive search term prefixed by @samp{+}, indicating that this search
7807 term @i{must} occur/match in the entry. The closing bracket/brace will add a
7808 negative search term which @i{must not} occur/match in the entry for it to be
7812 @tsubheading{Remote editing}
7813 @cindex remote editing, from agenda
7818 @cindex undoing remote-editing events
7819 @cindex remote editing, undo
7820 @orgcmd{C-_,org-agenda-undo}
7821 Undo a change due to a remote editing command. The change is undone
7822 both in the agenda buffer and in the remote buffer.
7824 @orgcmd{t,org-agenda-todo}
7825 Change the TODO state of the item, both in the agenda and in the
7828 @orgcmd{C-S-@key{right},org-agenda-todo-nextset}
7829 @orgcmd{C-S-@key{left},org-agenda-todo-previousset}
7830 Switch to the next/previous set of TODO keywords.
7832 @orgcmd{C-k,org-agenda-kill}
7833 @vindex org-agenda-confirm-kill
7834 Delete the current agenda item along with the entire subtree belonging
7835 to it in the original Org file. If the text to be deleted remotely
7836 is longer than one line, the kill needs to be confirmed by the user. See
7837 variable @code{org-agenda-confirm-kill}.
7839 @orgcmd{C-c C-w,org-agenda-refile}
7840 Refile the entry at point.
7842 @orgcmdkskc{C-c C-x C-a,a,org-agenda-archive-default-with-confirmation}
7843 @vindex org-archive-default-command
7844 Archive the subtree corresponding to the entry at point using the default
7845 archiving command set in @code{org-archive-default-command}. When using the
7846 @code{a} key, confirmation will be required.
7848 @orgcmd{C-c C-x a,org-agenda-toggle-archive-tag}
7849 Toggle the ARCHIVE tag for the current headline.
7851 @orgcmd{C-c C-x A,org-agenda-archive-to-archive-sibling}
7852 Move the subtree corresponding to the current entry to its @emph{archive
7855 @orgcmdkskc{C-c C-x C-s,$,org-agenda-archive}
7856 Archive the subtree corresponding to the current headline. This means the
7857 entry will be moved to the configured archive location, most likely a
7860 @orgcmd{T,org-agenda-show-tags}
7861 @vindex org-agenda-show-inherited-tags
7862 Show all tags associated with the current item. This is useful if you have
7863 turned off @code{org-agenda-show-inherited-tags}, but still want to see all
7864 tags of a headline occasionally.
7866 @orgcmd{:,org-agenda-set-tags}
7867 Set tags for the current headline. If there is an active region in the
7868 agenda, change a tag for all headings in the region.
7872 Set the priority for the current item (@command{org-agenda-priority}).
7873 Org-mode prompts for the priority character. If you reply with @key{SPC}, the
7874 priority cookie is removed from the entry.
7876 @orgcmd{P,org-agenda-show-priority}
7877 Display weighted priority of current item.
7879 @orgcmdkkc{+,S-@key{up},org-agenda-priority-up}
7880 Increase the priority of the current item. The priority is changed in
7881 the original buffer, but the agenda is not resorted. Use the @kbd{r}
7884 @orgcmdkkc{-,S-@key{down},org-agenda-priority-down}
7885 Decrease the priority of the current item.
7887 @orgcmdkkc{z,C-c C-z,org-agenda-add-note}
7888 @vindex org-log-into-drawer
7889 Add a note to the entry. This note will be recorded, and then files to the
7890 same location where state change notes are put. Depending on
7891 @code{org-log-into-drawer}, this maybe inside a drawer.
7893 @orgcmd{C-c C-a,org-attach}
7894 Dispatcher for all command related to attachments.
7896 @orgcmd{C-c C-s,org-agenda-schedule}
7897 Schedule this item, with prefix arg remove the scheduling timestamp
7899 @orgcmd{C-c C-d,org-agenda-deadline}
7900 Set a deadline for this item, with prefix arg remove the deadline.
7902 @orgcmd{k,org-agenda-action}
7903 Agenda actions, to set dates for selected items to the cursor date.
7904 This command also works in the calendar! The command prompts for an
7907 m @r{Mark the entry at point for action. You can also make entries}
7908 @r{in Org files with @kbd{C-c C-x C-k}.}
7909 d @r{Set the deadline of the marked entry to the date at point.}
7910 s @r{Schedule the marked entry at the date at point.}
7911 r @r{Call @code{org-capture} with the cursor date as default date.}
7914 Press @kbd{r} afterward to refresh the agenda and see the effect of the
7917 @orgcmd{S-@key{right},org-agenda-do-date-later}
7918 Change the timestamp associated with the current line by one day into the
7919 future. With a numeric prefix argument, change it by that many days. For
7920 example, @kbd{3 6 5 S-@key{right}} will change it by a year. With a
7921 @kbd{C-u} prefix, change the time by one hour. If you immediately repeat the
7922 command, it will continue to change hours even without the prefix arg. With
7923 a double @kbd{C-u C-u} prefix, do the same for changing minutes. The stamp
7924 is changed in the original Org file, but the change is not directly reflected
7925 in the agenda buffer. Use @kbd{r} or @kbd{g} to update the buffer.
7927 @orgcmd{S-@key{left},org-agenda-do-date-earlier}
7928 Change the timestamp associated with the current line by one day
7931 @orgcmd{>,org-agenda-date-prompt}
7932 Change the timestamp associated with the current line. The key @kbd{>} has
7933 been chosen, because it is the same as @kbd{S-.} on my keyboard.
7935 @orgcmd{I,org-agenda-clock-in}
7936 Start the clock on the current item. If a clock is running already, it
7939 @orgcmd{O,org-agenda-clock-out}
7940 Stop the previously started clock.
7942 @orgcmd{X,org-agenda-clock-cancel}
7943 Cancel the currently running clock.
7945 @orgcmd{J,org-agenda-clock-goto}
7946 Jump to the running clock in another window.
7948 @tsubheading{Bulk remote editing selected entries}
7949 @cindex remote editing, bulk, from agenda
7951 @orgcmd{m,org-agenda-bulk-mark}
7952 Mark the entry at point for bulk action.
7954 @orgcmd{u,org-agenda-bulk-unmark}
7955 Unmark entry for bulk action.
7957 @orgcmd{U,org-agenda-bulk-remove-all-marks}
7958 Unmark all marked entries for bulk action.
7960 @orgcmd{B,org-agenda-bulk-action}
7961 Bulk action: act on all marked entries in the agenda. This will prompt for
7962 another key to select the action to be applied. The prefix arg to @kbd{B}
7963 will be passed through to the @kbd{s} and @kbd{d} commands, to bulk-remove
7964 these special timestamps.
7966 r @r{Prompt for a single refile target and move all entries. The entries}
7967 @r{will no longer be in the agenda, refresh (@kbd{g}) to bring them back.}
7968 $ @r{Archive all selected entries.}
7969 A @r{Archive entries by moving them to their respective archive siblings.}
7970 t @r{Change TODO state. This prompts for a single TODO keyword and}
7971 @r{changes the state of all selected entries, bypassing blocking and}
7972 @r{suppressing logging notes (but not time stamps).}
7973 + @r{Add a tag to all selected entries.}
7974 - @r{Remove a tag from all selected entries.}
7975 s @r{Schedule all items to a new date. To shift existing schedule dates}
7976 @r{by a fixed number of days, use something starting with double plus}
7977 @r{at the prompt, for example @samp{++8d} or @samp{++2w}.}
7978 d @r{Set deadline to a specific date.}
7982 @tsubheading{Calendar commands}
7983 @cindex calendar commands, from agenda
7985 @orgcmd{c,org-agenda-goto-calendar}
7986 Open the Emacs calendar and move to the date at the agenda cursor.
7988 @orgcmd{c,org-calendar-goto-agenda}
7989 When in the calendar, compute and show the Org-mode agenda for the
7992 @cindex diary entries, creating from agenda
7993 @orgcmd{i,org-agenda-diary-entry}
7994 @vindex org-agenda-diary-file
7995 Insert a new entry into the diary, using the date at the cursor and (for
7996 block entries) the date at the mark. This will add to the Emacs diary
7997 file@footnote{This file is parsed for the agenda when
7998 @code{org-agenda-include-diary} is set.}, in a way similar to the @kbd{i}
7999 command in the calendar. The diary file will pop up in another window, where
8000 you can add the entry.
8002 If you configure @code{org-agenda-diary-file} to point to an Org-mode file,
8003 Org will create entries (in org-mode syntax) in that file instead. Most
8004 entries will be stored in a date-based outline tree that will later make it
8005 easy to archive appointments from previous months/years. The tree will be
8006 built under an entry with a @code{DATE_TREE} property, or else with years as
8007 top-level entries. Emacs will prompt you for the entry text - if you specify
8008 it, the entry will be created in @code{org-agenda-diary-file} without further
8009 interaction. If you directly press @key{RET} at the prompt without typing
8010 text, the target file will be shown in another window for you to finish the
8011 entry there. See also the @kbd{k r} command.
8013 @orgcmd{M,org-agenda-phases-of-moon}
8014 Show the phases of the moon for the three months around current date.
8016 @orgcmd{S,org-agenda-sunrise-sunset}
8017 Show sunrise and sunset times. The geographical location must be set
8018 with calendar variables, see the documentation for the Emacs calendar.
8020 @orgcmd{C,org-agenda-convert-date}
8021 Convert the date at cursor into many other cultural and historic
8024 @orgcmd{H,org-agenda-holidays}
8025 Show holidays for three months around the cursor date.
8027 @item M-x org-export-icalendar-combine-agenda-files
8028 Export a single iCalendar file containing entries from all agenda files.
8029 This is a globally available command, and also available in the agenda menu.
8031 @tsubheading{Exporting to a file}
8032 @orgcmd{C-x C-w,org-write-agenda}
8033 @cindex exporting agenda views
8034 @cindex agenda views, exporting
8035 @vindex org-agenda-exporter-settings
8036 Write the agenda view to a file. Depending on the extension of the selected
8037 file name, the view will be exported as HTML (extension @file{.html} or
8038 @file{.htm}), Postscript (extension @file{.ps}), PDF (extension @file{.pdf}),
8039 and plain text (any other extension). When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix
8040 argument, immediately open the newly created file. Use the variable
8041 @code{org-agenda-exporter-settings} to set options for @file{ps-print} and
8042 for @file{htmlize} to be used during export.
8044 @tsubheading{Quit and Exit}
8045 @orgcmd{q,org-agenda-quit}
8046 Quit agenda, remove the agenda buffer.
8048 @cindex agenda files, removing buffers
8049 @orgcmd{x,org-agenda-exit}
8050 Exit agenda, remove the agenda buffer and all buffers loaded by Emacs
8051 for the compilation of the agenda. Buffers created by the user to
8052 visit Org files will not be removed.
8056 @node Custom agenda views, Exporting Agenda Views, Agenda commands, Agenda Views
8057 @section Custom agenda views
8058 @cindex custom agenda views
8059 @cindex agenda views, custom
8061 Custom agenda commands serve two purposes: to store and quickly access
8062 frequently used TODO and tags searches, and to create special composite
8063 agenda buffers. Custom agenda commands will be accessible through the
8064 dispatcher (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}), just like the default commands.
8067 * Storing searches:: Type once, use often
8068 * Block agenda:: All the stuff you need in a single buffer
8069 * Setting Options:: Changing the rules
8072 @node Storing searches, Block agenda, Custom agenda views, Custom agenda views
8073 @subsection Storing searches
8075 The first application of custom searches is the definition of keyboard
8076 shortcuts for frequently used searches, either creating an agenda
8077 buffer, or a sparse tree (the latter covering of course only the current
8080 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
8081 Custom commands are configured in the variable
8082 @code{org-agenda-custom-commands}. You can customize this variable, for
8083 example by pressing @kbd{C-c a C}. You can also directly set it with
8084 Emacs Lisp in @file{.emacs}. The following example contains all valid
8089 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8090 '(("w" todo "WAITING")
8091 ("W" todo-tree "WAITING")
8092 ("u" tags "+boss-urgent")
8093 ("v" tags-todo "+boss-urgent")
8094 ("U" tags-tree "+boss-urgent")
8095 ("f" occur-tree "\\<FIXME\\>")
8096 ("h" . "HOME+Name tags searches") ; description for "h" prefix
8097 ("hl" tags "+home+Lisa")
8098 ("hp" tags "+home+Peter")
8099 ("hk" tags "+home+Kim")))
8104 The initial string in each entry defines the keys you have to press
8105 after the dispatcher command @kbd{C-c a} in order to access the command.
8106 Usually this will be just a single character, but if you have many
8107 similar commands, you can also define two-letter combinations where the
8108 first character is the same in several combinations and serves as a
8109 prefix key@footnote{You can provide a description for a prefix key by
8110 inserting a cons cell with the prefix and the description.}. The second
8111 parameter is the search type, followed by the string or regular
8112 expression to be used for the matching. The example above will
8117 as a global search for TODO entries with @samp{WAITING} as the TODO
8120 as the same search, but only in the current buffer and displaying the
8121 results as a sparse tree
8123 as a global tags search for headlines marked @samp{:boss:} but not
8126 as the same search as @kbd{C-c a u}, but limiting the search to
8127 headlines that are also TODO items
8129 as the same search as @kbd{C-c a u}, but only in the current buffer and
8130 displaying the result as a sparse tree
8132 to create a sparse tree (again: current buffer only) with all entries
8133 containing the word @samp{FIXME}
8135 as a prefix command for a HOME tags search where you have to press an
8136 additional key (@kbd{l}, @kbd{p} or @kbd{k}) to select a name (Lisa,
8137 Peter, or Kim) as additional tag to match.
8140 @node Block agenda, Setting Options, Storing searches, Custom agenda views
8141 @subsection Block agenda
8142 @cindex block agenda
8143 @cindex agenda, with block views
8145 Another possibility is the construction of agenda views that comprise
8146 the results of @emph{several} commands, each of which creates a block in
8147 the agenda buffer. The available commands include @code{agenda} for the
8148 daily or weekly agenda (as created with @kbd{C-c a a}), @code{alltodo}
8149 for the global TODO list (as constructed with @kbd{C-c a t}), and the
8150 matching commands discussed above: @code{todo}, @code{tags}, and
8151 @code{tags-todo}. Here are two examples:
8155 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8156 '(("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks"
8160 ("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks"
8168 This will define @kbd{C-c a h} to create a multi-block view for stuff
8169 you need to attend to at home. The resulting agenda buffer will contain
8170 your agenda for the current week, all TODO items that carry the tag
8171 @samp{home}, and also all lines tagged with @samp{garden}. Finally the
8172 command @kbd{C-c a o} provides a similar view for office tasks.
8174 @node Setting Options, , Block agenda, Custom agenda views
8175 @subsection Setting options for custom commands
8176 @cindex options, for custom agenda views
8178 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
8179 Org-mode contains a number of variables regulating agenda construction
8180 and display. The global variables define the behavior for all agenda
8181 commands, including the custom commands. However, if you want to change
8182 some settings just for a single custom view, you can do so. Setting
8183 options requires inserting a list of variable names and values at the
8184 right spot in @code{org-agenda-custom-commands}. For example:
8188 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8189 '(("w" todo "WAITING"
8190 ((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-down))
8191 (org-agenda-prefix-format " Mixed: ")))
8192 ("U" tags-tree "+boss-urgent"
8193 ((org-show-following-heading nil)
8194 (org-show-hierarchy-above nil)))
8196 ((org-agenda-files '("~org/notes.org"))
8197 (org-agenda-text-search-extra-files nil)))))
8202 Now the @kbd{C-c a w} command will sort the collected entries only by
8203 priority, and the prefix format is modified to just say @samp{ Mixed: }
8204 instead of giving the category of the entry. The sparse tags tree of
8205 @kbd{C-c a U} will now turn out ultra-compact, because neither the
8206 headline hierarchy above the match, nor the headline following the match
8207 will be shown. The command @kbd{C-c a N} will do a text search limited
8208 to only a single file.
8210 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
8211 For command sets creating a block agenda,
8212 @code{org-agenda-custom-commands} has two separate spots for setting
8213 options. You can add options that should be valid for just a single
8214 command in the set, and options that should be valid for all commands in
8215 the set. The former are just added to the command entry, the latter
8216 must come after the list of command entries. Going back to the block
8217 agenda example (@pxref{Block agenda}), let's change the sorting strategy
8218 for the @kbd{C-c a h} commands to @code{priority-down}, but let's sort
8219 the results for GARDEN tags query in the opposite order,
8220 @code{priority-up}. This would look like this:
8224 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8225 '(("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks"
8229 ((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-up)))))
8230 ((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-down))))
8231 ("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks"
8238 As you see, the values and parentheses setting is a little complex.
8239 When in doubt, use the customize interface to set this variable---it
8240 fully supports its structure. Just one caveat: when setting options in
8241 this interface, the @emph{values} are just Lisp expressions. So if the
8242 value is a string, you need to add the double-quotes around the value
8246 @node Exporting Agenda Views, Agenda column view, Custom agenda views, Agenda Views
8247 @section Exporting Agenda Views
8248 @cindex agenda views, exporting
8250 If you are away from your computer, it can be very useful to have a printed
8251 version of some agenda views to carry around. Org-mode can export custom
8252 agenda views as plain text, HTML@footnote{You need to install Hrvoje Niksic's
8253 @file{htmlize.el}.}, Postscript, PDF@footnote{To create PDF output, the
8254 ghostscript @file{ps2pdf} utility must be installed on the system. Selecting
8255 a PDF file with also create the postscript file.}, and iCalendar files. If
8256 you want to do this only occasionally, use the command
8259 @orgcmd{C-x C-w,org-write-agenda}
8260 @cindex exporting agenda views
8261 @cindex agenda views, exporting
8262 @vindex org-agenda-exporter-settings
8263 Write the agenda view to a file. Depending on the extension of the selected
8264 file name, the view will be exported as HTML (extension @file{.html} or
8265 @file{.htm}), Postscript (extension @file{.ps}), iCalendar (extension
8266 @file{.ics}), or plain text (any other extension). Use the variable
8267 @code{org-agenda-exporter-settings} to set options for @file{ps-print} and
8268 for @file{htmlize} to be used during export, for example
8270 @vindex org-agenda-add-entry-text-maxlines
8271 @vindex htmlize-output-type
8272 @vindex ps-number-of-columns
8273 @vindex ps-landscape-mode
8275 (setq org-agenda-exporter-settings
8276 '((ps-number-of-columns 2)
8277 (ps-landscape-mode t)
8278 (org-agenda-add-entry-text-maxlines 5)
8279 (htmlize-output-type 'css)))
8283 If you need to export certain agenda views frequently, you can associate
8284 any custom agenda command with a list of output file names
8285 @footnote{If you want to store standard views like the weekly agenda
8286 or the global TODO list as well, you need to define custom commands for
8287 them in order to be able to specify file names.}. Here is an example
8288 that first defines custom commands for the agenda and the global
8289 TODO list, together with a number of files to which to export them.
8290 Then we define two block agenda commands and specify file names for them
8291 as well. File names can be relative to the current working directory,
8296 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8297 '(("X" agenda "" nil ("agenda.html" "agenda.ps"))
8298 ("Y" alltodo "" nil ("todo.html" "todo.txt" "todo.ps"))
8299 ("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks"
8304 ("~/views/home.html"))
8305 ("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks"
8310 ("~/views/office.ps" "~/calendars/office.ics"))))
8314 The extension of the file name determines the type of export. If it is
8315 @file{.html}, Org-mode will use the @file{htmlize.el} package to convert
8316 the buffer to HTML and save it to this file name. If the extension is
8317 @file{.ps}, @code{ps-print-buffer-with-faces} is used to produce
8318 Postscript output. If the extension is @file{.ics}, iCalendar export is
8319 run export over all files that were used to construct the agenda, and
8320 limit the export to entries listed in the agenda. Any other
8321 extension produces a plain ASCII file.
8323 The export files are @emph{not} created when you use one of those
8324 commands interactively because this might use too much overhead.
8325 Instead, there is a special command to produce @emph{all} specified
8329 @orgcmd{C-c a e,org-store-agenda-views}
8330 Export all agenda views that have export file names associated with
8334 You can use the options section of the custom agenda commands to also
8335 set options for the export commands. For example:
8338 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8340 ((ps-number-of-columns 2)
8341 (ps-landscape-mode t)
8342 (org-agenda-prefix-format " [ ] ")
8343 (org-agenda-with-colors nil)
8344 (org-agenda-remove-tags t))
8349 This command sets two options for the Postscript exporter, to make it
8350 print in two columns in landscape format---the resulting page can be cut
8351 in two and then used in a paper agenda. The remaining settings modify
8352 the agenda prefix to omit category and scheduling information, and
8353 instead include a checkbox to check off items. We also remove the tags
8354 to make the lines compact, and we don't want to use colors for the
8355 black-and-white printer. Settings specified in
8356 @code{org-agenda-exporter-settings} will also apply, but the settings
8357 in @code{org-agenda-custom-commands} take precedence.
8360 From the command line you may also use
8362 emacs -f org-batch-store-agenda-views -kill
8365 or, if you need to modify some parameters@footnote{Quoting depends on the
8366 system you use, please check the FAQ for examples.}
8368 emacs -eval '(org-batch-store-agenda-views \
8369 org-agenda-ndays 30 \
8370 org-agenda-start-day "2007-11-01" \
8371 org-agenda-include-diary nil \
8372 org-agenda-files (quote ("~/org/project.org")))' \
8376 which will create the agenda views restricted to the file
8377 @file{~/org/project.org}, without diary entries and with a 30-day
8380 You can also extract agenda information in a way that allows further
8381 processing by other programs. See @ref{Extracting agenda information}, for
8385 @node Agenda column view, , Exporting Agenda Views, Agenda Views
8386 @section Using column view in the agenda
8387 @cindex column view, in agenda
8388 @cindex agenda, column view
8390 Column view (@pxref{Column view}) is normally used to view and edit
8391 properties embedded in the hierarchical structure of an Org file. It can be
8392 quite useful to use column view also from the agenda, where entries are
8393 collected by certain criteria.
8396 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-c,org-agenda-columns}
8397 Turn on column view in the agenda.
8400 To understand how to use this properly, it is important to realize that the
8401 entries in the agenda are no longer in their proper outline environment.
8402 This causes the following issues:
8406 @vindex org-columns-default-format
8407 @vindex org-overriding-columns-format
8408 Org needs to make a decision which @code{COLUMNS} format to use. Since the
8409 entries in the agenda are collected from different files, and different files
8410 may have different @code{COLUMNS} formats, this is a non-trivial problem.
8411 Org first checks if the variable @code{org-overriding-columns-format} is
8412 currently set, and if so, takes the format from there. Otherwise it takes
8413 the format associated with the first item in the agenda, or, if that item
8414 does not have a specific format (defined in a property, or in its file), it
8415 uses @code{org-columns-default-format}.
8417 @cindex property, special, CLOCKSUM
8418 If any of the columns has a summary type defined (@pxref{Column attributes}),
8419 turning on column view in the agenda will visit all relevant agenda files and
8420 make sure that the computations of this property are up to date. This is
8421 also true for the special @code{CLOCKSUM} property. Org will then sum the
8422 values displayed in the agenda. In the daily/weekly agenda, the sums will
8423 cover a single day, in all other views they cover the entire block. It is
8424 vital to realize that the agenda may show the same entry @emph{twice} (for
8425 example as scheduled and as a deadline), and it may show two entries from the
8426 same hierarchy (for example a @emph{parent} and its @emph{child}). In these
8427 cases, the summation in the agenda will lead to incorrect results because
8428 some values will count double.
8430 When the column view in the agenda shows the @code{CLOCKSUM}, that is always
8431 the entire clocked time for this item. So even in the daily/weekly agenda,
8432 the clocksum listed in column view may originate from times outside the
8433 current view. This has the advantage that you can compare these values with
8434 a column listing the planned total effort for a task---one of the major
8435 applications for column view in the agenda. If you want information about
8436 clocked time in the displayed period use clock table mode (press @kbd{R} in
8441 @node Markup, Exporting, Agenda Views, Top
8442 @chapter Markup for rich export
8444 When exporting Org-mode documents, the exporter tries to reflect the
8445 structure of the document as accurately as possible in the backend. Since
8446 export targets like HTML, La@TeX{}, or DocBook allow much richer formatting,
8447 Org-mode has rules on how to prepare text for rich export. This section
8448 summarizes the markup rules used in an Org-mode buffer.
8451 * Structural markup elements:: The basic structure as seen by the exporter
8452 * Images and tables:: Tables and Images will be included
8453 * Literal examples:: Source code examples with special formatting
8454 * Include files:: Include additional files into a document
8455 * Index entries:: Making an index
8456 * Macro replacement:: Use macros to create complex output
8457 * Embedded LaTeX:: LaTeX can be freely used inside Org documents
8460 @node Structural markup elements, Images and tables, Markup, Markup
8461 @section Structural markup elements
8464 * Document title:: Where the title is taken from
8465 * Headings and sections:: The document structure as seen by the exporter
8466 * Table of contents:: The if and where of the table of contents
8467 * Initial text:: Text before the first heading?
8469 * Paragraphs:: Paragraphs
8470 * Footnote markup:: Footnotes
8471 * Emphasis and monospace:: Bold, italic, etc.
8472 * Horizontal rules:: Make a line
8473 * Comment lines:: What will *not* be exported
8476 @node Document title, Headings and sections, Structural markup elements, Structural markup elements
8477 @subheading Document title
8478 @cindex document title, markup rules
8481 The title of the exported document is taken from the special line
8485 #+TITLE: This is the title of the document
8489 If this line does not exist, the title is derived from the first non-empty,
8490 non-comment line in the buffer. If no such line exists, or if you have
8491 turned off exporting of the text before the first headline (see below), the
8492 title will be the file name without extension.
8494 @cindex property, EXPORT_TITLE
8495 If you are exporting only a subtree by marking is as the region, the heading
8496 of the subtree will become the title of the document. If the subtree has a
8497 property @code{EXPORT_TITLE}, that will take precedence.
8499 @node Headings and sections, Table of contents, Document title, Structural markup elements
8500 @subheading Headings and sections
8501 @cindex headings and sections, markup rules
8503 @vindex org-export-headline-levels
8504 The outline structure of the document as described in @ref{Document
8505 Structure}, forms the basis for defining sections of the exported document.
8506 However, since the outline structure is also used for (for example) lists of
8507 tasks, only the first three outline levels will be used as headings. Deeper
8508 levels will become itemized lists. You can change the location of this
8509 switch globally by setting the variable @code{org-export-headline-levels}, or on a
8510 per-file basis with a line
8517 @node Table of contents, Initial text, Headings and sections, Structural markup elements
8518 @subheading Table of contents
8519 @cindex table of contents, markup rules
8521 @vindex org-export-with-toc
8522 The table of contents is normally inserted directly before the first headline
8523 of the file. If you would like to get it to a different location, insert the
8524 string @code{[TABLE-OF-CONTENTS]} on a line by itself at the desired
8525 location. The depth of the table of contents is by default the same as the
8526 number of headline levels, but you can choose a smaller number, or turn off
8527 the table of contents entirely, by configuring the variable
8528 @code{org-export-with-toc}, or on a per-file basis with a line like
8531 #+OPTIONS: toc:2 (only to two levels in TOC)
8532 #+OPTIONS: toc:nil (no TOC at all)
8535 @node Initial text, Lists, Table of contents, Structural markup elements
8536 @subheading Text before the first headline
8537 @cindex text before first headline, markup rules
8540 Org-mode normally exports the text before the first headline, and even uses
8541 the first line as the document title. The text will be fully marked up. If
8542 you need to include literal HTML, La@TeX{}, or DocBook code, use the special
8543 constructs described below in the sections for the individual exporters.
8545 @vindex org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading
8546 Some people like to use the space before the first headline for setup and
8547 internal links and therefore would like to control the exported text before
8548 the first headline in a different way. You can do so by setting the variable
8549 @code{org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading} to @code{t}. On a per-file
8550 basis, you can get the same effect with @samp{#+OPTIONS: skip:t}.
8553 If you still want to have some text before the first headline, use the
8554 @code{#+TEXT} construct:
8558 #+TEXT: This text will go before the *first* headline.
8559 #+TEXT: [TABLE-OF-CONTENTS]
8560 #+TEXT: This goes between the table of contents and the first headline
8563 @node Lists, Paragraphs, Initial text, Structural markup elements
8565 @cindex lists, markup rules
8567 Plain lists as described in @ref{Plain lists}, are translated to the backend's
8568 syntax for such lists. Most backends support unordered, ordered, and
8571 @node Paragraphs, Footnote markup, Lists, Structural markup elements
8572 @subheading Paragraphs, line breaks, and quoting
8573 @cindex paragraphs, markup rules
8575 Paragraphs are separated by at least one empty line. If you need to enforce
8576 a line break within a paragraph, use @samp{\\} at the end of a line.
8578 To keep the line breaks in a region, but otherwise use normal formatting, you
8579 can use this construct, which can also be used to format poetry.
8581 @cindex #+BEGIN_VERSE
8584 Great clouds overhead
8585 Tiny black birds rise and fall
8592 When quoting a passage from another document, it is customary to format this
8593 as a paragraph that is indented on both the left and the right margin. You
8594 can include quotations in Org-mode documents like this:
8596 @cindex #+BEGIN_QUOTE
8599 Everything should be made as simple as possible,
8600 but not any simpler -- Albert Einstein
8604 If you would like to center some text, do it like this:
8605 @cindex #+BEGIN_CENTER
8608 Everything should be made as simple as possible, \\
8614 @node Footnote markup, Emphasis and monospace, Paragraphs, Structural markup elements
8615 @subheading Footnote markup
8616 @cindex footnotes, markup rules
8617 @cindex @file{footnote.el}
8619 Footnotes defined in the way described in @ref{Footnotes}, will be exported by
8620 all backends. Org allows multiple references to the same note, and
8621 different backends support this to varying degrees.
8623 @node Emphasis and monospace, Horizontal rules, Footnote markup, Structural markup elements
8624 @subheading Emphasis and monospace
8626 @cindex underlined text, markup rules
8627 @cindex bold text, markup rules
8628 @cindex italic text, markup rules
8629 @cindex verbatim text, markup rules
8630 @cindex code text, markup rules
8631 @cindex strike-through text, markup rules
8632 You can make words @b{*bold*}, @i{/italic/}, _underlined_, @code{=code=}
8633 and @code{~verbatim~}, and, if you must, @samp{+strike-through+}. Text
8634 in the code and verbatim string is not processed for Org-mode specific
8635 syntax, it is exported verbatim.
8637 @node Horizontal rules, Comment lines, Emphasis and monospace, Structural markup elements
8638 @subheading Horizontal rules
8639 @cindex horizontal rules, markup rules
8640 A line consisting of only dashes, and at least 5 of them, will be
8641 exported as a horizontal line (@samp{<hr/>} in HTML).
8643 @node Comment lines, , Horizontal rules, Structural markup elements
8644 @subheading Comment lines
8645 @cindex comment lines
8646 @cindex exporting, not
8647 @cindex #+BEGIN_COMMENT
8649 Lines starting with @samp{#} in column zero are treated as comments and will
8650 never be exported. If you want an indented line to be treated as a comment,
8651 start it with @samp{#+ }. Also entire subtrees starting with the word
8652 @samp{COMMENT} will never be exported. Finally, regions surrounded by
8653 @samp{#+BEGIN_COMMENT} ... @samp{#+END_COMMENT} will not be exported.
8658 Toggle the COMMENT keyword at the beginning of an entry.
8662 @node Images and tables, Literal examples, Structural markup elements, Markup
8663 @section Images and Tables
8665 @cindex tables, markup rules
8668 Both the native Org-mode tables (@pxref{Tables}) and tables formatted with
8669 the @file{table.el} package will be exported properly. For Org-mode tables,
8670 the lines before the first horizontal separator line will become table header
8671 lines. You can use the following lines somewhere before the table to assign
8672 a caption and a label for cross references, and in the text you can refer to
8673 the object with @code{\ref@{tab:basic-data@}}:
8676 #+CAPTION: This is the caption for the next table (or link)
8677 #+LABEL: tbl:basic-data
8682 @cindex inlined images, markup rules
8683 Some backends (HTML, La@TeX{}, and DocBook) allow you to directly include
8684 images into the exported document. Org does this, if a link to an image
8685 files does not have a description part, for example @code{[[./img/a.jpg]]}.
8686 If you wish to define a caption for the image and maybe a label for internal
8687 cross references, make sure that the link is on a line by itself and precede
8688 it with @code{#+CAPTION} and @code{#+LABEL} as follows:
8691 #+CAPTION: This is the caption for the next figure link (or table)
8692 #+LABEL: fig:SED-HR4049
8696 You may also define additional attributes for the figure. As this is
8697 backend-specific, see the sections about the individual backends for more
8700 @xref{Handling links,the discussion of image links}.
8702 @node Literal examples, Include files, Images and tables, Markup
8703 @section Literal examples
8704 @cindex literal examples, markup rules
8705 @cindex code line references, markup rules
8707 You can include literal examples that should not be subjected to
8708 markup. Such examples will be typeset in monospace, so this is well suited
8709 for source code and similar examples.
8710 @cindex #+BEGIN_EXAMPLE
8714 Some example from a text file.
8718 Note that such blocks may be @i{indented} in order to align nicely with
8719 indented text and in particular with plain list structure (@pxref{Plain
8720 lists}). For simplicity when using small examples, you can also start the
8721 example lines with a colon followed by a space. There may also be additional
8722 whitespace before the colon:
8726 : Some example from a text file.
8729 @cindex formatting source code, markup rules
8730 If the example is source code from a programming language, or any other text
8731 that can be marked up by font-lock in Emacs, you can ask for the example to
8732 look like the fontified Emacs buffer@footnote{This works automatically for
8733 the HTML backend (it requires version 1.34 of the @file{htmlize.el} package,
8734 which is distributed with Org.) Fontified code chunks in LaTeX can be
8735 achieved using either the listings or the
8736 @url{http://code.google.com/p/minted, minted,} package. To use listings, turn
8737 on the variable @code{org-export-latex-listings} and ensure that the listings
8738 package is included by the LaTeX header (e.g. by configuring
8739 @code{org-export-latex-packages-alist}). See the listings documentation for
8740 configuration options, including obtaining colored output. For minted it is
8741 necessary to install the program @url{http://pygments.org, pygments}, in
8742 addition to setting @code{org-export-latex-minted}, ensuring that the minted
8743 package is included by the LaTeX header, and ensuring that the
8744 @code{-shell-escape} option is passed to @file{pdflatex} (see
8745 @code{org-latex-to-pdf-process}). See the documentation of the variables
8746 @code{org-export-latex-listings} and @code{org-export-latex-minted} for
8747 further details.}. This is done with the @samp{src} block, where you also
8748 need to specify the name of the major mode that should be used to fontify the
8753 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
8754 (defun org-xor (a b)
8760 Both in @code{example} and in @code{src} snippets, you can add a @code{-n}
8761 switch to the end of the @code{BEGIN} line, to get the lines of the example
8762 numbered. If you use a @code{+n} switch, the numbering from the previous
8763 numbered snippet will be continued in the current one. In literal examples,
8764 Org will interpret strings like @samp{(ref:name)} as labels, and use them as
8765 targets for special hyperlinks like @code{[[(name)]]} (i.e. the reference name
8766 enclosed in single parenthesis). In HTML, hovering the mouse over such a
8767 link will remote-highlight the corresponding code line, which is kind of
8770 You can also add a @code{-r} switch which @i{removes} the labels from the
8771 source code@footnote{Adding @code{-k} to @code{-n -r} will @i{keep} the
8772 labels in the source code while using line numbers for the links, which might
8773 be useful to explain those in an org-mode example code.}. With the @code{-n}
8774 switch, links to these references will be labeled by the line numbers from
8775 the code listing, otherwise links will use the labels with no parentheses.
8779 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp -n -r
8780 (save-excursion (ref:sc)
8781 (goto-char (point-min)) (ref:jump)
8783 In line [[(sc)]] we remember the current position. [[(jump)][Line (jump)]]
8787 @vindex org-coderef-label-format
8788 If the syntax for the label format conflicts with the language syntax, use a
8789 @code{-l} switch to change the format, for example @samp{#+BEGIN_SRC pascal
8790 -n -r -l "((%s))"}. See also the variable @code{org-coderef-label-format}.
8792 HTML export also allows examples to be published as text areas, @xref{Text
8793 areas in HTML export}.
8798 Edit the source code example at point in its native mode. This works by
8799 switching to a temporary buffer with the source code. You need to exit by
8800 pressing @kbd{C-c '} again@footnote{Upon exit, lines starting with @samp{*}
8801 or @samp{#} will get a comma prepended, to keep them from being interpreted
8802 by Org as outline nodes or special comments. These commas will be stripped
8803 for editing with @kbd{C-c '}, and also for export.}, the edited version will
8804 then replace the old version in the Org buffer. Fixed-width regions
8805 (where each line starts with a colon followed by a space) will be edited
8806 using @code{artist-mode}@footnote{You may select a different-mode with the
8807 variable @code{org-edit-fixed-width-region-mode}.} to allow creating ASCII
8808 drawings easily. Using this command in an empty line will create a new
8812 Calling @code{org-store-link} while editing a source code example in a
8813 temporary buffer created with @kbd{C-c '} will prompt for a label, make sure
8814 that it is unique in the current buffer, and insert it with the proper
8815 formatting like @samp{(ref:label)} at the end of the current line. Then the
8816 label is stored as a link @samp{(label)}, for retrieval with @kbd{C-c C-l}.
8820 @node Include files, Index entries, Literal examples, Markup
8821 @section Include files
8822 @cindex include files, markup rules
8824 During export, you can include the content of another file. For example, to
8825 include your @file{.emacs} file, you could use:
8829 #+INCLUDE: "~/.emacs" src emacs-lisp
8832 The optional second and third parameter are the markup (e.g. @samp{quote},
8833 @samp{example}, or @samp{src}), and, if the markup is @samp{src}, the
8834 language for formatting the contents. The markup is optional, if it is not
8835 given, the text will be assumed to be in Org-mode format and will be
8836 processed normally. The include line will also allow additional keyword
8837 parameters @code{:prefix1} and @code{:prefix} to specify prefixes for the
8838 first line and for each following line, @code{:minlevel} in order to get
8839 org-mode content demoted to a specified level, as well as any options
8840 accepted by the selected markup. For example, to include a file as an item,
8844 #+INCLUDE: "~/snippets/xx" :prefix1 " + " :prefix " "
8850 Visit the include file at point.
8853 @node Index entries, Macro replacement, Include files, Markup
8854 @section Index entries
8855 @cindex index entries, for publishing
8857 You can specify entries that will be used for generating an index during
8858 publishing. This is done by lines starting with @code{#+INDEX}. An entry
8859 the contains an exclamation mark will create a sub item. See @ref{Generating
8860 an index} for more information.
8865 #+INDEX: Application!CV
8871 @node Macro replacement, Embedded LaTeX, Index entries, Markup
8872 @section Macro replacement
8873 @cindex macro replacement, during export
8876 You can define text snippets with
8879 #+MACRO: name replacement text $1, $2 are arguments
8882 @noindent which can be referenced anywhere in the document (even in
8883 code examples) with @code{@{@{@{name(arg1,arg2)@}@}@}}. In addition to
8884 defined macros, @code{@{@{@{title@}@}@}}, @code{@{@{@{author@}@}@}}, etc.,
8885 will reference information set by the @code{#+TITLE:}, @code{#+AUTHOR:}, and
8886 similar lines. Also, @code{@{@{@{date(@var{FORMAT})@}@}@}} and
8887 @code{@{@{@{modification-time(@var{FORMAT})@}@}@}} refer to current date time
8888 and to the modification time of the file being exported, respectively.
8889 @var{FORMAT} should be a format string understood by
8890 @code{format-time-string}.
8892 Macro expansion takes place during export, and some people use it to
8893 construct complex HTML code.
8896 @node Embedded LaTeX, , Macro replacement, Markup
8897 @section Embedded La@TeX{}
8898 @cindex @TeX{} interpretation
8899 @cindex La@TeX{} interpretation
8901 Plain ASCII is normally sufficient for almost all note taking. One
8902 exception, however, are scientific notes which need to be able to contain
8903 mathematical symbols and the occasional formula. La@TeX{}@footnote{La@TeX{}
8904 is a macro system based on Donald E. Knuth's @TeX{} system. Many of the
8905 features described here as ``La@TeX{}'' are really from @TeX{}, but for
8906 simplicity I am blurring this distinction.} is widely used to typeset
8907 scientific documents. Org-mode supports embedding La@TeX{} code into its
8908 files, because many academics are used to writing and reading La@TeX{} source
8909 code, and because it can be readily processed to produce pretty output for a
8910 number of export backends.
8913 * Special symbols:: Greek letters and other symbols
8914 * Subscripts and superscripts:: Simple syntax for raising/lowering text
8915 * LaTeX fragments:: Complex formulas made easy
8916 * Previewing LaTeX fragments:: What will this snippet look like?
8917 * CDLaTeX mode:: Speed up entering of formulas
8920 @node Special symbols, Subscripts and superscripts, Embedded LaTeX, Embedded LaTeX
8921 @subsection Special symbols
8922 @cindex math symbols
8923 @cindex special symbols
8924 @cindex @TeX{} macros
8925 @cindex La@TeX{} fragments, markup rules
8926 @cindex HTML entities
8927 @cindex La@TeX{} entities
8929 You can use La@TeX{} macros to insert special symbols like @samp{\alpha} to
8930 indicate the Greek letter, or @samp{\to} to indicate an arrow. Completion
8931 for these macros is available, just type @samp{\} and maybe a few letters,
8932 and press @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} to see possible completions. Unlike La@TeX{}
8933 code, Org-mode allows these macros to be present without surrounding math
8934 delimiters, for example:
8937 Angles are written as Greek letters \alpha, \beta and \gamma.
8940 @vindex org-entities
8941 During export, these symbols will be transformed into the native format of
8942 the exporter backend. Strings like @code{\alpha} will be exported as
8943 @code{α} in the HTML output, and as @code{$\alpha$} in the La@TeX{}
8944 output. Similarly, @code{\nbsp} will become @code{ } in HTML and
8945 @code{~} in La@TeX{}. If you need such a symbol inside a word, terminate it
8946 like this: @samp{\Aacute@{@}stor}.
8948 A large number of entities is provided, with names taken from both HTML and
8949 La@TeX{}, see the variable @code{org-entities} for the complete list.
8950 @samp{\-} is treated as a shy hyphen, and @samp{--}, @samp{---}, and
8951 @samp{...} are all converted into special commands creating hyphens of
8952 different lengths or a compact set of dots.
8954 If you would like to see entities displayed as UTF8 characters, use the
8955 following command@footnote{You can turn this on by default by setting the
8956 variable @code{org-pretty-entities}, or on a per-file base with the
8957 @code{#+STARTUP} option @code{entitiespretty}.}:
8962 Toggle display of entities as UTF8 characters. This does not change the
8963 buffer content which remains plain ASCII, but it overlays the UTF8 character
8964 for display purposes only.
8967 @node Subscripts and superscripts, LaTeX fragments, Special symbols, Embedded LaTeX
8968 @subsection Subscripts and superscripts
8972 Just like in La@TeX{}, @samp{^} and @samp{_} are used to indicate super-
8973 and subscripts. Again, these can be used without embedding them in
8974 math-mode delimiters. To increase the readability of ASCII text, it is
8975 not necessary (but OK) to surround multi-character sub- and superscripts
8976 with curly braces. For example
8979 The mass if the sun is M_sun = 1.989 x 10^30 kg. The radius of
8980 the sun is R_@{sun@} = 6.96 x 10^8 m.
8983 @vindex org-export-with-sub-superscripts
8984 To avoid interpretation as raised or lowered text, you can quote @samp{^} and
8985 @samp{_} with a backslash: @samp{\^} and @samp{\_}. If you write a text
8986 where the underscore is often used in a different context, Org's convention
8987 to always interpret these as subscripts can get in your way. Configure the
8988 variable @code{org-export-with-sub-superscripts} to globally change this
8989 convention, or use, on a per-file basis:
8995 @noindent With this setting, @samp{a_b} will not be interpreted as a
8996 subscript, but @samp{a_@{b@}} will.
9001 In addition to showing entities as UTF8 characters, this command will also
9002 format sub- and superscripts in a WYSIWYM way.
9005 @node LaTeX fragments, Previewing LaTeX fragments, Subscripts and superscripts, Embedded LaTeX
9006 @subsection La@TeX{} fragments
9007 @cindex La@TeX{} fragments
9009 @vindex org-format-latex-header
9010 Going beyond symbols and sub- and superscripts, a full formula language is
9011 needed. Org-mode can contain La@TeX{} math fragments, and it supports ways
9012 to process these for several export backends. When exporting to La@TeX{},
9013 the code is obviously left as it is. When exporting to HTML, Org invokes the
9014 @uref{http://www.mathjax.org, MathJax library} (@pxref{Math formatting in
9015 HTML export}) to process and display the math@footnote{If you plan to use
9016 this regularly or on pages with significant page views, you should install
9017 @file{MathJax} on your own
9018 server in order to limit the load of our server.}. Finally, it can also
9019 process the mathematical expressions into images@footnote{For this to work
9020 you need to be on a system with a working La@TeX{} installation. You also
9021 need the @file{dvipng} program, available at
9022 @url{http://sourceforge.net/projects/dvipng/}. The La@TeX{} header that will
9023 be used when processing a fragment can be configured with the variable
9024 @code{org-format-latex-header}.} that can be displayed in a browser or in
9027 La@TeX{} fragments don't need any special marking at all. The following
9028 snippets will be identified as La@TeX{} source code:
9031 Environments of any kind@footnote{When @file{MathJax} is used, only the
9032 environment recognized by @file{MathJax} will be processed. When dvipng is
9033 used to create images, any La@TeX{} environments will be handled.}. The only
9034 requirement is that the @code{\begin} statement appears on a new line,
9035 preceded by only whitespace.
9037 Text within the usual La@TeX{} math delimiters. To avoid conflicts with
9038 currency specifications, single @samp{$} characters are only recognized as
9039 math delimiters if the enclosed text contains at most two line breaks, is
9040 directly attached to the @samp{$} characters with no whitespace in between,
9041 and if the closing @samp{$} is followed by whitespace, punctuation or a dash.
9042 For the other delimiters, there is no such restriction, so when in doubt, use
9043 @samp{\(...\)} as inline math delimiters.
9046 @noindent For example:
9049 \begin@{equation@} % arbitrary environments,
9050 x=\sqrt@{b@} % even tables, figures
9051 \end@{equation@} % etc
9053 If $a^2=b$ and \( b=2 \), then the solution must be
9054 either $$ a=+\sqrt@{2@} $$ or \[ a=-\sqrt@{2@} \].
9058 @vindex org-format-latex-options
9059 If you need any of the delimiter ASCII sequences for other purposes, you
9060 can configure the option @code{org-format-latex-options} to deselect the
9061 ones you do not wish to have interpreted by the La@TeX{} converter.
9063 @vindex org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments
9064 LaTeX processing can be configured with the variable
9065 @code{org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments}. The default setting is @code{t}
9066 which means @file{MathJax} for HTML, and no processing for DocBook, ASCII and
9067 LaTeX backends. You can also set this variable on a per-file basis using one
9071 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:t @r{Do the right thing automatically (MathJax)}
9072 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:dvipng @r{Force using dvipng images}
9073 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:nil @r{Do not process La@TeX{} fragments at all}
9074 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:verbatim @r{Verbatim export, for jsMath or so}
9077 @node Previewing LaTeX fragments, CDLaTeX mode, LaTeX fragments, Embedded LaTeX
9078 @subsection Previewing LaTeX fragments
9079 @cindex LaTeX fragments, preview
9081 If you have @file{dvipng} installed, La@TeX{} fragments can be processed to
9082 produce preview images of the typeset expressions:
9087 Produce a preview image of the La@TeX{} fragment at point and overlay it
9088 over the source code. If there is no fragment at point, process all
9089 fragments in the current entry (between two headlines). When called
9090 with a prefix argument, process the entire subtree. When called with
9091 two prefix arguments, or when the cursor is before the first headline,
9092 process the entire buffer.
9095 Remove the overlay preview images.
9098 @vindex org-format-latex-options
9099 You can customize the variable @code{org-format-latex-options} to influence
9100 some aspects of the preview. In particular, the @code{:scale} (and for HTML
9101 export, @code{:html-scale}) property can be used to adjust the size of the
9104 @node CDLaTeX mode, , Previewing LaTeX fragments, Embedded LaTeX
9105 @subsection Using CDLa@TeX{} to enter math
9108 CDLa@TeX{} mode is a minor mode that is normally used in combination with a
9109 major La@TeX{} mode like AUC@TeX{} in order to speed-up insertion of
9110 environments and math templates. Inside Org-mode, you can make use of
9111 some of the features of CDLa@TeX{} mode. You need to install
9112 @file{cdlatex.el} and @file{texmathp.el} (the latter comes also with
9113 AUC@TeX{}) from @url{http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik/Tools/cdlatex}.
9114 Don't use CDLa@TeX{} mode itself under Org-mode, but use the light
9115 version @code{org-cdlatex-mode} that comes as part of Org-mode. Turn it
9116 on for the current buffer with @code{M-x org-cdlatex-mode}, or for all
9120 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook 'turn-on-org-cdlatex)
9123 When this mode is enabled, the following features are present (for more
9124 details see the documentation of CDLa@TeX{} mode):
9128 Environment templates can be inserted with @kbd{C-c @{}.
9131 The @key{TAB} key will do template expansion if the cursor is inside a
9132 La@TeX{} fragment@footnote{Org-mode has a method to test if the cursor is
9133 inside such a fragment, see the documentation of the function
9134 @code{org-inside-LaTeX-fragment-p}.}. For example, @key{TAB} will
9135 expand @code{fr} to @code{\frac@{@}@{@}} and position the cursor
9136 correctly inside the first brace. Another @key{TAB} will get you into
9137 the second brace. Even outside fragments, @key{TAB} will expand
9138 environment abbreviations at the beginning of a line. For example, if
9139 you write @samp{equ} at the beginning of a line and press @key{TAB},
9140 this abbreviation will be expanded to an @code{equation} environment.
9141 To get a list of all abbreviations, type @kbd{M-x cdlatex-command-help}.
9145 @vindex cdlatex-simplify-sub-super-scripts
9146 Pressing @kbd{_} and @kbd{^} inside a La@TeX{} fragment will insert these
9147 characters together with a pair of braces. If you use @key{TAB} to move
9148 out of the braces, and if the braces surround only a single character or
9149 macro, they are removed again (depending on the variable
9150 @code{cdlatex-simplify-sub-super-scripts}).
9153 Pressing the backquote @kbd{`} followed by a character inserts math
9154 macros, also outside La@TeX{} fragments. If you wait more than 1.5 seconds
9155 after the backquote, a help window will pop up.
9158 Pressing the single-quote @kbd{'} followed by another character modifies
9159 the symbol before point with an accent or a font. If you wait more than
9160 1.5 seconds after the backquote, a help window will pop up. Character
9161 modification will work only inside La@TeX{} fragments, outside the quote
9165 @node Exporting, Publishing, Markup, Top
9169 Org-mode documents can be exported into a variety of other formats. For
9170 printing and sharing of notes, ASCII export produces a readable and simple
9171 version of an Org file. HTML export allows you to publish a notes file on
9172 the web, while the XOXO format provides a solid base for exchange with a
9173 broad range of other applications. La@TeX{} export lets you use Org-mode and
9174 its structured editing functions to easily create La@TeX{} files. DocBook
9175 export makes it possible to convert Org files to many other formats using
9176 DocBook tools. For project management you can create gantt and resource
9177 charts by using TaskJuggler export. To incorporate entries with associated
9178 times like deadlines or appointments into a desktop calendar program like
9179 iCal, Org-mode can also produce extracts in the iCalendar format. Currently
9180 Org-mode only supports export, not import of these different formats.
9182 Org supports export of selected regions when @code{transient-mark-mode} is
9183 enabled (default in Emacs 23).
9186 * Selective export:: Using tags to select and exclude trees
9187 * Export options:: Per-file export settings
9188 * The export dispatcher:: How to access exporter commands
9189 * ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export:: Exporting to flat files with encoding
9190 * HTML export:: Exporting to HTML
9191 * LaTeX and PDF export:: Exporting to La@TeX{}, and processing to PDF
9192 * DocBook export:: Exporting to DocBook
9193 * TaskJuggler export:: Exporting to TaskJuggler
9194 * Freemind export:: Exporting to Freemind mind maps
9195 * XOXO export:: Exporting to XOXO
9196 * iCalendar export:: Exporting in iCalendar format
9199 @node Selective export, Export options, Exporting, Exporting
9200 @section Selective export
9201 @cindex export, selective by tags
9203 @vindex org-export-select-tags
9204 @vindex org-export-exclude-tags
9205 You may use tags to select the parts of a document that should be exported,
9206 or to exclude parts from export. This behavior is governed by two variables:
9207 @code{org-export-select-tags} and @code{org-export-exclude-tags}.
9209 Org first checks if any of the @emph{select} tags is present in the buffer.
9210 If yes, all trees that do not carry one of these tags will be excluded. If a
9211 selected tree is a subtree, the heading hierarchy above it will also be
9212 selected for export, but not the text below those headings.
9215 If none of the select tags is found, the whole buffer will be selected for
9219 Finally, all subtrees that are marked by any of the @emph{exclude} tags will
9220 be removed from the export buffer.
9222 @node Export options, The export dispatcher, Selective export, Exporting
9223 @section Export options
9224 @cindex options, for export
9226 @cindex completion, of option keywords
9227 The exporter recognizes special lines in the buffer which provide
9228 additional information. These lines may be put anywhere in the file.
9229 The whole set of lines can be inserted into the buffer with @kbd{C-c
9230 C-e t}. For individual lines, a good way to make sure the keyword is
9231 correct is to type @samp{#+} and then use @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} completion
9232 (@pxref{Completion}). For a summary of other in-buffer settings not
9233 specifically related to export, see @ref{In-buffer settings}.
9234 In particular, note that you can place commonly-used (export) options in
9235 a separate file which can be included using @code{#+SETUPFILE}.
9238 @orgcmd{C-c C-e t,org-insert-export-options-template}
9239 Insert template with export options, see example below.
9246 @cindex #+DESCRIPTION
9254 @cindex #+EXPORT_SELECT_TAGS
9255 @cindex #+EXPORT_EXCLUDE_TAGS
9257 @cindex #+LATEX_HEADER
9258 @vindex user-full-name
9259 @vindex user-mail-address
9260 @vindex org-export-default-language
9262 #+TITLE: the title to be shown (default is the buffer name)
9263 #+AUTHOR: the author (default taken from @code{user-full-name})
9264 #+DATE: a date, fixed, of a format string for @code{format-time-string}
9265 #+EMAIL: his/her email address (default from @code{user-mail-address})
9266 #+DESCRIPTION: the page description, e.g. for the XHTML meta tag
9267 #+KEYWORDS: the page keywords, e.g. for the XHTML meta tag
9268 #+LANGUAGE: language for HTML, e.g. @samp{en} (@code{org-export-default-language})
9269 #+TEXT: Some descriptive text to be inserted at the beginning.
9270 #+TEXT: Several lines may be given.
9271 #+OPTIONS: H:2 num:t toc:t \n:nil @@:t ::t |:t ^:t f:t TeX:t ...
9272 #+BIND: lisp-var lisp-val, e.g.: org-export-latex-low-levels itemize
9273 @r{You need to confirm using these, or configure @code{org-export-allow-BIND}}
9274 #+LINK_UP: the ``up'' link of an exported page
9275 #+LINK_HOME: the ``home'' link of an exported page
9276 #+LATEX_HEADER: extra line(s) for the LaTeX header, like \usepackage@{xyz@}
9277 #+EXPORT_SELECT_TAGS: Tags that select a tree for export
9278 #+EXPORT_EXCLUDE_TAGS: Tags that exclude a tree from export
9279 #+XSLT: the XSLT stylesheet used by DocBook exporter to generate FO file
9283 The OPTIONS line is a compact@footnote{If you want to configure many options
9284 this way, you can use several OPTIONS lines.} form to specify export
9285 settings. Here you can:
9286 @cindex headline levels
9287 @cindex section-numbers
9288 @cindex table of contents
9289 @cindex line-break preservation
9290 @cindex quoted HTML tags
9291 @cindex fixed-width sections
9293 @cindex @TeX{}-like syntax for sub- and superscripts
9295 @cindex special strings
9296 @cindex emphasized text
9297 @cindex @TeX{} macros
9298 @cindex La@TeX{} fragments
9299 @cindex author info, in export
9300 @cindex time info, in export
9302 H: @r{set the number of headline levels for export}
9303 num: @r{turn on/off section-numbers}
9304 toc: @r{turn on/off table of contents, or set level limit (integer)}
9305 \n: @r{turn on/off line-break-preservation (DOES NOT WORK)}
9306 @@: @r{turn on/off quoted HTML tags}
9307 :: @r{turn on/off fixed-width sections}
9308 |: @r{turn on/off tables}
9309 ^: @r{turn on/off @TeX{}-like syntax for sub- and superscripts. If}
9310 @r{you write "^:@{@}", @code{a_@{b@}} will be interpreted, but}
9311 @r{the simple @code{a_b} will be left as it is.}
9312 -: @r{turn on/off conversion of special strings.}
9313 f: @r{turn on/off footnotes like this[1].}
9314 todo: @r{turn on/off inclusion of TODO keywords into exported text}
9315 pri: @r{turn on/off priority cookies}
9316 tags: @r{turn on/off inclusion of tags, may also be @code{not-in-toc}}
9317 <: @r{turn on/off inclusion of any time/date stamps like DEADLINES}
9318 *: @r{turn on/off emphasized text (bold, italic, underlined)}
9319 TeX: @r{turn on/off simple @TeX{} macros in plain text}
9320 LaTeX: @r{configure export of La@TeX{} fragments. Default @code{auto}}
9321 skip: @r{turn on/off skipping the text before the first heading}
9322 author: @r{turn on/off inclusion of author name/email into exported file}
9323 email: @r{turn on/off inclusion of author email into exported file}
9324 creator: @r{turn on/off inclusion of creator info into exported file}
9325 timestamp: @r{turn on/off inclusion creation time into exported file}
9326 d: @r{turn on/off inclusion of drawers}
9329 These options take effect in both the HTML and La@TeX{} export, except for
9330 @code{TeX} and @code{LaTeX}, which are respectively @code{t} and @code{nil}
9331 for the La@TeX{} export. The default values for these and many other options
9332 are given by a set of variables. For a list of such variables, the
9333 corresponding OPTIONS keys and also the publishing keys (@pxref{Project
9334 alist}), see the constant @code{org-export-plist-vars}.
9336 When exporting only a single subtree by selecting it with @kbd{C-c @@} before
9337 calling an export command, the subtree can overrule some of the file's export
9338 settings with properties @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}, @code{EXPORT_TITLE},
9339 @code{EXPORT_TEXT}, @code{EXPORT_AUTHOR}, @code{EXPORT_DATE}, and
9340 @code{EXPORT_OPTIONS}.
9342 @node The export dispatcher, ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export, Export options, Exporting
9343 @section The export dispatcher
9344 @cindex dispatcher, for export commands
9346 All export commands can be reached using the export dispatcher, which is a
9347 prefix key that prompts for an additional key specifying the command.
9348 Normally the entire file is exported, but if there is an active region that
9349 contains one outline tree, the first heading is used as document title and
9350 the subtrees are exported.
9353 @orgcmd{C-c C-e,org-export}
9354 @vindex org-export-run-in-background
9355 Dispatcher for export and publishing commands. Displays a help-window
9356 listing the additional key(s) needed to launch an export or publishing
9357 command. The prefix arg is passed through to the exporter. A double prefix
9358 @kbd{C-u C-u} causes most commands to be executed in the background, in a
9359 separate Emacs process@footnote{To make this behavior the default, customize
9360 the variable @code{org-export-run-in-background}.}.
9361 @orgcmd{C-c C-e v,org-export-visible}
9362 Like @kbd{C-c C-e}, but only export the text that is currently visible
9363 (i.e. not hidden by outline visibility).
9364 @orgcmd{C-u C-u C-c C-e,org-export}
9365 @vindex org-export-run-in-background
9366 Call an the exporter, but reverse the setting of
9367 @code{org-export-run-in-background}, i.e. request background processing if
9368 not set, or force processing in the current Emacs process if set.
9371 @node ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export, HTML export, The export dispatcher, Exporting
9372 @section ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export
9373 @cindex ASCII export
9374 @cindex Latin-1 export
9375 @cindex UTF-8 export
9377 ASCII export produces a simple and very readable version of an Org-mode
9378 file, containing only plain ASCII. Latin-1 and UTF-8 export augment the file
9379 with special characters and symbols available in these encodings.
9381 @cindex region, active
9382 @cindex active region
9383 @cindex transient-mark-mode
9385 @orgcmd{C-c C-e a,org-export-as-ascii}
9386 @cindex property, EXPORT_FILE_NAME
9387 Export as ASCII file. For an Org file, @file{myfile.org}, the ASCII file
9388 will be @file{myfile.txt}. The file will be overwritten without
9389 warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This requires
9390 @code{transient-mark-mode} be turned on.}, only the region will be
9391 exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
9392 current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will
9393 become the document title. If the tree head entry has or inherits an
9394 @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME} property, that name will be used for the
9396 @orgcmd{C-c C-e A,org-export-as-ascii-to-buffer}
9397 Export to a temporary buffer, do not create a file.
9398 @orgcmd{C-c C-e n,org-export-as-latin1}
9399 @xorgcmd{C-c C-e N,org-export-as-latin1-to-buffer}
9400 Like the above commands, but use Latin-1 encoding.
9401 @orgcmd{C-c C-e u,org-export-as-utf8}
9402 @xorgcmd{C-c C-e U,org-export-as-utf8-to-buffer}
9403 Like the above commands, but use UTF-8 encoding.
9404 @item C-c C-e v a/n/u
9405 Export only the visible part of the document.
9408 @cindex headline levels, for exporting
9409 In the exported version, the first 3 outline levels will become
9410 headlines, defining a general document structure. Additional levels
9411 will be exported as itemized lists. If you want that transition to occur
9412 at a different level, specify it with a prefix argument. For example,
9419 creates only top level headlines and does the rest as items. When
9420 headlines are converted to items, the indentation of the text following
9421 the headline is changed to fit nicely under the item. This is done with
9422 the assumption that the first body line indicates the base indentation of
9423 the body text. Any indentation larger than this is adjusted to preserve
9424 the layout relative to the first line. Should there be lines with less
9425 indentation than the first, these are left alone.
9427 @vindex org-export-ascii-links-to-notes
9428 Links will be exported in a footnote-like style, with the descriptive part in
9429 the text and the link in a note before the next heading. See the variable
9430 @code{org-export-ascii-links-to-notes} for details and other options.
9432 @node HTML export, LaTeX and PDF export, ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export, Exporting
9433 @section HTML export
9436 Org-mode contains an HTML (XHTML 1.0 strict) exporter with extensive
9437 HTML formatting, in ways similar to John Gruber's @emph{markdown}
9438 language, but with additional support for tables.
9441 * HTML Export commands:: How to invoke HTML export
9442 * Quoting HTML tags:: Using direct HTML in Org-mode
9443 * Links in HTML export:: How links will be interpreted and formatted
9444 * Tables in HTML export:: How to modify the formatting of tables
9445 * Images in HTML export:: How to insert figures into HTML output
9446 * Math formatting in HTML export:: Beautiful math also on the web
9447 * Text areas in HTML export:: An alternative way to show an example
9448 * CSS support:: Changing the appearance of the output
9449 * JavaScript support:: Info and Folding in a web browser
9452 @node HTML Export commands, Quoting HTML tags, HTML export, HTML export
9453 @subsection HTML export commands
9455 @cindex region, active
9456 @cindex active region
9457 @cindex transient-mark-mode
9459 @orgcmd{C-c C-e h,org-export-as-html}
9460 @cindex property, EXPORT_FILE_NAME
9461 Export as HTML file @file{myfile.html}. For an Org file @file{myfile.org},
9462 the ASCII file will be @file{myfile.html}. The file will be overwritten
9463 without warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This requires
9464 @code{transient-mark-mode} be turned on.}, only the region will be
9465 exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
9466 current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will become the document
9467 title. If the tree head entry has, or inherits, an @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}
9468 property, that name will be used for the export.
9469 @orgcmd{C-c C-e b,org-export-as-html-and-open}
9470 Export as HTML file and immediately open it with a browser.
9471 @orgcmd{C-c C-e H,org-export-as-html-to-buffer}
9472 Export to a temporary buffer, do not create a file.
9473 @orgcmd{C-c C-e R,org-export-region-as-html}
9474 Export the active region to a temporary buffer. With a prefix argument, do
9475 not produce the file header and footer, but just the plain HTML section for
9476 the region. This is good for cut-and-paste operations.
9477 @item C-c C-e v h/b/H/R
9478 Export only the visible part of the document.
9479 @item M-x org-export-region-as-html
9480 Convert the region to HTML under the assumption that it was Org-mode
9481 syntax before. This is a global command that can be invoked in any
9483 @item M-x org-replace-region-by-HTML
9484 Replace the active region (assumed to be in Org-mode syntax) by HTML
9488 @cindex headline levels, for exporting
9489 In the exported version, the first 3 outline levels will become headlines,
9490 defining a general document structure. Additional levels will be exported as
9491 itemized lists. If you want that transition to occur at a different level,
9492 specify it with a numeric prefix argument. For example,
9499 creates two levels of headings and does the rest as items.
9501 @node Quoting HTML tags, Links in HTML export, HTML Export commands, HTML export
9502 @subsection Quoting HTML tags
9504 Plain @samp{<} and @samp{>} are always transformed to @samp{<} and
9505 @samp{>} in HTML export. If you want to include simple HTML tags
9506 which should be interpreted as such, mark them with @samp{@@} as in
9507 @samp{@@<b>bold text@@</b>}. Note that this really works only for
9508 simple tags. For more extensive HTML that should be copied verbatim to
9509 the exported file use either
9512 @cindex #+BEGIN_HTML
9514 #+HTML: Literal HTML code for export
9518 @cindex #+BEGIN_HTML
9522 All lines between these markers are exported literally
9527 @node Links in HTML export, Tables in HTML export, Quoting HTML tags, HTML export
9528 @subsection Links in HTML export
9530 @cindex links, in HTML export
9531 @cindex internal links, in HTML export
9532 @cindex external links, in HTML export
9533 Internal links (@pxref{Internal links}) will continue to work in HTML. This
9534 includes automatic links created by radio targets (@pxref{Radio
9535 targets}). Links to external files will still work if the target file is on
9536 the same @i{relative} path as the published Org file. Links to other
9537 @file{.org} files will be translated into HTML links under the assumption
9538 that an HTML version also exists of the linked file, at the same relative
9539 path. @samp{id:} links can then be used to jump to specific entries across
9540 files. For information related to linking files while publishing them to a
9541 publishing directory see @ref{Publishing links}.
9543 If you want to specify attributes for links, you can do so using a special
9544 @code{#+ATTR_HTML} line to define attributes that will be added to the
9545 @code{<a>} or @code{<img>} tags. Here is an example that sets @code{title}
9546 and @code{style} attributes for a link:
9550 #+ATTR_HTML: title="The Org-mode homepage" style="color:red;"
9551 [[http://orgmode.org]]
9554 @node Tables in HTML export, Images in HTML export, Links in HTML export, HTML export
9556 @cindex tables, in HTML
9557 @vindex org-export-html-table-tag
9559 Org-mode tables are exported to HTML using the table tag defined in
9560 @code{org-export-html-table-tag}. The default setting makes tables without
9561 cell borders and frame. If you would like to change this for individual
9562 tables, place something like the following before the table:
9567 #+CAPTION: This is a table with lines around and between cells
9568 #+ATTR_HTML: border="2" rules="all" frame="all"
9571 @node Images in HTML export, Math formatting in HTML export, Tables in HTML export, HTML export
9572 @subsection Images in HTML export
9574 @cindex images, inline in HTML
9575 @cindex inlining images in HTML
9576 @vindex org-export-html-inline-images
9577 HTML export can inline images given as links in the Org file, and
9578 it can make an image the clickable part of a link. By
9579 default@footnote{But see the variable
9580 @code{org-export-html-inline-images}.}, images are inlined if a link does
9581 not have a description. So @samp{[[file:myimg.jpg]]} will be inlined,
9582 while @samp{[[file:myimg.jpg][the image]]} will just produce a link
9583 @samp{the image} that points to the image. If the description part
9584 itself is a @code{file:} link or a @code{http:} URL pointing to an
9585 image, this image will be inlined and activated so that clicking on the
9586 image will activate the link. For example, to include a thumbnail that
9587 will link to a high resolution version of the image, you could use:
9590 [[file:highres.jpg][file:thumb.jpg]]
9593 If you need to add attributes to an inlined image, use a @code{#+ATTR_HTML}.
9594 In the example below we specify the @code{alt} and @code{title} attributes to
9595 support text viewers and accessibility, and align it to the right.
9600 #+CAPTION: A black cat stalking a spider
9601 #+ATTR_HTML: alt="cat/spider image" title="Action!" align="right"
9606 and you could use @code{http} addresses just as well.
9608 @node Math formatting in HTML export, Text areas in HTML export, Images in HTML export, HTML export
9609 @subsection Math formatting in HTML export
9613 La@TeX{} math snippets (@pxref{LaTeX fragments}) can be displayed in two
9614 different ways on HTML pages. The default is to use the
9615 @uref{http://www.mathjax.org, MathJax system} which should work out of the
9616 box with Org mode installation because @code{http://orgmode.org} serves
9617 @file{MathJax} for Org-mode users for small applications and for testing
9618 purposes. @b{If you plan to use this regularly or on pages with significant
9619 page views, you should install@footnote{Installation instructions can be
9620 found on the MathJax website, see
9621 @uref{http://www.mathjax.org/resources/docs/?installation.html}.} MathJax on
9622 your own server in order to limit the load of our server.} To configure
9623 @file{MathJax}, use the variable @code{org-export-html-mathjax-options} or
9624 insert something like the following into the buffer:
9627 #+MATHJAX: align:"left" mathml:t path:"/MathJax/MathJax.js"
9630 @noindent See the docstring of the variable
9631 @code{org-export-html-mathjax-options} for the meaning of the parameters in
9634 If you prefer, you can also request that La@TeX{} are processed into small
9635 images that will be inserted into the browser page. Before the availability
9636 of MathJax, this was the default method for Org files. This method requires
9637 that the @file{dvipng} program is available on your system. You can still
9638 get this processing with
9641 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:dvipng
9644 @node Text areas in HTML export, CSS support, Math formatting in HTML export, HTML export
9645 @subsection Text areas in HTML export
9647 @cindex text areas, in HTML
9648 An alternative way to publish literal code examples in HTML is to use text
9649 areas, where the example can even be edited before pasting it into an
9650 application. It is triggered by a @code{-t} switch at an @code{example} or
9651 @code{src} block. Using this switch disables any options for syntax and
9652 label highlighting, and line numbering, which may be present. You may also
9653 use @code{-h} and @code{-w} switches to specify the height and width of the
9654 text area, which default to the number of lines in the example, and 80,
9655 respectively. For example
9658 #+BEGIN_EXAMPLE -t -w 40
9659 (defun org-xor (a b)
9666 @node CSS support, JavaScript support, Text areas in HTML export, HTML export
9667 @subsection CSS support
9668 @cindex CSS, for HTML export
9669 @cindex HTML export, CSS
9671 @vindex org-export-html-todo-kwd-class-prefix
9672 @vindex org-export-html-tag-class-prefix
9673 You can also give style information for the exported file. The HTML exporter
9674 assigns the following special CSS classes@footnote{If the classes on TODO
9675 keywords and tags lead to conflicts, use the variables
9676 @code{org-export-html-todo-kwd-class-prefix} and
9677 @code{org-export-html-tag-class-prefix} to make them unique.} to appropriate
9678 parts of the document---your style specifications may change these, in
9679 addition to any of the standard classes like for headlines, tables, etc.
9681 p.author @r{author information, including email}
9682 p.date @r{publishing date}
9683 p.creator @r{creator info, about org-mode version}
9684 .title @r{document title}
9685 .todo @r{TODO keywords, all not-done states}
9686 .done @r{the DONE keywords, all stated the count as done}
9687 .WAITING @r{each TODO keyword also uses a class named after itself}
9688 .timestamp @r{timestamp}
9689 .timestamp-kwd @r{keyword associated with a timestamp, like SCHEDULED}
9690 .timestamp-wrapper @r{span around keyword plus timestamp}
9691 .tag @r{tag in a headline}
9692 ._HOME @r{each tag uses itself as a class, "@@" replaced by "_"}
9693 .target @r{target for links}
9694 .linenr @r{the line number in a code example}
9695 .code-highlighted @r{for highlighting referenced code lines}
9696 div.outline-N @r{div for outline level N (headline plus text))}
9697 div.outline-text-N @r{extra div for text at outline level N}
9698 .section-number-N @r{section number in headlines, different for each level}
9699 div.figure @r{how to format an inlined image}
9700 pre.src @r{formatted source code}
9701 pre.example @r{normal example}
9702 p.verse @r{verse paragraph}
9703 div.footnotes @r{footnote section headline}
9704 p.footnote @r{footnote definition paragraph, containing a footnote}
9705 .footref @r{a footnote reference number (always a <sup>)}
9706 .footnum @r{footnote number in footnote definition (always <sup>)}
9709 @vindex org-export-html-style-default
9710 @vindex org-export-html-style-include-default
9711 @vindex org-export-html-style
9712 @vindex org-export-html-extra
9713 @vindex org-export-html-style-default
9714 Each exported file contains a compact default style that defines these
9715 classes in a basic way@footnote{This style is defined in the constant
9716 @code{org-export-html-style-default}, which you should not modify. To turn
9717 inclusion of these defaults off, customize
9718 @code{org-export-html-style-include-default}}. You may overwrite these
9719 settings, or add to them by using the variables @code{org-export-html-style}
9720 (for Org-wide settings) and @code{org-export-html-style-extra} (for more
9721 granular settings, like file-local settings). To set the latter variable
9722 individually for each file, you can use
9726 #+STYLE: <link rel="stylesheet" type="text/css" href="stylesheet.css" />
9730 For longer style definitions, you can use several such lines. You could also
9731 directly write a @code{<style>} @code{</style>} section in this way, without
9732 referring to an external file.
9734 In order to add styles to a subtree, use the @code{:HTML_CONTAINER_CLASS:}
9735 property to assign a class to the tree. In order to specify CSS styles for a
9736 particular headline, you can use the id specified in a @code{:CUSTOM_ID:}
9739 @c FIXME: More about header and footer styles
9740 @c FIXME: Talk about links and targets.
9742 @node JavaScript support, , CSS support, HTML export
9743 @subsection JavaScript supported display of web pages
9745 @cindex Rose, Sebastian
9746 Sebastian Rose has written a JavaScript program especially designed to
9747 enhance the web viewing experience of HTML files created with Org. This
9748 program allows you to view large files in two different ways. The first one
9749 is an @emph{Info}-like mode where each section is displayed separately and
9750 navigation can be done with the @kbd{n} and @kbd{p} keys (and some other keys
9751 as well, press @kbd{?} for an overview of the available keys). The second
9752 view type is a @emph{folding} view much like Org provides inside Emacs. The
9753 script is available at @url{http://orgmode.org/org-info.js} and you can find
9754 the documentation for it at @url{http://orgmode.org/worg/code/org-info-js/}.
9755 We host the script at our site, but if you use it a lot, you might
9756 not want to be dependent on @url{orgmode.org} and prefer to install a local
9757 copy on your own web server.
9759 To use the script, you need to make sure that the @file{org-jsinfo.el} module
9760 gets loaded. It should be loaded by default, but you can try @kbd{M-x
9761 customize-variable @key{RET} org-modules @key{RET}} to convince yourself that
9762 this is indeed the case. All it then takes to make use of the program is
9763 adding a single line to the Org file:
9765 @cindex #+INFOJS_OPT
9767 #+INFOJS_OPT: view:info toc:nil
9771 If this line is found, the HTML header will automatically contain the code
9772 needed to invoke the script. Using the line above, you can set the following
9776 path: @r{The path to the script. The default is to grab the script from}
9777 @r{@url{http://orgmode.org/org-info.js}, but you might want to have}
9778 @r{a local copy and use a path like @samp{../scripts/org-info.js}.}
9779 view: @r{Initial view when website is first shown. Possible values are:}
9780 info @r{Info-like interface with one section per page.}
9781 overview @r{Folding interface, initially showing only top-level.}
9782 content @r{Folding interface, starting with all headlines visible.}
9783 showall @r{Folding interface, all headlines and text visible.}
9784 sdepth: @r{Maximum headline level that will still become an independent}
9785 @r{section for info and folding modes. The default is taken from}
9786 @r{@code{org-export-headline-levels} (= the @code{H} switch in @code{#+OPTIONS}).}
9787 @r{If this is smaller than in @code{org-export-headline-levels}, each}
9788 @r{info/folding section can still contain child headlines.}
9789 toc: @r{Should the table of content @emph{initially} be visible?}
9790 @r{Even when @code{nil}, you can always get to the "toc" with @kbd{i}.}
9791 tdepth: @r{The depth of the table of contents. The defaults are taken from}
9792 @r{the variables @code{org-export-headline-levels} and @code{org-export-with-toc}.}
9793 ftoc: @r{Does the css of the page specify a fixed position for the "toc"?}
9794 @r{If yes, the toc will never be displayed as a section.}
9795 ltoc: @r{Should there be short contents (children) in each section?}
9796 @r{Make this @code{above} if the section should be above initial text.}
9797 mouse: @r{Headings are highlighted when the mouse is over them. Should be}
9798 @r{@samp{underline} (default) or a background color like @samp{#cccccc}.}
9799 buttons: @r{Should view-toggle buttons be everywhere? When @code{nil} (the}
9800 @r{default), only one such button will be present.}
9803 @vindex org-infojs-options
9804 @vindex org-export-html-use-infojs
9805 You can choose default values for these options by customizing the variable
9806 @code{org-infojs-options}. If you always want to apply the script to your
9807 pages, configure the variable @code{org-export-html-use-infojs}.
9809 @node LaTeX and PDF export, DocBook export, HTML export, Exporting
9810 @section La@TeX{} and PDF export
9811 @cindex La@TeX{} export
9813 @cindex Guerry, Bastien
9815 Org-mode contains a La@TeX{} exporter written by Bastien Guerry. With
9816 further processing@footnote{The default LaTeX output is designed for
9817 processing with pdftex or latex. It includes packages that are not
9818 compatible with xetex and possibly luatex. See the variables
9819 @code{org-export-latex-default-packages-alist} and
9820 @code{org-export-latex-packages-alist}.}, this backend is also used to
9821 produce PDF output. Since the La@TeX{} output uses @file{hyperref} to
9822 implement links and cross references, the PDF output file will be fully
9826 * LaTeX/PDF export commands:: Which key invokes which commands
9827 * Header and sectioning:: Setting up the export file structure
9828 * Quoting LaTeX code:: Incorporating literal La@TeX{} code
9829 * Tables in LaTeX export:: Options for exporting tables to La@TeX{}
9830 * Images in LaTeX export:: How to insert figures into La@TeX{} output
9831 * Beamer class export:: Turning the file into a presentation
9834 @node LaTeX/PDF export commands, Header and sectioning, LaTeX and PDF export, LaTeX and PDF export
9835 @subsection La@TeX{} export commands
9837 @cindex region, active
9838 @cindex active region
9839 @cindex transient-mark-mode
9841 @orgcmd{C-c C-e l,org-export-as-latex}
9842 @cindex property EXPORT_FILE_NAME
9843 Export as La@TeX{} file @file{myfile.tex}. For an Org file
9844 @file{myfile.org}, the ASCII file will be @file{myfile.tex}. The file will
9845 be overwritten without warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This
9846 requires @code{transient-mark-mode} be turned on.}, only the region will be
9847 exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
9848 current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will become the document
9849 title. If the tree head entry has or inherits an @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}
9850 property, that name will be used for the export.
9851 @orgcmd{C-c C-e L,org-export-as-latex-to-buffer}
9852 Export to a temporary buffer, do not create a file.
9854 Export only the visible part of the document.
9855 @item M-x org-export-region-as-latex
9856 Convert the region to La@TeX{} under the assumption that it was Org-mode
9857 syntax before. This is a global command that can be invoked in any
9859 @item M-x org-replace-region-by-latex
9860 Replace the active region (assumed to be in Org-mode syntax) by La@TeX{}
9862 @orgcmd{C-c C-e p,org-export-as-pdf}
9863 Export as La@TeX{} and then process to PDF.
9864 @orgcmd{C-c C-e d,org-export-as-pdf-and-open}
9865 Export as La@TeX{} and then process to PDF, then open the resulting PDF file.
9868 @cindex headline levels, for exporting
9869 @vindex org-latex-low-levels
9870 In the exported version, the first 3 outline levels will become
9871 headlines, defining a general document structure. Additional levels
9872 will be exported as description lists. The exporter can ignore them or
9873 convert them to a custom string depending on
9874 @code{org-latex-low-levels}.
9876 If you want that transition to occur at a different level, specify it
9877 with a numeric prefix argument. For example,
9884 creates two levels of headings and does the rest as items.
9886 @node Header and sectioning, Quoting LaTeX code, LaTeX/PDF export commands, LaTeX and PDF export
9887 @subsection Header and sectioning structure
9888 @cindex La@TeX{} class
9889 @cindex La@TeX{} sectioning structure
9890 @cindex La@TeX{} header
9891 @cindex header, for LaTeX files
9892 @cindex sectioning structure, for LaTeX export
9894 By default, the La@TeX{} output uses the class @code{article}.
9896 @vindex org-export-latex-default-class
9897 @vindex org-export-latex-classes
9898 @vindex org-export-latex-default-packages-alist
9899 @vindex org-export-latex-packages-alist
9900 @cindex #+LATEX_HEADER
9901 @cindex #+LATEX_CLASS
9902 @cindex #+LATEX_CLASS_OPTIONS
9903 @cindex property, LATEX_CLASS
9904 @cindex property, LATEX_CLASS_OPTIONS
9905 You can change this globally by setting a different value for
9906 @code{org-export-latex-default-class} or locally by adding an option like
9907 @code{#+LaTeX_CLASS: myclass} in your file, or with a @code{:LaTeX_CLASS:}
9908 property that applies when exporting a region containing only this (sub)tree.
9909 The class must be listed in @code{org-export-latex-classes}. This variable
9910 defines a header template for each class@footnote{Into which the values of
9911 @code{org-export-latex-default-packages-alist} and
9912 @code{org-export-latex-packages-alist} are spliced.}, and allows you to
9913 define the sectioning structure for each class. You can also define your own
9914 classes there. @code{#+LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS} or a @code{LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS}
9915 property can specify the options for the @code{\documentclass} macro. You
9916 can also use @code{#+LATEX_HEADER: \usepackage@{xyz@}} to add lines to the
9917 header. See the docstring of @code{org-export-latex-classes} for more
9920 @node Quoting LaTeX code, Tables in LaTeX export, Header and sectioning, LaTeX and PDF export
9921 @subsection Quoting La@TeX{} code
9923 Embedded La@TeX{} as described in @ref{Embedded LaTeX}, will be correctly
9924 inserted into the La@TeX{} file. This includes simple macros like
9925 @samp{\ref@{LABEL@}} to create a cross reference to a figure. Furthermore,
9926 you can add special code that should only be present in La@TeX{} export with
9927 the following constructs:
9930 @cindex #+BEGIN_LaTeX
9932 #+LaTeX: Literal LaTeX code for export
9936 @cindex #+BEGIN_LaTeX
9940 All lines between these markers are exported literally
9945 @node Tables in LaTeX export, Images in LaTeX export, Quoting LaTeX code, LaTeX and PDF export
9946 @subsection Tables in La@TeX{} export
9947 @cindex tables, in La@TeX{} export
9949 For La@TeX{} export of a table, you can specify a label and a caption
9950 (@pxref{Images and tables}). You can also use the @code{ATTR_LaTeX} line to
9951 request a @code{longtable} environment for the table, so that it may span
9952 several pages, or provide the @code{multicolumn} keyword that will make the
9953 table span the page in a multicolumn environment (@code{table*} environment).
9954 Finally, you can set the alignment string:
9958 @cindex #+ATTR_LaTeX
9960 #+CAPTION: A long table
9962 #+ATTR_LaTeX: longtable align=l|lp@{3cm@}r|l
9968 @node Images in LaTeX export, Beamer class export, Tables in LaTeX export, LaTeX and PDF export
9969 @subsection Images in La@TeX{} export
9970 @cindex images, inline in La@TeX{}
9971 @cindex inlining images in La@TeX{}
9973 Images that are linked to without a description part in the link, like
9974 @samp{[[file:img.jpg]]} or @samp{[[./img.jpg]]} will be inserted into the PDF
9975 output file resulting from La@TeX{} processing. Org will use an
9976 @code{\includegraphics} macro to insert the image. If you have specified a
9977 caption and/or a label as described in @ref{Images and tables}, the figure
9978 will be wrapped into a @code{figure} environment and thus become a floating
9979 element. You can use an @code{#+ATTR_LaTeX:} line to specify the various
9980 options that can be used in the optional argument of the
9981 @code{\includegraphics} macro. To modify the placement option of the
9982 @code{figure} environment, add something like @samp{placement=[h!]} to the
9985 If you would like to let text flow around the image, add the word @samp{wrap}
9986 to the @code{#+ATTR_LaTeX:} line, which will make the figure occupy the left
9987 half of the page. To fine-tune, the @code{placement} field will be the set
9988 of additional arguments needed by the @code{wrapfigure} environment. Note
9989 that if you change the size of the image, you need to use compatible settings
9990 for @code{\includegraphics} and @code{wrapfigure}.
9994 @cindex #+ATTR_LaTeX
9996 #+CAPTION: The black-body emission of the disk around HR 4049
9997 #+LABEL: fig:SED-HR4049
9998 #+ATTR_LaTeX: width=5cm,angle=90
9999 [[./img/sed-hr4049.pdf]]
10001 #+ATTR_LaTeX: width=0.38\textwidth wrap placement=@{r@}@{0.4\textwidth@}
10005 If you need references to a label created in this way, write
10006 @samp{\ref@{fig:SED-HR4049@}} just like in La@TeX{}.
10008 @node Beamer class export, , Images in LaTeX export, LaTeX and PDF export
10009 @subsection Beamer class export
10011 The LaTeX class @file{beamer} allows production of high quality presentations
10012 using LaTeX and pdf processing. Org-mode has special support for turning an
10013 Org-mode file or tree into a @file{beamer} presentation.
10015 When the LaTeX class for the current buffer (as set with @code{#+LaTeX_CLASS:
10016 beamer}) or subtree (set with a @code{LaTeX_CLASS} property) is
10017 @code{beamer}, a special export mode will turn the file or tree into a beamer
10018 presentation. Any tree with not-too-deep level nesting should in principle be
10019 exportable as a beamer presentation. By default, the top-level entries (or
10020 the first level below the selected subtree heading) will be turned into
10021 frames, and the outline structure below this level will become itemize lists.
10022 You can also configure the variable @code{org-beamer-frame-level} to a
10023 different level - then the hierarchy above frames will produce the sectioning
10024 structure of the presentation.
10026 A template for useful in-buffer settings or properties can be inserted into
10027 the buffer with @kbd{M-x org-insert-beamer-options-template}. Among other
10028 things, this will install a column view format which is very handy for
10029 editing special properties used by beamer.
10031 You can influence the structure of the presentation using the following
10036 The environment that should be used to format this entry. Valid environments
10037 are defined in the constant @code{org-beamer-environments-default}, and you
10038 can define more in @code{org-beamer-environments-extra}. If this property is
10039 set, the entry will also get a @code{:B_environment:} tag to make this
10040 visible. This tag has no semantic meaning, it is only a visual aid.
10041 @item BEAMER_envargs
10042 The beamer-special arguments that should be used for the environment, like
10043 @code{[t]} or @code{[<+->]} of @code{<2-3>}. If the @code{BEAMER_col}
10044 property is also set, something like @code{C[t]} can be added here as well to
10045 set an options argument for the implied @code{columns} environment.
10046 @code{c[t]} or @code{c<2->} will set an options for the implied @code{column}
10049 The width of a column that should start with this entry. If this property is
10050 set, the entry will also get a @code{:BMCOL:} property to make this visible.
10051 Also this tag is only a visual aid. When this is a plain number, it will be
10052 interpreted as a fraction of @code{\textwidth}. Otherwise it will be assumed
10053 that you have specified the units, like @samp{3cm}. The first such property
10054 in a frame will start a @code{columns} environment to surround the columns.
10055 This environment is closed when an entry has a @code{BEAMER_col} property
10056 with value 0 or 1, or automatically at the end of the frame.
10058 Additional commands that should be inserted after the environment has been
10059 opened. For example, when creating a frame, this can be used to specify
10063 Frames will automatically receive a @code{fragile} option if they contain
10064 source code that uses the verbatim environment. Special @file{beamer}
10065 specific code can be inserted using @code{#+BEAMER:} and
10066 @code{#+BEGIN_beamer...#+end_beamer} constructs, similar to other export
10067 backends, but with the difference that @code{#+LaTeX:} stuff will be included
10068 in the presentation as well.
10070 Outline nodes with @code{BEAMER_env} property value @samp{note} or
10071 @samp{noteNH} will be formatted as beamer notes, i,e, they will be wrapped
10072 into @code{\note@{...@}}. The former will include the heading as part of the
10073 note text, the latter will ignore the heading of that node. To simplify note
10074 generation, it is actually enough to mark the note with a @emph{tag} (either
10075 @code{:B_note:} or @code{:B_noteNH:}) instead of creating the
10076 @code{BEAMER_env} property.
10078 You can turn on a special minor mode @code{org-beamer-mode} for editing
10086 @orgcmd{C-c C-b,org-beamer-select-environment}
10087 In @code{org-beamer-mode}, this key offers fast selection of a beamer
10088 environment or the @code{BEAMER_col} property.
10091 Column view provides a great way to set the environment of a node and other
10092 important parameters. Make sure you are using a COLUMN format that is geared
10093 toward this special purpose. The command @kbd{M-x
10094 org-insert-beamer-options-template} defines such a format.
10096 Here is a simple example Org document that is intended for beamer export.
10099 #+LaTeX_CLASS: beamer
10100 #+TITLE: Example Presentation
10101 #+AUTHOR: Carsten Dominik
10102 #+LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS: [presentation]
10103 #+BEAMER_FRAME_LEVEL: 2
10104 #+BEAMER_HEADER_EXTRA: \usetheme@{Madrid@}\usecolortheme@{default@}
10105 #+COLUMNS: %35ITEM %10BEAMER_env(Env) %10BEAMER_envargs(Args) %4BEAMER_col(Col) %8BEAMER_extra(Ex)
10107 * This is the first structural section
10109 ** Frame 1 \\ with a subtitle
10110 *** Thanks to Eric Fraga :BMCOL:B_block:
10113 :BEAMER_envargs: C[t]
10116 for the first viable beamer setup in Org
10117 *** Thanks to everyone else :BMCOL:B_block:
10121 :BEAMER_envargs: <2->
10123 for contributing to the discussion
10124 **** This will be formatted as a beamer note :B_note:
10125 ** Frame 2 \\ where we will not use columns
10126 *** Request :B_block:
10127 Please test this stuff!
10133 For more information, see the documentation on Worg.
10135 @node DocBook export, TaskJuggler export, LaTeX and PDF export, Exporting
10136 @section DocBook export
10137 @cindex DocBook export
10139 @cindex Cui, Baoqiu
10141 Org contains a DocBook exporter written by Baoqiu Cui. Once an Org file is
10142 exported to DocBook format, it can be further processed to produce other
10143 formats, including PDF, HTML, man pages, etc., using many available DocBook
10144 tools and stylesheets.
10146 Currently DocBook exporter only supports DocBook V5.0.
10149 * DocBook export commands:: How to invoke DocBook export
10150 * Quoting DocBook code:: Incorporating DocBook code in Org files
10151 * Recursive sections:: Recursive sections in DocBook
10152 * Tables in DocBook export:: Tables are exported as HTML tables
10153 * Images in DocBook export:: How to insert figures into DocBook output
10154 * Special characters:: How to handle special characters
10157 @node DocBook export commands, Quoting DocBook code, DocBook export, DocBook export
10158 @subsection DocBook export commands
10160 @cindex region, active
10161 @cindex active region
10162 @cindex transient-mark-mode
10164 @orgcmd{C-c C-e D,org-export-as-docbook}
10165 @cindex property EXPORT_FILE_NAME
10166 Export as DocBook file. For an Org file, @file{myfile.org}, the DocBook XML
10167 file will be @file{myfile.xml}. The file will be overwritten without
10168 warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This requires
10169 @code{transient-mark-mode} to be turned on}, only the region will be
10170 exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
10171 current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will become the document
10172 title. If the tree head entry has, or inherits, an @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}
10173 property, that name will be used for the export.
10174 @orgcmd{C-c C-e V,org-export-as-docbook-pdf-and-open}
10175 Export as DocBook file, process to PDF, then open the resulting PDF file.
10177 @vindex org-export-docbook-xslt-proc-command
10178 @vindex org-export-docbook-xsl-fo-proc-command
10179 Note that, in order to produce PDF output based on exported DocBook file, you
10180 need to have XSLT processor and XSL-FO processor software installed on your
10181 system. Check variables @code{org-export-docbook-xslt-proc-command} and
10182 @code{org-export-docbook-xsl-fo-proc-command}.
10184 @vindex org-export-docbook-xslt-stylesheet
10185 The stylesheet argument @code{%s} in variable
10186 @code{org-export-docbook-xslt-proc-command} is replaced by the value of
10187 variable @code{org-export-docbook-xslt-stylesheet}, which needs to be set by
10188 the user. You can also overrule this global setting on a per-file basis by
10189 adding an in-buffer setting @code{#+XSLT:} to the Org file.
10191 @orgkey{C-c C-e v D}
10192 Export only the visible part of the document.
10195 @node Quoting DocBook code, Recursive sections, DocBook export commands, DocBook export
10196 @subsection Quoting DocBook code
10198 You can quote DocBook code in Org files and copy it verbatim into exported
10199 DocBook file with the following constructs:
10202 @cindex #+BEGIN_DOCBOOK
10204 #+DOCBOOK: Literal DocBook code for export
10208 @cindex #+BEGIN_DOCBOOK
10212 All lines between these markers are exported by DocBook exporter
10217 For example, you can use the following lines to include a DocBook warning
10218 admonition. As to what this warning says, you should pay attention to the
10219 document context when quoting DocBook code in Org files. You may make
10220 exported DocBook XML files invalid by not quoting DocBook code correctly.
10225 <para>You should know what you are doing when quoting DocBook XML code
10226 in your Org file. Invalid DocBook XML file may be generated by
10227 DocBook exporter if you are not careful!</para>
10232 @node Recursive sections, Tables in DocBook export, Quoting DocBook code, DocBook export
10233 @subsection Recursive sections
10234 @cindex DocBook recursive sections
10236 DocBook exporter exports Org files as articles using the @code{article}
10237 element in DocBook. Recursive sections, i.e. @code{section} elements, are
10238 used in exported articles. Top level headlines in Org files are exported as
10239 top level sections, and lower level headlines are exported as nested
10240 sections. The entire structure of Org files will be exported completely, no
10241 matter how many nested levels of headlines there are.
10243 Using recursive sections makes it easy to port and reuse exported DocBook
10244 code in other DocBook document types like @code{book} or @code{set}.
10246 @node Tables in DocBook export, Images in DocBook export, Recursive sections, DocBook export
10247 @subsection Tables in DocBook export
10248 @cindex tables, in DocBook export
10250 Tables in Org files are exported as HTML tables, which have been supported since
10253 If a table does not have a caption, an informal table is generated using the
10254 @code{informaltable} element; otherwise, a formal table will be generated
10255 using the @code{table} element.
10257 @node Images in DocBook export, Special characters, Tables in DocBook export, DocBook export
10258 @subsection Images in DocBook export
10259 @cindex images, inline in DocBook
10260 @cindex inlining images in DocBook
10262 Images that are linked to without a description part in the link, like
10263 @samp{[[file:img.jpg]]} or @samp{[[./img.jpg]]}, will be exported to DocBook
10264 using @code{mediaobject} elements. Each @code{mediaobject} element contains
10265 an @code{imageobject} that wraps an @code{imagedata} element. If you have
10266 specified a caption for an image as described in @ref{Images and tables}, a
10267 @code{caption} element will be added in @code{mediaobject}. If a label is
10268 also specified, it will be exported as an @code{xml:id} attribute of the
10269 @code{mediaobject} element.
10271 @vindex org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes
10272 Image attributes supported by the @code{imagedata} element, like @code{align}
10273 or @code{width}, can be specified in two ways: you can either customize
10274 variable @code{org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes} or use the
10275 @code{#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:} line. Attributes specified in variable
10276 @code{org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes} are applied to all inline
10277 images in the Org file to be exported (unless they are overridden by image
10278 attributes specified in @code{#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:} lines).
10280 The @code{#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:} line can be used to specify additional image
10281 attributes or override default image attributes for individual images. If
10282 the same attribute appears in both the @code{#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:} line and
10283 variable @code{org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes}, the former
10284 takes precedence. Here is an example about how image attributes can be
10289 @cindex #+ATTR_DOCBOOK
10291 #+CAPTION: The logo of Org-mode
10292 #+LABEL: unicorn-svg
10293 #+ATTR_DOCBOOK: scalefit="1" width="100%" depth="100%"
10294 [[./img/org-mode-unicorn.svg]]
10297 @vindex org-export-docbook-inline-image-extensions
10298 By default, DocBook exporter recognizes the following image file types:
10299 @file{jpeg}, @file{jpg}, @file{png}, @file{gif}, and @file{svg}. You can
10300 customize variable @code{org-export-docbook-inline-image-extensions} to add
10301 more types to this list as long as DocBook supports them.
10303 @node Special characters, , Images in DocBook export, DocBook export
10304 @subsection Special characters in DocBook export
10305 @cindex Special characters in DocBook export
10307 @vindex org-export-docbook-doctype
10308 @vindex org-entities
10309 Special characters that are written in @TeX{}-like syntax, such as @code{\alpha},
10310 @code{\Gamma}, and @code{\Zeta}, are supported by DocBook exporter. These
10311 characters are rewritten to XML entities, like @code{α},
10312 @code{Γ}, and @code{Ζ}, based on the list saved in variable
10313 @code{org-entities}. As long as the generated DocBook file includes the
10314 corresponding entities, these special characters are recognized.
10316 You can customize variable @code{org-export-docbook-doctype} to include the
10317 entities you need. For example, you can set variable
10318 @code{org-export-docbook-doctype} to the following value to recognize all
10319 special characters included in XHTML entities:
10322 "<!DOCTYPE article [
10323 <!ENTITY % xhtml1-symbol PUBLIC
10324 \"-//W3C//ENTITIES Symbol for HTML//EN//XML\"
10325 \"http://www.w3.org/2003/entities/2007/xhtml1-symbol.ent\"
10332 @node TaskJuggler export, Freemind export, DocBook export, Exporting
10333 @section TaskJuggler export
10334 @cindex TaskJuggler export
10335 @cindex Project management
10337 @uref{http://www.taskjuggler.org/, TaskJuggler} is a project management tool.
10338 It provides an optimizing scheduler that computes your project time lines and
10339 resource assignments based on the project outline and the constraints that
10342 The TaskJuggler exporter is a bit different from other exporters, such as the
10343 HTML and LaTeX exporters for example, in that it does not export all the
10344 nodes of a document or strictly follow the order of the nodes in the
10347 Instead the TaskJuggler exporter looks for a tree that defines the tasks and
10348 a optionally tree that defines the resources for this project. It then
10349 creates a TaskJuggler file based on these trees and the attributes defined in
10352 @subsection TaskJuggler export commands
10355 @orgcmd{C-c C-e j,org-export-as-taskjuggler}
10356 Export as TaskJuggler file.
10358 @orgcmd{C-c C-e J,org-export-as-taskjuggler-and-open}
10359 Export as TaskJuggler file and then open the file with TaskJugglerUI.
10364 @vindex org-export-taskjuggler-project-tag
10365 Create your tasks as you usually do with Org-mode. Assign efforts to each
10366 task using properties (it's easiest to do this in the column view). You
10367 should end up with something similar to the example by Peter Jones in
10368 @url{http://www.contextualdevelopment.com/static/artifacts/articles/2008/project-planning/project-planning.org}.
10369 Now mark the top node of your tasks with a tag named
10370 @code{:taskjuggler_project:} (or whatever you customized
10371 @code{org-export-taskjuggler-project-tag} to). You are now ready to export
10372 the project plan with @kbd{C-c C-e J} which will export the project plan and
10373 open a gantt chart in TaskJugglerUI.
10375 @subsection Resources
10377 @vindex org-export-taskjuggler-resource-tag
10378 Next you can define resources and assign those to work on specific tasks. You
10379 can group your resources hierarchically. Tag the top node of the resources
10380 with @code{:taskjuggler_resource:} (or whatever you customized
10381 @code{org-export-taskjuggler-resource-tag} to). You can optionally assign an
10382 identifier (named @samp{resource_id}) to the resources (using the standard
10383 Org properties commands, @pxref{Property syntax}) or you can let the exporter
10384 generate identifiers automatically (the exporter picks the first word of the
10385 headline as the identifier as long as it is unique, see the documentation of
10386 @code{org-taskjuggler-get-unique-id}). Using that identifier you can then
10387 allocate resources to tasks. This is again done with the @samp{allocate}
10388 property on the tasks. Do this in column view or when on the task type
10389 @kbd{C-c C-x p allocate @key{RET} <resource_id> @key{RET}}.
10391 Once the allocations are done you can again export to TaskJuggler and check
10392 in the Resource Allocation Graph which person is working on what task at what
10395 @subsection Export of properties
10397 The exporter also takes TODO state information into consideration, i.e. if a
10398 task is marked as done it will have the corresponding attribute in
10399 TaskJuggler (@samp{complete 100}). Also it will export any property on a task
10400 resource or resource node which is known to TaskJuggler, such as
10401 @samp{limits}, @samp{vacation}, @samp{shift}, @samp{booking},
10402 @samp{efficiency}, @samp{journalentry}, @samp{rate} for resources or
10403 @samp{account}, @samp{start}, @samp{note}, @samp{duration}, @samp{end},
10404 @samp{journalentry}, @samp{milestone}, @samp{reference}, @samp{responsible},
10405 @samp{scheduling}, etc for tasks.
10407 @subsection Dependencies
10409 The exporter will handle dependencies that are defined in the tasks either
10410 with the @samp{ORDERED} attribute (@pxref{TODO dependencies}), with the
10411 @samp{BLOCKER} attribute (see org-depend.el) or alternatively with a
10412 @samp{depends} attribute. Both the @samp{BLOCKER} and the @samp{depends}
10413 attribute can be either @samp{previous-sibling} or a reference to an
10414 identifier (named @samp{task_id}) which is defined for another task in the
10415 project. @samp{BLOCKER} and the @samp{depends} attribute can define multiple
10416 dependencies separated by either space or comma. You can also specify
10417 optional attributes on the dependency by simply appending it. The following
10418 examples should illustrate this:
10423 :task_id: preparation
10426 * Training material
10428 :task_id: training_material
10431 ** Markup Guidelines
10435 ** Workflow Guidelines
10442 :BLOCKER: training_material @{ gapduration 1d @} preparation
10446 @subsection Reports
10448 @vindex org-export-taskjuggler-default-reports
10449 TaskJuggler can produce many kinds of reports (e.g. gantt chart, resource
10450 allocation, etc). The user defines what kind of reports should be generated
10451 for a project in the TaskJuggler file. The exporter will automatically insert
10452 some default reports in the file. These defaults are defined in
10453 @code{org-export-taskjuggler-default-reports}. They can be modified using
10454 customize along with a number of other options. For a more complete list, see
10455 @kbd{M-x customize-group @key{RET} org-export-taskjuggler @key{RET}}.
10457 For more information and examples see the Org-taskjuggler tutorial at
10458 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-tutorials/org-taskjuggler.php}.
10460 @node Freemind export, XOXO export, TaskJuggler export, Exporting
10461 @section Freemind export
10462 @cindex Freemind export
10465 The Freemind exporter was written by Lennart Borgman.
10468 @orgcmd{C-c C-e m,org-export-as-freemind}
10469 Export as Freemind mind map @file{myfile.mm}.
10472 @node XOXO export, iCalendar export, Freemind export, Exporting
10473 @section XOXO export
10474 @cindex XOXO export
10476 Org-mode contains an exporter that produces XOXO-style output.
10477 Currently, this exporter only handles the general outline structure and
10478 does not interpret any additional Org-mode features.
10481 @orgcmd{C-c C-e x,org-export-as-xoxo}
10482 Export as XOXO file @file{myfile.html}.
10483 @orgkey{C-c C-e v x}
10484 Export only the visible part of the document.
10487 @node iCalendar export, , XOXO export, Exporting
10488 @section iCalendar export
10489 @cindex iCalendar export
10491 @vindex org-icalendar-include-todo
10492 @vindex org-icalendar-use-deadline
10493 @vindex org-icalendar-use-scheduled
10494 @vindex org-icalendar-categories
10495 @vindex org-icalendar-alarm-time
10496 Some people use Org-mode for keeping track of projects, but still prefer a
10497 standard calendar application for anniversaries and appointments. In this
10498 case it can be useful to show deadlines and other time-stamped items in Org
10499 files in the calendar application. Org-mode can export calendar information
10500 in the standard iCalendar format. If you also want to have TODO entries
10501 included in the export, configure the variable
10502 @code{org-icalendar-include-todo}. Plain timestamps are exported as VEVENT,
10503 and TODO items as VTODO. It will also create events from deadlines that are
10504 in non-TODO items. Deadlines and scheduling dates in TODO items will be used
10505 to set the start and due dates for the TODO entry@footnote{See the variables
10506 @code{org-icalendar-use-deadline} and @code{org-icalendar-use-scheduled}.}.
10507 As categories, it will use the tags locally defined in the heading, and the
10508 file/tree category@footnote{To add inherited tags or the TODO state,
10509 configure the variable @code{org-icalendar-categories}.}. See the variable
10510 @code{org-icalendar-alarm-time} for a way to assign alarms to entries with a
10513 @vindex org-icalendar-store-UID
10514 @cindex property, ID
10515 The iCalendar standard requires each entry to have a globally unique
10516 identifier (UID). Org creates these identifiers during export. If you set
10517 the variable @code{org-icalendar-store-UID}, the UID will be stored in the
10518 @code{:ID:} property of the entry and re-used next time you report this
10519 entry. Since a single entry can give rise to multiple iCalendar entries (as
10520 a timestamp, a deadline, a scheduled item, and as a TODO item), Org adds
10521 prefixes to the UID, depending on what triggered the inclusion of the entry.
10522 In this way the UID remains unique, but a synchronization program can still
10523 figure out from which entry all the different instances originate.
10526 @orgcmd{C-c C-e i,org-export-icalendar-this-file}
10527 Create iCalendar entries for the current file and store them in the same
10528 directory, using a file extension @file{.ics}.
10529 @orgcmd{C-c C-e I, org-export-icalendar-all-agenda-files}
10530 @vindex org-agenda-files
10531 Like @kbd{C-c C-e i}, but do this for all files in
10532 @code{org-agenda-files}. For each of these files, a separate iCalendar
10533 file will be written.
10534 @orgcmd{C-c C-e c,org-export-icalendar-combine-agenda-files}
10535 @vindex org-combined-agenda-icalendar-file
10536 Create a single large iCalendar file from all files in
10537 @code{org-agenda-files} and write it to the file given by
10538 @code{org-combined-agenda-icalendar-file}.
10541 @vindex org-use-property-inheritance
10542 @vindex org-icalendar-include-body
10543 @cindex property, SUMMARY
10544 @cindex property, DESCRIPTION
10545 @cindex property, LOCATION
10546 The export will honor SUMMARY, DESCRIPTION and LOCATION@footnote{The LOCATION
10547 property can be inherited from higher in the hierarchy if you configure
10548 @code{org-use-property-inheritance} accordingly.} properties if the selected
10549 entries have them. If not, the summary will be derived from the headline,
10550 and the description from the body (limited to
10551 @code{org-icalendar-include-body} characters).
10553 How this calendar is best read and updated, depends on the application
10554 you are using. The FAQ covers this issue.
10556 @node Publishing, Working With Source Code, Exporting, Top
10557 @chapter Publishing
10560 Org includes a publishing management system that allows you to configure
10561 automatic HTML conversion of @emph{projects} composed of interlinked org
10562 files. You can also configure Org to automatically upload your exported HTML
10563 pages and related attachments, such as images and source code files, to a web
10566 You can also use Org to convert files into PDF, or even combine HTML and PDF
10567 conversion so that files are available in both formats on the server.
10569 Publishing has been contributed to Org by David O'Toole.
10572 * Configuration:: Defining projects
10573 * Uploading files:: How to get files up on the server
10574 * Sample configuration:: Example projects
10575 * Triggering publication:: Publication commands
10578 @node Configuration, Uploading files, Publishing, Publishing
10579 @section Configuration
10581 Publishing needs significant configuration to specify files, destination
10582 and many other properties of a project.
10585 * Project alist:: The central configuration variable
10586 * Sources and destinations:: From here to there
10587 * Selecting files:: What files are part of the project?
10588 * Publishing action:: Setting the function doing the publishing
10589 * Publishing options:: Tweaking HTML export
10590 * Publishing links:: Which links keep working after publishing?
10591 * Sitemap:: Generating a list of all pages
10592 * Generating an index:: An index that reaches across pages
10595 @node Project alist, Sources and destinations, Configuration, Configuration
10596 @subsection The variable @code{org-publish-project-alist}
10597 @cindex org-publish-project-alist
10598 @cindex projects, for publishing
10600 @vindex org-publish-project-alist
10601 Publishing is configured almost entirely through setting the value of one
10602 variable, called @code{org-publish-project-alist}. Each element of the list
10603 configures one project, and may be in one of the two following forms:
10606 ("project-name" :property value :property value ...)
10607 @r{i.e. a well-formed property list with alternating keys and values}
10609 ("project-name" :components ("project-name" "project-name" ...))
10613 In both cases, projects are configured by specifying property values. A
10614 project defines the set of files that will be published, as well as the
10615 publishing configuration to use when publishing those files. When a project
10616 takes the second form listed above, the individual members of the
10617 @code{:components} property are taken to be sub-projects, which group
10618 together files requiring different publishing options. When you publish such
10619 a ``meta-project'', all the components will also be published, in the
10622 @node Sources and destinations, Selecting files, Project alist, Configuration
10623 @subsection Sources and destinations for files
10624 @cindex directories, for publishing
10626 Most properties are optional, but some should always be set. In
10627 particular, Org needs to know where to look for source files,
10628 and where to put published files.
10630 @multitable @columnfractions 0.3 0.7
10631 @item @code{:base-directory}
10632 @tab Directory containing publishing source files
10633 @item @code{:publishing-directory}
10634 @tab Directory where output files will be published. You can directly
10635 publish to a webserver using a file name syntax appropriate for
10636 the Emacs @file{tramp} package. Or you can publish to a local directory and
10637 use external tools to upload your website (@pxref{Uploading files}).
10638 @item @code{:preparation-function}
10639 @tab Function or list of functions to be called before starting the
10640 publishing process, for example, to run @code{make} for updating files to be
10641 published. The project property list is scoped into this call as the
10642 variable @code{project-plist}.
10643 @item @code{:completion-function}
10644 @tab Function or list of functions called after finishing the publishing
10645 process, for example, to change permissions of the resulting files. The
10646 project property list is scoped into this call as the variable
10647 @code{project-plist}.
10651 @node Selecting files, Publishing action, Sources and destinations, Configuration
10652 @subsection Selecting files
10653 @cindex files, selecting for publishing
10655 By default, all files with extension @file{.org} in the base directory
10656 are considered part of the project. This can be modified by setting the
10658 @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
10659 @item @code{:base-extension}
10660 @tab Extension (without the dot!) of source files. This actually is a
10661 regular expression. Set this to the symbol @code{any} if you want to get all
10662 files in @code{:base-directory}, even without extension.
10664 @item @code{:exclude}
10665 @tab Regular expression to match file names that should not be
10666 published, even though they have been selected on the basis of their
10669 @item @code{:include}
10670 @tab List of files to be included regardless of @code{:base-extension}
10671 and @code{:exclude}.
10673 @item @code{:recursive}
10674 @tab Non-nil means, check base-directory recursively for files to publish.
10677 @node Publishing action, Publishing options, Selecting files, Configuration
10678 @subsection Publishing action
10679 @cindex action, for publishing
10681 Publishing means that a file is copied to the destination directory and
10682 possibly transformed in the process. The default transformation is to export
10683 Org files as HTML files, and this is done by the function
10684 @code{org-publish-org-to-html} which calls the HTML exporter (@pxref{HTML
10685 export}). But you also can publish your content as PDF files using
10686 @code{org-publish-org-to-pdf}, or as @code{ascii}, @code{latin1} or
10687 @code{utf8} encoded files using the corresponding functions. If you want to
10688 publish the Org file itself, but with @i{archived}, @i{commented}, and
10689 @i{tag-excluded} trees removed, use @code{org-publish-org-to-org} and set the
10690 parameters @code{:plain-source} and/or @code{:htmlized-source}. This will
10691 produce @file{file.org} and @file{file.org.html} in the publishing
10692 directory@footnote{@file{file-source.org} and @file{file-source.org.html} if
10693 source and publishing directories are equal. Note that with this kind of
10694 setup, you need to add @code{:exclude "-source\\.org"} to the project
10695 definition in @code{org-publish-project-alist} to avoid that the published
10696 source files will be considered as new org files the next time the project is
10697 published.}. Other files like images only need to be copied to the
10698 publishing destination, for this you may use @code{org-publish-attachment}.
10699 For non-Org files, you always need to specify the publishing function:
10701 @multitable @columnfractions 0.3 0.7
10702 @item @code{:publishing-function}
10703 @tab Function executing the publication of a file. This may also be a
10704 list of functions, which will all be called in turn.
10705 @item @code{:plain-source}
10706 @tab Non-nil means, publish plain source.
10707 @item @code{:htmlized-source}
10708 @tab Non-nil means, publish htmlized source.
10711 The function must accept three arguments: a property list containing at least
10712 a @code{:publishing-directory} property, the name of the file to be
10713 published, and the path to the publishing directory of the output file. It
10714 should take the specified file, make the necessary transformation (if any)
10715 and place the result into the destination folder.
10717 @node Publishing options, Publishing links, Publishing action, Configuration
10718 @subsection Options for the HTML/La@TeX{} exporters
10719 @cindex options, for publishing
10721 The property list can be used to set many export options for the HTML
10722 and La@TeX{} exporters. In most cases, these properties correspond to user
10723 variables in Org. The table below lists these properties along
10724 with the variable they belong to. See the documentation string for the
10725 respective variable for details.
10727 @vindex org-export-html-link-up
10728 @vindex org-export-html-link-home
10729 @vindex org-export-default-language
10730 @vindex org-display-custom-times
10731 @vindex org-export-headline-levels
10732 @vindex org-export-with-section-numbers
10733 @vindex org-export-section-number-format
10734 @vindex org-export-with-toc
10735 @vindex org-export-preserve-breaks
10736 @vindex org-export-with-archived-trees
10737 @vindex org-export-with-emphasize
10738 @vindex org-export-with-sub-superscripts
10739 @vindex org-export-with-special-strings
10740 @vindex org-export-with-footnotes
10741 @vindex org-export-with-drawers
10742 @vindex org-export-with-tags
10743 @vindex org-export-with-todo-keywords
10744 @vindex org-export-with-priority
10745 @vindex org-export-with-TeX-macros
10746 @vindex org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments
10747 @vindex org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading
10748 @vindex org-export-with-fixed-width
10749 @vindex org-export-with-timestamps
10750 @vindex org-export-author-info
10751 @vindex org-export-email
10752 @vindex org-export-creator-info
10753 @vindex org-export-with-tables
10754 @vindex org-export-highlight-first-table-line
10755 @vindex org-export-html-style-include-default
10756 @vindex org-export-html-style
10757 @vindex org-export-html-style-extra
10758 @vindex org-export-html-link-org-files-as-html
10759 @vindex org-export-html-inline-images
10760 @vindex org-export-html-extension
10761 @vindex org-export-html-table-tag
10762 @vindex org-export-html-expand
10763 @vindex org-export-html-with-timestamp
10764 @vindex org-export-publishing-directory
10765 @vindex org-export-html-preamble
10766 @vindex org-export-html-postamble
10767 @vindex org-export-html-auto-preamble
10768 @vindex org-export-html-auto-postamble
10769 @vindex user-full-name
10770 @vindex user-mail-address
10771 @vindex org-export-select-tags
10772 @vindex org-export-exclude-tags
10774 @multitable @columnfractions 0.32 0.68
10775 @item @code{:link-up} @tab @code{org-export-html-link-up}
10776 @item @code{:link-home} @tab @code{org-export-html-link-home}
10777 @item @code{:language} @tab @code{org-export-default-language}
10778 @item @code{:customtime} @tab @code{org-display-custom-times}
10779 @item @code{:headline-levels} @tab @code{org-export-headline-levels}
10780 @item @code{:section-numbers} @tab @code{org-export-with-section-numbers}
10781 @item @code{:section-number-format} @tab @code{org-export-section-number-format}
10782 @item @code{:table-of-contents} @tab @code{org-export-with-toc}
10783 @item @code{:preserve-breaks} @tab @code{org-export-preserve-breaks}
10784 @item @code{:archived-trees} @tab @code{org-export-with-archived-trees}
10785 @item @code{:emphasize} @tab @code{org-export-with-emphasize}
10786 @item @code{:sub-superscript} @tab @code{org-export-with-sub-superscripts}
10787 @item @code{:special-strings} @tab @code{org-export-with-special-strings}
10788 @item @code{:footnotes} @tab @code{org-export-with-footnotes}
10789 @item @code{:drawers} @tab @code{org-export-with-drawers}
10790 @item @code{:tags} @tab @code{org-export-with-tags}
10791 @item @code{:todo-keywords} @tab @code{org-export-with-todo-keywords}
10792 @item @code{:priority} @tab @code{org-export-with-priority}
10793 @item @code{:TeX-macros} @tab @code{org-export-with-TeX-macros}
10794 @item @code{:LaTeX-fragments} @tab @code{org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments}
10795 @item @code{:latex-listings} @tab @code{org-export-latex-listings}
10796 @item @code{:skip-before-1st-heading} @tab @code{org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading}
10797 @item @code{:fixed-width} @tab @code{org-export-with-fixed-width}
10798 @item @code{:timestamps} @tab @code{org-export-with-timestamps}
10799 @item @code{:author-info} @tab @code{org-export-author-info}
10800 @item @code{:email-info} @tab @code{org-export-email-info}
10801 @item @code{:creator-info} @tab @code{org-export-creator-info}
10802 @item @code{:tables} @tab @code{org-export-with-tables}
10803 @item @code{:table-auto-headline} @tab @code{org-export-highlight-first-table-line}
10804 @item @code{:style-include-default} @tab @code{org-export-html-style-include-default}
10805 @item @code{:style} @tab @code{org-export-html-style}
10806 @item @code{:style-extra} @tab @code{org-export-html-style-extra}
10807 @item @code{:convert-org-links} @tab @code{org-export-html-link-org-files-as-html}
10808 @item @code{:inline-images} @tab @code{org-export-html-inline-images}
10809 @item @code{:html-extension} @tab @code{org-export-html-extension}
10810 @item @code{:xml-declaration} @tab @code{org-export-html-xml-declaration}
10811 @item @code{:html-table-tag} @tab @code{org-export-html-table-tag}
10812 @item @code{:expand-quoted-html} @tab @code{org-export-html-expand}
10813 @item @code{:timestamp} @tab @code{org-export-html-with-timestamp}
10814 @item @code{:publishing-directory} @tab @code{org-export-publishing-directory}
10815 @item @code{:preamble} @tab @code{org-export-html-preamble}
10816 @item @code{:postamble} @tab @code{org-export-html-postamble}
10817 @item @code{:auto-preamble} @tab @code{org-export-html-auto-preamble}
10818 @item @code{:auto-postamble} @tab @code{org-export-html-auto-postamble}
10819 @item @code{:author} @tab @code{user-full-name}
10820 @item @code{:email} @tab @code{user-mail-address} : @code{addr;addr;..}
10821 @item @code{:select-tags} @tab @code{org-export-select-tags}
10822 @item @code{:exclude-tags} @tab @code{org-export-exclude-tags}
10823 @item @code{:latex-image-options} @tab @code{org-export-latex-image-default-option}
10826 Most of the @code{org-export-with-*} variables have the same effect in
10827 both HTML and La@TeX{} exporters, except for @code{:TeX-macros} and
10828 @code{:LaTeX-fragments}, respectively @code{nil} and @code{t} in the
10831 @vindex org-publish-project-alist
10832 When a property is given a value in @code{org-publish-project-alist},
10833 its setting overrides the value of the corresponding user variable (if
10834 any) during publishing. Options set within a file (@pxref{Export
10835 options}), however, override everything.
10837 @node Publishing links, Sitemap, Publishing options, Configuration
10838 @subsection Links between published files
10839 @cindex links, publishing
10841 To create a link from one Org file to another, you would use
10842 something like @samp{[[file:foo.org][The foo]]} or simply
10843 @samp{file:foo.org.} (@pxref{Hyperlinks}). When published, this link
10844 becomes a link to @file{foo.html}. In this way, you can interlink the
10845 pages of your "org web" project and the links will work as expected when
10846 you publish them to HTML. If you also publish the Org source file and want
10847 to link to that, use an @code{http:} link instead of a @code{file:} link,
10848 because @code{file:} links are converted to link to the corresponding
10851 You may also link to related files, such as images. Provided you are careful
10852 with relative file names, and provided you have also configured Org to upload
10853 the related files, these links will work too. See @ref{Complex example}, for
10854 an example of this usage.
10856 Sometimes an Org file to be published may contain links that are
10857 only valid in your production environment, but not in the publishing
10858 location. In this case, use the property
10860 @multitable @columnfractions 0.4 0.6
10861 @item @code{:link-validation-function}
10862 @tab Function to validate links
10866 to define a function for checking link validity. This function must
10867 accept two arguments, the file name and a directory relative to which
10868 the file name is interpreted in the production environment. If this
10869 function returns @code{nil}, then the HTML generator will only insert a
10870 description into the HTML file, but no link. One option for this
10871 function is @code{org-publish-validate-link} which checks if the given
10872 file is part of any project in @code{org-publish-project-alist}.
10874 @node Sitemap, Generating an index, Publishing links, Configuration
10875 @subsection Generating a sitemap
10876 @cindex sitemap, of published pages
10878 The following properties may be used to control publishing of
10879 a map of files for a given project.
10881 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.65
10882 @item @code{:auto-sitemap}
10883 @tab When non-nil, publish a sitemap during @code{org-publish-current-project}
10884 or @code{org-publish-all}.
10886 @item @code{:sitemap-filename}
10887 @tab Filename for output of sitemap. Defaults to @file{sitemap.org} (which
10888 becomes @file{sitemap.html}).
10890 @item @code{:sitemap-title}
10891 @tab Title of sitemap page. Defaults to name of file.
10893 @item @code{:sitemap-function}
10894 @tab Plug-in function to use for generation of the sitemap.
10895 Defaults to @code{org-publish-org-sitemap}, which generates a plain list
10896 of links to all files in the project.
10898 @item @code{:sitemap-sort-folders}
10899 @tab Where folders should appear in the sitemap. Set this to @code{first}
10900 (default) or @code{last} to display folders first or last,
10901 respectively. Any other value will mix files and folders.
10903 @item @code{:sitemap-alphabetically}
10904 @tab The site map is normally sorted alphabetically. Set this explicitly to
10905 @code{nil} to turn off sorting.
10907 @item @code{:sitemap-ignore-case}
10908 @tab Should sorting be case-sensitive? Default @code{nil}.
10912 @node Generating an index, , Sitemap, Configuration
10913 @subsection Generating an index
10914 @cindex index, in a publishing project
10916 Org-mode can generate an index across the files of a publishing project.
10918 @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
10919 @item @code{:makeindex}
10920 @tab When non-nil, generate in index in the file @file{theindex.org} and
10921 publish it as @file{theindex.html}.
10924 The file will be create when first publishing a project with the
10925 @code{:makeindex} set. The file only contains a statement @code{#+include:
10926 "theindex.inc"}. You can then built around this include statement by adding
10927 a title, style information etc.
10929 @node Uploading files, Sample configuration, Configuration, Publishing
10930 @section Uploading files
10934 For those people already utilizing third party sync tools such as
10935 @command{rsync} or @command{unison}, it might be preferable not to use the built in
10936 @i{remote} publishing facilities of Org-mode which rely heavily on
10937 Tramp. Tramp, while very useful and powerful, tends not to be
10938 so efficient for multiple file transfer and has been known to cause problems
10941 Specialized synchronization utilities offer several advantages. In addition
10942 to timestamp comparison, they also do content and permissions/attribute
10943 checks. For this reason you might prefer to publish your web to a local
10944 directory (possibly even @i{in place} with your Org files) and then use
10945 @file{unison} or @file{rsync} to do the synchronization with the remote host.
10947 Since Unison (for example) can be configured as to which files to transfer to
10948 a certain remote destination, it can greatly simplify the project publishing
10949 definition. Simply keep all files in the correct location, process your Org
10950 files with @code{org-publish} and let the synchronization tool do the rest.
10951 You do not need, in this scenario, to include attachments such as @file{jpg},
10952 @file{css} or @file{gif} files in the project definition since the 3rd party
10955 Publishing to a local directory is also much faster than to a remote one, so
10956 that you can afford more easily to republish entire projects. If you set
10957 @code{org-publish-use-timestamps-flag} to @code{nil}, you gain the main
10958 benefit of re-including any changed external files such as source example
10959 files you might include with @code{#+INCLUDE}. The timestamp mechanism in
10960 Org is not smart enough to detect if included files have been modified.
10962 @node Sample configuration, Triggering publication, Uploading files, Publishing
10963 @section Sample configuration
10965 Below we provide two example configurations. The first one is a simple
10966 project publishing only a set of Org files. The second example is
10967 more complex, with a multi-component project.
10970 * Simple example:: One-component publishing
10971 * Complex example:: A multi-component publishing example
10974 @node Simple example, Complex example, Sample configuration, Sample configuration
10975 @subsection Example: simple publishing configuration
10977 This example publishes a set of Org files to the @file{public_html}
10978 directory on the local machine.
10981 (setq org-publish-project-alist
10983 :base-directory "~/org/"
10984 :publishing-directory "~/public_html"
10985 :section-numbers nil
10986 :table-of-contents nil
10987 :style "<link rel=\"stylesheet\"
10988 href=\"../other/mystyle.css\"
10989 type=\"text/css\"/>")))
10992 @node Complex example, , Simple example, Sample configuration
10993 @subsection Example: complex publishing configuration
10995 This more complicated example publishes an entire website, including
10996 Org files converted to HTML, image files, Emacs Lisp source code, and
10997 style sheets. The publishing directory is remote and private files are
11000 To ensure that links are preserved, care should be taken to replicate
11001 your directory structure on the web server, and to use relative file
11002 paths. For example, if your Org files are kept in @file{~/org} and your
11003 publishable images in @file{~/images}, you would link to an image with
11006 file:../images/myimage.png
11009 On the web server, the relative path to the image should be the
11010 same. You can accomplish this by setting up an "images" folder in the
11011 right place on the web server, and publishing images to it.
11014 (setq org-publish-project-alist
11016 :base-directory "~/org/"
11017 :base-extension "org"
11018 :publishing-directory "/ssh:user@@host:~/html/notebook/"
11019 :publishing-function org-publish-org-to-html
11020 :exclude "PrivatePage.org" ;; regexp
11022 :section-numbers nil
11023 :table-of-contents nil
11024 :style "<link rel=\"stylesheet\"
11025 href=\"../other/mystyle.css\" type=\"text/css\"/>"
11027 :auto-postamble nil)
11030 :base-directory "~/images/"
11031 :base-extension "jpg\\|gif\\|png"
11032 :publishing-directory "/ssh:user@@host:~/html/images/"
11033 :publishing-function org-publish-attachment)
11036 :base-directory "~/other/"
11037 :base-extension "css\\|el"
11038 :publishing-directory "/ssh:user@@host:~/html/other/"
11039 :publishing-function org-publish-attachment)
11040 ("website" :components ("orgfiles" "images" "other"))))
11043 @node Triggering publication, , Sample configuration, Publishing
11044 @section Triggering publication
11046 Once properly configured, Org can publish with the following commands:
11049 @orgcmd{C-c C-e X,org-publish}
11050 Prompt for a specific project and publish all files that belong to it.
11051 @orgcmd{C-c C-e P,org-publish-current-project}
11052 Publish the project containing the current file.
11053 @orgcmd{C-c C-e F,org-publish-current-file}
11054 Publish only the current file.
11055 @orgcmd{C-c C-e E,org-publish-all}
11056 Publish every project.
11059 @vindex org-publish-use-timestamps-flag
11060 Org uses timestamps to track when a file has changed. The above functions
11061 normally only publish changed files. You can override this and force
11062 publishing of all files by giving a prefix argument to any of the commands
11063 above, or by customizing the variable @code{org-publish-use-timestamps-flag}.
11064 This may be necessary in particular if files include other files via
11065 @code{#+SETUPFILE:} or @code{#+INCLUDE:}.
11067 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
11068 @comment Working With Source Code, Miscellaneous, Publishing, Top
11070 @node Working With Source Code, Miscellaneous, Publishing, Top
11071 @chapter Working with source code
11072 @cindex Schulte, Eric
11073 @cindex Davison, Dan
11074 @cindex source code, working with
11076 Source code can be included in Org-mode documents using a @samp{src} block,
11080 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
11081 (defun org-xor (a b)
11087 Org-mode provides a number of features for working with live source code,
11088 including editing of code blocks in their native major-mode, evaluation of
11089 code blocks, tangling of code blocks, and exporting code blocks and their
11090 results in several formats. This functionality was contributed by Eric
11091 Schulte and Dan Davison, and was originally named Org-babel.
11093 The following sections describe Org-mode's code block handling facilities.
11096 * Structure of code blocks:: Code block syntax described
11097 * Editing source code:: Language major-mode editing
11098 * Exporting code blocks:: Export contents and/or results
11099 * Extracting source code:: Create pure source code files
11100 * Evaluating code blocks:: Place results of evaluation in the Org-mode buffer
11101 * Library of Babel:: Use and contribute to a library of useful code blocks
11102 * Languages:: List of supported code block languages
11103 * Header arguments:: Configure code block functionality
11104 * Results of evaluation:: How evaluation results are handled
11105 * Noweb reference syntax:: Literate programming in Org-mode
11106 * Key bindings and useful functions:: Work quickly with code blocks
11107 * Batch execution:: Call functions from the command line
11110 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
11111 @comment Structure of code blocks, Editing source code, Working With Source Code, Working With Source Code
11113 @node Structure of code blocks, Editing source code, Working With Source Code, Working With Source Code
11114 @section Structure of code blocks
11115 @cindex code block, structure
11116 @cindex source code, block structure
11118 The structure of code blocks is as follows:
11122 #+begin_src <language> <switches> <header arguments>
11127 code blocks can also be embedded in text as so called inline code blocks as
11130 src_<language>@{<body>@}
11136 src_<language>[<header arguments>]@{<body>@}
11141 This name is associated with the code block. This is similar to the
11142 @samp{#+tblname} lines that can be used to name tables in Org-mode files.
11143 Referencing the name of a code block makes it possible to evaluate the
11144 block from other places in the file, other files, or from Org-mode table
11145 formulas (see @ref{The spreadsheet}).
11147 The language of the code in the block.
11149 Switches controlling exportation of the code block (see switches discussion in
11150 @ref{Literal examples})
11151 @item <header arguments>
11152 Optional header arguments control many aspects of evaluation, export and
11153 tangling of code blocks. See the @ref{Header arguments}
11154 section. Header arguments can also be set on a per-buffer or per-subtree
11155 basis using properties.
11160 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
11161 @comment Editing source code, Exporting code blocks, Structure of code blocks, Working With Source Code
11163 @node Editing source code, Exporting code blocks, Structure of code blocks, Working With Source Code
11164 @section Editing source code
11165 @cindex code block, editing
11166 @cindex source code, editing
11169 Use @kbd{C-c '} to edit the current code block. This brings up
11170 a language major-mode edit buffer containing the body of the code
11171 block. Saving this buffer will write the new contents back to the Org
11172 buffer. Use @kbd{C-c '} again to exit.
11174 The @code{org-src-mode} minor mode will be active in the edit buffer. The
11175 following variables can be used to configure the behavior of the edit
11176 buffer. See also the customization group @code{org-edit-structure} for
11177 further configuration options.
11180 @item org-src-lang-modes
11181 If an Emacs major-mode named @code{<lang>-mode} exists, where
11182 @code{<lang>} is the language named in the header line of the code block,
11183 then the edit buffer will be placed in that major-mode. This variable
11184 can be used to map arbitrary language names to existing major modes.
11185 @item org-src-window-setup
11186 Controls the way Emacs windows are rearranged when the edit buffer is created.
11187 @item org-src-preserve-indentation
11188 This variable is especially useful for tangling languages such as
11189 python, in which whitespace indentation in the output is critical.
11190 @item org-src-ask-before-returning-to-edit-buffer
11191 By default, Org will ask before returning to an open edit buffer. Set
11192 this variable to nil to switch without asking.
11195 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
11196 @comment Exporting code blocks, Extracting source code, Editing source code, Working With Source Code
11198 @node Exporting code blocks, Extracting source code, Editing source code, Working With Source Code
11199 @section Exporting code blocks
11200 @cindex code block, exporting
11201 @cindex source code, exporting
11203 It is possible to export the @emph{contents} of code blocks, the
11204 @emph{results} of code block evaluation, @emph{neither}, or @emph{both}. For
11205 most languages, the default exports the contents of code blocks. However, for
11206 some languages (e.g. @code{ditaa}) the default exports the results of code
11207 block evaluation. For information on exporting code block bodies, see
11208 @ref{Literal examples}.
11210 The @code{:exports} header argument can be used to specify export
11213 @subsubheading Header arguments:
11215 @item :exports code
11216 The default in most languages. The body of the code block is exported, as
11217 described in @ref{Literal examples}.
11218 @item :exports results
11219 The code block will be evaluated and the results will be placed in the
11220 Org-mode buffer for export, either updating previous results of the code
11221 block located anywhere in the buffer or, if no previous results exist,
11222 placing the results immediately after the code block. The body of the code
11223 block will not be exported.
11224 @item :exports both
11225 Both the code block and its results will be exported.
11226 @item :exports none
11227 Neither the code block nor its results will be exported.
11230 It is possible to inhibit the evaluation of code blocks during export.
11231 Setting the the @code{org-export-babel-evaluate} variable to @code{nil} will
11232 ensure that no code blocks are evaluated as part of the export process. This
11233 can be useful in situations where potentially untrusted Org-mode files are
11234 exported in an automated fashion, for example when Org-mode is used as the
11235 markup language for a wiki.
11237 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
11238 @comment Extracting source code, Evaluating code blocks, Exporting code blocks, Working With Source Code
11239 @node Extracting source code, Evaluating code blocks, Exporting code blocks, Working With Source Code
11240 @section Extracting source code
11241 @cindex source code, extracting
11242 @cindex code block, extracting source code
11244 Creating pure source code files by extracting code from source blocks is
11245 referred to as ``tangling''---a term adopted from the literate programming
11246 community. During ``tangling'' of code blocks their bodies are expanded
11247 using @code{org-babel-expand-src-block} which can expand both variable and
11248 ``noweb'' style references (see @ref{Noweb reference syntax}).
11250 @subsubheading Header arguments
11253 The default. The code block is not included in the tangled output.
11255 Include the code block in the tangled output. The output file name is the
11256 name of the org file with the extension @samp{.org} replaced by the extension
11257 for the block language.
11258 @item :tangle filename
11259 Include the code block in the tangled output to file @samp{filename}.
11263 @subsubheading Functions
11265 @item org-babel-tangle
11266 Tangle the current file. Bound to @kbd{C-c C-v t}.
11267 @item org-babel-tangle-file
11268 Choose a file to tangle. Bound to @kbd{C-c C-v f}.
11271 @subsubheading Hooks
11273 @item org-babel-post-tangle-hook
11274 This hook is run from within code files tangled by @code{org-babel-tangle}.
11275 Example applications could include post-processing, compilation or evaluation
11276 of tangled code files.
11279 @node Evaluating code blocks, Library of Babel, Extracting source code, Working With Source Code
11280 @section Evaluating code blocks
11281 @cindex code block, evaluating
11282 @cindex source code, evaluating
11284 Code blocks can be evaluated@footnote{Whenever code is evaluated there is a
11285 potential for that code to do harm. Org-mode provides a number of safeguards
11286 to ensure that it only evaluates code with explicit confirmation from the
11287 user. For information on these safeguards (and on how to disable them) see
11288 @ref{Code evaluation security}.} and the results placed in the Org-mode
11289 buffer. By default, evaluation is only turned on for @code{emacs-lisp} code
11290 blocks, however support exists for evaluating blocks in many languages. See
11291 @ref{Languages} for a list of supported languages. See @ref{Structure of
11292 code blocks} for information on the syntax used to define a code block.
11295 There are a number of ways to evaluate code blocks. The simplest is to press
11296 @kbd{C-c C-c} or @kbd{C-c C-v e} with the point on a code block@footnote{The
11297 @code{org-babel-no-eval-on-ctrl-c-ctrl-c} variable can be used to remove code
11298 evaluation from the @kbd{C-c C-c} key binding.}. This will call the
11299 @code{org-babel-execute-src-block} function to evaluate the block and insert
11300 its results into the Org-mode buffer.
11302 It is also possible to evaluate named code blocks from anywhere in an
11303 Org-mode buffer or an Org-mode table. @code{#+call} (or synonymously
11304 @code{#+function} or @code{#+lob}) lines can be used to remotely execute code
11305 blocks located in the current Org-mode buffer or in the ``Library of Babel''
11306 (see @ref{Library of Babel}). These lines use the following syntax.
11309 #+call: <name>(<arguments>) <header arguments>
11310 #+function: <name>(<arguments>) <header arguments>
11311 #+lob: <name>(<arguments>) <header arguments>
11316 The name of the code block to be evaluated.
11318 Arguments specified in this section will be passed to the code block.
11319 @item <header arguments>
11320 Header arguments can be placed after the function invocation. See
11321 @ref{Header arguments} for more information on header arguments.
11325 @node Library of Babel, Languages, Evaluating code blocks, Working With Source Code
11326 @section Library of Babel
11327 @cindex babel, library of
11328 @cindex source code, library
11329 @cindex code block, library
11331 The ``Library of Babel'' is a library of code blocks
11332 that can be called from any Org-mode file. The library is housed in an
11333 Org-mode file located in the @samp{contrib} directory of Org-mode.
11334 Org-mode users can deposit functions they believe to be generally
11335 useful in the library.
11337 Code blocks defined in the ``Library of Babel'' can be called remotely as if
11338 they were in the current Org-mode buffer (see @ref{Evaluating code blocks}
11339 for information on the syntax of remote code block evaluation).
11342 Code blocks located in any Org-mode file can be loaded into the ``Library of
11343 Babel'' with the @code{org-babel-lob-ingest} function, bound to @kbd{C-c C-v
11346 @node Languages, Header arguments, Library of Babel, Working With Source Code
11348 @cindex babel, languages
11349 @cindex source code, languages
11350 @cindex code block, languages
11352 Code blocks in the following languages are supported.
11354 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.3 0.22 0.2
11355 @item @b{Language} @tab @b{Identifier} @tab @b{Language} @tab @b{Identifier}
11356 @item Asymptote @tab asymptote @tab C @tab C
11357 @item C++ @tab C++ @tab Clojure @tab clojure
11358 @item css @tab css @tab ditaa @tab ditaa
11359 @item Graphviz @tab dot @tab Emacs Lisp @tab emacs-lisp
11360 @item gnuplot @tab gnuplot @tab Haskell @tab haskell
11361 @item LaTeX @tab latex @tab Matlab @tab matlab
11362 @item Mscgen @tab mscgen @tab Objective Caml @tab ocaml
11363 @item Octave @tab octave @tab OZ @tab oz
11364 @item Perl @tab perl @tab Python @tab python
11365 @item R @tab R @tab Ruby @tab ruby
11366 @item Sass @tab sass @tab GNU Screen @tab screen
11367 @item shell @tab sh @tab SQL @tab sql
11368 @item Sqlite @tab sqlite
11371 Language-specific documentation is available for some languages. If
11372 available, it can be found at
11373 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/babel/languages}.
11375 The @code{org-babel-load-languages} controls which languages are enabled for
11376 evaluation (by default only @code{emacs-lisp} is enabled). This variable can
11377 be set using the customization interface or by adding code like the following
11378 to your emacs configuration.
11381 The following disables @code{emacs-lisp} evaluation and enables evaluation of
11382 @code{R} code blocks.
11386 (org-babel-do-load-languages
11387 'org-babel-load-languages
11388 '((emacs-lisp . nil)
11392 It is also possible to enable support for a language by loading the related
11393 elisp file with @code{require}.
11396 The following adds support for evaluating @code{clojure} code blocks.
11400 (require 'ob-clojure)
11403 @node Header arguments, Results of evaluation, Languages, Working With Source Code
11404 @section Header arguments
11405 @cindex code block, header arguments
11406 @cindex source code, block header arguments
11408 Code block functionality can be configured with header arguments. This
11409 section provides an overview of the use of header arguments, and then
11410 describes each header argument in detail.
11413 * Using header arguments:: Different ways to set header arguments
11414 * Specific header arguments:: List of header arguments
11417 @node Using header arguments, Specific header arguments, Header arguments, Header arguments
11418 @subsection Using header arguments
11420 The values of header arguments can be set in six different ways, each more
11421 specific (and having higher priority) than the last.
11423 * System-wide header arguments:: Set global default values
11424 * Language-specific header arguments:: Set default values by language
11425 * Buffer-wide header arguments:: Set default values for a specific buffer
11426 * Header arguments in Org-mode properties:: Set default values for a buffer or heading
11427 * Code block specific header arguments:: The most common way to set values
11428 * Header arguments in function calls:: The most specific level
11432 @node System-wide header arguments, Language-specific header arguments, Using header arguments, Using header arguments
11433 @subsubheading System-wide header arguments
11434 @vindex org-babel-default-header-args
11435 System-wide values of header arguments can be specified by customizing the
11436 @code{org-babel-default-header-args} variable:
11440 :results => "replace"
11447 @c org-babel-default-header-args is a variable defined in `org-babel.el'.
11449 @c ((:session . "none")
11450 @c (:results . "replace")
11451 @c (:exports . "code")
11453 @c (:noweb . "no"))
11457 @c Default arguments to use when evaluating a code block.
11460 For example, the following example could be used to set the default value of
11461 @code{:noweb} header arguments to @code{yes}. This would have the effect of
11462 expanding @code{:noweb} references by default when evaluating source code
11466 (setq org-babel-default-header-args
11467 (cons '(:noweb . "yes")
11468 (assq-delete-all :noweb org-babel-default-header-args)))
11471 @node Language-specific header arguments, Buffer-wide header arguments, System-wide header arguments, Using header arguments
11472 @subsubheading Language-specific header arguments
11473 Each language can define its own set of default header arguments. See the
11474 language-specific documentation available online at
11475 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/babel}.
11477 @node Buffer-wide header arguments, Header arguments in Org-mode properties, Language-specific header arguments, Using header arguments
11478 @subsubheading Buffer-wide header arguments
11479 Buffer-wide header arguments may be specified through the use of a special
11480 line placed anywhere in an Org-mode file. The line consists of the
11481 @code{#+BABEL:} keyword followed by a series of header arguments which may be
11482 specified using the standard header argument syntax.
11484 For example the following would set @code{session} to @code{*R*}, and
11485 @code{results} to @code{silent} for every code block in the buffer, ensuring
11486 that all execution took place in the same session, and no results would be
11487 inserted into the buffer.
11490 #+BABEL: :session *R* :results silent
11493 @node Header arguments in Org-mode properties, Code block specific header arguments, Buffer-wide header arguments, Using header arguments
11494 @subsubheading Header arguments in Org-mode properties
11496 Header arguments are also read from Org-mode properties (see @ref{Property
11497 syntax}), which can be set on a buffer-wide or per-heading basis. An example
11498 of setting a header argument for all code blocks in a buffer is
11501 #+property: tangle yes
11504 When properties are used to set default header arguments, they are looked up
11505 with inheritance, so the value of the @code{:cache} header argument will default
11506 to @code{yes} in all code blocks in the subtree rooted at the following
11517 @vindex org-babel-default-header-args
11518 Properties defined in this way override the properties set in
11519 @code{org-babel-default-header-args}. It is convenient to use the
11520 @code{org-set-property} function bound to @kbd{C-c C-x p} to set properties
11521 in Org-mode documents.
11523 @node Code block specific header arguments, Header arguments in function calls, Header arguments in Org-mode properties, Using header arguments
11524 @subsubheading Code block specific header arguments
11526 The most common way to assign values to header arguments is at the
11527 code block level. This can be done by listing a sequence of header
11528 arguments and their values as part of the @code{#+begin_src} line.
11529 Properties set in this way override both the values of
11530 @code{org-babel-default-header-args} and header arguments specified as
11531 properties. In the following example, the @code{:results} header argument
11532 is set to @code{silent}, meaning the results of execution will not be
11533 inserted in the buffer, and the @code{:exports} header argument is set to
11534 @code{code}, meaning only the body of the code block will be
11535 preserved on export to HTML or LaTeX.
11538 #+source: factorial
11539 #+begin_src haskell :results silent :exports code :var n=0
11541 fac n = n * fac (n-1)
11544 Similarly, it is possible to set header arguments for inline code blocks:
11547 src_haskell[:exports both]@{fac 5@}
11550 @node Header arguments in function calls, , Code block specific header arguments, Using header arguments
11551 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
11552 @subsubheading Header arguments in function calls
11554 At the most specific level, header arguments for ``Library of Babel'' or
11555 function call lines can be set as shown below:
11558 #+call: factorial(n=5) :exports results
11561 @node Specific header arguments, , Using header arguments, Header arguments
11562 @subsection Specific header arguments
11563 The following header arguments are defined:
11566 * var:: Pass arguments to code blocks
11567 * results:: Specify the type of results and how they will
11568 be collected and handled
11569 * file:: Specify a path for file output
11570 * dir:: Specify the default (possibly remote)
11571 directory for code block execution
11572 * exports:: Export code and/or results
11573 * tangle:: Toggle tangling and specify file name
11574 * comments:: Toggle insertion of comments in tangled
11576 * no-expand:: Turn off variable assignment and noweb
11577 expansion during tangling
11578 * session:: Preserve the state of code evaluation
11579 * noweb:: Toggle expansion of noweb references
11580 * cache:: Avoid re-evaluating unchanged code blocks
11581 * hlines:: Handle horizontal lines in tables
11582 * colnames:: Handle column names in tables
11583 * rownames:: Handle row names in tables
11584 * shebang:: Make tangled files executable
11585 * eval:: Limit evaluation of specific code blocks
11588 @node var, results, Specific header arguments, Specific header arguments
11589 @subsubsection @code{:var}
11590 The @code{:var} header argument is used to pass arguments to code blocks.
11591 The specifics of how arguments are included in a code block vary by language;
11592 these are addressed in the language-specific documentation. However, the
11593 syntax used to specify arguments is the same across all languages. The
11594 values passed to arguments can be literal values, values from org-mode tables
11595 and literal example blocks, or the results of other code blocks.
11597 These values can be indexed in a manner similar to arrays---see the
11598 ``indexable variable values'' heading below.
11600 The following syntax is used to pass arguments to code blocks using the
11601 @code{:var} header argument.
11607 where @code{assign} can take one of the following forms
11610 @item literal value
11611 either a string @code{"string"} or a number @code{9}.
11616 #+tblname: example-table
11622 #+source: table-length
11623 #+begin_src emacs-lisp :var table=example-table
11627 #+results: table-length
11631 a code block name, as assigned by @code{#+srcname:}, followed by
11635 #+begin_src emacs-lisp :var length=table-length()
11643 In addition, an argument can be passed to the code block referenced
11644 by @code{:var}. The argument is passed within the parentheses following the
11649 #+begin_src emacs-lisp :var input=8
11657 #+begin_src emacs-lisp :var input=double(input=1)
11666 @subsubheading Alternate argument syntax
11667 It is also possible to specify arguments in a potentially more natural way
11668 using the @code{#+source:} line of a code block. As in the following
11669 example arguments can be packed inside of parenthesis, separated by commas,
11670 following the source name.
11673 #+source: double(input=0, x=2)
11674 #+begin_src emacs-lisp
11679 @subsubheading Indexable variable values
11680 It is possible to reference portions of variable values by ``indexing'' into
11681 the variables. Indexes are 0 based with negative values counting back from
11682 the end. If an index is separated by @code{,}s then each subsequent section
11683 will index into the next deepest nesting or dimension of the value. The
11684 following example assigns the last cell of the first row the table
11685 @code{example-table} to the variable @code{data}:
11688 #+results: example-table
11694 #+begin_src emacs-lisp :var data=example-table[0,-1]
11702 Ranges of variable values can be referenced using two integers separated by a
11703 @code{:}, in which case the entire inclusive range is referenced. For
11704 example the following assigns the middle three rows of @code{example-table}
11708 #+results: example-table
11715 #+begin_src emacs-lisp :var data=example-table[1:3]
11725 Additionally, an empty index, or the single character @code{*}, are both
11726 interpreted to mean the entire range and as such are equivalent to
11727 @code{0:-1}, as shown in the following example in which the entire first
11728 column is referenced.
11731 #+results: example-table
11737 #+begin_src emacs-lisp :var data=example-table[,0]
11745 It is possible to index into the results of code blocks as well as tables.
11746 Any number of dimensions can be indexed. Dimensions are separated from one
11747 another by commas, as shown in the following example.
11751 #+begin_src emacs-lisp
11752 '(((1 2 3) (4 5 6) (7 8 9))
11753 ((10 11 12) (13 14 15) (16 17 18))
11754 ((19 20 21) (22 23 24) (25 26 27)))
11757 #+begin_src emacs-lisp :var data=3D[1,,1]
11765 @node results, file, var, Specific header arguments
11766 @subsubsection @code{:results}
11768 There are three classes of @code{:results} header argument. Only one option
11769 per class may be supplied per code block.
11773 @b{collection} header arguments specify how the results should be collected
11774 from the code block
11776 @b{type} header arguments specify what type of result the code block will
11777 return---which has implications for how they will be inserted into the
11780 @b{handling} header arguments specify how the results of evaluating the code
11781 block should be handled.
11784 @subsubheading Collection
11785 The following options are mutually exclusive, and specify how the results
11786 should be collected from the code block.
11790 This is the default. The result is the value of the last statement in the
11791 code block. This header argument places the evaluation in functional
11792 mode. Note that in some languages, e.g., python, use of this result type
11793 requires that a @code{return} statement be included in the body of the source
11794 code block. E.g., @code{:results value}.
11795 @item @code{output}
11796 The result is the collection of everything printed to STDOUT during the
11797 execution of the code block. This header argument places the
11798 evaluation in scripting mode. E.g., @code{:results output}.
11801 @subsubheading Type
11803 The following options are mutually exclusive and specify what type of results
11804 the code block will return. By default, results are inserted as either a
11805 table or scalar depending on their value.
11808 @item @code{table}, @code{vector}
11809 The results should be interpreted as an Org-mode table. If a single value is
11810 returned, it will be converted into a table with one row and one column.
11811 E.g., @code{:results value table}.
11813 The results should be interpreted as an Org-mode list. If a single scalar
11814 value is returned it will be converted into a list with only one element.
11815 @item @code{scalar}, @code{verbatim}
11816 The results should be interpreted literally---they will not be
11817 converted into a table. The results will be inserted into the Org-mode
11818 buffer as quoted text. E.g., @code{:results value verbatim}.
11820 The results will be interpreted as the path to a file, and will be inserted
11821 into the Org-mode buffer as a file link. E.g., @code{:results value file}.
11822 @item @code{raw}, @code{org}
11823 The results are interpreted as raw Org-mode code and are inserted directly
11824 into the buffer. If the results look like a table they will be aligned as
11825 such by Org-mode. E.g., @code{:results value raw}.
11827 Results are assumed to be HTML and will be enclosed in a @code{begin_html}
11828 block. E.g., @code{:results value html}.
11830 Results assumed to be LaTeX and are enclosed in a @code{begin_latex} block.
11831 E.g., @code{:results value latex}.
11833 Result are assumed to be parseable code and are enclosed in a code block.
11834 E.g., @code{:results value code}.
11836 The result is converted to pretty-printed code and is enclosed in a code
11837 block. This option currently supports Emacs Lisp, python, and ruby. E.g.,
11838 @code{:results value pp}.
11841 @subsubheading Handling
11842 The following results options indicate what happens with the
11843 results once they are collected.
11846 @item @code{silent}
11847 The results will be echoed in the minibuffer but will not be inserted into
11848 the Org-mode buffer. E.g., @code{:results output silent}.
11849 @item @code{replace}
11850 The default value. Any existing results will be removed, and the new results
11851 will be inserted into the Org-mode buffer in their place. E.g.,
11852 @code{:results output replace}.
11853 @item @code{append}
11854 If there are pre-existing results of the code block then the new results will
11855 be appended to the existing results. Otherwise the new results will be
11856 inserted as with @code{replace}.
11857 @item @code{prepend}
11858 If there are pre-existing results of the code block then the new results will
11859 be prepended to the existing results. Otherwise the new results will be
11860 inserted as with @code{replace}.
11863 @node file, dir, results, Specific header arguments
11864 @subsubsection @code{:file}
11866 The header argument @code{:file} is used to specify a path for file output.
11867 An Org-mode style @code{file:} link is inserted into the buffer as the result
11868 (see @ref{Link format}). Common examples are graphical output from R,
11869 gnuplot, ditaa and LaTeX code blocks.
11871 Note that for some languages, including R, gnuplot, LaTeX and ditaa,
11872 graphical output is sent to the specified file without the file being
11873 referenced explicitly in the code block. See the documentation for the
11874 individual languages for details. In contrast, general purpose languages such
11875 as python and ruby require that the code explicitly create output
11876 corresponding to the path indicated by @code{:file}.
11879 @node dir, exports, file, Specific header arguments
11880 @subsubsection @code{:dir} and remote execution
11882 While the @code{:file} header argument can be used to specify the path to the
11883 output file, @code{:dir} specifies the default directory during code block
11884 execution. If it is absent, then the directory associated with the current
11885 buffer is used. In other words, supplying @code{:dir path} temporarily has
11886 the same effect as changing the current directory with @kbd{M-x cd path}, and
11887 then not supplying @code{:dir}. Under the surface, @code{:dir} simply sets
11888 the value of the Emacs variable @code{default-directory}.
11890 When using @code{:dir}, you should supply a relative path for file output
11891 (e.g. @code{:file myfile.jpg} or @code{:file results/myfile.jpg}) in which
11892 case that path will be interpreted relative to the default directory.
11894 In other words, if you want your plot to go into a folder called Work in your
11895 home directory, you could use
11898 #+begin_src R :file myplot.png :dir ~/Work
11899 matplot(matrix(rnorm(100), 10), type="l")
11903 @subsubheading Remote execution
11904 A directory on a remote machine can be specified using tramp file syntax, in
11905 which case the code will be evaluated on the remote machine. An example is
11908 #+begin_src R :file plot.png :dir /dand@@yakuba.princeton.edu:
11909 plot(1:10, main=system("hostname", intern=TRUE))
11913 Text results will be returned to the local Org-mode buffer as usual, and file
11914 output will be created on the remote machine with relative paths interpreted
11915 relative to the remote directory. An Org-mode link to the remote file will be
11918 So, in the above example a plot will be created on the remote machine,
11919 and a link of the following form will be inserted in the org buffer:
11922 [[file:/scp:dand@@yakuba.princeton.edu:/home/dand/plot.png][plot.png]]
11925 Most of this functionality follows immediately from the fact that @code{:dir}
11926 sets the value of the Emacs variable @code{default-directory}, thanks to
11927 tramp. Those using XEmacs, or GNU Emacs prior to version 23 may need to
11928 install tramp separately in order for the these features to work correctly.
11930 @subsubheading Further points
11934 If @code{:dir} is used in conjunction with @code{:session}, although it will
11935 determine the starting directory for a new session as expected, no attempt is
11936 currently made to alter the directory associated with an existing session.
11938 @code{:dir} should typically not be used to create files during export with
11939 @code{:exports results} or @code{:exports both}. The reason is that, in order
11940 to retain portability of exported material between machines, during export
11941 links inserted into the buffer will *not* be expanded against @code{default
11942 directory}. Therefore, if @code{default-directory} is altered using
11943 @code{:dir}, it is probable that the file will be created in a location to
11944 which the link does not point.
11947 @node exports, tangle, dir, Specific header arguments
11948 @subsubsection @code{:exports}
11950 The @code{:exports} header argument specifies what should be included in HTML
11951 or LaTeX exports of the Org-mode file.
11955 The default. The body of code is included into the exported file. E.g.,
11956 @code{:exports code}.
11957 @item @code{results}
11958 The result of evaluating the code is included in the exported file. E.g.,
11959 @code{:exports results}.
11961 Both the code and results are included in the exported file. E.g.,
11962 @code{:exports both}.
11964 Nothing is included in the exported file. E.g., @code{:exports none}.
11967 @node tangle, comments, exports, Specific header arguments
11968 @subsubsection @code{:tangle}
11970 The @code{:tangle} header argument specifies whether or not the code
11971 block should be included in tangled extraction of source code files.
11975 The code block is exported to a source code file named after the
11976 basename (name w/o extension) of the Org-mode file. E.g., @code{:tangle
11979 The default. The code block is not exported to a source code file.
11980 E.g., @code{:tangle no}.
11982 Any other string passed to the @code{:tangle} header argument is interpreted
11983 as a file basename to which the block will be exported. E.g., @code{:tangle
11987 @node comments, no-expand, tangle, Specific header arguments
11988 @subsubsection @code{:comments}
11989 By default code blocks are tangled to source-code files without any insertion
11990 of comments beyond those which may already exist in the body of the code
11991 block. The @code{:comments} header argument can be set as follows to control
11992 the insertion of extra comments into the tangled code file.
11996 The default. No extra comments are inserted during tangling.
11998 The code block is wrapped in comments which contain pointers back to the
11999 original Org file from which the code was tangled.
12001 A synonym for ``link'' to maintain backwards compatibility.
12003 Include text from the org-mode file as a comment.
12005 The text is picked from the leading context of the tangled code and is
12006 limited by the nearest headline or source block as the case may be.
12008 Turns on both the ``link'' and ``org'' comment options.
12011 @node no-expand, session, comments, Specific header arguments
12012 @subsubsection @code{:no-expand}
12014 By default, code blocks are expanded with @code{org-babel-expand-src-block}
12015 during tangling. This has the effect of assigning values to variables
12016 specified with @code{:var} (see @ref{var}), and of replacing ``noweb''
12017 references (see @ref{Noweb reference syntax}) with their targets. The
12018 @code{:no-expand} header argument can be used to turn off this behavior.
12020 @node session, noweb, no-expand, Specific header arguments
12021 @subsubsection @code{:session}
12023 The @code{:session} header argument starts a session for an interpreted
12024 language where state is preserved.
12026 By default, a session is not started.
12028 A string passed to the @code{:session} header argument will give the session
12029 a name. This makes it possible to run concurrent sessions for each
12030 interpreted language.
12032 @node noweb, cache, session, Specific header arguments
12033 @subsubsection @code{:noweb}
12035 The @code{:noweb} header argument controls expansion of ``noweb'' style (see
12036 @ref{Noweb reference syntax}) references in a code block. This header
12037 argument can have one of three values: @code{yes} @code{no} or @code{tangle}.
12041 All ``noweb'' syntax references in the body of the code block will be
12042 expanded before the block is evaluated, tangled or exported.
12044 The default. No ``noweb'' syntax specific action is taken on evaluating
12045 code blocks, However, noweb references will still be expanded during
12047 @item @code{tangle}
12048 All ``noweb'' syntax references in the body of the code block will be
12049 expanded before the block is tangled, however ``noweb'' references will not
12050 be expanded when the block is evaluated or exported.
12053 @subsubheading Noweb prefix lines
12054 Noweb insertions are now placed behind the line prefix of the
12055 @code{<<reference>>}.
12056 This behavior is illustrated in the following example. Because the
12057 @code{<<example>>} noweb reference appears behind the SQL comment syntax,
12058 each line of the expanded noweb reference will be commented.
12071 -- multi-line body of example
12074 Note that noweb replacement text that does not contain any newlines will not
12075 be affected by this change, so it is still possible to use inline noweb
12078 @node cache, hlines, noweb, Specific header arguments
12079 @subsubsection @code{:cache}
12081 The @code{:cache} header argument controls the use of in-buffer caching of
12082 the results of evaluating code blocks. It can be used to avoid re-evaluating
12083 unchanged code blocks. This header argument can have one of two
12084 values: @code{yes} or @code{no}.
12088 The default. No caching takes place, and the code block will be evaluated
12089 every time it is called.
12091 Every time the code block is run a sha1 hash of the code and arguments
12092 passed to the block will be generated. This hash is packed into the
12093 @code{#+results:} line and will be checked on subsequent
12094 executions of the code block. If the code block has not
12095 changed since the last time it was evaluated, it will not be re-evaluated.
12098 @node hlines, colnames, cache, Specific header arguments
12099 @subsubsection @code{:hlines}
12101 Tables are frequently represented with one or more horizontal lines, or
12102 hlines. The @code{:hlines} argument to a code block accepts the
12103 values @code{yes} or @code{no}, with a default value of @code{no}.
12107 Strips horizontal lines from the input table. In most languages this is the
12108 desired effect because an @code{hline} symbol is interpreted as an unbound
12109 variable and raises an error. Setting @code{:hlines no} or relying on the
12110 default value yields the following results.
12113 #+tblname: many-cols
12120 #+source: echo-table
12121 #+begin_src python :var tab=many-cols
12125 #+results: echo-table
12132 Leaves hlines in the table. Setting @code{:hlines yes} has this effect.
12135 #+tblname: many-cols
12142 #+source: echo-table
12143 #+begin_src python :var tab=many-cols :hlines yes
12147 #+results: echo-table
12156 @node colnames, rownames, hlines, Specific header arguments
12157 @subsubsection @code{:colnames}
12159 The @code{:colnames} header argument accepts the values @code{yes},
12160 @code{no}, or @code{nil} for unassigned. The default value is @code{nil}.
12164 If an input table looks like it has column names
12165 (because its second row is an hline), then the column
12166 names will be removed from the table before
12167 processing, then reapplied to the results.
12170 #+tblname: less-cols
12176 #+srcname: echo-table-again
12177 #+begin_src python :var tab=less-cols
12178 return [[val + '*' for val in row] for row in tab]
12181 #+results: echo-table-again
12189 No column name pre-processing takes place
12192 Column names are removed and reapplied as with @code{nil} even if the table
12193 does not ``look like'' it has column names (i.e. the second row is not an
12197 @node rownames, shebang, colnames, Specific header arguments
12198 @subsubsection @code{:rownames}
12200 The @code{:rownames} header argument can take on the values @code{yes}
12201 or @code{no}, with a default value of @code{no}.
12205 No row name pre-processing will take place.
12208 The first column of the table is removed from the table before processing,
12209 and is then reapplied to the results.
12212 #+tblname: with-rownames
12213 | one | 1 | 2 | 3 | 4 | 5 |
12214 | two | 6 | 7 | 8 | 9 | 10 |
12216 #+srcname: echo-table-once-again
12217 #+begin_src python :var tab=with-rownames :rownames yes
12218 return [[val + 10 for val in row] for row in tab]
12221 #+results: echo-table-once-again
12222 | one | 11 | 12 | 13 | 14 | 15 |
12223 | two | 16 | 17 | 18 | 19 | 20 |
12227 @node shebang, eval, rownames, Specific header arguments
12228 @subsubsection @code{:shebang}
12230 Setting the @code{:shebang} header argument to a string value
12231 (e.g. @code{:shebang "#!/bin/bash"}) causes the string to be inserted as the
12232 first line of any tangled file holding the code block, and the file
12233 permissions of the tangled file are set to make it executable.
12235 @node eval, , shebang, Specific header arguments
12236 @subsubsection @code{:eval}
12237 The @code{:eval} header argument can be used to limit the evaluation of
12238 specific code blocks. @code{:eval} accepts two arguments ``never'' and
12239 ``query''. @code{:eval never} will ensure that a code block is never
12240 evaluated, this can be useful for protecting against the evaluation of
12241 dangerous code blocks. @code{:eval query} will require a query for every
12242 execution of a code block regardless of the value of the
12243 @code{org-confirm-babel-evaluate} variable.
12245 @node Results of evaluation, Noweb reference syntax, Header arguments, Working With Source Code
12246 @section Results of evaluation
12247 @cindex code block, results of evaluation
12248 @cindex source code, results of evaluation
12250 The way in which results are handled depends on whether a session is invoked,
12251 as well as on whether @code{:results value} or @code{:results output} is
12252 used. The following table shows the possibilities:
12254 @multitable @columnfractions 0.26 0.33 0.41
12255 @item @tab @b{Non-session} @tab @b{Session}
12256 @item @code{:results value} @tab value of last expression @tab value of last expression
12257 @item @code{:results output} @tab contents of STDOUT @tab concatenation of interpreter output
12260 Note: With @code{:results value}, the result in both @code{:session} and
12261 non-session is returned to Org-mode as a table (a one- or two-dimensional
12262 vector of strings or numbers) when appropriate.
12264 @subsection Non-session
12265 @subsubsection @code{:results value}
12266 This is the default. Internally, the value is obtained by wrapping the code
12267 in a function definition in the external language, and evaluating that
12268 function. Therefore, code should be written as if it were the body of such a
12269 function. In particular, note that python does not automatically return a
12270 value from a function unless a @code{return} statement is present, and so a
12271 @samp{return} statement will usually be required in python.
12273 This is the only one of the four evaluation contexts in which the code is
12274 automatically wrapped in a function definition.
12276 @subsubsection @code{:results output}
12277 The code is passed to the interpreter as an external process, and the
12278 contents of the standard output stream are returned as text. (In certain
12279 languages this also contains the error output stream; this is an area for
12282 @subsection @code{:session}
12283 @subsubsection @code{:results value}
12284 The code is passed to the interpreter running as an interactive Emacs
12285 inferior process. The result returned is the result of the last evaluation
12286 performed by the interpreter. (This is obtained in a language-specific
12287 manner: the value of the variable @code{_} in python and ruby, and the value
12288 of @code{.Last.value} in R).
12290 @subsubsection @code{:results output}
12291 The code is passed to the interpreter running as an interactive Emacs
12292 inferior process. The result returned is the concatenation of the sequence of
12293 (text) output from the interactive interpreter. Notice that this is not
12294 necessarily the same as what would be sent to @code{STDOUT} if the same code
12295 were passed to a non-interactive interpreter running as an external
12296 process. For example, compare the following two blocks:
12299 #+begin_src python :results output
12310 In non-session mode, the '2' is not printed and does not appear.
12312 #+begin_src python :results output :session
12324 But in @code{:session} mode, the interactive interpreter receives input '2'
12325 and prints out its value, '2'. (Indeed, the other print statements are
12328 @node Noweb reference syntax, Key bindings and useful functions, Results of evaluation, Working With Source Code
12329 @section Noweb reference syntax
12330 @cindex code block, noweb reference
12331 @cindex syntax, noweb
12332 @cindex source code, noweb reference
12334 The ``noweb'' (see @uref{http://www.cs.tufts.edu/~nr/noweb/}) Literate
12335 Programming system allows named blocks of code to be referenced by using the
12336 familiar Noweb syntax:
12339 <<code-block-name>>
12342 When a code block is tangled or evaluated, whether or not ``noweb''
12343 references are expanded depends upon the value of the @code{:noweb} header
12344 argument. If @code{:noweb yes}, then a Noweb reference is expanded before
12345 evaluation. If @code{:noweb no}, the default, then the reference is not
12346 expanded before evaluation.
12348 Note: the default value, @code{:noweb no}, was chosen to ensure that
12349 correct code is not broken in a language, such as Ruby, where
12350 @code{<<arg>>} is a syntactically valid construct. If @code{<<arg>>} is not
12351 syntactically valid in languages that you use, then please consider setting
12354 @node Key bindings and useful functions, Batch execution, Noweb reference syntax, Working With Source Code
12355 @section Key bindings and useful functions
12356 @cindex code block, key bindings
12358 Many common Org-mode key sequences are re-bound depending on
12361 Within a code block, the following key bindings
12364 @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
12366 @item @kbd{C-c C-c} @tab org-babel-execute-src-block
12368 @item @kbd{C-c C-o} @tab org-babel-open-src-block-result
12370 @item @kbd{C-@key{up}} @tab org-babel-load-in-session
12372 @item @kbd{M-@key{down}} @tab org-babel-pop-to-session
12375 In an Org-mode buffer, the following key bindings are active:
12377 @multitable @columnfractions 0.45 0.55
12379 @kindex C-c C-v C-a
12380 @item @kbd{C-c C-v a} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-a} @tab org-babel-sha1-hash
12382 @kindex C-c C-v C-b
12383 @item @kbd{C-c C-v b} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-b} @tab org-babel-execute-buffer
12385 @kindex C-c C-v C-f
12386 @item @kbd{C-c C-v f} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-f} @tab org-babel-tangle-file
12388 @item @kbd{C-c C-v g} @tab org-babel-goto-named-source-block
12390 @item @kbd{C-c C-v h} @tab org-babel-describe-bindings
12392 @kindex C-c C-v C-l
12393 @item @kbd{C-c C-v l} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-l} @tab org-babel-lob-ingest
12395 @kindex C-c C-v C-p
12396 @item @kbd{C-c C-v p} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-p} @tab org-babel-expand-src-block
12398 @kindex C-c C-v C-s
12399 @item @kbd{C-c C-v s} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-s} @tab org-babel-execute-subtree
12401 @kindex C-c C-v C-t
12402 @item @kbd{C-c C-v t} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-t} @tab org-babel-tangle
12404 @kindex C-c C-v C-z
12405 @item @kbd{C-c C-v z} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-z} @tab org-babel-switch-to-session
12408 @c When possible these keybindings were extended to work when the control key is
12409 @c kept pressed, resulting in the following additional keybindings.
12411 @c @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
12412 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-a} @tab org-babel-sha1-hash
12413 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-b} @tab org-babel-execute-buffer
12414 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-f} @tab org-babel-tangle-file
12415 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-l} @tab org-babel-lob-ingest
12416 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-p} @tab org-babel-expand-src-block
12417 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-s} @tab org-babel-execute-subtree
12418 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-t} @tab org-babel-tangle
12419 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-z} @tab org-babel-switch-to-session
12422 @node Batch execution, , Key bindings and useful functions, Working With Source Code
12423 @section Batch execution
12424 @cindex code block, batch execution
12425 @cindex source code, batch execution
12427 It is possible to call functions from the command line. This shell
12428 script calls @code{org-babel-tangle} on every one of its arguments.
12430 Be sure to adjust the paths to fit your system.
12434 # -*- mode: shell-script -*-
12436 # tangle files with org-mode
12440 ORGINSTALL="~/src/org/lisp/org-install.el"
12442 # wrap each argument in the code required to call tangle on it
12444 FILES="$FILES \"$i\""
12447 emacs -Q --batch -l $ORGINSTALL \
12449 (add-to-list 'load-path (expand-file-name \"~/src/org/lisp/\"))
12450 (add-to-list 'load-path (expand-file-name \"~/src/org/contrib/lisp/\"))
12451 (require 'org)(require 'org-exp)(require 'ob)(require 'ob-tangle)
12452 (mapc (lambda (file)
12453 (find-file (expand-file-name file \"$DIR\"))
12455 (kill-buffer)) '($FILES)))" 2>&1 |grep tangled
12458 @node Miscellaneous, Hacking, Working With Source Code, Top
12459 @chapter Miscellaneous
12462 * Completion:: M-TAB knows what you need
12463 * Easy Templates:: Quick insertion of structural elements
12464 * Speed keys:: Electric commands at the beginning of a headline
12465 * Code evaluation security:: Org mode files evaluate inline code
12466 * Customization:: Adapting Org to your taste
12467 * In-buffer settings:: Overview of the #+KEYWORDS
12468 * The very busy C-c C-c key:: When in doubt, press C-c C-c
12469 * Clean view:: Getting rid of leading stars in the outline
12470 * TTY keys:: Using Org on a tty
12471 * Interaction:: Other Emacs packages
12475 @node Completion, Easy Templates, Miscellaneous, Miscellaneous
12476 @section Completion
12477 @cindex completion, of @TeX{} symbols
12478 @cindex completion, of TODO keywords
12479 @cindex completion, of dictionary words
12480 @cindex completion, of option keywords
12481 @cindex completion, of tags
12482 @cindex completion, of property keys
12483 @cindex completion, of link abbreviations
12484 @cindex @TeX{} symbol completion
12485 @cindex TODO keywords completion
12486 @cindex dictionary word completion
12487 @cindex option keyword completion
12488 @cindex tag completion
12489 @cindex link abbreviations, completion of
12491 Emacs would not be Emacs without completion, and Org-mode uses it whenever it
12492 makes sense. If you prefer an @i{iswitchb}- or @i{ido}-like interface for
12493 some of the completion prompts, you can specify your preference by setting at
12494 most one of the variables @code{org-completion-use-iswitchb}
12495 @code{org-completion-use-ido}.
12497 Org supports in-buffer completion. This type of completion does
12498 not make use of the minibuffer. You simply type a few letters into
12499 the buffer and use the key to complete text right there.
12502 @kindex M-@key{TAB}
12504 Complete word at point
12507 At the beginning of a headline, complete TODO keywords.
12509 After @samp{\}, complete @TeX{} symbols supported by the exporter.
12511 After @samp{*}, complete headlines in the current buffer so that they
12512 can be used in search links like @samp{[[*find this headline]]}.
12514 After @samp{:} in a headline, complete tags. The list of tags is taken
12515 from the variable @code{org-tag-alist} (possibly set through the
12516 @samp{#+TAGS} in-buffer option, @pxref{Setting tags}), or it is created
12517 dynamically from all tags used in the current buffer.
12519 After @samp{:} and not in a headline, complete property keys. The list
12520 of keys is constructed dynamically from all keys used in the current
12523 After @samp{[}, complete link abbreviations (@pxref{Link abbreviations}).
12525 After @samp{#+}, complete the special keywords like @samp{TYP_TODO} or
12526 @samp{OPTIONS} which set file-specific options for Org-mode. When the
12527 option keyword is already complete, pressing @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} again
12528 will insert example settings for this keyword.
12530 In the line after @samp{#+STARTUP: }, complete startup keywords,
12531 i.e. valid keys for this line.
12533 Elsewhere, complete dictionary words using Ispell.
12537 @node Easy Templates, Speed keys, Completion, Miscellaneous
12538 @section Easy Templates
12539 @cindex template insertion
12540 @cindex insertion, of templates
12542 Org-mode supports insertion of empty structural elements (like
12543 @code{#+BEGIN_SRC} and @code{#+END_SRC} pairs) with just a few key
12544 strokes. This is achieved through a native template expansion mechanism.
12545 Note that Emacs has several other template mechanisms which could be used in
12546 a similar way, for example @file{yasnippet}.
12548 To insert a structural element, type a @samp{<}, followed by a template
12549 selector and @kbd{@key{TAB}}. Completion takes effect only when the above
12550 keystrokes are typed on a line by itself.
12552 The following template selectors are currently supported.
12554 @multitable @columnfractions 0.1 0.9
12555 @item @kbd{s} @tab @code{#+begin_src ... #+end_src}
12556 @item @kbd{e} @tab @code{#+begin_example ... #+end_example}
12557 @item @kbd{q} @tab @code{#+begin_quote ... #+end_quote}
12558 @item @kbd{v} @tab @code{#+begin_verse ... #+end_verse}
12559 @item @kbd{c} @tab @code{#+begin_center ... #+end_center}
12560 @item @kbd{l} @tab @code{#+begin_latex ... #+end_latex}
12561 @item @kbd{L} @tab @code{#+latex:}
12562 @item @kbd{h} @tab @code{#+begin_html ... #+end_html}
12563 @item @kbd{H} @tab @code{#+html:}
12564 @item @kbd{a} @tab @code{#+begin_ascii ... #+end_ascii}
12565 @item @kbd{A} @tab @code{#+ascii:}
12566 @item @kbd{i} @tab @code{#+include:} line
12569 For example, on an empty line, typing "<e" and then pressing TAB, will expand
12570 into a complete EXAMPLE template.
12572 You can install additional templates by customizing the variable
12573 @code{org-structure-template-alist}. Refer docstring of the variable for
12574 additional details.
12576 @node Speed keys, Code evaluation security, Easy Templates, Miscellaneous
12577 @section Speed keys
12579 @vindex org-use-speed-commands
12580 @vindex org-speed-commands-user
12582 Single keys can be made to execute commands when the cursor is at the
12583 beginning of a headline, i.e. before the first star. Configure the variable
12584 @code{org-use-speed-commands} to activate this feature. There is a
12585 pre-defined list of commands, and you can add more such commands using the
12586 variable @code{org-speed-commands-user}. Speed keys do not only speed up
12587 navigation and other commands, but they also provide an alternative way to
12588 execute commands bound to keys that are not or not easily available on a tty,
12589 or on a small mobile device with a limited keyboard.
12591 To see which commands are available, activate the feature and press @kbd{?}
12592 with the cursor at the beginning of a headline.
12594 @node Code evaluation security, Customization, Speed keys, Miscellaneous
12595 @section Code evaluation and security issues
12597 Org provides tools to work with the code snippets, including evaluating them.
12599 Running code on your machine always comes with a security risk. Badly
12600 written or malicious code can be executed on purpose or by accident. Org has
12601 default settings which will only evaluate such code if you give explicit
12602 permission to do so, and as a casual user of these features you should leave
12603 these precautions intact.
12605 For people who regularly work with such code, the confirmation prompts can
12606 become annoying, and you might want to turn them off. This can be done, but
12607 you must be aware of the risks that are involved.
12609 Code evaluation can happen under the following circumstances:
12612 @item Source code blocks
12613 Source code blocks can be evaluated during export, or when pressing @kbd{C-c
12614 C-c} in the block. The most important thing to realize here is that Org mode
12615 files which contain code snippets are, in a certain sense, like executable
12616 files. So you should accept them and load them into Emacs only from trusted
12617 sources - just like you would do with a program you install on your computer.
12619 Make sure you know what you are doing before customizing the variables
12620 which take off the default security brakes.
12622 @defopt org-confirm-babel-evaluate
12623 When set to t user is queried before code block evaluation
12626 @item Following @code{shell} and @code{elisp} links
12627 Org has two link types that can directly evaluate code (@pxref{External
12628 links}). These links can be problematic because the code to be evaluated is
12631 @defopt org-confirm-shell-link-function
12632 Function to queries user about shell link execution.
12634 @defopt org-confirm-elisp-link-function
12635 Functions to query user for Emacs Lisp link execution.
12638 @item Formulas in tables
12639 Formulas in tables (@pxref{The spreadsheet}) are code that is evaluated
12640 either by the @i{calc} interpreter, or by the @i{Emacs Lisp} interpreter.
12643 @node Customization, In-buffer settings, Code evaluation security, Miscellaneous
12644 @section Customization
12645 @cindex customization
12646 @cindex options, for customization
12647 @cindex variables, for customization
12649 There are more than 180 variables that can be used to customize
12650 Org. For the sake of compactness of the manual, I am not
12651 describing the variables here. A structured overview of customization
12652 variables is available with @kbd{M-x org-customize}. Or select
12653 @code{Browse Org Group} from the @code{Org->Customization} menu. Many
12654 settings can also be activated on a per-file basis, by putting special
12655 lines into the buffer (@pxref{In-buffer settings}).
12657 @node In-buffer settings, The very busy C-c C-c key, Customization, Miscellaneous
12658 @section Summary of in-buffer settings
12659 @cindex in-buffer settings
12660 @cindex special keywords
12662 Org-mode uses special lines in the buffer to define settings on a
12663 per-file basis. These lines start with a @samp{#+} followed by a
12664 keyword, a colon, and then individual words defining a setting. Several
12665 setting words can be in the same line, but you can also have multiple
12666 lines for the keyword. While these settings are described throughout
12667 the manual, here is a summary. After changing any of those lines in the
12668 buffer, press @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the line to
12669 activate the changes immediately. Otherwise they become effective only
12670 when the file is visited again in a new Emacs session.
12672 @vindex org-archive-location
12674 @item #+ARCHIVE: %s_done::
12675 This line sets the archive location for the agenda file. It applies for
12676 all subsequent lines until the next @samp{#+ARCHIVE} line, or the end
12677 of the file. The first such line also applies to any entries before it.
12678 The corresponding variable is @code{org-archive-location}.
12680 This line sets the category for the agenda file. The category applies
12681 for all subsequent lines until the next @samp{#+CATEGORY} line, or the
12682 end of the file. The first such line also applies to any entries before it.
12683 @item #+COLUMNS: %25ITEM .....
12684 @cindex property, COLUMNS
12685 Set the default format for columns view. This format applies when
12686 columns view is invoked in locations where no @code{COLUMNS} property
12688 @item #+CONSTANTS: name1=value1 ...
12689 @vindex org-table-formula-constants
12690 @vindex org-table-formula
12691 Set file-local values for constants to be used in table formulas. This
12692 line set the local variable @code{org-table-formula-constants-local}.
12693 The global version of this variable is
12694 @code{org-table-formula-constants}.
12695 @item #+FILETAGS: :tag1:tag2:tag3:
12696 Set tags that can be inherited by any entry in the file, including the
12698 @item #+DRAWERS: NAME1 .....
12699 @vindex org-drawers
12700 Set the file-local set of drawers. The corresponding global variable is
12701 @code{org-drawers}.
12702 @item #+LINK: linkword replace
12703 @vindex org-link-abbrev-alist
12704 These lines (several are allowed) specify link abbreviations.
12705 @xref{Link abbreviations}. The corresponding variable is
12706 @code{org-link-abbrev-alist}.
12707 @item #+PRIORITIES: highest lowest default
12708 @vindex org-highest-priority
12709 @vindex org-lowest-priority
12710 @vindex org-default-priority
12711 This line sets the limits and the default for the priorities. All three
12712 must be either letters A-Z or numbers 0-9. The highest priority must
12713 have a lower ASCII number that the lowest priority.
12714 @item #+PROPERTY: Property_Name Value
12715 This line sets a default inheritance value for entries in the current
12716 buffer, most useful for specifying the allowed values of a property.
12717 @cindex #+SETUPFILE
12718 @item #+SETUPFILE: file
12719 This line defines a file that holds more in-buffer setup. Normally this is
12720 entirely ignored. Only when the buffer is parsed for option-setting lines
12721 (i.e. when starting Org-mode for a file, when pressing @kbd{C-c C-c} in a
12722 settings line, or when exporting), then the contents of this file are parsed
12723 as if they had been included in the buffer. In particular, the file can be
12724 any other Org-mode file with internal setup. You can visit the file the
12725 cursor is in the line with @kbd{C-c '}.
12728 This line sets options to be used at startup of Org-mode, when an
12729 Org file is being visited.
12731 The first set of options deals with the initial visibility of the outline
12732 tree. The corresponding variable for global default settings is
12733 @code{org-startup-folded}, with a default value @code{t}, which means
12735 @vindex org-startup-folded
12736 @cindex @code{overview}, STARTUP keyword
12737 @cindex @code{content}, STARTUP keyword
12738 @cindex @code{showall}, STARTUP keyword
12739 @cindex @code{showeverything}, STARTUP keyword
12741 overview @r{top-level headlines only}
12742 content @r{all headlines}
12743 showall @r{no folding of any entries}
12744 showeverything @r{show even drawer contents}
12747 @vindex org-startup-indented
12748 @cindex @code{indent}, STARTUP keyword
12749 @cindex @code{noindent}, STARTUP keyword
12750 Dynamic virtual indentation is controlled by the variable
12751 @code{org-startup-indented}@footnote{Emacs 23 and Org-mode 6.29 are required}
12753 indent @r{start with @code{org-indent-mode} turned on}
12754 noindent @r{start with @code{org-indent-mode} turned off}
12757 @vindex org-startup-align-all-tables
12758 Then there are options for aligning tables upon visiting a file. This
12759 is useful in files containing narrowed table columns. The corresponding
12760 variable is @code{org-startup-align-all-tables}, with a default value
12762 @cindex @code{align}, STARTUP keyword
12763 @cindex @code{noalign}, STARTUP keyword
12765 align @r{align all tables}
12766 noalign @r{don't align tables on startup}
12769 @vindex org-startup-with-inline-images
12770 When visiting a file, inline images can be automatically displayed. The
12771 corresponding variable is @code{org-startup-with-inline-images}, with a
12772 default value @code{nil} to avoid delays when visiting a file.
12773 @cindex @code{inlineimages}, STARTUP keyword
12774 @cindex @code{noinlineimages}, STARTUP keyword
12776 inlineimages @r{show inline images}
12777 noinlineimages @r{don't show inline images on startup}
12780 @vindex org-log-done
12781 @vindex org-log-note-clock-out
12782 @vindex org-log-repeat
12783 Logging the closing and reopening of TODO items and clock intervals can be
12784 configured using these options (see variables @code{org-log-done},
12785 @code{org-log-note-clock-out} and @code{org-log-repeat})
12786 @cindex @code{logdone}, STARTUP keyword
12787 @cindex @code{lognotedone}, STARTUP keyword
12788 @cindex @code{nologdone}, STARTUP keyword
12789 @cindex @code{lognoteclock-out}, STARTUP keyword
12790 @cindex @code{nolognoteclock-out}, STARTUP keyword
12791 @cindex @code{logrepeat}, STARTUP keyword
12792 @cindex @code{lognoterepeat}, STARTUP keyword
12793 @cindex @code{nologrepeat}, STARTUP keyword
12794 @cindex @code{logreschedule}, STARTUP keyword
12795 @cindex @code{lognotereschedule}, STARTUP keyword
12796 @cindex @code{nologreschedule}, STARTUP keyword
12797 @cindex @code{logredeadline}, STARTUP keyword
12798 @cindex @code{lognoteredeadline}, STARTUP keyword
12799 @cindex @code{nologredeadline}, STARTUP keyword
12800 @cindex @code{logrefile}, STARTUP keyword
12801 @cindex @code{lognoterefile}, STARTUP keyword
12802 @cindex @code{nologrefile}, STARTUP keyword
12804 logdone @r{record a timestamp when an item is marked DONE}
12805 lognotedone @r{record timestamp and a note when DONE}
12806 nologdone @r{don't record when items are marked DONE}
12807 logrepeat @r{record a time when reinstating a repeating item}
12808 lognoterepeat @r{record a note when reinstating a repeating item}
12809 nologrepeat @r{do not record when reinstating repeating item}
12810 lognoteclock-out @r{record a note when clocking out}
12811 nolognoteclock-out @r{don't record a note when clocking out}
12812 logreschedule @r{record a timestamp when scheduling time changes}
12813 lognotereschedule @r{record a note when scheduling time changes}
12814 nologreschedule @r{do not record when a scheduling date changes}
12815 logredeadline @r{record a timestamp when deadline changes}
12816 lognoteredeadline @r{record a note when deadline changes}
12817 nologredeadline @r{do not record when a deadline date changes}
12818 logrefile @r{record a timestamp when refiling}
12819 lognoterefile @r{record a note when refiling}
12820 nologrefile @r{do not record when refiling}
12822 @vindex org-hide-leading-stars
12823 @vindex org-odd-levels-only
12824 Here are the options for hiding leading stars in outline headings, and for
12825 indenting outlines. The corresponding variables are
12826 @code{org-hide-leading-stars} and @code{org-odd-levels-only}, both with a
12827 default setting @code{nil} (meaning @code{showstars} and @code{oddeven}).
12828 @cindex @code{hidestars}, STARTUP keyword
12829 @cindex @code{showstars}, STARTUP keyword
12830 @cindex @code{odd}, STARTUP keyword
12831 @cindex @code{even}, STARTUP keyword
12833 hidestars @r{make all but one of the stars starting a headline invisible.}
12834 showstars @r{show all stars starting a headline}
12835 indent @r{virtual indentation according to outline level}
12836 noindent @r{no virtual indentation according to outline level}
12837 odd @r{allow only odd outline levels (1,3,...)}
12838 oddeven @r{allow all outline levels}
12840 @vindex org-put-time-stamp-overlays
12841 @vindex org-time-stamp-overlay-formats
12842 To turn on custom format overlays over timestamps (variables
12843 @code{org-put-time-stamp-overlays} and
12844 @code{org-time-stamp-overlay-formats}), use
12845 @cindex @code{customtime}, STARTUP keyword
12847 customtime @r{overlay custom time format}
12849 @vindex constants-unit-system
12850 The following options influence the table spreadsheet (variable
12851 @code{constants-unit-system}).
12852 @cindex @code{constcgs}, STARTUP keyword
12853 @cindex @code{constSI}, STARTUP keyword
12855 constcgs @r{@file{constants.el} should use the c-g-s unit system}
12856 constSI @r{@file{constants.el} should use the SI unit system}
12858 @vindex org-footnote-define-inline
12859 @vindex org-footnote-auto-label
12860 @vindex org-footnote-auto-adjust
12861 To influence footnote settings, use the following keywords. The
12862 corresponding variables are @code{org-footnote-define-inline},
12863 @code{org-footnote-auto-label}, and @code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}.
12864 @cindex @code{fninline}, STARTUP keyword
12865 @cindex @code{nofninline}, STARTUP keyword
12866 @cindex @code{fnlocal}, STARTUP keyword
12867 @cindex @code{fnprompt}, STARTUP keyword
12868 @cindex @code{fnauto}, STARTUP keyword
12869 @cindex @code{fnconfirm}, STARTUP keyword
12870 @cindex @code{fnplain}, STARTUP keyword
12871 @cindex @code{fnadjust}, STARTUP keyword
12872 @cindex @code{nofnadjust}, STARTUP keyword
12874 fninline @r{define footnotes inline}
12875 fnnoinline @r{define footnotes in separate section}
12876 fnlocal @r{define footnotes near first reference, but not inline}
12877 fnprompt @r{prompt for footnote labels}
12878 fnauto @r{create [fn:1]-like labels automatically (default)}
12879 fnconfirm @r{offer automatic label for editing or confirmation}
12880 fnplain @r{create [1]-like labels automatically}
12881 fnadjust @r{automatically renumber and sort footnotes}
12882 nofnadjust @r{do not renumber and sort automatically}
12884 @cindex org-hide-block-startup
12885 To hide blocks on startup, use these keywords. The corresponding variable is
12886 @code{org-hide-block-startup}.
12887 @cindex @code{hideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
12888 @cindex @code{nohideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
12890 hideblocks @r{Hide all begin/end blocks on startup}
12891 nohideblocks @r{Do not hide blocks on startup}
12893 @cindex org-pretty-entities
12894 The the display of entities as UTF8 characters is governed by the variable
12895 @code{org-pretty-entities} and the keywords
12896 @cindex @code{entitiespretty}, STARTUP keyword
12897 @cindex @code{entitiesplain}, STARTUP keyword
12899 entitiespretty @r{Show entities as UTF8 characters where possible}
12900 entitiesplain @r{Leave entities plain}
12902 @item #+TAGS: TAG1(c1) TAG2(c2)
12903 @vindex org-tag-alist
12904 These lines (several such lines are allowed) specify the valid tags in
12905 this file, and (potentially) the corresponding @emph{fast tag selection}
12906 keys. The corresponding variable is @code{org-tag-alist}.
12908 This line contains the formulas for the table directly above the line.
12909 @item #+TITLE:, #+AUTHOR:, #+EMAIL:, #+LANGUAGE:, #+TEXT:, #+DATE:,
12910 @itemx #+OPTIONS:, #+BIND:, #+XSLT:,
12911 @itemx #+DESCRIPTION:, #+KEYWORDS:,
12912 @itemx #+LATEX_HEADER:, #+STYLE:, #+LINK_UP:, #+LINK_HOME:,
12913 @itemx #+EXPORT_SELECT_TAGS:, #+EXPORT_EXCLUDE_TAGS:
12914 These lines provide settings for exporting files. For more details see
12915 @ref{Export options}.
12916 @item #+TODO: #+SEQ_TODO: #+TYP_TODO:
12917 @vindex org-todo-keywords
12918 These lines set the TODO keywords and their interpretation in the
12919 current file. The corresponding variable is @code{org-todo-keywords}.
12922 @node The very busy C-c C-c key, Clean view, In-buffer settings, Miscellaneous
12923 @section The very busy C-c C-c key
12925 @cindex C-c C-c, overview
12927 The key @kbd{C-c C-c} has many purposes in Org, which are all
12928 mentioned scattered throughout this manual. One specific function of
12929 this key is to add @emph{tags} to a headline (@pxref{Tags}). In many
12930 other circumstances it means something like @emph{``Hey Org, look
12931 here and update according to what you see here''}. Here is a summary of
12932 what this means in different contexts.
12936 If there are highlights in the buffer from the creation of a sparse
12937 tree, or from clock display, remove these highlights.
12939 If the cursor is in one of the special @code{#+KEYWORD} lines, this
12940 triggers scanning the buffer for these lines and updating the
12943 If the cursor is inside a table, realign the table. This command
12944 works even if the automatic table editor has been turned off.
12946 If the cursor is on a @code{#+TBLFM} line, re-apply the formulas to
12949 If the current buffer is a capture buffer, close the note and file it.
12950 With a prefix argument, file it, without further interaction, to the
12953 If the cursor is on a @code{<<<target>>>}, update radio targets and
12954 corresponding links in this buffer.
12956 If the cursor is in a property line or at the start or end of a property
12957 drawer, offer property commands.
12959 If the cursor is at a footnote reference, go to the corresponding
12960 definition, and vice versa.
12962 If the cursor is on a statistics cookie, update it.
12964 If the cursor is in a plain list item with a checkbox, toggle the status
12967 If the cursor is on a numbered item in a plain list, renumber the
12970 If the cursor is on the @code{#+BEGIN} line of a dynamic block, the
12974 @node Clean view, TTY keys, The very busy C-c C-c key, Miscellaneous
12975 @section A cleaner outline view
12976 @cindex hiding leading stars
12977 @cindex dynamic indentation
12978 @cindex odd-levels-only outlines
12979 @cindex clean outline view
12981 Some people find it noisy and distracting that the Org headlines start with a
12982 potentially large number of stars, and that text below the headlines is not
12983 indented. While this is no problem when writing a @emph{book-like} document
12984 where the outline headings are really section headings, in a more
12985 @emph{list-oriented} outline, indented structure is a lot cleaner:
12989 * Top level headline | * Top level headline
12990 ** Second level | * Second level
12991 *** 3rd level | * 3rd level
12992 some text | some text
12993 *** 3rd level | * 3rd level
12994 more text | more text
12995 * Another top level headline | * Another top level headline
13001 If you are using at least Emacs 23.2@footnote{Emacs 23.1 can actually crash
13002 with @code{org-indent-mode}} and version 6.29 of Org, this kind of view can
13003 be achieved dynamically at display time using @code{org-indent-mode}. In
13004 this minor mode, all lines are prefixed for display with the necessary amount
13005 of space@footnote{@code{org-indent-mode} also sets the @code{wrap-prefix}
13006 property, such that @code{visual-line-mode} (or purely setting
13007 @code{word-wrap}) wraps long lines (including headlines) correctly indented.
13008 }. Also headlines are prefixed with additional stars, so that the amount of
13009 indentation shifts by two@footnote{See the variable
13010 @code{org-indent-indentation-per-level}.} spaces per level. All headline
13011 stars but the last one are made invisible using the @code{org-hide}
13012 face@footnote{Turning on @code{org-indent-mode} sets
13013 @code{org-hide-leading-stars} to @code{t} and @code{org-adapt-indentation} to
13014 @code{nil}.} - see below under @samp{2.} for more information on how this
13015 works. You can turn on @code{org-indent-mode} for all files by customizing
13016 the variable @code{org-startup-indented}, or you can turn it on for
13017 individual files using
13023 If you want a similar effect in earlier version of Emacs and/or Org, or if
13024 you want the indentation to be hard space characters so that the plain text
13025 file looks as similar as possible to the Emacs display, Org supports you in
13030 @emph{Indentation of text below headlines}@*
13031 You may indent text below each headline to make the left boundary line up
13032 with the headline, like
13036 more text, now indented
13039 @vindex org-adapt-indentation
13040 Org supports this with paragraph filling, line wrapping, and structure
13041 editing@footnote{See also the variable @code{org-adapt-indentation}.},
13042 preserving or adapting the indentation as appropriate.
13045 @vindex org-hide-leading-stars
13046 @emph{Hiding leading stars}@* You can modify the display in such a way that
13047 all leading stars become invisible. To do this in a global way, configure
13048 the variable @code{org-hide-leading-stars} or change this on a per-file basis
13052 #+STARTUP: hidestars
13053 #+STARTUP: showstars
13056 With hidden stars, the tree becomes:
13060 * Top level headline
13068 @vindex org-hide @r{(face)}
13069 The leading stars are not truly replaced by whitespace, they are only
13070 fontified with the face @code{org-hide} that uses the background color as
13071 font color. If you are not using either white or black background, you may
13072 have to customize this face to get the wanted effect. Another possibility is
13073 to set this font such that the extra stars are @i{almost} invisible, for
13074 example using the color @code{grey90} on a white background.
13077 @vindex org-odd-levels-only
13078 Things become cleaner still if you skip all the even levels and use only odd
13079 levels 1, 3, 5..., effectively adding two stars to go from one outline level
13080 to the next@footnote{When you need to specify a level for a property search
13081 or refile targets, @samp{LEVEL=2} will correspond to 3 stars, etc@.}. In this
13082 way we get the outline view shown at the beginning of this section. In order
13083 to make the structure editing and export commands handle this convention
13084 correctly, configure the variable @code{org-odd-levels-only}, or set this on
13085 a per-file basis with one of the following lines:
13092 You can convert an Org file from single-star-per-level to the
13093 double-star-per-level convention with @kbd{M-x org-convert-to-odd-levels
13094 RET} in that file. The reverse operation is @kbd{M-x
13095 org-convert-to-oddeven-levels}.
13098 @node TTY keys, Interaction, Clean view, Miscellaneous
13099 @section Using Org on a tty
13100 @cindex tty key bindings
13102 Because Org contains a large number of commands, by default many of
13103 Org's core commands are bound to keys that are generally not
13104 accessible on a tty, such as the cursor keys (@key{left}, @key{right},
13105 @key{up}, @key{down}), @key{TAB} and @key{RET}, in particular when used
13106 together with modifiers like @key{Meta} and/or @key{Shift}. To access
13107 these commands on a tty when special keys are unavailable, the following
13108 alternative bindings can be used. The tty bindings below will likely be
13109 more cumbersome; you may find for some of the bindings below that a
13110 customized workaround suits you better. For example, changing a timestamp
13111 is really only fun with @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} keys, whereas on a
13112 tty you would rather use @kbd{C-c .} to re-insert the timestamp.
13114 @multitable @columnfractions 0.15 0.2 0.1 0.2
13115 @item @b{Default} @tab @b{Alternative 1} @tab @b{Speed key} @tab @b{Alternative 2}
13116 @item @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} @tab @kbd{C-u @key{TAB}} @tab @kbd{C} @tab
13117 @item @kbd{M-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x l} @tab @kbd{l} @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{left}}
13118 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x L} @tab @kbd{L} @tab
13119 @item @kbd{M-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x r} @tab @kbd{r} @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{right}}
13120 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x R} @tab @kbd{R} @tab
13121 @item @kbd{M-@key{up}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x u} @tab @kbd{ } @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{up}}
13122 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{up}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x U} @tab @kbd{U} @tab
13123 @item @kbd{M-@key{down}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x d} @tab @kbd{ } @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{down}}
13124 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{down}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x D} @tab @kbd{D} @tab
13125 @item @kbd{S-@key{RET}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x c} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
13126 @item @kbd{M-@key{RET}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x m} @tab @kbd{ } @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{RET}}
13127 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{RET}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x M} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
13128 @item @kbd{S-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{left}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
13129 @item @kbd{S-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{right}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
13130 @item @kbd{S-@key{up}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{up}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
13131 @item @kbd{S-@key{down}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{down}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
13132 @item @kbd{C-S-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x @key{left}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
13133 @item @kbd{C-S-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x @key{right}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
13137 @node Interaction, , TTY keys, Miscellaneous
13138 @section Interaction with other packages
13139 @cindex packages, interaction with other
13140 Org lives in the world of GNU Emacs and interacts in various ways
13141 with other code out there.
13144 * Cooperation:: Packages Org cooperates with
13145 * Conflicts:: Packages that lead to conflicts
13148 @node Cooperation, Conflicts, Interaction, Interaction
13149 @subsection Packages that Org cooperates with
13152 @cindex @file{calc.el}
13153 @cindex Gillespie, Dave
13154 @item @file{calc.el} by Dave Gillespie
13155 Org uses the Calc package for implementing spreadsheet
13156 functionality in its tables (@pxref{The spreadsheet}). Org
13157 checks for the availability of Calc by looking for the function
13158 @code{calc-eval} which will have been autoloaded during setup if Calc has
13159 been installed properly. As of Emacs 22, Calc is part of the Emacs
13160 distribution. Another possibility for interaction between the two
13161 packages is using Calc for embedded calculations. @xref{Embedded Mode,
13162 , Embedded Mode, Calc, GNU Emacs Calc Manual}.
13163 @item @file{constants.el} by Carsten Dominik
13164 @cindex @file{constants.el}
13165 @cindex Dominik, Carsten
13166 @vindex org-table-formula-constants
13167 In a table formula (@pxref{The spreadsheet}), it is possible to use
13168 names for natural constants or units. Instead of defining your own
13169 constants in the variable @code{org-table-formula-constants}, install
13170 the @file{constants} package which defines a large number of constants
13171 and units, and lets you use unit prefixes like @samp{M} for
13172 @samp{Mega}, etc@. You will need version 2.0 of this package, available
13173 at @url{http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik/Tools}. Org checks for
13174 the function @code{constants-get}, which has to be autoloaded in your
13175 setup. See the installation instructions in the file
13176 @file{constants.el}.
13177 @item @file{cdlatex.el} by Carsten Dominik
13178 @cindex @file{cdlatex.el}
13179 @cindex Dominik, Carsten
13180 Org-mode can make use of the CDLa@TeX{} package to efficiently enter
13181 La@TeX{} fragments into Org files. See @ref{CDLaTeX mode}.
13182 @item @file{imenu.el} by Ake Stenhoff and Lars Lindberg
13183 @cindex @file{imenu.el}
13184 Imenu allows menu access to an index of items in a file. Org-mode
13185 supports Imenu---all you need to do to get the index is the following:
13187 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook
13188 (lambda () (imenu-add-to-menubar "Imenu")))
13190 @vindex org-imenu-depth
13191 By default the index is two levels deep---you can modify the depth using
13192 the option @code{org-imenu-depth}.
13193 @item @file{remember.el} by John Wiegley
13194 @cindex @file{remember.el}
13195 @cindex Wiegley, John
13196 Org used to use this package for capture, but no longer does.
13197 @item @file{speedbar.el} by Eric M. Ludlam
13198 @cindex @file{speedbar.el}
13199 @cindex Ludlam, Eric M.
13200 Speedbar is a package that creates a special frame displaying files and
13201 index items in files. Org-mode supports Speedbar and allows you to
13202 drill into Org files directly from the Speedbar. It also allows you to
13203 restrict the scope of agenda commands to a file or a subtree by using
13204 the command @kbd{<} in the Speedbar frame.
13205 @cindex @file{table.el}
13206 @item @file{table.el} by Takaaki Ota
13208 @cindex table editor, @file{table.el}
13209 @cindex @file{table.el}
13210 @cindex Ota, Takaaki
13212 Complex ASCII tables with automatic line wrapping, column- and row-spanning,
13213 and alignment can be created using the Emacs table package by Takaaki Ota
13214 (@uref{http://sourceforge.net/projects/table}, and also part of Emacs 22).
13215 Org-mode will recognize these tables and export them properly. Because of
13216 interference with other Org-mode functionality, you unfortunately cannot edit
13217 these tables directly in the buffer. Instead, you need to use the command
13218 @kbd{C-c '} to edit them, similar to source code snippets.
13221 @orgcmd{C-c ',org-edit-special}
13222 Edit a @file{table.el} table. Works when the cursor is in a table.el table.
13224 @orgcmd{C-c ~,org-table-create-with-table.el}
13225 Insert a @file{table.el} table. If there is already a table at point, this
13226 command converts it between the @file{table.el} format and the Org-mode
13227 format. See the documentation string of the command
13228 @code{org-convert-table} for the restrictions under which this is
13231 @file{table.el} is part of Emacs since Emacs 22.
13232 @item @file{footnote.el} by Steven L. Baur
13233 @cindex @file{footnote.el}
13234 @cindex Baur, Steven L.
13235 Org-mode recognizes numerical footnotes as provided by this package.
13236 However, Org-mode also has its own footnote support (@pxref{Footnotes}),
13237 which makes using @file{footnote.el} unnecessary.
13240 @node Conflicts, , Cooperation, Interaction
13241 @subsection Packages that lead to conflicts with Org-mode
13245 @cindex @code{shift-selection-mode}
13246 @vindex org-support-shift-select
13247 In Emacs 23, @code{shift-selection-mode} is on by default, meaning that
13248 cursor motions combined with the shift key should start or enlarge regions.
13249 This conflicts with the use of @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} commands in Org to change
13250 timestamps, TODO keywords, priorities, and item bullet types if the cursor is
13251 at such a location. By default, @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} commands outside
13252 special contexts don't do anything, but you can customize the variable
13253 @code{org-support-shift-select}. Org-mode then tries to accommodate shift
13254 selection by (i) using it outside of the special contexts where special
13255 commands apply, and by (ii) extending an existing active region even if the
13256 cursor moves across a special context.
13258 @item @file{CUA.el} by Kim. F. Storm
13259 @cindex @file{CUA.el}
13260 @cindex Storm, Kim. F.
13261 @vindex org-replace-disputed-keys
13262 Key bindings in Org conflict with the @kbd{S-<cursor>} keys used by CUA mode
13263 (as well as @code{pc-select-mode} and @code{s-region-mode}) to select and extend the
13264 region. In fact, Emacs 23 has this built-in in the form of
13265 @code{shift-selection-mode}, see previous paragraph. If you are using Emacs
13266 23, you probably don't want to use another package for this purpose. However,
13267 if you prefer to leave these keys to a different package while working in
13268 Org-mode, configure the variable @code{org-replace-disputed-keys}. When set,
13269 Org will move the following key bindings in Org files, and in the agenda
13270 buffer (but not during date selection).
13273 S-UP -> M-p S-DOWN -> M-n
13274 S-LEFT -> M-- S-RIGHT -> M-+
13275 C-S-LEFT -> M-S-- C-S-RIGHT -> M-S-+
13278 @vindex org-disputed-keys
13279 Yes, these are unfortunately more difficult to remember. If you want
13280 to have other replacement keys, look at the variable
13281 @code{org-disputed-keys}.
13283 @item @file{yasnippet.el}
13284 @cindex @file{yasnippet.el}
13285 The way Org-mode binds the TAB key (binding to @code{[tab]} instead of
13286 @code{"\t"}) overrules yasnippets' access to this key. The following code
13287 fixed this problem:
13290 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook
13292 (org-set-local 'yas/trigger-key [tab])
13293 (define-key yas/keymap [tab] 'yas/next-field-group)))
13296 @item @file{windmove.el} by Hovav Shacham
13297 @cindex @file{windmove.el}
13298 This package also uses the @kbd{S-<cursor>} keys, so everything written
13299 in the paragraph above about CUA mode also applies here. If you want make
13300 the windmove function active in locations where Org-mode does not have
13301 special functionality on @kbd{S-@key{cursor}}, add this to your
13305 ;; Make windmove work in org-mode:
13306 (add-hook 'org-shiftup-final-hook 'windmove-up)
13307 (add-hook 'org-shiftleft-final-hook 'windmove-left)
13308 (add-hook 'org-shiftdown-final-hook 'windmove-down)
13309 (add-hook 'org-shiftright-final-hook 'windmove-right)
13312 @item @file{viper.el} by Michael Kifer
13313 @cindex @file{viper.el}
13315 Viper uses @kbd{C-c /} and therefore makes this key not access the
13316 corresponding Org-mode command @code{org-sparse-tree}. You need to find
13317 another key for this command, or override the key in
13318 @code{viper-vi-global-user-map} with
13321 (define-key viper-vi-global-user-map "C-c /" 'org-sparse-tree)
13327 @node Hacking, MobileOrg, Miscellaneous, Top
13331 This appendix covers some aspects where users can extend the functionality of
13335 * Hooks:: Who to reach into Org's internals
13336 * Add-on packages:: Available extensions
13337 * Adding hyperlink types:: New custom link types
13338 * Context-sensitive commands:: How to add functionality to such commands
13339 * Tables in arbitrary syntax:: Orgtbl for La@TeX{} and other programs
13340 * Dynamic blocks:: Automatically filled blocks
13341 * Special agenda views:: Customized views
13342 * Extracting agenda information:: Postprocessing of agenda information
13343 * Using the property API:: Writing programs that use entry properties
13344 * Using the mapping API:: Mapping over all or selected entries
13347 @node Hooks, Add-on packages, Hacking, Hacking
13351 Org has a large number of hook variables that can be used to add
13352 functionality. This appendix about hacking is going to illustrate the
13353 use of some of them. A complete list of all hooks with documentation is
13354 maintained by the Worg project and can be found at
13355 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-configs/org-hooks.php}.
13357 @node Add-on packages, Adding hyperlink types, Hooks, Hacking
13358 @section Add-on packages
13359 @cindex add-on packages
13361 A large number of add-on packages have been written by various authors.
13362 These packages are not part of Emacs, but they are distributed as contributed
13363 packages with the separate release available at the Org-mode home page at
13364 @uref{http://orgmode.org}. The list of contributed packages, along with
13365 documentation about each package, is maintained by the Worg project at
13366 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/}.
13370 @node Adding hyperlink types, Context-sensitive commands, Add-on packages, Hacking
13371 @section Adding hyperlink types
13372 @cindex hyperlinks, adding new types
13374 Org has a large number of hyperlink types built-in
13375 (@pxref{Hyperlinks}). If you would like to add new link types, Org
13376 provides an interface for doing so. Let's look at an example file,
13377 @file{org-man.el}, that will add support for creating links like
13378 @samp{[[man:printf][The printf manpage]]} to show Unix manual pages inside
13382 ;;; org-man.el - Support for links to manpages in Org
13386 (org-add-link-type "man" 'org-man-open)
13387 (add-hook 'org-store-link-functions 'org-man-store-link)
13389 (defcustom org-man-command 'man
13390 "The Emacs command to be used to display a man page."
13392 :type '(choice (const man) (const woman)))
13394 (defun org-man-open (path)
13395 "Visit the manpage on PATH.
13396 PATH should be a topic that can be thrown at the man command."
13397 (funcall org-man-command path))
13399 (defun org-man-store-link ()
13400 "Store a link to a manpage."
13401 (when (memq major-mode '(Man-mode woman-mode))
13402 ;; This is a man page, we do make this link
13403 (let* ((page (org-man-get-page-name))
13404 (link (concat "man:" page))
13405 (description (format "Manpage for %s" page)))
13406 (org-store-link-props
13409 :description description))))
13411 (defun org-man-get-page-name ()
13412 "Extract the page name from the buffer name."
13413 ;; This works for both `Man-mode' and `woman-mode'.
13414 (if (string-match " \\(\\S-+\\)\\*" (buffer-name))
13415 (match-string 1 (buffer-name))
13416 (error "Cannot create link to this man page")))
13420 ;;; org-man.el ends here
13424 You would activate this new link type in @file{.emacs} with
13431 Let's go through the file and see what it does.
13434 It does @code{(require 'org)} to make sure that @file{org.el} has been
13437 The next line calls @code{org-add-link-type} to define a new link type
13438 with prefix @samp{man}. The call also contains the name of a function
13439 that will be called to follow such a link.
13441 @vindex org-store-link-functions
13442 The next line adds a function to @code{org-store-link-functions}, in
13443 order to allow the command @kbd{C-c l} to record a useful link in a
13444 buffer displaying a man page.
13447 The rest of the file defines the necessary variables and functions.
13448 First there is a customization variable that determines which Emacs
13449 command should be used to display man pages. There are two options,
13450 @code{man} and @code{woman}. Then the function to follow a link is
13451 defined. It gets the link path as an argument---in this case the link
13452 path is just a topic for the manual command. The function calls the
13453 value of @code{org-man-command} to display the man page.
13455 Finally the function @code{org-man-store-link} is defined. When you try
13456 to store a link with @kbd{C-c l}, this function will be called to
13457 try to make a link. The function must first decide if it is supposed to
13458 create the link for this buffer type; we do this by checking the value
13459 of the variable @code{major-mode}. If not, the function must exit and
13460 return the value @code{nil}. If yes, the link is created by getting the
13461 manual topic from the buffer name and prefixing it with the string
13462 @samp{man:}. Then it must call the command @code{org-store-link-props}
13463 and set the @code{:type} and @code{:link} properties. Optionally you
13464 can also set the @code{:description} property to provide a default for
13465 the link description when the link is later inserted into an Org
13466 buffer with @kbd{C-c C-l}.
13468 When is makes sense for your new link type, you may also define a function
13469 @code{org-PREFIX-complete-link} that implements special (e.g. completion)
13470 support for inserting such a link with @kbd{C-c C-l}. Such a function should
13471 not accept any arguments, and return the full link with prefix.
13473 @node Context-sensitive commands, Tables in arbitrary syntax, Adding hyperlink types, Hacking
13474 @section Context-sensitive commands
13475 @cindex context-sensitive commands, hooks
13476 @cindex add-ons, context-sensitive commands
13477 @vindex org-ctrl-c-ctrl-c-hook
13479 Org has several commands that act differently depending on context. The most
13480 important example it the @kbd{C-c C-c} (@pxref{The very busy C-c C-c key}).
13481 Also the @kbd{M-cursor} and @kbd{M-S-cursor} keys have this property.
13483 Add-ons can tap into this functionality by providing a function that detects
13484 special context for that add-on and executes functionality appropriate for
13485 the context. Here is an example from Dan Davison's @file{org-R.el} which
13486 allows you to evaluate commands based on the @file{R} programming language
13487 @footnote{@file{org-R.el} has been replaced by the org-mode functionality
13488 described in @ref{Working With Source Code} and is now obsolete.}. For this
13489 package, special contexts are lines that start with @code{#+R:} or
13493 (defun org-R-apply-maybe ()
13494 "Detect if this is context for org-R and execute R commands."
13495 (if (save-excursion
13496 (beginning-of-line 1)
13497 (looking-at "#\\+RR?:"))
13498 (progn (call-interactively 'org-R-apply)
13499 t) ;; to signal that we took action
13500 nil)) ;; to signal that we did not
13502 (add-hook 'org-ctrl-c-ctrl-c-hook 'org-R-apply-maybe)
13505 The function first checks if the cursor is in such a line. If that is the
13506 case, @code{org-R-apply} is called and the function returns @code{t} to
13507 signal that action was taken, and @kbd{C-c C-c} will stop looking for other
13508 contexts. If the function finds it should do nothing locally, it returns @code{nil} so that other, similar functions can have a try.
13511 @node Tables in arbitrary syntax, Dynamic blocks, Context-sensitive commands, Hacking
13512 @section Tables and lists in arbitrary syntax
13513 @cindex tables, in other modes
13514 @cindex lists, in other modes
13515 @cindex Orgtbl mode
13517 Since Orgtbl mode can be used as a minor mode in arbitrary buffers, a
13518 frequent feature request has been to make it work with native tables in
13519 specific languages, for example La@TeX{}. However, this is extremely
13520 hard to do in a general way, would lead to a customization nightmare,
13521 and would take away much of the simplicity of the Orgtbl-mode table
13524 This appendix describes a different approach. We keep the Orgtbl mode
13525 table in its native format (the @i{source table}), and use a custom
13526 function to @i{translate} the table to the correct syntax, and to
13527 @i{install} it in the right location (the @i{target table}). This puts
13528 the burden of writing conversion functions on the user, but it allows
13529 for a very flexible system.
13531 Bastien added the ability to do the same with lists, in Orgstruct mode. You
13532 can use Org's facilities to edit and structure lists by turning
13533 @code{orgstruct-mode} on, then locally exporting such lists in another format
13534 (HTML, La@TeX{} or Texinfo.)
13538 * Radio tables:: Sending and receiving radio tables
13539 * A LaTeX example:: Step by step, almost a tutorial
13540 * Translator functions:: Copy and modify
13541 * Radio lists:: Doing the same for lists
13544 @node Radio tables, A LaTeX example, Tables in arbitrary syntax, Tables in arbitrary syntax
13545 @subsection Radio tables
13546 @cindex radio tables
13548 To define the location of the target table, you first need to create two
13549 lines that are comments in the current mode, but contain magic words for
13550 Orgtbl mode to find. Orgtbl mode will insert the translated table
13551 between these lines, replacing whatever was there before. For example:
13554 /* BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL table_name */
13555 /* END RECEIVE ORGTBL table_name */
13559 Just above the source table, we put a special line that tells
13560 Orgtbl mode how to translate this table and where to install it. For
13564 #+ORGTBL: SEND table_name translation_function arguments....
13568 @code{table_name} is the reference name for the table that is also used
13569 in the receiver lines. @code{translation_function} is the Lisp function
13570 that does the translation. Furthermore, the line can contain a list of
13571 arguments (alternating key and value) at the end. The arguments will be
13572 passed as a property list to the translation function for
13573 interpretation. A few standard parameters are already recognized and
13574 acted upon before the translation function is called:
13578 Skip the first N lines of the table. Hlines do count as separate lines for
13581 @item :skipcols (n1 n2 ...)
13582 List of columns that should be skipped. If the table has a column with
13583 calculation marks, that column is automatically discarded as well.
13584 Please note that the translator function sees the table @emph{after} the
13585 removal of these columns, the function never knows that there have been
13586 additional columns.
13590 The one problem remaining is how to keep the source table in the buffer
13591 without disturbing the normal workings of the file, for example during
13592 compilation of a C file or processing of a La@TeX{} file. There are a
13593 number of different solutions:
13597 The table could be placed in a block comment if that is supported by the
13598 language. For example, in C mode you could wrap the table between
13599 @samp{/*} and @samp{*/} lines.
13601 Sometimes it is possible to put the table after some kind of @i{END}
13602 statement, for example @samp{\bye} in @TeX{} and @samp{\end@{document@}}
13605 You can just comment the table line-by-line whenever you want to process
13606 the file, and uncomment it whenever you need to edit the table. This
13607 only sounds tedious---the command @kbd{M-x orgtbl-toggle-comment}
13608 makes this comment-toggling very easy, in particular if you bind it to a
13612 @node A LaTeX example, Translator functions, Radio tables, Tables in arbitrary syntax
13613 @subsection A La@TeX{} example of radio tables
13614 @cindex La@TeX{}, and Orgtbl mode
13616 The best way to wrap the source table in La@TeX{} is to use the
13617 @code{comment} environment provided by @file{comment.sty}. It has to be
13618 activated by placing @code{\usepackage@{comment@}} into the document
13619 header. Orgtbl mode can insert a radio table skeleton@footnote{By
13620 default this works only for La@TeX{}, HTML, and Texinfo. Configure the
13621 variable @code{orgtbl-radio-tables} to install templates for other
13622 modes.} with the command @kbd{M-x orgtbl-insert-radio-table}. You will
13623 be prompted for a table name, let's say we use @samp{salesfigures}. You
13624 will then get the following template:
13626 @cindex #+ORGTBL, SEND
13628 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
13629 % END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
13631 #+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex
13637 @vindex La@TeX{}-verbatim-environments
13638 The @code{#+ORGTBL: SEND} line tells Orgtbl mode to use the function
13639 @code{orgtbl-to-latex} to convert the table into La@TeX{} and to put it
13640 into the receiver location with name @code{salesfigures}. You may now
13641 fill in the table, feel free to use the spreadsheet features@footnote{If
13642 the @samp{#+TBLFM} line contains an odd number of dollar characters,
13643 this may cause problems with font-lock in La@TeX{} mode. As shown in the
13644 example you can fix this by adding an extra line inside the
13645 @code{comment} environment that is used to balance the dollar
13646 expressions. If you are using AUC@TeX{} with the font-latex library, a
13647 much better solution is to add the @code{comment} environment to the
13648 variable @code{LaTeX-verbatim-environments}.}:
13651 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
13652 % END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
13654 #+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex
13655 | Month | Days | Nr sold | per day |
13656 |-------+------+---------+---------|
13657 | Jan | 23 | 55 | 2.4 |
13658 | Feb | 21 | 16 | 0.8 |
13659 | March | 22 | 278 | 12.6 |
13660 #+TBLFM: $4=$3/$2;%.1f
13661 % $ (optional extra dollar to keep font-lock happy, see footnote)
13666 When you are done, press @kbd{C-c C-c} in the table to get the converted
13667 table inserted between the two marker lines.
13669 Now let's assume you want to make the table header by hand, because you
13670 want to control how columns are aligned, etc@. In this case we make sure
13671 that the table translator skips the first 2 lines of the source
13672 table, and tell the command to work as a @i{splice}, i.e. to not produce
13673 header and footer commands of the target table:
13676 \begin@{tabular@}@{lrrr@}
13677 Month & \multicolumn@{1@}@{c@}@{Days@} & Nr.\ sold & per day\\
13678 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
13679 % END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
13683 #+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex :splice t :skip 2
13684 | Month | Days | Nr sold | per day |
13685 |-------+------+---------+---------|
13686 | Jan | 23 | 55 | 2.4 |
13687 | Feb | 21 | 16 | 0.8 |
13688 | March | 22 | 278 | 12.6 |
13689 #+TBLFM: $4=$3/$2;%.1f
13693 The La@TeX{} translator function @code{orgtbl-to-latex} is already part of
13694 Orgtbl mode. It uses a @code{tabular} environment to typeset the table
13695 and marks horizontal lines with @code{\hline}. Furthermore, it
13696 interprets the following parameters (see also @pxref{Translator functions}):
13699 @item :splice nil/t
13700 When set to t, return only table body lines, don't wrap them into a
13701 tabular environment. Default is nil.
13704 A format to be used to wrap each field, it should contain @code{%s} for the
13705 original field value. For example, to wrap each field value in dollars,
13706 you could use @code{:fmt "$%s$"}. This may also be a property list with
13707 column numbers and formats. for example @code{:fmt (2 "$%s$" 4 "%s\\%%")}.
13708 A function of one argument can be used in place of the strings; the
13709 function must return a formatted string.
13712 Use this format to print numbers with exponentials. The format should
13713 have @code{%s} twice for inserting mantissa and exponent, for example
13714 @code{"%s\\times10^@{%s@}"}. The default is @code{"%s\\,(%s)"}. This
13715 may also be a property list with column numbers and formats, for example
13716 @code{:efmt (2 "$%s\\times10^@{%s@}$" 4 "$%s\\cdot10^@{%s@}$")}. After
13717 @code{efmt} has been applied to a value, @code{fmt} will also be
13718 applied. Similar to @code{fmt}, functions of two arguments can be
13719 supplied instead of strings.
13722 @node Translator functions, Radio lists, A LaTeX example, Tables in arbitrary syntax
13723 @subsection Translator functions
13724 @cindex HTML, and Orgtbl mode
13725 @cindex translator function
13727 Orgtbl mode has several translator functions built-in: @code{orgtbl-to-csv}
13728 (comma-separated values), @code{orgtbl-to-tsv} (TAB-separated values)
13729 @code{orgtbl-to-latex}, @code{orgtbl-to-html}, and @code{orgtbl-to-texinfo}.
13730 Except for @code{orgtbl-to-html}@footnote{The HTML translator uses the same
13731 code that produces tables during HTML export.}, these all use a generic
13732 translator, @code{orgtbl-to-generic}. For example, @code{orgtbl-to-latex}
13733 itself is a very short function that computes the column definitions for the
13734 @code{tabular} environment, defines a few field and line separators and then
13735 hands processing over to the generic translator. Here is the entire code:
13739 (defun orgtbl-to-latex (table params)
13740 "Convert the Orgtbl mode TABLE to LaTeX."
13741 (let* ((alignment (mapconcat (lambda (x) (if x "r" "l"))
13742 org-table-last-alignment ""))
13745 :tstart (concat "\\begin@{tabular@}@{" alignment "@}")
13746 :tend "\\end@{tabular@}"
13747 :lstart "" :lend " \\\\" :sep " & "
13748 :efmt "%s\\,(%s)" :hline "\\hline")))
13749 (orgtbl-to-generic table (org-combine-plists params2 params))))
13753 As you can see, the properties passed into the function (variable
13754 @var{PARAMS}) are combined with the ones newly defined in the function
13755 (variable @var{PARAMS2}). The ones passed into the function (i.e. the
13756 ones set by the @samp{ORGTBL SEND} line) take precedence. So if you
13757 would like to use the La@TeX{} translator, but wanted the line endings to
13758 be @samp{\\[2mm]} instead of the default @samp{\\}, you could just
13759 overrule the default with
13762 #+ORGTBL: SEND test orgtbl-to-latex :lend " \\\\[2mm]"
13765 For a new language, you can either write your own converter function in
13766 analogy with the La@TeX{} translator, or you can use the generic function
13767 directly. For example, if you have a language where a table is started
13768 with @samp{!BTBL!}, ended with @samp{!ETBL!}, and where table lines are
13769 started with @samp{!BL!}, ended with @samp{!EL!}, and where the field
13770 separator is a TAB, you could call the generic translator like this (on
13774 #+ORGTBL: SEND test orgtbl-to-generic :tstart "!BTBL!" :tend "!ETBL!"
13775 :lstart "!BL! " :lend " !EL!" :sep "\t"
13779 Please check the documentation string of the function
13780 @code{orgtbl-to-generic} for a full list of parameters understood by
13781 that function, and remember that you can pass each of them into
13782 @code{orgtbl-to-latex}, @code{orgtbl-to-texinfo}, and any other function
13783 using the generic function.
13785 Of course you can also write a completely new function doing complicated
13786 things the generic translator cannot do. A translator function takes
13787 two arguments. The first argument is the table, a list of lines, each
13788 line either the symbol @code{hline} or a list of fields. The second
13789 argument is the property list containing all parameters specified in the
13790 @samp{#+ORGTBL: SEND} line. The function must return a single string
13791 containing the formatted table. If you write a generally useful
13792 translator, please post it on @email{emacs-orgmode@@gnu.org} so that
13793 others can benefit from your work.
13795 @node Radio lists, , Translator functions, Tables in arbitrary syntax
13796 @subsection Radio lists
13797 @cindex radio lists
13798 @cindex org-list-insert-radio-list
13800 Sending and receiving radio lists works exactly the same way than sending and
13801 receiving radio tables (@pxref{Radio tables}). As for radio tables, you can
13802 insert radio lists templates in HTML, La@TeX{} and Texinfo modes by calling
13803 @code{org-list-insert-radio-list}.
13805 Here are the differences with radio tables:
13809 Orgstruct mode must be active.
13811 Use the @code{ORGLST} keyword instead of @code{ORGTBL}.
13813 The available translation functions for radio lists don't take
13816 @kbd{C-c C-c} will work when pressed on the first item of the list.
13819 Here is a La@TeX{} example. Let's say that you have this in your
13824 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGLST to-buy
13825 % END RECEIVE ORGLST to-buy
13827 #+ORGLST: SEND to-buy org-list-to-latex
13836 Pressing `C-c C-c' on @code{a new house} and will insert the converted
13837 La@TeX{} list between the two marker lines.
13839 @node Dynamic blocks, Special agenda views, Tables in arbitrary syntax, Hacking
13840 @section Dynamic blocks
13841 @cindex dynamic blocks
13843 Org documents can contain @emph{dynamic blocks}. These are
13844 specially marked regions that are updated by some user-written function.
13845 A good example for such a block is the clock table inserted by the
13846 command @kbd{C-c C-x C-r} (@pxref{Clocking work time}).
13848 Dynamic block are enclosed by a BEGIN-END structure that assigns a name
13849 to the block and can also specify parameters for the function producing
13850 the content of the block.
13852 #+BEGIN:dynamic block
13854 #+BEGIN: myblock :parameter1 value1 :parameter2 value2 ...
13859 Dynamic blocks are updated with the following commands
13862 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-u,org-dblock-update}
13863 Update dynamic block at point.
13864 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-x C-u}
13865 Update all dynamic blocks in the current file.
13868 Updating a dynamic block means to remove all the text between BEGIN and
13869 END, parse the BEGIN line for parameters and then call the specific
13870 writer function for this block to insert the new content. If you want
13871 to use the original content in the writer function, you can use the
13872 extra parameter @code{:content}.
13874 For a block with name @code{myblock}, the writer function is
13875 @code{org-dblock-write:myblock} with as only parameter a property list
13876 with the parameters given in the begin line. Here is a trivial example
13877 of a block that keeps track of when the block update function was last
13881 #+BEGIN: block-update-time :format "on %m/%d/%Y at %H:%M"
13887 The corresponding block writer function could look like this:
13890 (defun org-dblock-write:block-update-time (params)
13891 (let ((fmt (or (plist-get params :format) "%d. %m. %Y")))
13892 (insert "Last block update at: "
13893 (format-time-string fmt (current-time)))))
13896 If you want to make sure that all dynamic blocks are always up-to-date,
13897 you could add the function @code{org-update-all-dblocks} to a hook, for
13898 example @code{before-save-hook}. @code{org-update-all-dblocks} is
13899 written in a way such that it does nothing in buffers that are not in
13902 @node Special agenda views, Extracting agenda information, Dynamic blocks, Hacking
13903 @section Special agenda views
13904 @cindex agenda views, user-defined
13906 Org provides a special hook that can be used to narrow down the selection
13907 made by these agenda views: @code{todo}, @code{alltodo}, @code{tags}, @code{tags-todo},
13908 @code{tags-tree}. You may specify a function that is used at each match to verify
13909 if the match should indeed be part of the agenda view, and if not, how
13910 much should be skipped.
13912 Let's say you want to produce a list of projects that contain a WAITING
13913 tag anywhere in the project tree. Let's further assume that you have
13914 marked all tree headings that define a project with the TODO keyword
13915 PROJECT. In this case you would run a TODO search for the keyword
13916 PROJECT, but skip the match unless there is a WAITING tag anywhere in
13917 the subtree belonging to the project line.
13919 To achieve this, you must write a function that searches the subtree for
13920 the tag. If the tag is found, the function must return @code{nil} to
13921 indicate that this match should not be skipped. If there is no such
13922 tag, return the location of the end of the subtree, to indicate that
13923 search should continue from there.
13926 (defun my-skip-unless-waiting ()
13927 "Skip trees that are not waiting"
13928 (let ((subtree-end (save-excursion (org-end-of-subtree t))))
13929 (if (re-search-forward ":waiting:" subtree-end t)
13930 nil ; tag found, do not skip
13931 subtree-end))) ; tag not found, continue after end of subtree
13934 Now you may use this function in an agenda custom command, for example
13938 (org-add-agenda-custom-command
13939 '("b" todo "PROJECT"
13940 ((org-agenda-skip-function 'my-skip-unless-waiting)
13941 (org-agenda-overriding-header "Projects waiting for something: "))))
13944 @vindex org-agenda-overriding-header
13945 Note that this also binds @code{org-agenda-overriding-header} to get a
13946 meaningful header in the agenda view.
13948 @vindex org-odd-levels-only
13949 @vindex org-agenda-skip-function
13950 A general way to create custom searches is to base them on a search for
13951 entries with a certain level limit. If you want to study all entries with
13952 your custom search function, simply do a search for
13953 @samp{LEVEL>0}@footnote{Note that, when using @code{org-odd-levels-only}, a
13954 level number corresponds to order in the hierarchy, not to the number of
13955 stars.}, and then use @code{org-agenda-skip-function} to select the entries
13956 you really want to have.
13958 You may also put a Lisp form into @code{org-agenda-skip-function}. In
13959 particular, you may use the functions @code{org-agenda-skip-entry-if}
13960 and @code{org-agenda-skip-subtree-if} in this form, for example:
13963 @item '(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'scheduled)
13964 Skip current entry if it has been scheduled.
13965 @item '(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'notscheduled)
13966 Skip current entry if it has not been scheduled.
13967 @item '(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'deadline)
13968 Skip current entry if it has a deadline.
13969 @item '(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'scheduled 'deadline)
13970 Skip current entry if it has a deadline, or if it is scheduled.
13971 @item '(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'todo '("TODO" "WAITING"))
13972 Skip current entry if the TODO keyword is TODO or WAITING.
13973 @item '(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'todo 'done)
13974 Skip current entry if the TODO keyword marks a DONE state.
13975 @item '(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'timestamp)
13976 Skip current entry if it has any timestamp, may also be deadline or scheduled.
13977 @item '(org-agenda-skip-entry 'regexp "regular expression")
13978 Skip current entry if the regular expression matches in the entry.
13979 @item '(org-agenda-skip-entry 'notregexp "regular expression")
13980 Skip current entry unless the regular expression matches.
13981 @item '(org-agenda-skip-subtree-if 'regexp "regular expression")
13982 Same as above, but check and skip the entire subtree.
13985 Therefore we could also have written the search for WAITING projects
13986 like this, even without defining a special function:
13989 (org-add-agenda-custom-command
13990 '("b" todo "PROJECT"
13991 ((org-agenda-skip-function '(org-agenda-skip-subtree-if
13992 'regexp ":waiting:"))
13993 (org-agenda-overriding-header "Projects waiting for something: "))))
13996 @node Extracting agenda information, Using the property API, Special agenda views, Hacking
13997 @section Extracting agenda information
13998 @cindex agenda, pipe
13999 @cindex Scripts, for agenda processing
14001 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
14002 Org provides commands to access agenda information for the command
14003 line in Emacs batch mode. This extracted information can be sent
14004 directly to a printer, or it can be read by a program that does further
14005 processing of the data. The first of these commands is the function
14006 @code{org-batch-agenda}, that produces an agenda view and sends it as
14007 ASCII text to STDOUT. The command takes a single string as parameter.
14008 If the string has length 1, it is used as a key to one of the commands
14009 you have configured in @code{org-agenda-custom-commands}, basically any
14010 key you can use after @kbd{C-c a}. For example, to directly print the
14011 current TODO list, you could use
14014 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -eval '(org-batch-agenda "t")' | lpr
14017 If the parameter is a string with 2 or more characters, it is used as a
14018 tags/TODO match string. For example, to print your local shopping list
14019 (all items with the tag @samp{shop}, but excluding the tag
14020 @samp{NewYork}), you could use
14023 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs \
14024 -eval '(org-batch-agenda "+shop-NewYork")' | lpr
14028 You may also modify parameters on the fly like this:
14031 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs \
14032 -eval '(org-batch-agenda "a" \
14033 org-agenda-ndays 30 \
14034 org-agenda-include-diary nil \
14035 org-agenda-files (quote ("~/org/project.org")))' \
14040 which will produce a 30-day agenda, fully restricted to the Org file
14041 @file{~/org/projects.org}, not even including the diary.
14043 If you want to process the agenda data in more sophisticated ways, you
14044 can use the command @code{org-batch-agenda-csv} to get a comma-separated
14045 list of values for each agenda item. Each line in the output will
14046 contain a number of fields separated by commas. The fields in a line
14050 category @r{The category of the item}
14051 head @r{The headline, without TODO keyword, TAGS and PRIORITY}
14052 type @r{The type of the agenda entry, can be}
14053 todo @r{selected in TODO match}
14054 tagsmatch @r{selected in tags match}
14055 diary @r{imported from diary}
14056 deadline @r{a deadline}
14057 scheduled @r{scheduled}
14058 timestamp @r{appointment, selected by timestamp}
14059 closed @r{entry was closed on date}
14060 upcoming-deadline @r{warning about nearing deadline}
14061 past-scheduled @r{forwarded scheduled item}
14062 block @r{entry has date block including date}
14063 todo @r{The TODO keyword, if any}
14064 tags @r{All tags including inherited ones, separated by colons}
14065 date @r{The relevant date, like 2007-2-14}
14066 time @r{The time, like 15:00-16:50}
14067 extra @r{String with extra planning info}
14068 priority-l @r{The priority letter if any was given}
14069 priority-n @r{The computed numerical priority}
14073 Time and date will only be given if a timestamp (or deadline/scheduled)
14074 led to the selection of the item.
14076 A CSV list like this is very easy to use in a post-processing script.
14077 For example, here is a Perl program that gets the TODO list from
14078 Emacs/Org and prints all the items, preceded by a checkbox:
14083 # define the Emacs command to run
14084 $cmd = "emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -eval '(org-batch-agenda-csv \"t\")'";
14086 # run it and capture the output
14087 $agenda = qx@{$cmd 2>/dev/null@};
14089 # loop over all lines
14090 foreach $line (split(/\n/,$agenda)) @{
14091 # get the individual values
14092 ($category,$head,$type,$todo,$tags,$date,$time,$extra,
14093 $priority_l,$priority_n) = split(/,/,$line);
14094 # process and print
14095 print "[ ] $head\n";
14099 @node Using the property API, Using the mapping API, Extracting agenda information, Hacking
14100 @section Using the property API
14101 @cindex API, for properties
14102 @cindex properties, API
14104 Here is a description of the functions that can be used to work with
14107 @defun org-entry-properties &optional pom which
14108 Get all properties of the entry at point-or-marker POM.@*
14109 This includes the TODO keyword, the tags, time strings for deadline,
14110 scheduled, and clocking, and any additional properties defined in the
14111 entry. The return value is an alist, keys may occur multiple times
14112 if the property key was used several times.@*
14113 POM may also be nil, in which case the current entry is used.
14114 If WHICH is nil or `all', get all properties. If WHICH is
14115 `special' or `standard', only get that subclass.
14117 @vindex org-use-property-inheritance
14118 @defun org-entry-get pom property &optional inherit
14119 Get value of PROPERTY for entry at point-or-marker POM. By default,
14120 this only looks at properties defined locally in the entry. If INHERIT
14121 is non-nil and the entry does not have the property, then also check
14122 higher levels of the hierarchy. If INHERIT is the symbol
14123 @code{selective}, use inheritance if and only if the setting of
14124 @code{org-use-property-inheritance} selects PROPERTY for inheritance.
14127 @defun org-entry-delete pom property
14128 Delete the property PROPERTY from entry at point-or-marker POM.
14131 @defun org-entry-put pom property value
14132 Set PROPERTY to VALUE for entry at point-or-marker POM.
14135 @defun org-buffer-property-keys &optional include-specials
14136 Get all property keys in the current buffer.
14139 @defun org-insert-property-drawer
14140 Insert a property drawer at point.
14143 @defun org-entry-put-multivalued-property pom property &rest values
14144 Set PROPERTY at point-or-marker POM to VALUES. VALUES should be a list of
14145 strings. They will be concatenated, with spaces as separators.
14148 @defun org-entry-get-multivalued-property pom property
14149 Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
14150 values and return the values as a list of strings.
14153 @defun org-entry-add-to-multivalued-property pom property value
14154 Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
14155 values and make sure that VALUE is in this list.
14158 @defun org-entry-remove-from-multivalued-property pom property value
14159 Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
14160 values and make sure that VALUE is @emph{not} in this list.
14163 @defun org-entry-member-in-multivalued-property pom property value
14164 Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
14165 values and check if VALUE is in this list.
14168 @defopt org-property-allowed-value-functions
14169 Hook for functions supplying allowed values for specific.
14170 The functions must take a single argument, the name of the property, and
14171 return a flat list of allowed values. If @samp{:ETC} is one of
14172 the values, use the values as completion help, but allow also other values
14173 to be entered. The functions must return @code{nil} if they are not
14174 responsible for this property.
14177 @node Using the mapping API, , Using the property API, Hacking
14178 @section Using the mapping API
14179 @cindex API, for mapping
14180 @cindex mapping entries, API
14182 Org has sophisticated mapping capabilities to find all entries satisfying
14183 certain criteria. Internally, this functionality is used to produce agenda
14184 views, but there is also an API that can be used to execute arbitrary
14185 functions for each or selected entries. The main entry point for this API
14188 @defun org-map-entries func &optional match scope &rest skip
14189 Call FUNC at each headline selected by MATCH in SCOPE.
14191 FUNC is a function or a Lisp form. The function will be called without
14192 arguments, with the cursor positioned at the beginning of the headline.
14193 The return values of all calls to the function will be collected and
14194 returned as a list.
14196 The call to FUNC will be wrapped into a save-excursion form, so FUNC
14197 does not need to preserve point. After evaluation, the cursor will be
14198 moved to the end of the line (presumably of the headline of the
14199 processed entry) and search continues from there. Under some
14200 circumstances, this may not produce the wanted results. For example,
14201 if you have removed (e.g. archived) the current (sub)tree it could
14202 mean that the next entry will be skipped entirely. In such cases, you
14203 can specify the position from where search should continue by making
14204 FUNC set the variable `org-map-continue-from' to the desired buffer
14207 MATCH is a tags/property/todo match as it is used in the agenda match view.
14208 Only headlines that are matched by this query will be considered during
14209 the iteration. When MATCH is nil or t, all headlines will be
14210 visited by the iteration.
14212 SCOPE determines the scope of this command. It can be any of:
14215 nil @r{the current buffer, respecting the restriction if any}
14216 tree @r{the subtree started with the entry at point}
14217 file @r{the current buffer, without restriction}
14219 @r{the current buffer, and any archives associated with it}
14220 agenda @r{all agenda files}
14221 agenda-with-archives
14222 @r{all agenda files with any archive files associated with them}
14224 @r{if this is a list, all files in the list will be scanned}
14227 The remaining args are treated as settings for the skipping facilities of
14228 the scanner. The following items can be given here:
14230 @vindex org-agenda-skip-function
14232 archive @r{skip trees with the archive tag}
14233 comment @r{skip trees with the COMMENT keyword}
14234 function or Lisp form
14235 @r{will be used as value for @code{org-agenda-skip-function},}
14236 @r{so whenever the function returns t, FUNC}
14237 @r{will not be called for that entry and search will}
14238 @r{continue from the point where the function leaves it}
14242 The function given to that mapping routine can really do anything you like.
14243 It can use the property API (@pxref{Using the property API}) to gather more
14244 information about the entry, or in order to change metadata in the entry.
14245 Here are a couple of functions that might be handy:
14247 @defun org-todo &optional arg
14248 Change the TODO state of the entry, see the docstring of the functions for
14249 the many possible values for the argument ARG.
14252 @defun org-priority &optional action
14253 Change the priority of the entry, see the docstring of this function for the
14254 possible values for ACTION.
14257 @defun org-toggle-tag tag &optional onoff
14258 Toggle the tag TAG in the current entry. Setting ONOFF to either @code{on}
14259 or @code{off} will not toggle tag, but ensure that it is either on or off.
14263 Promote the current entry.
14267 Demote the current entry.
14270 Here is a simple example that will turn all entries in the current file with
14271 a tag @code{TOMORROW} into TODO entries with the keyword @code{UPCOMING}.
14272 Entries in comment trees and in archive trees will be ignored.
14276 '(org-todo "UPCOMING")
14277 "+TOMORROW" 'file 'archive 'comment)
14280 The following example counts the number of entries with TODO keyword
14281 @code{WAITING}, in all agenda files.
14284 (length (org-map-entries t "/+WAITING" 'agenda))
14287 @node MobileOrg, History and Acknowledgments, Hacking, Top
14288 @appendix MobileOrg
14292 @uref{http://mobileorg.ncogni.to/, MobileOrg} is an application for the
14293 @i{iPhone/iPod Touch} series of devices, developed by Richard Moreland.
14294 @i{MobileOrg} offers offline viewing and capture support for an Org-mode
14295 system rooted on a ``real'' computer. It does also allow you to record
14296 changes to existing entries. Android users should check out
14297 @uref{http://wiki.github.com/matburt/mobileorg-android/, MobileOrg Android}
14300 This appendix describes the support Org has for creating agenda views in a
14301 format that can be displayed by @i{MobileOrg}, and for integrating notes
14302 captured and changes made by @i{MobileOrg} into the main system.
14304 For changing tags and TODO states in MobileOrg, you should have set up the
14305 customization variables @code{org-todo-keywords} and @code{org-tags-alist} to
14306 cover all important tags and TODO keywords, even if individual files use only
14307 part of these. MobileOrg will also offer you states and tags set up with
14308 in-buffer settings, but it will understand the logistics of TODO state
14309 @i{sets} (@pxref{Per-file keywords}) and @i{mutually exclusive} tags
14310 (@pxref{Setting tags}) only for those set in these variables.
14313 * Setting up the staging area:: Where to interact with the mobile device
14314 * Pushing to MobileOrg:: Uploading Org files and agendas
14315 * Pulling from MobileOrg:: Integrating captured and flagged items
14318 @node Setting up the staging area, Pushing to MobileOrg, MobileOrg, MobileOrg
14319 @section Setting up the staging area
14321 MobileOrg needs to interact with Emacs through directory on a server. If you
14322 are using a public server, you should consider to encrypt the files that are
14323 uploaded to the server. This can be done with Org-mode 7.02 and with
14324 @i{MobileOrg 1.5} (iPhone version), and you need an @file{openssl}
14325 installation on your system. To turn on encryption, set a password in
14326 @i{MobileOrg} and, on the Emacs side, configure the variable
14327 @code{org-mobile-use-encryption}@footnote{If you can safely store the
14328 password in your Emacs setup, you might also want to configure
14329 @code{org-mobile-encryption-password}. Please read the docstring of that
14330 variable. Note that encryption will apply only to the contents of the
14331 @file{.org} files. The file names themselves will remain visible.}.
14333 The easiest way to create that directory is to use a free
14334 @uref{http://dropbox.com,Dropbox.com} account@footnote{If you cannot use
14335 Dropbox, or if your version of MobileOrg does not support it, you can use a
14336 webdav server. For more information, check out the the documentation of
14337 MobileOrg and also this
14338 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-faq.php#mobileorg_webdav, FAQ entry}.}.
14339 When MobileOrg first connects to your Dropbox, it will create a directory
14340 @i{MobileOrg} inside the Dropbox. After the directory has been created, tell
14344 (setq org-mobile-directory "~/Dropbox/MobileOrg")
14347 Org-mode has commands to put files for @i{MobileOrg} into that directory,
14348 and to read captured notes from there.
14350 @node Pushing to MobileOrg, Pulling from MobileOrg, Setting up the staging area, MobileOrg
14351 @section Pushing to MobileOrg
14353 This operation copies all files currently listed in @code{org-mobile-files}
14354 to the directory @code{org-mobile-directory}. By default this list contains
14355 all agenda files (as listed in @code{org-agenda-files}), but additional files
14356 can be included by customizing @code{org-mobiles-files}. File names will be
14357 staged with path relative to @code{org-directory}, so all files should be
14358 inside this directory. The push operation also creates a special Org file
14359 @file{agendas.org} with all custom agenda view defined by the
14360 user@footnote{While creating the agendas, Org-mode will force ID properties
14361 on all referenced entries, so that these entries can be uniquely identified
14362 if @i{MobileOrg} flags them for further action. If you do not want to get
14363 these properties in so many entries, you can set the variable
14364 @code{org-mobile-force-id-on-agenda-items} to @code{nil}. Org mode will then
14365 rely on outline paths, in the hope that these will be unique enough.}.
14366 Finally, Org writes the file @file{index.org}, containing links to all other
14367 files. @i{MobileOrg} first reads this file from the server, and then
14368 downloads all agendas and Org files listed in it. To speed up the download,
14369 MobileOrg will only read files whose checksums@footnote{stored automatically
14370 in the file @file{checksums.dat}} have changed.
14372 @node Pulling from MobileOrg, , Pushing to MobileOrg, MobileOrg
14373 @section Pulling from MobileOrg
14375 When @i{MobileOrg} synchronizes with the server, it not only pulls the Org
14376 files for viewing. It also appends captured entries and pointers to flagged
14377 and changed entries to the file @file{mobileorg.org} on the server. Org has
14378 a @emph{pull} operation that integrates this information into an inbox file
14379 and operates on the pointers to flagged entries. Here is how it works:
14383 Org moves all entries found in
14384 @file{mobileorg.org}@footnote{@file{mobileorg.org} will be empty after this
14385 operation.} and appends them to the file pointed to by the variable
14386 @code{org-mobile-inbox-for-pull}. Each captured entry and each editing event
14387 will be a top-level entry in the inbox file.
14389 After moving the entries, Org will attempt to implement the changes made in
14390 @i{MobileOrg}. Some changes are applied directly and without user
14391 interaction. Examples are all changes to tags, TODO state, headline and body
14392 text that can be cleanly applied. Entries that have been flagged for further
14393 action will receive a tag @code{:FLAGGED:}, so that they can be easily found
14394 again. When there is a problem finding an entry or applying the change, the
14395 pointer entry will remain in the inbox and will be marked with an error
14396 message. You need to later resolve these issues by hand.
14398 Org will then generate an agenda view with all flagged entries. The user
14399 should then go through these entries and do whatever actions are necessary.
14400 If a note has been stored while flagging an entry in @i{MobileOrg}, that note
14401 will be displayed in the echo area when the cursor is on the corresponding
14406 Pressing @kbd{?} in that special agenda will display the full flagging note in
14407 another window and also push it onto the kill ring. So you could use @kbd{?
14408 z C-y C-c C-c} to store that flagging note as a normal note in the entry.
14409 Pressing @kbd{?} twice in succession will offer to remove the
14410 @code{:FLAGGED:} tag along with the recorded flagging note (which is stored
14411 in a property). In this way you indicate, that the intended processing for
14412 this flagged entry is finished.
14417 If you are not able to process all flagged entries directly, you can always
14418 return to this agenda view@footnote{Note, however, that there is a subtle
14419 difference. The view created automatically by @kbd{M-x org-mobile-pull
14420 @key{RET}} is guaranteed to search all files that have been addressed by the
14421 last pull. This might include a file that is not currently in your list of
14422 agenda files. If you later use @kbd{C-c a ?} to regenerate the view, only
14423 the current agenda files will be searched.} using @kbd{C-c a ?}.
14425 @node History and Acknowledgments, Main Index, MobileOrg, Top
14426 @appendix History and acknowledgments
14427 @cindex acknowledgments
14431 Org was born in 2003, out of frustration over the user interface of the Emacs
14432 Outline mode. I was trying to organize my notes and projects, and using
14433 Emacs seemed to be the natural way to go. However, having to remember eleven
14434 different commands with two or three keys per command, only to hide and show
14435 parts of the outline tree, that seemed entirely unacceptable to me. Also,
14436 when using outlines to take notes, I constantly wanted to restructure the
14437 tree, organizing it parallel to my thoughts and plans. @emph{Visibility
14438 cycling} and @emph{structure editing} were originally implemented in the
14439 package @file{outline-magic.el}, but quickly moved to the more general
14440 @file{org.el}. As this environment became comfortable for project planning,
14441 the next step was adding @emph{TODO entries}, basic @emph{timestamps}, and
14442 @emph{table support}. These areas highlighted the two main goals that Org
14443 still has today: to be a new, outline-based, plain text mode with innovative
14444 and intuitive editing features, and to incorporate project planning
14445 functionality directly into a notes file.
14447 Since the first release, literally thousands of emails to me or to
14448 @email{emacs-orgmode@@gnu.org} have provided a constant stream of bug
14449 reports, feedback, new ideas, and sometimes patches and add-on code.
14450 Many thanks to everyone who has helped to improve this package. I am
14451 trying to keep here a list of the people who had significant influence
14452 in shaping one or more aspects of Org. The list may not be
14453 complete, if I have forgotten someone, please accept my apologies and
14456 Before I get to this list, a few special mentions are in order:
14459 @item Bastien Guerry
14460 Bastien has written a large number of extensions to Org (most of them
14461 integrated into the core by now), including the LaTeX exporter and the plain
14462 list parser. His support during the early days, when he basically acted as
14463 co-maintainer, was central to the success of this project. Bastien also
14464 invented Worg, helped establishing the Web presence of Org, and sponsors
14465 hosting costs for the orgmode.org website.
14466 @item Eric Schulte and Dan Davison
14467 Eric and Dan are jointly responsible for the Org-babel system, which turns
14468 Org into a multi-language environment for evaluating code and doing literate
14469 programming and reproducible research.
14471 John has contributed a number of great ideas and patches directly to Org,
14472 including the attachment system (@file{org-attach.el}), integration with
14473 Apple Mail (@file{org-mac-message.el}), hierarchical dependencies of TODO
14474 items, habit tracking (@file{org-habits.el}), and encryption
14475 (@file{org-crypt.el}). Also, the capture system is really an extended copy
14476 of his great @file{remember.el}.
14477 @item Sebastian Rose
14478 Without Sebastian, the HTML/XHTML publishing of Org would be the pitiful work
14479 of an ignorant amateur. Sebastian has pushed this part of Org onto a much
14480 higher level. He also wrote @file{org-info.js}, a Java script for displaying
14481 webpages derived from Org using an Info-like or a folding interface with
14482 single-key navigation.
14485 @noindent OK, now to the full list of contributions! Again, please let me
14486 know what I am missing here!
14491 @i{Russel Adams} came up with the idea for drawers.
14493 @i{Thomas Baumann} wrote @file{org-bbdb.el} and @file{org-mhe.el}.
14495 @i{Christophe Bataillon} created the great unicorn logo that we use on the
14498 @i{Alex Bochannek} provided a patch for rounding timestamps.
14500 @i{Jan Böcker} wrote @file{org-docview.el}.
14502 @i{Brad Bozarth} showed how to pull RSS feed data into Org-mode files.
14504 @i{Tom Breton} wrote @file{org-choose.el}.
14506 @i{Charles Cave}'s suggestion sparked the implementation of templates
14507 for Remember, which are now templates for capture.
14509 @i{Pavel Chalmoviansky} influenced the agenda treatment of items with
14512 @i{Gregory Chernov} patched support for Lisp forms into table
14513 calculations and improved XEmacs compatibility, in particular by porting
14514 @file{nouline.el} to XEmacs.
14516 @i{Sacha Chua} suggested copying some linking code from Planner.
14518 @i{Baoqiu Cui} contributed the DocBook exporter.
14520 @i{Eddward DeVilla} proposed and tested checkbox statistics. He also
14521 came up with the idea of properties, and that there should be an API for
14524 @i{Nick Dokos} tracked down several nasty bugs.
14526 @i{Kees Dullemond} used to edit projects lists directly in HTML and so
14527 inspired some of the early development, including HTML export. He also
14528 asked for a way to narrow wide table columns.
14530 @i{Thomas S. Dye} contributed documentation on Worg and helped integrating
14531 the Org-Babel documentation into the manual.
14533 @i{Christian Egli} converted the documentation into Texinfo format, inspired
14534 the agenda, patched CSS formatting into the HTML exporter, and wrote
14535 @file{org-taskjuggler.el}.
14537 @i{David Emery} provided a patch for custom CSS support in exported
14540 @i{Nic Ferrier} contributed mailcap and XOXO support.
14542 @i{Miguel A. Figueroa-Villanueva} implemented hierarchical checkboxes.
14544 @i{John Foerch} figured out how to make incremental search show context
14545 around a match in a hidden outline tree.
14547 @i{Raimar Finken} wrote @file{org-git-line.el}.
14549 @i{Mikael Fornius} works as a mailing list moderator.
14551 @i{Austin Frank} works as a mailing list moderator.
14553 @i{Eric Fraga} drove the development of BEAMER export with ideas and
14556 @i{Niels Giesen} had the idea to automatically archive DONE trees.
14558 @i{Nicolas Goaziou} rewrote much of the plain list code.
14560 @i{Kai Grossjohann} pointed out key-binding conflicts with other packages.
14562 @i{Bernt Hansen} has driven much of the support for auto-repeating tasks,
14563 task state change logging, and the clocktable. His clear explanations have
14564 been critical when we started to adopt the Git version control system.
14566 @i{Manuel Hermenegildo} has contributed various ideas, small fixes and
14569 @i{Phil Jackson} wrote @file{org-irc.el}.
14571 @i{Scott Jaderholm} proposed footnotes, control over whitespace between
14572 folded entries, and column view for properties.
14574 @i{Matt Jones} wrote @i{MobileOrg Android}.
14576 @i{Tokuya Kameshima} wrote @file{org-wl.el} and @file{org-mew.el}.
14578 @i{Shidai Liu} ("Leo") asked for embedded La@TeX{} and tested it. He also
14579 provided frequent feedback and some patches.
14581 @i{Matt Lundin} has proposed last-row references for table formulas and named
14582 invisible anchors. He has also worked a lot on the FAQ.
14584 @i{David Maus} wrote @file{org-atom.el}, maintains the issues file for Org,
14585 and is a prolific contributor on the mailing list with competent replies,
14586 small fixes and patches.
14588 @i{Jason F. McBrayer} suggested agenda export to CSV format.
14590 @i{Max Mikhanosha} came up with the idea of refiling.
14592 @i{Dmitri Minaev} sent a patch to set priority limits on a per-file
14595 @i{Stefan Monnier} provided a patch to keep the Emacs-Lisp compiler
14598 @i{Richard Moreland} wrote @i{MobileOrg} for the iPhone.
14600 @i{Rick Moynihan} proposed allowing multiple TODO sequences in a file
14601 and being able to quickly restrict the agenda to a subtree.
14603 @i{Todd Neal} provided patches for links to Info files and Elisp forms.
14605 @i{Greg Newman} refreshed the unicorn logo into its current form.
14607 @i{Tim O'Callaghan} suggested in-file links, search options for general
14608 file links, and TAGS.
14610 @i{Osamu Okano} wrote @file{orgcard2ref.pl}, a perl program to create a text
14611 version of the reference card.
14613 @i{Takeshi Okano} translated the manual and David O'Toole's tutorial
14616 @i{Oliver Oppitz} suggested multi-state TODO items.
14618 @i{Scott Otterson} sparked the introduction of descriptive text for
14619 links, among other things.
14621 @i{Pete Phillips} helped during the development of the TAGS feature, and
14622 provided frequent feedback.
14624 @i{Martin Pohlack} provided the code snippet to bundle character insertion
14625 into bundles of 20 for undo.
14627 @i{T.V. Raman} reported bugs and suggested improvements.
14629 @i{Matthias Rempe} (Oelde) provided ideas, Windows support, and quality
14632 @i{Paul Rivier} provided the basic implementation of named footnotes. He
14633 also acted as mailing list moderator for some time.
14635 @i{Kevin Rogers} contributed code to access VM files on remote hosts.
14637 @i{Frank Ruell} solved the mystery of the @code{keymapp nil} bug, a
14638 conflict with @file{allout.el}.
14640 @i{Jason Riedy} generalized the send-receive mechanism for Orgtbl tables with
14643 @i{Philip Rooke} created the Org reference card, provided lots
14644 of feedback, developed and applied standards to the Org documentation.
14646 @i{Christian Schlauer} proposed angular brackets around links, among
14649 @i{Paul Sexton} wrote @file{org-ctags.el}.
14651 Linking to VM/BBDB/Gnus was first inspired by @i{Tom Shannon}'s
14652 @file{organizer-mode.el}.
14654 @i{Ilya Shlyakhter} proposed the Archive Sibling, line numbering in literal
14655 examples, and remote highlighting for referenced code lines.
14657 @i{Stathis Sideris} wrote the @file{ditaa.jar} ASCII to PNG converter that is
14658 now packaged into Org's @file{contrib} directory.
14660 @i{Daniel Sinder} came up with the idea of internal archiving by locking
14663 @i{Dale Smith} proposed link abbreviations.
14665 @i{James TD Smith} has contributed a large number of patches for useful
14666 tweaks and features.
14668 @i{Adam Spiers} asked for global linking commands, inspired the link
14669 extension system, added support for mairix, and proposed the mapping API.
14671 @i{Ulf Stegemann} created the table to translate special symbols to HTML,
14672 LaTeX, UTF-8, Latin-1 and ASCII.
14674 @i{Andy Stewart} contributed code to @file{org-w3m.el}, to copy HTML content
14675 with links transformation to Org syntax.
14677 @i{David O'Toole} wrote @file{org-publish.el} and drafted the manual
14678 chapter about publishing.
14680 @i{Sebastien Vauban} reported many issues with LaTeX and BEAMER export and
14681 enabled source code highlighling in Gnus.
14683 @i{Stefan Vollmar} organized a video-recorded talk at the
14684 Max-Planck-Institute for Neurology. He also inspired the creation of a
14685 concept index for HTML export.
14687 @i{J@"urgen Vollmer} contributed code generating the table of contents
14690 @i{Samuel Wales} has provided important feedback and bug reports.
14692 @i{Chris Wallace} provided a patch implementing the @samp{QUOTE}
14695 @i{David Wainberg} suggested archiving, and improvements to the linking
14698 @i{Carsten Wimmer} suggested some changes and helped fix a bug in
14701 @i{Roland Winkler} requested additional key bindings to make Org
14704 @i{Piotr Zielinski} wrote @file{org-mouse.el}, proposed agenda blocks
14705 and contributed various ideas and code snippets.
14709 @node Main Index, Key Index, History and Acknowledgments, Top
14710 @unnumbered Concept index
14714 @node Key Index, Command and Function Index, Main Index, Top
14715 @unnumbered Key index
14719 @node Command and Function Index, Variable Index, Key Index, Top
14720 @unnumbered Command and function index
14724 @node Variable Index, , Command and Function Index, Top
14725 @unnumbered Variable index
14727 This is not a complete index of variables and faces, only the ones that are
14728 mentioned in the manual. For a more complete list, use @kbd{M-x
14729 org-customize @key{RET}} and then click yourself through the tree.
14736 arch-tag: 7893d1Fe-cc57-4d13-b5e5-f494a1CBC7ac
14739 @c Local variables:
14741 @c indent-tabs-mode: nil
14742 @c paragraph-start: "
\b\\|^@[a-zA-Z]*[ \n]\\|^@x?org\\(key\\|cmd\\)\\|\f\\|[ ]*$"
14743 @c paragraph-separate: "
\b\\|^@[a-zA-Z]*[ \n]\\|^@x?org\\(key\\|cmd\\)\\|[ \f]*$"
14747 @c LocalWords: webdavhost pre